Bitcoin price faces resistance at $116,000, a high-timeframe confluence zone. Multiple rejections raise concerns that a bull trap could form if price loses momentum and key levels. Bitcoin (BTC) price has surged to the $116,000 level on Tuesday, testing a…
Increased Bitcoin selling by long-term holders may signal shifting market dynamics, potentially impacting future price stability and investor strategies.
Intuition launches its layer 3 Information Finance-driven mainnet to build a decentralized trust layer for AI and the internet following an $8.5 million funding round. According to a press release received by crypto.news, Intuition protocol has officially launched its mainnet…
Multi-agent protocol Adapt or ANP3 has been selected to be the first project to launch on Sui ecosystem’s AI launchpad Surge. The project is known for facilitating quantitative trading. On Oct. 29, Sui’s AI launchpad Surge announced that it has…
Grayscale Solana ETF intends to pass on 77% of net staking rewards, directly accruing that value into the product’s net asset value for investors. According to a press release dated Oct. 29, Grayscale Investments has launched its Grayscale Solana Trust…
Michael Saylor has outlined a future where Bitcoin powers the most efficient credit instruments in financial history. In a recent Money 20/20 interview, Bitcoin magnate Michael Saylor sat down with Scott Melker, host of The Wolf of All Streets, to…
Nasdaq-listed shipping company OceanPal Inc. is launching NEAR corporate treasury, joining a growing trend of non-crypto firms diversifying into digital assets. Nasdaq-listed OceanPal Inc., a global shipping company, has announced the completion of a US $120 million private investment in public equity…
Dogecoin moved past the $0.20 mark as crypto markets showed a mild rebound. According to market feeds, DOGE traded around $0.20261 at one check, and later reached $0.21 after a small uptick. Bitcoin was holding above $114,000 and Ethereum hovered above $4,200, giving the rally some broader support.
Dogecoin Whale Purchases Spark Buying
According to reports, large holders bought more than 327 million DOGE in the last 24 hours. That wave of big trades coincided with trading volume that rose about 10% above weekly averages.
The latest move signals stronger than usual activity. The purchases were picked up by on-chain trackers and have been pointed to as a likely reason for the recent price movement.
Technical Setup Points To A Tight Range
Based on reports from chart watchers, Dogecoin is trading inside a symmetrical triangle — a pattern that usually means price is being squeezed and could break out in either direction.
The Relative Strength Index stood at 58, which suggests the coin is neither overbought nor oversold. The MACD line is above its signal line, and the histogram shows modest upward momentum, though analysts caution it is not yet a strong surge.
Key Levels To Watch
Traders say a clear move above $0.22 would be the first sign that the bulls are in charge. On the upside, some market watchers list $0.25 as the next meaningful barrier, and a run toward $0.26+ has been floated as a possible target if momentum builds.
On the flip side, a drop below $0.18 could open the door to further losses and bring the consolidation phase back into focus.
Market Sentiment Remains Mixed
Reports have disclosed that DOGE advanced 1.35% to $0.21 during the session, marking its first close above the $0.2026 resistance level since August.
Still, a number of indicators suggest the move is tentative. Volume gains and whale interest are positive signs, but analysts are waiting for confirmation from price action and higher volume on a breakout.
What Could Go Wrong
There are risks. The triangle pattern can break to the downside as easily as it can break up, and the current momentum readings are moderate rather than strong.
If selling pressure mounts or if large wallets begin to shift coins back to exchanges, gains could be reversed quickly. Also, wider market swings in Bitcoin or Ethereum would likely pull DOGE along.
Watch The $0.22 Line
In short, DOGE is showing early signs of life, but a decisive outcome is not yet clear. Traders should watch $0.22 closely; a clean break with above-average volume would increase the odds of a move toward $0.25 and beyond.
If that level does not hold, the market may settle back into the $0.18–$0.22 range for a while longer.
Featured image from Unsplash, chart from TradingView
Wintermute, one of crypto’s largest market makers, struck an overtly risk-on tone in a Monday market update on X, arguing that a dovish macro turn and thawing US–China tensions have reset positioning and liquidity into a friendlier Q4 regime. In a post dated October 28, the firm wrote that “risk appetite is returning as softer CPI data and improving Trump-Xi relations lifted markets, with yields easing and volatility declining,” adding that “Bitcoin reclaimed $115k on ETF inflows and short squeezes, while DeFi and AI sectors led the recovery.”
Wintermute’s Bullish Crypto Outlook For Q4
The desk framed the impulse as both macro- and microstructure-driven. On the macro side, Wintermute pointed to “a softer US CPI print (3.0% YoY vs 3.1% expected)” and “the announcement of a Trump-Xi summit in Seoul,” which it said catalyzed “a broad rebound across assets” as the S&P 500 gained 1.9%, the VIX hovered “around 16,” and Treasury yields eased with rate-cut odds firming into this week’s Federal Reserve meeting.
On the crypto side, the update said “Bitcoin performed well with a 5.3% gain, climbing above $115k… amplified by $160m in short liquidations,” while “Ethereum tracked higher toward $4,200,” and “gold unwound nearly 7% from its highs, signaling a rotation from defensive assets into risk assets.”
Wintermute characterized the advance as broadening beneath the surface. “DeFi and AI names led gains on strong protocol revenue prints and improving on-chain activity,” while “Utilities and Tooling benefited from infrastructure-related rotation as new L2 deployments and restaking primitives drew liquidity.”
Derivatives posture turned supportive, too: “On the perp side, funding rates turned positive again across most majors… though positioning remains far from crowded.” The firm also flagged a turn in base money for crypto beta: “Stablecoin supply is ticking higher for the first time since September, reinforcing that macro tailwinds are beginning to translate into fresh inflows.
Spot demand from US spot ETFs, according to Wintermute, continues to anchor the structure even as activity cooled. “US spot BTC ETFs absorbed moderate inflows through the week even as volumes thinned, underscoring sticky structural demand.” Meanwhile, derivatives leverage “is rebuilding at a measured pace after the early-month flush,” which the firm framed as healthier—“cleaner leverage and more balanced funding.”
The house view into November is unambiguously constructive and leans on seasonality and positioning. One passage distilled the stance: “While Uptober had a bit of a false start, macro tailwinds, cooling inflation, ‘stabilizing’ geopolitical tension and a dovish FED are setting the stage for a supportive rest of the year, which historically (Q4) has been the strongest for Bitcoin.”
In its closing summary, Wintermute reiterated that “positioning is cleaner, volatility subdued, and capital rotation is gradually steering toward crypto. With liquidity conditions improving and sentiment stabilising, the setup into Q4 remains constructive, favouring further risk-on continuation.”
A Decisive Week For Crypto
The note drew immediate amplification from market commentators. DeFi analyst Ignas compressed the message into a trading takeaway: “Wintermute is telling you to max bid,” citing “yields… easing, volatility… down, and BTC reclaimed 115k helped by ETF inflows and short squeezes.” He highlighted Wintermute’s own line that “macro tailwinds, cooling inflation, ‘stabilizing’ geopolitical tension and a dovish FED are setting the stage for a supportive rest of the year.”
Whether this marks an outright regime shift or a tactically favorable window will hinge on this week’s event risk—namely the Fed decision and any concrete outcomes from the Trump–Xi engagement.
Wintermute, however, is explicit about the current state of play: markets are “rotating back into risk” with “cleaner positioning” and “calmer volatility,” Bitcoin “has reclaimed early-October losses with steady ETF inflows,” and sector leadership in DeFi and AI is consistent with an early-risk rotation. “With cleaner positioning, calmer volatility, and better macro visibility, the setup into November looks healthy for further recovery and rotation across crypto,” the firm concluded.
At press time, the total crypto market cap stood at $3.78 trillion.
Smart money is flowing into utility-focused presales ahead of altcoin season.
$XRP is once again ignoring the broader market while Bitcoin and Ethereum decline red.
Currently hovering above $2.65 with a cheeky 1.5% gain, $XRP didn’t get the memo that everyone else is having a bad time.
According to crypto expert CRYPTOWZRD, $XRP needs to stay above the $2.62 support level, as breaking through the $2.75 resistance could lead to a surge toward $3.
$XRP whales are accumulating at levels we haven’t seen before. While retail investors are doom-scrolling through red candles, smart money is quietly loading its position.
If you’re not positioning yourself in the best altcoins to buy now, you might be late to the party. Again.
While everyone’s watching $XRP test support levels with the focus of a hawk, let’s discuss three presale altcoins that could surge during this altcoin season.
1. Best Wallet Token ($BEST) – The Infrastructure Play Whales Are Quietly Loading
Prioritize hardware support, swaps/bridges, EVM + non-EVM, and strong security (audits, phishing alerts, biometrics, social recovery/MPC). Skip custodial risk and outdated add-ons, choose speed, safety, and full control.
Best Wallet is more than a wallet; it’s a comprehensive DeFi and NFT hub with a presale launchpad on the horizon. It speaks multi-chain fluently, which matters when altcoin season arrives and every chain comes to life.
Remember juggling seven wallets last cycle? Yeah—Best Wallet turns that chaos into one clean, connected stack.
Best Wallet token ($BEST) holders get exclusive access to early presale opportunities, reduced trading fees, and governance rights over which projects get featured on the platform. It’s a VIP pass to the hottest club filled with degens, and the bouncer is a smart contract.
Currently in presale at $0.025865, the token has already raised over $16.7M from investors who clearly understand that infrastructure plays win in bull markets, including a $33K buy in just 10 hours ago.
When $XRP finally rips past $2.75 and sparks the altcoin feeding frenzy, you’ll want a wallet built for chaos. Best Wallet is that stack, multi-chain, fast, and battle-ready. Get in early, and you’re positioned if volumes explode at launch.
2. Bitcoin Hyper ($HYPER) – The Layer 2 That Finally Makes Bitcoin Usable
Bitcoin is painfully slow with just 3-7 transactions per second. We’ve all been there, waiting 30 minutes for a transaction to confirm while watching the crypto market move without you, like you’re stuck in traffic while everyone else is already at the party.
Bitcoin Hyper ($HYPER) decided that wasn’t good enough and built a Layer 2 rollup for Bitcoin.
Bitcoin Hyper fuses Solana’s SVM with Bitcoin’s battle-tested security. Think Bitcoin’s trust with Solana-level speed: near-instant finality, tiny fees, and the same hard security that made BTC the OG.
The $HYPER token is currently in presale at $0.013185, and the project has already raised over $25.1M. Whale buys of $379.9K and $274K show that smart money is recognizing that Bitcoin needs scaling solutions and Bitcoin Hyper is actually delivering.
The tokenomics are refreshing, with 30% allocated to development, as it appears they genuinely want to build something. Novel concept in crypto, I know.
The presale is structured in stages with price increases as it progresses, so early birds genuinely do get better entry points. Learn how to buy Bitcoin Hyper before the next price increase.
Staking is available from day one, and with Bitcoin’s dominance likely to remain strong, regardless of what happens in the altcoin market, $HYPER offers a solid hedge that still provides sweet presale upside potential.
3. DeepSnitch AI ($DSNT) – The Intelligence Edge That Separates Winners from Exit Liquidity
Wouldn’t it be nice to know what the whales are doing before everyone else does? That’s exactly what DeepSnitch AI is building, and it’s about time someone did this properly.
DeepSnitch combines artificial intelligence with blockchain surveillance tools to provide regular traders with the same insights that whales and institutions have been using for years.
Five AI-powered tools analyze wallet movements, identify accumulation patterns, detect suspicious activity, and provide a heads-up when smart money is making moves.
The DeepSnitch AI token ($DSNT) is currently in Stage 2 presale at just $0.02032, having raised over $476K. That’s dirt cheap for a project with actual utility that solves a real problem.
When $XRP finally breaks through $2.75 and altcoin season goes nuclear, having DeepSnitch AI in your toolkit means you’ll see the next wave coming before most people realize there’s a wave at all.
$XRP is testing support while whales stack sats and experts call for a potential run to $3. Whether you’re betting on $XRP to break through or hedging your bets with high-potential presales, position now or cry later.
Best Wallet token gives you the infrastructure, Bitcoin Hyper gives you the Bitcoin upside with actual functionality, and DeepSnitch gives you the intelligence edge.
If there was ever a time to position yourself for the next leg up, it’s probably now.
After a turbulent month, the Dogecoin price looks to stabilizing just around the $0.2 level, and it continues to show strength at this level. However, there are some developments on the meme coin’s chart that suggest that there could be some bearish headwinds that could lead to another crash. Crypto analyst MyCryptoParadise outlines this in a recent analysis, showing the possible directions that the Dogecoin price could be headed in as the market unfolds.
Dogecoin Price Is Facing Strong Resistance
The first thing that stands out is that the crypto analyst explains that the Dogecoin price is already seeing a lot of resistance, especially on the 4-Hour chart. Since the price was rejected below $0.21, it suggests that bears are already putting a lot of pressure on the price at this level.
Another interesting chart is the Dogecoin 1-Hour chart that shows a breakdown in the Rising Wedge. The fact that this breakdown occurred with bearish divergence increases the possibilities of a price decrease, pushing it back down toward the next major support.
The crypto analyst also shows that this downward move is still supported by the confluence that has shown up. On the Dogecoin 1-Hour chart, the 200EMA has also been acting as a dynamic resistance, adding more pressure to an already bearish chart.
From here, the crypto analyst advises investors to be cautious before entering into the meme coin. For the best time to enter, it is best to wait for the price breakdown toward lower levels before taking a position. If the current trend plays out, then it could see another 10% breakdown.
In the event of this breakdown, then the next major level lies just above $0.18, which is where support is piling up. A cleaner bearish candlestick pattern would ensure an entry with lower risk, before the Dogecoin price begins another bounce.
However, just like with any setup, there is still the possibility for invalidation and this time, the bulls could do it. The Dogecoin price would have to break out and make a candle above the resistance zone on the 4-Hour chart. Such a sustained break would invalidate the bearish setup and create room for a bullish continuation.
The second part of the year has seen a notable surge in the US stock market, while Bitcoin (BTC) and the broader cryptocurrency market has faced its share of uncertainty and significant corrections.
With the Nasdaq recently surpassing the 26,000 mark, leading analysts are now suggesting that this milestone could be a clear indicator for Bitcoin to finish the year at new highs.
What Historical Patterns Indicate
According to experts at The Bull Theory, the pattern observed with the Nasdaq reaching all-time highs typically suggests a flow of liquidity, an increased risk appetite, and a shift of capital into growth assets. As this phase develops, it often sets the stage for Bitcoin’s next significant movement.
Data compiled by the analysts supports this assertion. Historically, in the first 30 days following a Nasdaq all-time high, Bitcoin has averaged a gain of approximately 7%. This return tends to grow, reaching about 14% within 60 days and climbing to an average of 25% by the 90-day mark.
This pattern is not merely coincidental; it reflects a capital rotation where liquidity does not disappear but instead shifts from traditional markets into higher-risk assets like Bitcoin.
The current situation appears to follow a similar trajectory. The Nasdaq’s rise to 26,000 indicates a wave of liquidity building beneath the surface. With rate cuts beginning and quantitative tightening coming to an end, global capital is once again seeking yield.
This scenario mirrors the conditions that contributed to Bitcoin’s significant breakouts in previous years, particularly in 2017, 2020, and 2023.
As such, the analysts note that the next four to five months may represent an acceleration phase for Bitcoin, coinciding with a potential pause in equities, which could lead to crypto becoming the primary outlet for liquidity.
Bitcoin Poised For Breakout Similar To 2020-2021 Cycle
Analysts like Ash Crypto also noted on social media that the BTC/NASDAQ weekly chart is revealing a repeating pattern reminiscent of the 2020-2021 cycle, during which Bitcoin significantly outperformed traditional tech stocks. In both cycles, the October to March timeframe has historically prompted major upward movements.
After a period of consolidation within a rising wedge, the BTC/NASDAQ pair appears poised for another breakout. Should this pattern repeat, Bitcoin may see substantial gains compared to the Nasdaq in the fourth quarter and into early 2026, Ash Crypto noted.
Notably, this sets the stage for a major rally that could see Bitcoin prices surpassing current records of over $126,000. However, the market is still characterized by increased volatility, and there is no clear path ahead for BTC.
The leading cryptocurrency is trading at $113,350 after a 2% correction in Tuesday’s trading session, following an initial surge above $115,000. This puts BTC 6.5% below record highs.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
Updated on 29th October, 2025 $HYPE price analysis shows that Hyperliquid is moving closer to its highest level as strong inflows and active trading continue. The token has gained steadily in recent days, showing a clear upward trend.
This steady movement suggests strong buying interest and positive sentiment in the market. Experts believe this growth reflects investor trust and ongoing liquidity expansion in the Hyperliquid network. This performance highlights how the project continues to attract attention from traders and market participants worldwide.
What Makes Hyperliquid and Its HYPE Token Unique?
Hyperliquid operates on a custom-built Layer 1 blockchain designed for ultra-fast on-chain transactions. It can handle more than 200,000 orders each second, showing the strength of its technology.
This structure supports quick settlements and offers a smooth trading experience that matches some of the leading centralized exchanges. The project’s $HYPE token powers the network by giving staking rewards and governance rights while supporting the decentralized perpetual trading model.
Why Is $HYPE Drawing Increasing Market Attention?
$HYPE price analysis shows a surge in both user participation and capital inflow. Weekly stablecoin inflows reached $25 million, and the network’s Total Value Locked rose beyond $2.41 billion, placing Hyperliquid among the top ten Layer 1 chains globally.
This momentum has positioned it as the third highest earning protocol with weekly revenue surpassing $20 million. These figures highlight strong operational performance and growing trust among users in the Hyperliquid ecosystem.
Metric
Value
Resistance Levels
$48.88, $50.00
Key Target if Breakout Occurs
$59.00
Support Levels
$45.37, $44.17, $42.27
Total Value Locked
$2.41 billion
Weekly Stablecoin Inflows
$25 million
Weekly Revenue
Over $20 million
Trading Volume Increase
+35.9% week on week
Tech Throughput
>200,000 orders/sec
Money Flow Index (MFI)
Above 63
Staking & Governance
$HYPE token powers network
How Do Trading Volumes Reflect Investor Confidence?
Trading activity across Hyperliquid’s perpetual markets has soared, climbing 35.9% within a week. Market watchers see this rise as a sign of strong liquidity and deep participation from traders.
One independent analyst noted that the combination of high throughput and steady volume growth makes Hyperliquid one of the few decentralized exchanges that can match centralized platforms in efficiency. These observations strengthen the overall bullish sentiment reflected in the $HYPE price analysis.
What Are Analysts Saying About Potential Price Levels?
Technical readings from $HYPE price analysis show a key resistance area between $48.88 and $50.00. The Money Flow Index stays strong, suggesting constant capital inflows and active buying interest.
If $HYPE moves above the $48 mark, analysts expect a possible climb toward $59, which would retest its earlier highest level. If the price fails to hold above that range, a short pullback under the recent resistance line could still take place.
What Drives Hyperliquid’s Competitive Edge?
Experts point to Hyperliquid’s unique mix of technology, tokenomics, and growing institutional interest. Its HIP 3 upgrade opened new perpetual markets, and recent buyback programs supported by a $644 million Assistance Fund have helped maintain token stability.
Combined with whale accumulation and long term staking rewards, these actions show lasting demand. A trader from Singapore said that Hyperliquid’s fundamentals look stronger than most peers and its revenue clearly proves it.
Conclusion
$HYPE price analysis paints a clear picture of a token supported by real growth and rising participation. The steady increase in inflows, trading activity, and network revenue points to a strong and positive outlook for Hyperliquid.
Resistance near $48 may still test short term confidence among traders and investors. Even so, both technical and fundamental indicators suggest a lasting upward trend as Hyperliquid strengthens its position among leading decentralized trading platforms.
Glossary
Layer 1 Blockchain: The main network where all crypto moves happen.
Perpetual Futures: Trades with no end date, so traders can stay in anytime.
Money Flow Index: Shows if more people are buying or selling a token.
Resistance Level: A price where the token often slows down or pulls back.
Inflows: Money coming into a project, showing rising interest.
Frequently Asked Questions About HYPE Price Analysis
What does HYPE price analysis show?
The HYPE price analysis shows strong inflows and rising market momentum.
How much inflow did Hyperliquid record?
Hyperliquid recorded around $25 million in weekly inflows.
How is HYPE performing in the market?
HYPE is one of the top earning projects with over $20 million in weekly revenue.
What are the key price levels for HYPE?
The main levels are $48 and $59. If it goes above $48, it may reach $59 again.
What can cause the next HYPE rally?
More inflows, strong trading, and good market support can start the next rally.
What if the new crypto presale in Nov 2025 was already revving up, and your ticket was still unclaimed? Every bull run begins the same way: with investors hunting for the top crypto to invest in before it explodes. The trick isn’t chasing hype; it’s spotting fundamentals wrapped in meme energy that actually holds up. That’s the rare blend pushing today’s most talked-about new project toward orbit.
While Bitcoin Cash and Cronos are catching attention with their market updates, this new crypto presale in Nov 2025 has ignited a frenzy unlike anything else. It’s called MoonBull ($MOBU), a meme token with math, muscle, and momentum. The presale is stacking holders faster than expected, proving that community conviction still drives the biggest rockets.
Why the New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025 by MoonBull Is Built Different
MoonBull’s new crypto presale in Nov 2025 isn’t about hype; it’s about intelligent design. The project’s Bull’s Engine transforms every sell order into a self-sustaining cycle that strengthens the ecosystem, 2% adds to liquidity for deeper markets, 2% flows back to holders as reflections, and 1% is burned permanently. Instead of losing value, each transaction in MoonBull’s system reinforces its structure, tightening supply, increasing scarcity, and rewarding long-term conviction.
Crypto Update: BCH Holds Steady, CRO Expands, and MoonBull Steals the Spotlight as the New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025 4
Then comes the showstopper, 95% APY staking. Once Stage 10 arrives, holders unlock access to a massive 14.6 billion $MOBU pool dedicated solely to yield rewards. Daily compounding, a short two-month lock on earnings, and zero minimum staking barriers make it accessible for everyone. The result? A meme coin with the mathematics of sustainability, fair, transparent, and rewarding at every level.
MoonBull’s New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025 Could Turn $1,000 Into a Launchpad Win
MoonBull’s new crypto presale in Nov 2025 is currently blazing through its fifth stage at $0.00006584, raising over $500,000 and onboarding more than 1,600 holders. Stage 1 participants have already seen returns of 163.36%, and projections toward the $0.00616 listing price point indicate an astonishing 9,256% potential ROI. With each 27.40% step up, scarcity deepens and momentum multiplies, creating a presale that rewards timing as much as belief.
A $1,000 entry at this stage could yield a massive position before the next price surge. Every phase fills fast, tightening the window for early access. This isn’t a hype bubble, it’s structured velocity. MoonBull feels like catching a rocket just before ignition, quiet for now, but heavy with potential energy. Once the engines fire, hesitation turns to hindsight.
Bitcoin Cash ($BCH) Price Today: Quiet Strength Before the Next Push
Bitcoin Cash continues to hold steady, trading near $559.96 with only a mild 0.52% dip in the past 24 hours. Analysts highlight improving liquidity and on-chain volume, signaling renewed investor confidence. As Bitcoin Cash moves toward its 52-week high, its market data suggests the bulls are quietly building pressure beneath the surface. Traders see it as a potential breakout candidate heading into late 2025.
The recent uptick in network activity and its cost-efficient transaction model make Bitcoin Cash appealing to both long-term holders and active users. It’s not chasing a presale surge like MoonBull, but it’s reinforcing its role as a stable mid-cap performer. In a volatile market, consistency is its meme, proving sometimes the quietest assets pack the longest charge.
Cronos saw its price rise 2.61% to $0.1517 following confirmation of a $6.4 billion treasury partnership between Crypto.com and Trump Media & Technology Group. This development signals institutional confidence in the Cronos ecosystem and could inject new liquidity across its DeFi channels. Traders interpret it as a bullish catalyst, hinting at expanded visibility and capital inflows in the months ahead.
Beyond the headlines, Cronos continues strengthening its market fundamentals through scalable solutions and user-driven innovation. The new partnership underscores how established networks are pulling in traditional finance, while emerging players like MoonBull focus on grassroots community growth. Both approaches aim for expansion, but Cronos works top-down, and MoonBull rises bottom-up, powered by its believers.
Crypto Update: BCH Holds Steady, CRO Expands, and MoonBull Steals the Spotlight as the New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025 5
Conclusion
The new crypto presale in Nov 2025 led by MoonBull proves that innovation still belongs to the bold. Among top performers like Bitcoin Cash and Cronos, MoonBull rises as the project that fuses narrative, staking, and deflationary tokenomics into a single unstoppable engine. Its presale momentum, 95% APY staking pool, and transparent 23-stage model make it one of the most talked-about opportunities heading into 2026.
MoonBull’s presale is live now. Stages fill quickly, and each milestone pushes the price higher. The market rarely offers second chances this early; those who spot liftoff before the roar will ride the wave when others are just waking up to the launch.
Crypto Update: BCH Holds Steady, CRO Expands, and MoonBull Steals the Spotlight as the New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025 6
Frequently Asked Questions for New Crypto Presale in Nov 2025
What makes MoonBull’s new crypto presale in Nov 2025 different?
MoonBull’s auto-liquidity, burn, and reflection system ensures every transaction fuels growth instead of draining it. Each trade redistributes rewards, adds liquidity, and burns supply, creating continuous scarcity and reinforcing the ecosystem’s strength through self-sustaining tokenomics on Ethereum.
How high are the returns in MoonBull staking?
MoonBull holders can earn an impressive 95% APY starting from Stage 10. Rewards are calculated daily from a 14.6 billion $MOBU staking pool, offering consistent passive income and encouraging long-term holding for believers in the project’s bullish vision.
Is MoonBull safe and audited?
Yes. MoonBull is built on Ethereum’s ERC-20 standard and has undergone a professional third-party audit. Liquidity is locked to protect investors, and the verified smart contract ensures complete transparency, security, and fairness across all presale and post-launch operations.
How can investors join the presale?
Investors can join the MoonBull presale by connecting a wallet to the official dashboard, selecting the desired amount, and purchasing $MOBU tokens at the active stage price. Tokens are claimable after launch once the liquidity lock activates.
Can $ MOBU’s price grow after launch?
While market outcomes can’t be guaranteed, MoonBull’s deflationary design, staking rewards, and limited supply create strong potential for upward momentum. With each transaction burn and staking lockup, scarcity strengthens , supporting a bullish environment for long-term $MOBU growth.
Glossary
Presale: Early token offering before exchange listing.
Staking: Earning yield by locking tokens.
Reflections: Automatic token rewards from transaction fees.
The WLFI airdrop is live as World Liberty Financial launches a major rewards program for early adopters of its USD1 stablecoin. The company confirmed that 8.4 million WLFI tokens will be distributed to early users through its USD1 Points Program, marking one of the most significant reward events tied to a stablecoin ecosystem this quarter.
According to the source, the initiative has already generated more than $500 million in transaction volume in under two months, showing strong demand and growing trust in the USD1 ecosystem across major partner exchanges.
WLFI Airdrop Expands USD1 Rewards
The WLFI airdrop rewards users who traded or held USD1 on exchanges such as Gate.io, KuCoin, LBank, HTX, Flipster, and MEXC. Each partner platform will manage its own eligibility criteria, claim timelines, and reward distribution.
World Liberty Financial stated that the program’s purpose is to build liquidity and long-term engagement for USD1 pairs while giving WLFI holders a way to participate in ecosystem governance. In a recent update from a leading crypto news outlet, the company described the initiative as a “user-first rewards model” that merges stablecoin adoption with real-world utility.
The rollout comes as WLFI continues to gain ground among top-traded governance tokens, with trading activity rising sharply following the announcement.
This WLFI airdrop follows a busy month for World Liberty Financial. Earlier in October, the company announced a debit card connected to USD1 and compatible with Apple Pay. The card aims to make stablecoin payments as seamless as traditional transactions.
The team also revealed plans to tokenize real-world assets such as real estate and commodities, alongside a treasury partnership with Bitcoin miner Hut 8. These efforts aim to link blockchain finance with everyday spending, turning the WLFI token into more than a speculative asset.
At the time of writing, WLFI trades around $0.114, up roughly 9 percent over the past 24 hours. Analysts believe the ongoing airdrop could keep trading momentum high as new users join the USD1 network.
Analyst Views And Market Impact
Market analysts view the WLFI airdrop as a calculated push to cement user loyalty. One industry researcher noted that the structure “rewards actual engagement rather than passive holding,” adding that token distribution tied to activity often leads to stronger on-chain participation.
However, observers also note that World Liberty Financial continues to face scrutiny over USD1’s reserve attestations and the transparency of token unlocks. The company has pledged to expand third-party audits and publish regular reports to reinforce user confidence.
Despite mixed sentiment, the strategy of linking stablecoin rewards with governance tokens could influence future models across decentralized finance.
Conclusion
The WLFI airdrop is a clear signal of World Liberty Financial’s long-term vision to make stablecoin use both rewarding and functional. By distributing 8.4 million tokens to early USD1 participants, the project has tied user loyalty to real utility.
Whether WLFI maintains its current market momentum or faces short-term volatility, one thing is sure. This airdrop shows how incentive-driven ecosystems can fuel stablecoin adoption while strengthening community trust.
Glossary of Key Terms
WLFI Token: The native governance token of World Liberty Financial, used for rewards and voting within its ecosystem.
USD1 Stablecoin: A U.S. dollar-pegged digital asset forming the base of WLFI’s financial network.
Airdrop: A free token distribution used to reward early users or promote engagement.
DeFi: Decentralized financial services built on blockchain without intermediaries.
Liquidity Pairs: Token pairings that help maintain smooth trading on exchanges.
FAQs About WLFI Airdrop
What is the WLFI airdrop?
It’s the distribution of 8.4 million WLFI tokens to early USD1 users as part of the USD1 Points Program.
Who qualifies for the WLFI airdrop?
Users who traded or held USD1 on partner exchanges like KuCoin, Gate.io, and MEXC, following each exchange’s criteria.
When will WLFI airdrop rewards be distributed?
Timelines differ per exchange, though most distributions are expected in the coming weeks.
How might the WLFI airdrop affect token value?
Analysts expect short-term volatility and long-term value growth tied to USD1 adoption.
In the cryptocurrency world, it sometimes feels like everyone is holding their breath, waiting for the next big breakout. 2025 has already proven that the best crypto presales with 100x potential are where the real action happens. Investors seeking explosive returns are closely watching innovative projects like BullZilla ($BZIL), which is positioning itself as a major contender in the upcoming bull cycle. Alongside respected players like TRON and Cronos, known for their long-term stability, BullZilla is stealing the spotlight with a powerful presale structure designed to propel early investors toward outsized gains.
With the market beginning to stabilize after a roller-coaster ride, crypto enthusiasts are focusing on the top presales with 100x potential. Among these, BullZilla stands out. While TRON and Cronos offer solid foundations, BullZilla has crafted a unique presale structure that could lead to massive returns. The project’s Stage 8 presale has already raised nearly $1 million, and with a growing number of holders and a steadily rising token price, this presale is one you don’t want to miss.
BullZilla’s Presale Is Surging. Secure Your Spot Before The Next Price Jump!
TRON (TRX) Price Dips 1.13% Amid Stable Market Conditions
TRON (TRX), one of the more prominent players in the blockchain space, recently saw a 1.13% dip, trading at $0.2978. Despite this minor setback, the token has experienced substantial growth over the years, climbing more than 27,000% from its all-time low of $0.001091 in 2017. While it remains down by 32.42% from its peak of $0.4407 last December, TRON’s position is far from fragile. With a market cap of $28.19 billion and trading volumes of around $749.27 million, TRON’s ecosystem is firmly established in the world of decentralized applications (dApps), offering strong support to developers and users alike.
TRON’s continued growth is a clear indicator of its stability and adoption within the blockchain space. It offers scalability, low transaction fees, and supports a wide array of dApps. For investors, TRON offers a reliable investment, but unlike newer projects like BullZilla, it doesn’t provide the same high-risk, high-reward potential of early-stage presale investments. Its consistency makes it a good choice for conservative crypto investors seeking long-term stability, but without the massive returns seen in presale projects.
Frequently Asked Questions about TRON Coin
What makes TRON a reliable investment?
TRON offers low fees, strong scalability, and a large active ecosystem with continuous development. Its longstanding stability and adoption make it a dependable crypto choice during volatile market conditions.
How does TRON’s performance compare to new presales like BullZilla?
TRON delivers steady long-term growth, while BullZilla’s early presale phase offers higher upside potential. TRON is lower risk and established, whereas BullZilla offers higher rewards for investors seeking explosive returns.
BullZilla Presale Nears $1M Raised and Tops Charts Among the Best Crypto Presales with 100x Potential
In the world of best crypto presales with 100x potential BullZilla stands out for its unique approach and overwhelming community response. As of Stage 8 (Echoes of the Bull-A), BullZilla has already raised over $980K, with more than 31 billion tokens sold. The project has attracted over 3,300 holders and is rapidly approaching a major milestone. The next stage will see a 3.35% price increase from $0.00019906 to $0.00020573, signaling further upside. Investors who joined early have already experienced an ROI of over 3,361.91%, making it one of the most exciting presales in the current market.
TRX Price Holds $0.297, CRO Stabilizes at $0.152, and BullZilla Emerges as 2025’s Best Crypto Presale with 100x Potential 11
Investment Scenario: What $6,000 Could Yield with BullZilla
Imagine putting $6,000 into BullZilla at the current Stage 8 price of $0.00019906. If the price jumps 3.35% to $0.00020573 in the next phase, your investment could yield an impressive number of tokens, potentially valued at over $100,000 when the price hits its listing target of $0.00527. This kind of potential ROI is precisely what makes BullZilla one of the best presales to watch for investors looking for high-risk, high-reward opportunities.
How to Join BullZilla Presale
To participate in the BullZilla presale, visit the official presale website, connect a Web3 wallet such as MetaMask or Trust Wallet, purchase ETH through a trusted exchange, and transfer it to your wallet. Then swap ETH for $BZIL tokens directly on the platform. Tokens purchased during presale remain automatically locked until the event concludes, ensuring market stability and preventing early dumping. Vesting schedules, allocation details, and claim timelines are clearly visible on the dashboard, maintaining transparency and investor confidence at every step.
Frequently Asked Questions about BullZilla Presale
Why is BullZilla gaining so much attention?
BullZilla stands out due to its combination of meme coin hype and real utility. With innovative tokenomics and community engagement, it has captured the interest of investors seeking both growth and sustainability in presale projects.
What makes BullZilla’s presale unique?
BullZilla’s presale structure is driven by scarcity, with its Progressive Price Engine and Roar Burn Mechanism creating a deflationary environment. This ensures long-term growth for early participants and rewards holders who stake their tokens.
What’s the ROI potential for BullZilla presale investors?
Early investors in BullZilla have already seen an ROI of up to 3,361.91%. With its price set to rise, future investors could see substantial returns as the presale moves toward completion.
TRX Price Holds $0.297, CRO Stabilizes at $0.152, and BullZilla Emerges as 2025’s Best Crypto Presale with 100x Potential 12
Cronos (CRO) has declined 1.73% over the last 24 hours, trading at $0.1523. Despite this setback, Cronos remains a key player in the crypto market, with a total market cap of $5.49 billion. Trading volumes for the day stand at $21.22 million, and the total supply of CRO is 98.11 billion, with 36.07 billion in circulation. Since its all-time low in 2018, Cronos has surged over 1,200%, but it is still down by 84.32% from its peak in 2021. This price movement signals a consolidation phase for Cronos, with investors eyeing potential long-term growth opportunities once market conditions stabilize.
Frequently Asked Questions about Cronos coin.
What is Cronos’ role in the crypto ecosystem?
Cronos is the native currency of the Cronos blockchain, which is designed to facilitate the development and deployment of decentralized applications. It supports a wide range of dApps and is integral to the platform’s operations.
How does Cronos perform in comparison to other cryptos?
Cronos offers a stable investment with strong use cases, particularly in decentralized finance. While newer projects like BullZilla present high-risk, high-reward scenarios, Cronos appeals to investors seeking steady returns.
Conclusion
Among the best crypto presales with 100x potential BullZilla continues to emerge as the standout opportunity, while TRON and Cronos provide a stable backbone for cautious investors watching market trends closely. Their recent news signals markets cooling without collapsing, reflecting a healthy consolidation phase and encouraging accumulation rather than fear. TRON’s ecosystem continues to grow, with substantial transaction volume, and Cronos maintains relevance despite temporary dips. Still, momentum drives crypto returns, and BullZilla’s presale price stages rising by design position early supporters for major upside gains ahead.
BullZilla’s engineered scarcity, automated burn cycles, and staking incentives encourage holding as Stage 8 approaches $1 million in raised funds. That traction reflects strong demand before the token’s exchange listings unlock. TRON and Cronos remain reliable long-term plays, but neither offers BullZilla’s combination of early-access pricing and rapid community growth. Timing separates average returns from life-changing outcomes in crypto markets. Entering before the next 3.35 percent stage increase could lock in significant upside as excitement among many investors accelerates.
Bullzilla’s Presale Is Exploding. Join Now Before The Next Price Surge!
TRX Price Holds $0.297, CRO Stabilizes at $0.152, and BullZilla Emerges as 2025’s Best Crypto Presale with 100x Potential 13
This article is for informational purposes only and does not constitute financial advice. Readers should conduct their own research before investing in any cryptocurrency or presale project.
Open interest tied to XRP and Solana futures on the Chicago derivatives giant set fresh records this week, reaching roughly 3 billion dollars in notional value. The surge shows that the rotation into regulated altcoin exposure is not a passing fad. It is building depth. It is also changing where professional traders set risk.
What drove the jump
According to the exchange data summarized in the report, active positions rose to about 9,900 contracts across standard and micro XRP futures, and roughly 15,600 contracts across the Solana complex.
That stack translated into the 3 billion dollar open interest milestone, a level last approached only briefly in prior bursts of activity. Price context helps. At the time of publication, XRP hovered near 2.63 dollars and SOL traded around 196 dollars, suggesting the interest formed while both assets held firm ranges rather than blow-off spikes. That pattern usually points to stickier positioning.
A fast adoption curve for alt futures
The Solana standard contract, sized at 500 SOL, went live in March 2025. It crossed 1 billion dollars in open interest by August. XRP futures launched in May and cleared the same mark within three months. Few listed crypto products have scaled that quickly outside the two market leaders. The move reflects a broader institutional comfort with listed alternatives to offshore perpetuals and an appetite to hedge or express views without wallet plumbing.
Executives and liquidity providers see structural demand
Product leaders and market makers have been clear about why this corner is growing.
“The launch of these options contracts builds on the significant growth and increasing liquidity we have seen across our suite of Solana and XRP futures,”
said Giovanni Vicioso, Global Head of Cryptocurrency Products at the exchange, when unveiling options on the two futures in September. He added that contracts in two sizes give both institutions and active individual traders more flexibility to manage exposure.
The liquidity side is singing a similar tune.
“The launch of options on Solana and XRP futures is the latest example of the move beyond the staples of bitcoin and ether and demonstrates continued demand from the market to have exposure to a broader set of products,”
said Roman Makarov of DRW’s Cumberland unit. FalconX’s Joshua Lim pointed to the rise of digital-asset treasuries and access vehicles that need better hedging tools on these names.
Why the record matters for traders
Rising open interest on a regulated venue usually improves price discovery and narrows spreads. It also makes cash-and-carry and calendar strategies cleaner because funding and margin are standardized.
With options listed on both XRP and SOL futures, dealers can structure overlays instead of reaching for less transparent instruments. If the exchange’s plan to enable continuous crypto trading next year proceeds as outlined, the ease of managing weekend risk could improve further, which has been a longstanding pain point for traditional funds exploring digital assets.
The road ahead
The important tell is that these milestones arrived outside of a single news shock. The contracts scaled within months of launch, then broke records again as the market settled. That is usually what durable adoption looks like.
More participants are choosing listed instruments for exposure and hedging, and not only in the headline names. If flows remain steady, volatility episodes may start to resolve with less slippage as depth firms up across the curve. For altcoins, that is a quiet vote of confidence that goes beyond social buzz and into the realm of risk management.
Conclusion
The latest open interest highs in XRP and Solana futures show a maturing market where regulated rails are pulling in both liquidity and longer-horizon capital. With options support and potential improvements to trading hours, the toolbox is getting better. Traders who once avoided alt derivatives for operational reasons now have fewer excuses. The infrastructure is catching up to the interest.
FAQ
What is open interest and why does it matter here? Open interest is the number of outstanding futures or options contracts that have not been closed. Higher open interest on a regulated venue often signals deeper liquidity and cleaner price discovery for strategies like basis trades and hedges.
When did these futures launch? Solana futures launched in March 2025. XRP futures launched in May 2025. Both reached the 1 billion dollar open interest level within months.
Are options available on these futures? Yes. Options on Solana and XRP futures were announced for mid-October 2025, expanding the available hedging and trading structures.
Glossary of key terms
Notional open interest: The dollar value of all open contracts, calculated by multiplying contract size by the underlying price and the number of open positions. It lets traders compare depth across products with different sizes.
Cash-and-carry trade: A market-neutral strategy that involves buying the spot asset and selling the corresponding futures to capture the basis. It relies on reliable funding, margin terms, and liquid futures markets.
Calendar spread: A trade that goes long one futures expiry and short another to express a view on term structure or to manage funding risk through time, often used by dealers when options are active.
Continuous trading model: A venue structure that aims to offer round-the-clock trading with minimal maintenance windows, which can reduce gap risk during weekends and holidays.
This article was first published on The Bit Journal. Ethereum Surge sees the world’s second-largest cryptocurrency rapidly outpacing Bitcoin (BTC), as institutional investors increasingly shift their focus toward the leading smart contract platform dominating the digital asset landscape.
The institutional fund holdings in Ethereum have increased by an astounding 138% over the last year, making nearly four times the rate of growth of Bitcoin, indicating a significant change in market sentiment, and driving a great Ethereum surge in the global markets.
Ethereum Surge Fueled by Institutional Inflows
Once seen as merely an “alternative play” to Bitcoin, Ethereum is now stepping confidently out of Bitcoin’s shadow. Recent fund data shows that Ethereum holdings have soared to approximately 6.8 million Ethereum, which is mostly due to spot ETF inflows, enticing staking yields, and the increasing dominance of Ethereum throughout DeFi and asset tokenization.
Such institutional interest has brought additional momentum to the current Ethereum surge which has made it a dominant figure in the next crypto cycle.
Bitcoin’s Momentum Slows Amid Ethereum Surge
Conversely, Bitcoin still maintains its conventional purpose of a reserve asset of institutions, as there is a consistent though modest increase of 36% in the number of funds held of 1.3 million BTC.
As the number of institutional funds entering Bitcoin grows, it is slower than all other indices and may signify a slowdown in momentum, but Ethereum’s explosion signifies that investors are more willing to embrace growth and innovation.
Altcoin Market Signals Imminent Capital Rotation
Ethereum is not however the only altcoin that is gaining institutional momentum. The market first indications suggest that the long awaited altcoin rotation is possible to be already in action.
As Joao Wedson, the CEO of Alphractal, argues, the existing configuration is very similar to past crypto market cycles, where Bitcoin gains predominance only to see a dramatic shift in capitals to altcoins, usually due to a round of Ethereum surge and a fresh wave of market enthusiasm.
Altcoins Season Index shows the strongest momentum for BTC! However, I see it as strategic to start accumulating altcoins now, anticipating the upcoming rotation from BTC to Altcoins. Focus mainly on newer altcoins — history keeps repeating itself!
Wedson pointed out that only four of the 55 trailed altcoins have shown more performance in the last 60 days than Bitcoin. However, such a narrow performance is typically followed by a wide-ranging recovery in risk appetite a traditional indication of early accumulation.
This period of accumulation, analysts believe, is the point where newer altcoins quietly bottom, creating the next step of the rotation. Some of the tokens like Synthetix (SNX) and Binance Coin (BNB) have already started recording an increase in relative returns, which indicated that early-cycle measures are strengthening, in part with the broader Ethereum surge throughout institutional portfolios.
This trend is also supported by historical data. A long-term comparative chart of the altcoins versus Bitcoin reveals that altcoin booms have traditionally followed Bitcoin booms, in both the 2017 and 2021 cycles.
This keeps me awake at night
If this trend line extends into 2025/6 we should see the biggest alt season of all time
While some believe altcoins will never compete with Bitcoin again
Ranging into 2025, technical charts are once again showing a multi-year wedge breakout in various altcoins a pattern that has heretofore occurred before massive rallies. Should this trend continue to be true, the next market turn may already be shaping up, and the Ethereum surge may be at the forefront and reestablishing the balance of power in the worldwide crypto market.
Conclusion
As 2025 approaches, Ethereum’s dominance and the growing institutional shift toward altcoins signal a transformative phase for the crypto market. If historical patterns hold true, Ethereum could spearhead the next major rotation, setting the stage for a broader altcoin rally and redefining the digital asset landscape worldwide.
Follow us onTwitter andLinkedIn, and join ourTelegram channel to be instantly informed about breaking news!
Widely followed analyst Income Sharks has raised caution about the current XRP trend, laying emphasis on the OBV indicator. His commentary highlighted that XRP still looks stronger than most major assets.
Crypto influencer Crypto Bitlord, who has over 426,000 followers on X, has shaken the XRP community with a bold XRP price prediction. In a recent post, Bitlord highlighted the strength of the XRP community, calling it “one of the largest crypto communities on Earth.” He suggested that once XRP breaks through the $21 mark this cycle, it could trigger a major global reaction.
Despite its latest recovery attempt, Cardano (ADA) would still need a significant rally to overtake Solana in the global crypto rankings. The fresh wave of downturn that rocked the broader crypto market yesterday has once again affected Cardano’s recovery prospects.
The XRP reserve on Binance is depleting drastically on Binance, suggesting accumulation by long-term holders. While some panicked during the latest market uncertainty, smart money investors are taking in massive amounts of XRP.
XRP has been showing signs of recovery after a turbulent few weeks, but some analysts believe a short-term pullback may be imminent. For context, following the crash on Oct.
Following a sharp increase in liquidity and concentrated large-wallet positioning, the Virtuals protocol price is currently trading around $1.53. This creates a traditional high-beta background, where a short squeeze might develop rapidly if purchasing pressure continues. Speculative flows have increased…
Fedi, the Bitcoin company building on top of the open source Fedimint protocol — a privacy-centric bitcoin payments method using Chaumian e-cash — is emerging from a period of quiet development to announce a new groundbreaking feature. Set for release today, this new capability within the Fedi app aims to make the creation of multi-signature e-cash mints easy, private, and secure for communities worldwide with just a few clicks, aligning with cypherpunk principles of decentralization and user sovereignty.
Built into their increasingly popular Android and iOS apps, the new release allows users to easily create a new Fedimint federation with the help of G-bot, a friendly chatbot interface. Mint founders need to pay a basic service fee, add some basic information in minutes for the mint, and wait a few hours.
The G-bot then finds trusted anonymous Guardians to help form the user’s mint federation. This process decentralizes the custody of the mint’s bitcoin reserves — needed to operate an e-cash mint. It also helps prevent collusion as mint operators are anonymous from each other and would need to reveal themselves publicly to be able to find other key holders to collude.
This Fedimint protocol is fundamentally built on privacy, a cornerstone of Bitcoin and the cypherpunk movement. “The first line of the Cypherpunk Manifesto is that privacy is necessary for an open society in the electronic age. It’s not nice to have. It’s not convenient. It’s necessary.” Obi Nwosu, CEO of Fedi, told Bitcoin Magazine in an exclusive interview. He added a cautionary warning about the future, which the world would be wise to avoid: “Bitcoin without privacy is our worst nightmare. It’s 1984 coin, it’s the panopticoin.”
Founded in 2022, Fedi has been quietly working to deliver the promises of private digital cash to the world, based on one of the most promising technologies designed for that purpose, David Chaum’s 1982 Chaumian e-cash. This form of digital money almost made it into every copy of Windows 1995, proof of its scalability and efficiency, but ironically failed due to its centralization, as Chaum and Gates reportedly could not reach a final agreement on the deal.
Fast forward 30 years, and the Bitcoin community has taken on the challenge of bringing private digital cash to the world, leveraging new possibilities unlocked by the Bitcoin network, which may solve the fundamental trade-off of Chaumian e-cash, the need to trust a single counterparty mint that issues and redeems the e-cash bills for the underlying currency.
It is interesting to note that Bitcoin was designed as a solution to the fundamental trade-offs of e-cash. While e-cash relies on a trusted server to approve transactions that are properly funded, it can do so without knowing any personal user information, since the system is fundamentally built on cryptography and not identity. It nevertheless requires a trusted server, which can in theory emit more e-cash bills than it has reserves for, a form of the ‘double spending problem’ Satoshi Nakamoto sought to address in his Bitcoin white paper.
Centralized e-cash mints can also be more easily harassed by hostile governments, as the pre-Bitcoin history of digital cash shows. Bitcoin decentralized the mint by distributing the accounting process the mint does with the invention of the Bitcoin node, anyone that runs a node has a copy of all bitcoin transactions and can independently verify the accounting integrity of the system, thus solving the ‘double spending problem’.
The downside of Bitcoin’s approach is that it leaves a public record of all transactions, which is not great for privacy, and has hard theoretical limits in terms of how many transactions it can process per second — it is not very scalable — two limits which the e-cash systems do not have.
The downsides of centralized cryptocurrency platforms are something that Nwosu has deep professional experience with; he was the founder and CEO of Coinfloor, a centralized cryptocurrency exchange founded in 2014. The exchange was the “First ‘Publicly Auditable’ Bitcoin Exchange” according to a 2014 Coindesk, through an innovative auditing process called proof of reserves. Recalling back on his experience with the matter, Nwosu said, “Being solvent is a very big thing for me as well as being able to prove that cryptographically, if possible”. That experience and his concern over a future without private digital cash are clear motivations for why he co-founded Fedi.
Creating scalable, decentralized, private digital cash, however, is not easy, neither technically nor politically. To solve this fundamental problem of finance and computer science, many in the Bitcoin community have been looking for ways to combine the benefits of Bitcoin and Chaumian e-cash in order to solve — or at least mitigate — the downsides of both systems. The Fedimint protocol’s most important innovation in this field is the development of federated e-cash mints, leveraging the security of Bitcoin’s native smart contract capabilities, especially multi-signature transactions.
Bitcoin’s multi-signature script enables something new in finance, a transaction that can only be executed if more than one party agrees to sign. Banks may have shared accounts across multiple parties, but those are rules enforced by lawyers, who need to comply with local laws, ultimately giving final say to the local government. Bitcoin, by contrast, defends the integrity of a multi-signature with the full weight of its international proof of work network, making these agreements as good as gold and unlocking a new kind of federated financial institution. The Liquid Network, as well as Bitcoin’s Lightning Network, exists only thanks to this multi-signature technology.
Fedimint takes multi-signature to the next level, making the members unknown to each other through the G-bot, protecting users of that mint from the collusion of the guardians while also adding redundancy to the custody of mint bitcoin reserves, which makes hacks more difficult. Fedimint also protects Guardians from accidental loss of keys, as a threshold of Guardians can restore the stability of a federation, say 3 out of 4 signers, in case one loses their keys or gets compromised, on the topic Nwosu said “the bigger risk isn’t collusion but users forgetting passwords, which federations mitigate since the system continues if one guardian fails.”
Ultimately, Nwosu expects there to be “tens of thousands, if not hundreds of thousands, of federations, each with a different set of users using it.” These mints connect to each other using the Bitcoin standard and its various payment rails such as onchain Bitcoin and the Lightning Network “offering cryptographic privacy within each federation. Even when sending between federations via Lightning, privacy remains high because users are interchangeable within pools. No single point of trust or failure.”
One common critique of e-cash systems, even post Bitcoin, is regarding self-custody. Critics argue that e-cash, even in a federated network, is nevertheless a custodial trusted system of money, and on this topic, Nwosu had a particularly powerful insight: “If you have self-custody and no privacy, you don’t have self-sovereignty because someone knows exactly what you’re doing and can confiscate your money at any point.” Because e-cash does not leave an on-chain footprint, it can be fundamentally more private than any blockchain.
Mono Protocol’s presale is redefining 2025’s crypto landscape by focusing on real utility, cross-chain simplicity, and developer-first design. #partnercontent
Alternative for Germany or AfD, the second-largest party in the government, has introduced a motion to establish a strategic Bitcoin reserve following a similar move by France. On Oct. 29, the Alternative for Germany party, the second-largest opposition in the…
This Wednesday in focus on the crypto market are the XRP price's ETF-driven breakout to $4 and Ethereum nearing the Fusaka hard fork, while Sequans offloads $111 million in BTC ahead of FOMC and Big Tech reports.
Nate Geraci, President of Novadius Wealth, reveals expectations for XRP after Solana's strong ETF debut. The market anticipates XRP ETFs to launch anytime soon.
Is CBDC good? Ripple CTO David Schwartz makes a stunning revelation, arguing that its impact depends on whether it expands choice or restricts individual freedom.
Starting October 27, 2025, users can borrow USDT or USDC against their BTC holdings at rates from 5% APR.
MEXC Loans is a flexible lending service that allows users to pledge one cryptocurrency as collateral to borrow another.
Borrowed funds can be used for spot and futures trading, earn products, withdrawals, or general liquidity needs.
MEXC, a leading global cryptocurrency exchange, has expanded its MEXC Loans product by adding Bitcoin (BTC) as a collateral option.
Starting October 27, 2025, users can borrow USDT or USDC against their BTC holdings at rates from 5% APR, allowing them to access liquidity without selling their bitcoin.
MEXC Loans is a flexible lending service that allows users to pledge one cryptocurrency as collateral to borrow another.
Borrowed funds can be used for spot and futures trading, earn products, withdrawals, or general liquidity needs.
With BTC now available as collateral, users can access instant loans while retaining exposure to the price movements of their bitcoin. Interest accrues daily, and collateral is released once the loan is repaid.
Key benefits
Low-Cost Capital: Borrow at rates starting from 5% APR (daily interest rate = APR / 365)
Instant Loans: Borrow and repay anytime through a smooth, simple process
High Initial LTV: Up to 85%, among the most competitive in the market
Versatile Usage: Use borrowed funds freely across MEXC products
Enhanced Capital Efficiency: Retain BTC exposure while unlocking liquidity
Users must complete Primary KYC verification before accessing the service.
This expansion reflects MEXC’s commitment to providing flexible financial tools that maximise asset utility.
The exchange will continue enhancing its product to better support users’ trading and investment strategies within the digital asset ecosystem.
For complete product details and terms, please visit the MEXC Loans page.
About MEXC
Founded in 2018, MEXC is committed to being “Your Easiest Way to Crypto.”
Serving over 40 million users across 170+ countries, MEXC is known for its broad selection of trending tokens, everyday airdrop opportunities, and low trading fees.
Our user-friendly platform is designed to support both new traders and experienced investors, offering secure and efficient access to digital assets.
MEXC prioritises simplicity and innovation, making crypto trading more accessible and rewarding.
For media inquiries, please contact MEXC PR team: media@mexc.com
Risk Disclaimer:
This content does not constitute investment advice. Given the highly volatile nature of the cryptocurrency market, investors are encouraged to carefully assess market fluctuations, project fundamentals, and potential financial risks before making any trading decisions.
Solana price hovered around $194 amid a 4.5% dip in the past 24 hours.
However, holding near $200 amid potential bullish catalysts could be key to bulls’ advances.
Exchange-traded funds, interest rates cut and treasury asset bets top list of bullish markers.
Solana (SOL) price dipped below the $200 mark on Wednesday as cryptocurrencies showed caution ahead of the Federal Reserve’s interest rate decision.
However, despite the 3.7% slip in the past 24 hours, institutional interest remains high. The overall macroeconomic tailwinds are also aligning, and SOL’s price could explode alongside other cryptocurrencies.
What’s bullish for Solana?
Despite the lackluster performance in the past month, Solana’s fundamentals suggest substantial upside potential.
Multiple bullish drivers point to this optimistic outlook and could fuel gains in coming months.
For instance, the rollout of spot Solana ETFs is forecast to catalyze unprecedented institutional inflows. Bitwise’s and Grayscale’s products lead the charge, but more are queued for SEC sign-off.
Day one volumes have analysts saying that a democratized access to SOL for traditional investors via familiar brokerage platforms as a potential price booster.
The ETF fervor aside, anticipation around the Federal Reserve’s interest rate decision is high. E
conomists have doubled down on a 25-basis-point reduction in the federal funds rate on Oct. 29, and anticipate a further rate cut in December. Analysts say these should be a catalyst for risk assets like cryptocurrencies.
Solana’s network activity adds to this outlook,including as seen in ecosystem revenue and decentralized exchange volumes. The SOL token is also attracting notable treasury bets.
Western Union, the world’s largest money transfer provider, building on Solana is a huge nod for the ecosystem.
Bitcoin and crypto influencer Lucky summed the above in a post on X.
Solana is catching the worldwide attention these days…
1️⃣ Solana’s first ETF launched in the U.S., hitting $56M+ trading volume on day one.
2️⃣ $8M traded in just 20 minutes, ranking among the most active crypto ETF debuts ever.
Per CoinGecko, Solana’s price traded at lows of $194 in early Asian hours on Oct. 29.
This is after bulls failed to make a decisive breakout above the psychological $200 mark, a threshold that now acts as a key base for both bulls and bears.
With prices down 3.7% in the past 24 hours, SOL is looking at a scenario where negative movement could extend losses to the $180 mark.
On the flipside, gains could see bulls target $250 and then $300 in the short term.
From the technical point of view, SOL price is respecting the downtrend line formed from early October.
The Relative Strength Index (RSI) on the daily chart is flatlining in the neutral area around 47.
However, while the Moving Average Convergence Divergence suggests buyers still have an upper hand, the histogram indicates bullish momentum is weakening.
The outlook suggests SOL’s price has a key immediate range of $180–$210 that could indicate next targets.
BTC is down 1% in the last 24 hours and is now trading below $113k.
The Fed is expected to cut interest rates by at least 25 basis points today.
FOMC meeting dominates headlines
Bitcoin, Ethereum (ETH), and Ripple (XRP) are currently bearish as they are struggling to break above key resistance levels. Bitcoin has dropped below 113k and is now trading around $112,950 per coin.
This price action comes after Bitcoin’s price was rejected at the 78.6% Fibonacci retracement level. The bearish performance in the last few hours comes ahead of the FOMC meeting in a few hours.
The Federal Reserve is expected to cut interest rates by at least 25 basis points, a move that could see Bitcoin and other leading cryptocurrencies rally in the near term. The rate cut is expected despite the ongoing U.S. government shutdown, which caused a financial data backlog in the last three weeks.
Bitcoin could hit $120k if the bullish trend resumes
The BTC/USD 4-hour chart is bearish and efficient as Bitcoin has underperformed in the last 24 hours. The bearish performance comes after Bitcoin retested and faced rejection from the 78.6% Fibonacci retracement level at $115,137 earlier this week. It is now down 1% in the last 24 hours and is currently trading below the 50-day Exponential Moving Average (EMA) at $112,950.
The Relative Strength Index (RSI) on the 4-hour chart hovers around 60, indicating a bullish bias among traders. Furthermore, the Moving Average Convergence Divergence (MACD) showed a bullish crossover on Sunday, supporting the bullish thesis.
If Bitcoin holds its price above the $112k level and closes its daily candle above $115,137, it could extend the rally toward the key psychological level at $120,000.
However, failure to close above the $115,137 resistance level could see Bitcoin lose its recent momentum and decline toward the 61.8% Fibonacci retracement level at $106,453.
The token gained as web3 and gaming investor Animoca Brands makes a strategic investment, a move that helped AERO price extend 24-hours to over 10% and briefly surpass the $1 mark.
The Animoca Brands’ backing of Aerodrome Finance adds to the growing institutional interest in the decentralized exchange project on Base.
Animoca Brands acquires, stakes AERO
Animoca Brands announced its acquisition of AERO tokens on October 28, noting it made purchases on the open market. The company then staked all of these tokens for veAERO, demonstrating long-term commitment to Aerodrome Finance.
We've market acquired a position in $AERO and max-locked as $veAERO.@AerodromeFi is an innovative, next-generation AMM that has consistently captured over 50% of @base's DEX TVL, establishing itself as the central liquidity hub for the ecosystem.
Buying and staking AERO aligns with Animoca’s mission to generate value in open networks and support innovative protocols.
As noted in the post above, the company sees Aerodrome as a dominant player on Base. With more than 50% of the DEX total value locked (TVL) on the blockchain, Aerodrome has become the central liquidity hub for the ecosystem.
“Aerodrome is a key component in the engine behind Base’s DeFi growth and Coinbase is making it seamless for its CEX users to trade tokens which have liquidity on DEXs such as Aerodrome thus driving more value to Aerodrome voters. With sustainable tokenomics for $AERO and the team’s ability to execute, Aerodrome has proven its standing as a key player in Base infrastructure,” Animoca Brands posted on X.
The investment follows a pattern of institutional backing for Aerodrome, including previous acquisitions by entities like Coinbase Ventures and Wintermute Ventures.
Alexander Cutler, CEO of Dromos Labs and a core contributor to Aerodrome, lauded Animoca’s move. He noted that AERO’s value is accessible only through open market participation and active involvement.
Price outlook: AERO bulls eye breakout above $1
At the time of writing, AERO is up nearly 2% on the day and has extended the uptick to 10% in the past 24 hours.
Over the past week, AERO has climbed 26%. This sees it outperform the broader market gains and form an uptrend since touching lows of $0.70 on Oct. 17.
Currently, price hovers in a key range near $0.99 as bulls aim for a decisive breakout above the $1 psychological level.
If AERO strengthens above $1, it would allow bulls to target the next hurdles around $1.2 and then $1.34.
The RSI at 70 on the 4-hour chart nonetheless suggests gains will firmly push AERO into the overbought zone. However, the MACD points to strength for buyers as the signal line cuts above the zero line, suggesting bullish momentum.
Crypto firms offering financial products must obtain an AFSL by 30 June.
Bitcoin and NFTs are said to be excluded from the financial product category.
The Treasury has finished consultations on new crypto legislation.
Australia has tightened its regulatory framework for digital assets, introducing updated guidelines that define how crypto service providers will be classified and licensed.
The Australian Securities and Investments Commission (ASIC) announced revisions to its Information Sheet 225.
Firms offering services tied to financial products will now need to apply for an Australian Financial Services License (AFSL) and join the Australian Financial Complaints Authority by June 30.
The updated document aims to streamline compliance requirements, strengthen investor protection, and bring digital asset providers under the same regulatory standards as traditional financial institutions.
This marks a significant shift in Australia’s approach to overseeing crypto-related businesses and ensuring greater market transparency.
The move aims to bring greater oversight to the rapidly evolving crypto industry while maintaining flexibility for tokens like Bitcoin, which will not be treated as financial products under the new guidance.
Bitcoin excluded, but stablecoins under scrutiny
Under the revised guidelines, ASIC clarified that cryptocurrencies such as Bitcoin, gaming non-fungible tokens (NFTs), and tokenised event tickets do not fall under the financial product category.
However, stablecoins, wrapped tokens, tokenised securities, and yield-bearing products like staking services and tokenised real estate will require licensing.
ASIC also confirmed in-principle regulatory relief for stablecoin and wrapped token distributors to help transition into compliance ahead of broader legislative reforms.
The updated framework outlines that services offering financial returns or lock-up periods will be classified as financial products, ensuring investors in yield-based assets are protected under existing finance laws.
Industry welcomes clarity but warns of implementation challenges
The update has been broadly welcomed across the blockchain sector for providing long-awaited clarity.
Industry groups and legal experts said the move provides visibility on ASIC’s approach to regulating the digital asset ecosystem.
However, they warned that the transition could create logistical hurdles due to limited local expertise, banking restrictions, and insurance access.
Blockchain APAC’s CEO noted that ASIC’s approach of implementing policy ahead of final legislation brings short-term certainty but also leaves room for interpretation.
These “structural bottlenecks,” including resource and compliance constraints, could shift risks from legal to operational levels if not addressed promptly.
Transition underway as crypto firms prepare for licensing
Industry players are now restructuring their operations to align with the new rules.
The Digital Economy Council of Australia called the update a significant step toward mainstream regulation but expressed concern about ASIC’s capacity to process a large volume of licensing applications in time.
The move follows the Albanese government’s proposal in March for a unified framework that places crypto exchanges under existing financial services laws.
The Treasury concluded consultations last week on draft legislation that would formalise this transition, further aligning Australia’s crypto oversight with global regulatory trends.
The update marks a turning point for Australia’s digital asset market, setting a roadmap for compliance while signalling the government’s intention to balance innovation with investor protection.
Shiba Inu has once again captured the spotlight, but this time not just for its meme status. The last few weeks have painted a turbulent picture for SHIB price, shifting sentiment from hopeful recovery to cautious defense at critical support zones.
As market fatigue sets in across the meme coin sector, traders are monitoring every technical move, questioning whether the Shiba Inu price can truly break free from its bearish grip or if further declines await.
Shibarium TVL
One of the most pressing narratives surrounding the Shiba Inu price is the struggle of its layer-2 solution, Shibarium. As per DeFillama, the Shibarium network’s total value locked stands at just $883,449, barely holding above the $1 million mark. This figure has been sliding since February’s peak above $6 million.
The lackluster TVL signals that DeFi adoption on Shibarium is falling short and thus fails to validate the long-term utility narrative for SHIB. Successively, the low DEX volume ($8,798 in 24 hours) further confirms that on-chain activity is muted.
SHIB Price Analysis
Zooming into the charts, SHIB price currently sits at $0.00001018, marking a -1.14% drop in the last day. Trading volume in the past 24 hours totals $151 million, down 2.89%, hinting at weakening enthusiasm among both buyers and sellers. The price bounced off a 24-hour low at $0.00001002 and failed to clear resistance near its daily high of $0.00001041.
A pivotal technical observation is that SHIB broke below its 7-day SMA at $0.00001021. This move, coupled with rejection at the 23.6% Fibonacci retracement level $0.000011688, reflects persistent selling pressure from bears. Both MACD and RSI indicators paint a cautious outlook, with MACD showing weak bullish momentum and RSI lingering near 41, leaving room for further downside.
Most importantly, traders are consistently defending the key $0.0000095 support level. Although recovery attempts are stalling beneath the 200-day SMA at $0.000012712. The presence of a death cross since September reinforces the idea that bearish sentiment is still firmly in control.
FAQs
What is the current SHIB price trend?
The SHIB price trades below its weekly average, facing resistance at the 23.6% Fibonacci level. Weak technical indicators and a death cross imply a bearish trend for now.
Is Shiba Inu gaining DeFi traction through Shibarium?
Shibarium’s TVL remains below $1 million, signaling weak utility growth and limited DeFi adoption. Most activity in the ecosystem is muted, dampening its utility-driven upside.
Grayscale has launched its Solana Trust ETF (GSOL) on NYSE Arca, offering investors direct exposure to Solana along with staking rewards. This ETF is one of the first in the U.S. to combine spot holdings with staking features, providing a unique way to earn income while holding Solana. As a major crypto asset, Solana’s ETF supports investors seeking both potential price growth and staking returns under a regulated framework, marking a significant step for crypto investment products.
The gap between traditional banking and digital assets is lately getting smaller.
In a significant move, two major banks completed a first-of-its-kind trade which shows how actively the financial institutions are engaging with crypto.
First-Of-Its-Kind Crypto Trade
DBS, one of Asia’s leading financial services groups, and Goldman Sachs, a leading global financial institution, successfully carried out the first-ever over-the-counter (OTC) cryptocurrency options trade.
The transaction involved trading cash-settled OTC Bitcoin and Ether options. These transactions allow firms offering crypto-linked products to better manage the risks tied to their digital asset holdings. OTC transactions are trades made directly between two parties, rather than through a public exchange.
The participation of such well-capitalised, trusted banks in such a trade is a major milestone for digital assets in the region.
DBS Sees Surge in Crypto-Linked Trades
This comes amid a rising demand for cryptocurrency-linked products with more accredited and institutional investors considering exposure to digital assets.
In the first half of 2025 alone, DBS clients traded over USD 1 billion in crypto options and structured notes, with volumes jumping nearly 60% from Q1 to Q2.
Jacky Tai, Group Head of Trading and Structuring at DBS, notes that more professional investors are looking for safe and reliable platforms to invest in digital assets. And in response, these platforms are working to strengthen their risk management and governance.
The recent trade also shows how these platforms can benefit from banks’ strong credit standing and structuring expertise, helping to bring the trad-fi practices into the digital asset space.
A Key Step Towards Interbank Crypto Market
Max Minton, Head of Digital Assets for Asia Pacific at Goldman Sachs, said this trade marks an important step in developing an interbank market for cash-settled OTC crypto options. He also expects this segment to grow as more institutional investors enter the space.
In September, DBS teamed up with Franklin Templeton and Ripple to offer accredited and institutional investors the ability to trade and lend using tokenised money market funds and Ripple’s U.S. dollar-backed stablecoin.
Last year DBS revealed plans to offer OTC crypto options and structured notes to eligible institutional and accredited investors, becoming the first Asian bank to do so.
As more institutions join in, crypto and traditional banking appear to be teaming up strongly to create a more stable and mature digital asset market.
SEI has entered a crucial phase as price action tests major structural levels following weeks of sustained sell pressure. Despite the broader market showing signs of stabilization, SEI price continues to hover near its yearly lows, sparking debate over its long-term viability. Network fundamentals remain intact, with strong throughput, growing ecosystem integrations, and a focus on high-performance trading infrastructure. Yet, investor confidence appears tested as liquidity thins and speculative momentum fades—leaving the market to decide whether SEI is oversold or losing ground in a competitive Layer-1 landscape.
Top Factors Preventing SEI’s Price From Gaining Momentum
Despite SEI’s strong network fundamentals, several underlying factors continue to limit its price recovery. One major concern is the decline in trading liquidity, as reduced market participation has amplified even minor sell-offs, keeping SEI under consistent pressure. Additionally, ecosystem growth has lagged behind expectations—with relatively few flagship DeFi or NFT projects launching on the network, organic demand for SEI remains subdued.
Another headwind comes from ongoing token unlocks, which introduce new supply into the market and dampen upward momentum. At the same time, investor capital has rotated toward larger, more established assets like Bitcoin, Ethereum, and Solana, leaving mid-cap projects like SEI struggling to attract fresh inflows. Finally, waning investor interest in Layer-1 narratives has contributed to overall fatigue across this segment, forcing SEI to prove its real-world utility before it can regain market attention.
What Could Trigger a Rebound for SEI
While sentiment around SEI has cooled, several developments could shift momentum back in its favor. The first catalyst could come from renewed ecosystem expansion—if the network attracts more liquidity protocols, DEX integrations, or real-world trading platforms, it could reignite interest in SEI’s unique positioning as a trading-focused Layer-1 chain.
Another potential turning point lies in strategic partnerships and developer traction. Increased activity from builders and cross-chain collaborations within the Cosmos ecosystem could strengthen SEI’s long-term value proposition. A clear rise in on-chain usage or TVL would likely validate the project’s technical advantages and help rebuild market confidence.
Lastly, a broader market rotation into high-performance Layer-1s could play to SEI’s strengths. As traders seek faster, more efficient alternatives for decentralized trading, Sei Network’s architecture could emerge as a preferred choice—positioning SEI as one of the few tokens capable of outperforming once liquidity and sentiment return.
Will the SEI Price Rebound to $0.5?
SEI’s price action has entered a critical zone as broader crypto markets consolidate ahead of major macro events. After months of steady decline, the token now trades near its long-term support, sparking debate between bearish exhaustion and early accumulation. Despite strong network fundamentals, investor sentiment remains cautious amid low liquidity and competitive pressures in the Layer-1 space. The coming weeks could be decisive in determining whether SEI’s consolidation signals a bottom or an extended phase of stagnation.
The weekly chart shows SEI testing the lower band of the Gaussian Channel, indicating an oversold zone where reversals often occur. The RSI hovers near 40, suggesting weakening bearish momentum but not yet signalling a clear recovery. If price rebounds from the channel’s lower boundary, SEI could retest the mid-channel resistance near $0.30, confirming early accumulation. However, a breakdown below the channel with RSI slipping further could reinforce bearish sentiment, potentially driving the token toward the next major support around $0.12.
Collectively, the short-term SEI price weakness reflects market fatigue, while the project’s focus on trading infrastructure and efficiency continues to set it apart in a crowded Layer-1 landscape. If Sei Network succeeds in attracting new dApps, partnerships, and liquidity, current levels could represent an attractive entry for long-term investors. However, sustained ecosystem stagnation may limit upside potential, leaving SEI struggling to reclaim broader market attention.
Germany’s right-wing Alternative for Germany (AfD) party, the second-largest opposition faction in the Bundestag, has introduced a motion to create a national Bitcoin reserve.
If approved, this proposal could transform Germany from a Bitcoin seller into one of Europe’s top holders and potentially kickstart a new wave of crypto-driven financial strategy across the EU.
Key Details of the Motion
The AfD’s proposal comes at a time when traditional currencies are under growing pressure from inflation and central bank interventions. The party, known for its eurosceptic stance, argues that Bitcoin could serve as a financial safety net for Germany, similar to how gold once did.
The AfD’s proposal calls for the federal government to acquire and hold a significant portion of Bitcoin, estimated at around 2% of the total supply, mirroring recent initiatives in France, where lawmaker Éric Ciotti has voiced similar intentions.
The motion aims to use Bitcoin to strengthen Germany’s reserves amid inflation and global uncertainty. The finance ministry will now review how to store it securely and align it with EU financial rules.
BREAKING: Germany’s AfD party has introduced a motion to establish a strategic Bitcoin reserve.
Ironically, this proposal follows Germany’s massive sale of nearly 50,000 seized BTC last year, coins originally seized from criminal investigations. However, it could have been worth more than $6.5 billion, at current prices near $113,000.
Critics within the crypto community viewed that sale as a costly mistake, claiming it showed short-term thinking at the government level.
Now, AfD’s move appears to flip that narrative, suggesting Germany should have held onto its Bitcoin instead of liquidating it.
Other Countries are in FOMO
If the motion is approved, Germany could become one of the first major economies to include Bitcoin in its national reserves. Interestingly, if Germany and France both proceed, it could spark a European race to accumulate Bitcoin as a sovereign asset.
Experts say many countries, especially in Europe and Asia, are watching Germany’s move closely. Governments now see Bitcoin not just as an investment, but as a tool to strengthen their economies.
TeraWulf to Raise $500 Million Through Convertible Notes for Texas Data Center Expansion
TeraWulf Inc. has announced a private offering of $500 million in convertible senior notes due 2032, with an option for initial purchasers to buy an additional $75 million. The company plans to use the net proceeds to fund the construction of a new data center campus in Abernathy, Texas, and for general corporate purposes.The move underscores TeraWulf’s continued investment in infrastructure expansion as demand for high-performance computing and digital asset mining capacity continues to grow across the United States.
October 29, 2025 11:06:50 UTC
Fed Rate Cuts Haven’t Sparked Alt Season Yet — ETH Still Faces Volatility Ahead of Trump–Xi Deadline
Despite widespread claims that Fed rate cuts would ignite altcoin season, Ethereum’s charts tell a different story. Following past cuts, ETH saw a pump-and-dump in September 2024, a strong rally in November likely tied to Trump’s election victory, and then a 66% drop after peaking in December. In 2025, ETH remains down 17% since September, though still up 67% since the first rate cut. With the Trump–Xi China tariff deadline approaching on Saturday, analysts warn that one post on Truth Social could either boost markets or trigger sharp selloffs.
October 29, 2025 11:05:15 UTC
Binance Launches KITEUSDT Pre-Market Trading and Announces MMTFinance Prime Sale
Binance Futures has announced the launch of pre-market trading for the KITEUSDT perpetual contract, expanding its offerings in the AI and DeFi sectors. Meanwhile, Binance Wallet revealed that the second phase of its Prime Sale Pre-TGE will feature MMTFinance (MMT), one of the largest DEXs on the Sui network. Kite AI, the project behind KITE, is an Agentic Payment Protocol backed by PayPal Ventures, signaling growing institutional interest in AI-integrated crypto solutions. These moves highlight Binance’s continued focus on early-stage innovation and cross-sector blockchain development.
October 29, 2025 10:56:53 UTC
Analyst Warns of Looming Liquidity Crisis as FOMC Decision Nears
With the FOMC decision just hours away, markets expect a 25 bps rate cut, but analysts warn the real story lies in Powell’s tone. One market strategist cautions that while the Fed may end Quantitative Tightening (QT), it won’t begin Quantitative Easing (QE) — meaning liquidity will stay tight and banks will remain starved for cash. He highlights growing stress in the repo market, calling it “worse than 2019,” as overnight funding collapses. With inflation still far above target, fresh money printing is unlikely soon. Expecting liquidity to vanish, he remains short on Bitcoin and stocks, targeting $116,700–$117,200.
October 29, 2025 10:56:53 UTC
ETH Rebounds Ahead of Fed Dovish Powell Could Fuel Rally
Ethereum (ETH) saw a sharp correction yesterday but quickly rebounded from the $3,900–$3,950 support zone, showing signs of resilience. Analysts suggest the recent selling was mainly due to investors de-risking ahead of today’s FOMC meeting. If Fed Chair Jerome Powell adopts a dovish tone, signaling confidence in further easing, ETH could rally again, supported by renewed liquidity and improving market sentiment.
October 29, 2025 10:52:26 UTC
Fed Rate Cut Today: Big Moment for Bitcoin and Markets
The Fed is set to cut rates by 25 bps today at 2 PM ET, with odds near 100%. Markets will focus on the Fed’s statement, Quantitative Tightening (QT) update, and Powell’s tone. Ending QT would mark a major liquidity shift, historically bullish for risk assets like crypto. If Powell signals confidence in easing inflation and slower growth, expect yields to fall, the dollar to weaken, and Bitcoin to rally. A cautious tone could lead to short-term consolidation instead.
October 29, 2025 10:46:09 UTC
Bitcoin Rebounds to $115K Amid Easing China Tensions, Eyes FED Rate Cut for Next Move
Bitcoin rebounded to $115,000 after easing tensions with China, showing renewed strength ahead of a key macro event. Markets are now focused on tomorrow’s FED interest rate decision, where a rate cut is widely expected.Analysts warn that the event could trigger a classic “sell-the-news” reaction, bringing short-term volatility. However, any initial dip may be short-lived — as increased liquidity and capital rotation from gold could drive Bitcoin’s next leg higher.
October 29, 2025 10:43:50 UTC
Beijing Court Jails Five for $166 Million USDT Cross-Border Exchange Scheme
A Beijing court has sentenced five individuals to prison terms ranging from two to four years for their involvement in a large-scale illegal foreign exchange operation using cryptocurrency. The group was found guilty of converting client-transferred RMB into USDT and transferring the funds across borders, effectively disguising foreign exchange transactions totaling over $166 million.The verdict underscores China’s continued crackdown on crypto-related financial crimes, particularly activities that violate the nation’s strict foreign exchange and capital control laws.
October 29, 2025 10:43:50 UTC
Binance to Delist Flamingo (FLM), Kadena (KDA), and Perpetual Protocol (PERP) on November 12
Binance has announced that it will delist and cease trading for all spot trading pairs involving Flamingo (FLM), Kadena (KDA), and Perpetual Protocol (PERP) on November 12, 2025, at 03:00 (UTC). The exchange stated that the decision was made following its regular project review process, which assesses factors such as project development activity, trading volume, and overall ecosystem health. Users are advised to complete any necessary trades or withdrawals before the delisting takes effect.
October 29, 2025 10:15:00 UTC
France Proposes Strategic Bitcoin Reserve
French lawmaker Éric Ciotti has proposed the creation of a national Bitcoin reserve, introducing a bill that would see France acquire 420,000 BTC about 2% of Bitcoin’s total supply over the next 7 to 8 years.The proposal outlines an ambitious plan to make France Europe’s first nation with a strategic Bitcoin reserve, powered by nuclear and hydroelectric mining, and funded through daily BTC purchases of roughly €15 million from national savings funds. The bill also suggests that seized crypto assets remain in the state treasury rather than being auctioned, and even opens the door for tax payments in Bitcoin (pending approval).
October 29, 2025 10:15:00 UTC
Live Blog Update
Bitcoin rebounded to $115,000 after easing tensions with China, showing renewed strength ahead of a key macro event. Markets are now focused on tomorrow’s FED interest rate decision, where a rate cut is widely expected.Analysts warn that the event could trigger a classic “sell-the-news” reaction, bringing short-term volatility. However, any initial dip may be short-lived — as increased liquidity and capital rotation from gold could drive Bitcoin’s next leg higher.
October 29, 2025 10:15:00 UTC
Bitcoin Holding $112K Support as Market Awaits FOMC — Analyst Sees $116K Target Ahead
Bitcoin continues to follow its expected trajectory, forming a higher low around the $112K region, according to recent market analysis. The analyst emphasized that maintaining this support level through the FOMC event could set the stage for another push toward $116K in the near term. While short-term volatility is likely, traders are advised to avoid overtrading and stay patient as Bitcoin consolidates. The current price action suggests the market remains on track for a potential rebound once the FOMC-driven uncertainty clears.
October 29, 2025 08:21:15 UTC
Van de Poppe Says Bitcoin at $112K Is a “Steal” Ahead of FOMC-Driven Volatility
Crypto analyst Michaël van de Poppe believes Bitcoin remains heavily undervalued despite recent market turbulence. In a post on X, he noted that the asset has retested lower levels, found buying pressure, and experienced a weak bounce, suggesting renewed accumulation. Van de Poppe warned traders that volatility is expected to surge as the FOMC event unfolds, advising inexperienced traders to avoid leveraged positions on such a high-risk day. He also compared Bitcoin’s performance to gold, saying the metal is currently stalling while Bitcoin lags behind making buying around $112,000 “essentially a steal.”
October 29, 2025 06:44:57 UTC
WLFI Holds Strong at $0.15 as Buyers Accumulate for Potential Breakout
WLFI is consolidating around the $0.15 mark, showing signs of strong accumulation after weeks of correction. The token has found solid support between $0.14 and $0.15 — a key demand zone that continues to attract buyers. With sellers losing momentum and buyers reloading positions, the market structure remains bullish as long as WLFI holds above $0.15. A sustained move beyond the $0.19 resistance level, identified as the point of control, could trigger a breakout and signal the next leg higher for the token.
October 29, 2025 06:44:06 UTC
Peter Schiff Warns Bitcoin Bubble May Burst as NASDAQ Hits Record High
Economist and gold advocate Peter Schiff has sounded another bearish alarm for Bitcoin, claiming the crypto’s failure to keep up with traditional markets signals an impending correction. In a post on X, Schiff noted that while Big Tech pushed the NASDAQ to a new record high, Bitcoin remains over 10% below its all-time high, and MicroStrategy ($MSTR) is down 48% from its November 2024 peak. Schiff argued that Bitcoin’s lag behind gold and tech stocks suggests “the bubble is about to pop,” reinforcing his long-standing skepticism toward the cryptocurrency market.
October 29, 2025 06:42:19 UTC
Pi Network Opens KYC Path for 3 Million Users with New Liveness Check Update
Pi Network has rolled out a new system process that could unblock an additional 3 million Pioneers currently stuck in Tentative KYC status. The update allows users to complete additional liveness checks directly in the app to verify their identity and move forward in the KYC process. The team urged users with a Tentative KYC status to complete the new liveness checks as soon as possible to ensure their accounts are verified and fully functional within the Pi ecosystem. This move is expected to accelerate the overall KYC completion rate across the network.
October 29, 2025 06:36:32 UTC
Bitcoin and Ethereum ETFs See Massive Inflows — $448 Million Poured In on October 28
October 28 marked another bullish day for crypto ETFs as both Bitcoin and Ethereum spot funds recorded strong investor interest. Bitcoin spot ETFs attracted $202 million in net inflows, extending their winning streak to a third consecutive day. Ethereum spot ETFs outshone Bitcoin, drawing in $246 million in net inflows, led by Fidelity’s FETH, which alone accounted for $99.27 million. The steady inflows into both Bitcoin and Ethereum ETFs signal renewed institutional confidence amid improving market sentiment and growing anticipation of further crypto market gains.
Last week, U.S. President Donald Trump pardoned Binance founder Changpeng Zhao (CZ). This move was criticized by many Democratic senators, including Elizabeth Warren and Adam Schiff, who publicly called out Trump’s decision.
Now, taking this investigation further, a group of seven democratic senators have issued a letter to the U.S. Attorney General condemning the pardon of the crypto billionaire.
Congress’s Joint Move Against Trump’s Pardon
On Tuesday, a letter to US Attorney General Pam Bondi and Treasury Secretary Scott Bessent was sent. This addressed how the presidential pardon affects law enforcement, particularly the Department of Justice’s (DOJ) ability to prosecute “white collar” and crypto-related crimes, especially those involved in money laundering and sanctions violations.
The letter accuses the pardon of undermining federal law enforcement. It also signals that wealthy or well-connected business figures can evade justice by supporting the president financially.
The senators raised four main questions that Bessent and Bondi are required to answer by November 4, 2025.
The general effect of a pardon on criminal deterrence
Impact on crypto-related criminal activities
The message it sends to federal law enforcement officers
The letter claims that this pardon could embolden corporate wrongdoers by signaling that financial or political connections to the President can erase criminal liability
Questioning Trump’s Abuse of Pardon Power
In an X post on Wednesday, Senator Schiff accused Trump of misusing his presidential power. Instead of using it in the right place, Trump is rewarding personal allies, family members, and wealthy supporters.
Schiff stated on the Senate floor, “The President isn’t using the power of his office to ensure hungry families have access to food next month…To make sure that Americans can afford to pay for their health care.”
“He’s using the power of his office to pardon a convicted billionaire and one who just happens to be doing business with the Trump family,” he added.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Why did President Trump pardon Binance founder Changpeng Zhao?
President Trump pardoned CZ as part of a broader move to support crypto innovation, though critics say it benefited a wealthy political ally.
Why are Democratic senators criticizing Trump’s pardon of CZ?
Democratic senators argue the pardon undermines justice by signaling that powerful business figures can escape accountability through influence.
How does Trump’s pardon affect crypto regulation in the U.S.?
Experts say it could complicate future crypto enforcement and policymaking, as it blurs lines between political decisions and legal accountability.
What happens next after the senators’ letter to the Attorney General?
The Attorney General and Treasury Secretary must respond by November 4, addressing how the pardon impacts law enforcement and crypto oversight.
The crypto market is turning its attention to XRP, which continues to outperform major players, including Bitcoin, Ethereum, and Solana. While most cryptocurrencies recorded moderate growth in Q3 2025, XRP’s market capitalization and price surged significantly, reflecting renewed investor confidence and expanding real-world adoption.
After months of quiet trading, XRP closed Q3 at $2.85, marking a 27% quarter-over-quarter increase, its strongest quarterly close ever. Its market cap rose 29% to $170.3 billion, surpassing the combined 13.3% growth of Bitcoin, Ethereum, and Solana. This remarkable performance signals a shift in market sentiment, as investors increasingly view XRP as a leading force in cross-border finance and tokenized assets.
The XRP Ledger (XRPL) also reported strong network activity. Average daily transactions rose 9% to 1.8 million, while new wallet addresses increased 46% to over 447,000, highlighting growing user adoption.
What’s Driving XRP’s Growth?
XRP’s latest rally isn’t just about price appreciation; it’s being driven by real-world adoption and ecosystem expansion. Messari’s report revealed that several corporate players have started adding XRP to their treasury reserves.
Companies such as Trident Digital, Webus, Wellgistics, and VivoPower, which invested $100 million in XRP, are among the early adopters. Ripple-backed Evernorth also made headlines after acquiring 388 million XRP, worth over $1 billion, making it one of the largest corporate holders of the token.
The rise of the Digital Asset Treasury (DAT) trend has further enhanced XRP’s visibility among institutional investors looking for efficient, stable, and blockchain-based financial solutions.
Expanding Ecosystem: Stablecoins and Real-World Assets (RWAs)
Ripple’s RLUSD stablecoin continues to gain traction, closing Q3 with a market cap of $88.8 million, up 34.7% from the previous quarter. Combined RLUSD supply across Ethereum and XRPL reached nearly $903 million by late October, showing strong momentum in multi-chain adoption.
Meanwhile, the Real-World Asset (RWA) sector on XRPL saw explosive growth, jumping 215% to $364.2 million. Projects like OpenEden US Treasury Bill Vault, Montis Group Limited, and Ondo Short-Term Bond Fund are leading this expansion, driving greater institutional participation in tokenized finance.
What’s Next for XRP?
With sustained ecosystem growth, corporate backing, and increasing adoption of stablecoins and RWAs, XRP is positioning itself as a key player in the evolving global financial landscape. The launch of innovative products like Gemini’s XRP credit card and Flare’s FXRP DeFi integration further boosts its real-world utility.
If this momentum continues, XRP could move well beyond its reputation as a payment-focused token, evolving into one of the most widely adopted digital assets, effectively bridging the gap between traditional finance and blockchain technology.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Why is XRP outperforming Bitcoin and Ethereum in 2025?
XRP is rising faster due to strong corporate adoption, increased real-world use, and growing interest in tokenized finance and stablecoins.
What is driving XRP’s market cap growth in Q3 2025?
XRP’s market cap surged from rising institutional investments, growing network activity, and expansion into real-world asset tokenization.
How are companies using XRP in their treasury reserves?
Major firms are adding XRP to reserves for faster, low-cost cross-border payments and to diversify into blockchain-based financial assets.
What’s next for XRP after its strong Q3 performance?
With new products, stablecoin expansion, and DeFi growth, XRP aims to evolve from a payment token into a key bridge for global finance.
Ethereum is gearing up for one of its biggest upgrades yet, the Fusaka fork, which has now gone live on its final testnet, Hoodi. This marks the last testing phase before the official mainnet launch scheduled for December 3, promising faster transactions, better security, and a smoother experience for users and developers.
A Smooth Final Test Before the Big Day
The Ethereum community celebrated another successful milestone this week as the developer team Nethermind confirmed that the Fusaka upgrade went live without any major issues. The test ensures the system is ready for the full rollout, keeping Ethereum on track for its year-end upgrade.
This latest step shows how much effort the Ethereum Foundation and its partners are putting into making the network more efficient and secure while preparing it for the next generation of decentralized applications.
What Fusaka Will Bring
The Fusaka update introduces several new features known as Ethereum Improvement Proposals (EIPs) that aim to make the network faster and easier to use. A major highlight is PeerDAS (EIP-7594), which allows validators to read only small parts of data instead of full chunks, making Ethereum nodes run more efficiently, especially for Layer 2 networks.
Other proposals like EIP-7825 and EIP-7935 will increase the gas limit and prepare the system for parallel execution, which means Ethereum will soon be able to process multiple smart contracts at once, a big leap for scalability.
A Three-Stage Launch Plan
The rollout of Fusaka will happen in three stages. First will be the mainnet activation, followed by an increase in data capacity (blob capacity), and finally a hard fork to expand that capacity further. Once this process is complete, Ethereum will move on to its next upgrade phase, Glamsterdam, which continues the network’s “Surge” roadmap focused on scalability improvements.
The goal of Fusaka is to make Ethereum more scalable without sacrificing its core strengths, security, and decentralization. Ethereum co-founder Vitalik Buterin has often called this the “blockchain trilemma.” While Ethereum has always been secure and decentralized, it has lagged behind faster rivals like Solana and Sui in transaction speed. Fusaka aims to fix that.
The Fusaka upgrade comes just six months after Ethereum’s Pectra update, which improved staking and wallet usability. With Fusaka nearing launch and Ether (ETH) trading strongly above $4,000, excitement is building for Ethereum’s next phase, one that could make it faster, safer, and ready for even bigger adoption in 2026.
Market Impact
After the Fusaka testnet success, Ethereum (ETH) is currently priced at $4,021.19 with a circulating supply of 120.7 million tokens. Despite being down 18.8% from its peak, Ethereum has shown massive long-term growth. The 50-day SMA at $4,229 signals short-term strength, while the 200-day SMA at $3,295 reflects long-term stability.. The upgrade shows how far Ethereum has come toward a more scalable and secure system.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What is the Ethereum Fusaka upgrade?
The Fusaka upgrade is Ethereum’s latest update focused on faster transactions, better scalability, and improved security for developers and users.
When will the Fusaka upgrade go live on the Ethereum mainnet?
Ethereum’s Fusaka mainnet launch is scheduled for December 3, marking the start of its next phase in the network’s scalability roadmap.
How will Fusaka improve Ethereum’s performance?
Fusaka boosts speed and scalability by allowing nodes to process data more efficiently and execute multiple smart contracts at once.
What impact could the Fusaka upgrade have on Ethereum’s price?
Fusaka could strengthen Ethereum’s long-term growth by improving network efficiency, attracting more developers, and boosting market confidence.
Price predictions for 2025 suggest highs of $50 and potential ETF approval.
Long-term forecasts indicate AVAX could reach $518.50 by 2030.
Avalanche (AVAX) has become a go-to platform for developers, especially after its Avalanche 9000 mainnet upgrade and the launch of the AVAX card in early 2025. With lower fees and growing real-world use cases, plus backing from giants like Mastercard and SMBC, AVAX is gaining serious traction.
As a result, many are intrigued to know Avalanche prediction and are wondering: “How high can AVAX price go?” or “Will AVAX reach $50?” or “Does Avalanche have a good long-term future?” So, if you’re planning an investment in Avalanche (AVAX). Explore our in-depth Avalanche Price Prediction 2025 to 2030.
According to Coinpedia’s AVAX price prediction, the altcoin may surpass the $49.46 mark in 2025. Moreover, the upcoming years are expected to be bullish, with a conservative momentum.
With an optimistic outlook, we expect the AVAX coin price to reach $50 in 2025.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$12.36
$30.91
$49.46
AVAX Price Prediction 2025
Avalanche (AVAX) showed signs of a major market shift after a long period of capped price action throughout 2025. In September, the token initiated a promising bullish rally by breaking the upper boundary of a ascending triangle pattern.
However, this optimism quickly dissipated as profit-taking satrted as soon as AVAX hit $35 this instantly led to a reversal, completely shattering the short-lived bullish outlook. The price correction intensified dramatically on October 10th when a significant crypto-market liquidation event, reportedly triggered by geopolitical tension, forced AVAX down to $17.50.
Despite this the immediate buy-back efforts by bulls to minimize the damage were not enough as a result the recovery faltered, and they only managed to establish and sustain support just above the $20 mark.
This sharp reversal has technically invalidated the pattern breakout, sending AVAX tumbling back inside its previous horizontal sideways trading channel. The token is now clinging precariously to the $20 support level. The market faces a pivotal moment because the odds suggest that either AVAX will continue a sideways consolidation within its range, or a new, convincing bullish catalyst will be required to reignite upward momentum and initiate another rally attempt.
Looking ahead, for AVAX to secure a strong finish to the year, it must first defeat the $26 range’s upper resistance. A successful push past this level, followed by flipping $35 into support during November, would set the ambitious target for the year-end close at $55.
However, should AVAX fail to hold the line and continue its decline, the immediate risk is a fall to $15 support, which would likely lead to prolonged sideways movement within the bearish $15 to $26 range throughout the remainder of the year.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$25
$33
$50
Avalanche Price Target November 2025
The optimism following AVAX’s failed September breakout quickly dissolved into a severe correction in October. a crypto-market liquidation event that forced AVAX to a low of $17.50. While immediate buy-back efforts have positioned just above the $20 support level.
AVAX has returned to its previous trading channel. Now, for AVAX to regain its momentum then in November is the month, it must first reclaim the $26 resistance. Also, flipping $35 into support this month is necessary to unlock the ambitious year-end target of $55.
Failure to hold the $20 support would drag AVAX to hit lower supports.
Safello’s TAO ETP joins a new wave of crypto ETFs hitting global markets, with fresh Solana, Litecoin and Hedera fund launches across the US and Hong Kong.
Seven Senate Democrats asked the US attorney general and the DOJ to explain President Trump’s pardon of Binance co-founder Changpeng Zhao, calling it a corrupt move.
Circle’s Arc has seen strong early adoption, with over 100 global financial and fintech giants, including BlackRock, Goldman Sachs, Visa and Mastercard, joining its public testnet.
Solana price is hovering under resistance as investors look for the next catalyst in a week dominated by ETF headlines and broader market turbulence. Solana is currently trading at $194.22, down 4.33% on the day but still up 5.17% for…
Ethereum price defends the $3,900 local support within an ascending triangle pattern, with a potential breakout target near the $4,800–$4,900 zone if resistance around $4,300 is breached. Following yesterday’s dump in Ethereum (ETH), likely driven by broader macro uncertainty ahead…
Investors are turning to low-entry, structured presales like Noomez, which launched today at just $0.00001 per token with built-in deflationary mechanics. #partnercontent
Crypto traders remained on edge as they await Fed Chair Powell’s speech following the FOMC meeting set to wrap up later today. According to data from crypto.news, the total crypto market cap slipped 1.2% to around $3.9 trillion, with most…
The Trump-backed stablecoin project is rewarding early adopters through its USD1 points program, distributing tokens across six exchanges as it expands into DeFi and real-world asset integrations.
A brief slip under $200 drew heavier selling before SOL steadied near $195–$196, as Bitwise touted BSOL’s debut and Grayscale said GSOL will list on NYSE Arca.
The moves come ahead of a pivotal Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) meeting on Oct. 28–29, where officials are widely expected to cut benchmark rates by 25 basis points to the 4.00%–4.25% range.
President Trump’s decision to pardon Binance founder CZ is sparking outrage with Senate Democrats now demanding a federal probe into what they call a “dangerous act of political favoritism.” A group of seven U.S. Senate Democrats, led by Senator Elizabeth…
The first U.S Solana spot ETF, Bitwise Solana ETF, has seen its net inflows surge to $69.45 million on its first day, beating out other altcoin ETFs which saw no inflows. According to data from SoSoValue, Bitwise’s first Solana ETF…
Known as the Liechtenstein Trust Integrity Network (LTIN), it’s operated by the state telecoms company, with contributions from half a dozen private firms.
Following the recent launch of multiple crypto ETFs, Bitwise Asset Manager’s CIO has forecasted a bright future for the firm’s Solana Staking Exchange-Traded Fund (ETF), as investors show strong initial interest in the investment product.
Bitwise Solana Staking ETF Sees Strong Start
On Tuesday, Bitwise CIO Matt Hougan predicted that the Bitwise Solana Staking ETF (BSOL) could attract significant institutional interest and become one of the leading investment products based on digital assets.
Hougan argued that Solana is “one of the most exciting crypto investment opportunities that exists today,” as it records “the most revenue of any blockchain.” He explained that institutional investors “love” both ETFs and revenue, which suggests that these investors will “love Solana ETFs.”
Bitwise’s CIO previously pointed out that there must be fundamental reasons for investors’ interest in investment vehicles such as ETFs and Digital Asset Treasuries (DATs), signaling that Solana has them. Therefore, he has “a feeling the Bitwise Solana Staking ETF, BSOL, is gonna be huge.”
Ahead of the launch, ETF Expert Eric Balchunas predicted that the first day volume for Bitwise’s Solana ETF could surpass the $50 million mark. Notably, the firm’s spot Bitcoin ETF (BITB) and spot Ethereum ETH (ETHW) recorded $237.9 million and $204 million on their first day, respectively.
Hougan has highlighted that Solana’s market capitalization is 1/20th the size of BTC and less than 1/4th the size of ETH. Based on this, the volume for an SOL ETF is expected to be smaller than that of ETFs based on the two leading crypto assets.
According to data shared by Balchunas, BSOL recorded an impressive volume of $10 million in the first 30 minutes of trading, hinting at initial demand. This amount surged to approximately $33 million by the half-day mark and hit $56 million by the end of its first trading day.
According to the analyst, BSOL had a strong start, noting that its “$56m is the MOST of any launch this year.. More than XRPR, SSK, Ives and BMNU.”
Crypto ETFs Launch Amid Government Shutdown
BSOL was among the crypto ETFs launched on October 28 despite the US government shutdown. As reported by NewsBTC, Bitwise, for its Solana Staking ETF, and Canary Capital, for its spot Litecoin (LTC) and Hedera (HBAR) ETFs, filed 8-A forms on Monday to launch the investment products this week despite the government shutdown.
Notably, the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) was set to approve over a dozen altcoin ETFs between October and November after delaying the decision deadline and releasing new generic listing standards for the products.
However, investors expected that the long-awaited green light would be delayed until the end of the government shutdown. Journalist Eleanor Terret explained that the launch was possible because an open government isn’t required and the 8-A filings are “just as important” as the S-1 forms, as they formally register ETF shares under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
As a result, after the NYSE certified all the filings for the ETFs, they could start trading on Tuesday. Meanwhile, Grayscale’s Solana Trust (GSOL) will convert into an ETF on Wednesday.
Global financial services company Western Union is making a strategic move into the world of stablecoins, responding to the evolving landscape created by the recent passage of the GENIUS Act in the US.
On Tuesday, the company announced its intention to launch the US Dollar Payment Token (USDPT), a new stablecoin, alongside its Digital Asset Network designed to integrate digital and fiat currencies.
Western Union New USDPT Stablecoin
Built on the Solana (SOL) blockchain and issued by Anchorage Digital Bank, USDPT aims to broaden the options for transferring money for customers, agents, and partners, while also bolstering Western Union’s treasury capabilities.
Through this initiative, the company plans to provide users with access to digital assets, allowing them to send, receive, spend, and hold USDPT with ease, supported by Western Union’s global compliance and risk management framework.
Devin McGranahan, President and CEO of Western Union, expressed the company’s commitment to harnessing emerging technologies to empower customers and communities.
“As we transition into the digital asset space, USDPT will enable us to take ownership of the economics associated with stablecoins,” McGranahan stated.
He also highlighted the significance of the Digital Asset Network, which aims to simplify cash off-ramps for digital assets by partnering with wallets and wallet providers, thereby allowing seamless access for customers via Western Union’s extensive global network.
Western Union anticipates that USDPT will launch in the first half of 2026, with plans for users to access the stablecoin through partner exchanges, ensuring broad availability and user-friendliness.
Stablecoins To Reduce Reliance On Traditional Banking
During Western Union’s third quarter of the year earnings call last Thursday, McGranahan revealed that the company has initiated a pilot program utilizing stablecoins for value transfer.
He noted that this pilot aims to leverage blockchain technology and stablecoins to decrease reliance on traditional correspondent banking systems, which will help shorten settlement times and enhance capital efficiency.
Historically, Western Union has maintained a cautious approach towards crypto, primarily due to concerns regarding volatility, regulatory challenges, and customer protection.
However, with the enactment of the GENIUS Act, McGranahan indicated that new opportunities are emerging for integrating digital assets into the company’s operations, enhancing efficiency, reducing friction, and ultimately improving the customer experience.
Western Union facilitates the transfer of billions of dollars annually, boasting a market capitalization of over $2.9 billion as of October 28, and generating more than $1 billion in adjusted revenue in the third quarter of the year alone.
Despite the announcement, SOL’s price has failed to react positively, currently attempting to hold the $200 line as the cryptocurrency’s next short-term support.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
On-chain analytics firm Glassnode has revealed a Bitcoin price range that defines the current battleground between recent buyers and profit-takers.
Bitcoin Cost Basis Distribution Shows Where Resistance & Support Are Strongest
In a new post on X, Glassnode has talked about where support and resistance levels lie for Bitcoin based on the Cost Basis Distribution (CBD). This indicator basically tells us about the total amount of supply that last changed hands at the various price levels that the cryptocurrency has visited in its history.
Below is the chart shared by the analytics firm that shows the trend in this metric over the last few months.
As is visible in the graph, the CBD highlights two levels for holding a dense amount of the cryptocurrency’s supply (shaded in red). The lower of these levels is situated near $111,000. A large chunk of buying at this mark occurred during the recent bearish phase in the asset.
The other level is located around $117,000, made up of investors who bought during the price rally to the all-time high (ATH). Naturally, these buyers would be underwater right now, while those who purchased at $111,000 would be in profit.
Generally, holders are sensitive to retests of their cost basis and can show some kind of reaction during one. Since these two levels host the cost basis of a significant amount of investors, it’s possible that when BTC will revisit them, some panic selling or buying will crop up.
Which behavior would be dominant usually comes down to the market mood and the direction of the retest. When the retest occurs from above, investors may choose to buy more, believing the same cost basis level would result in profits again in the future. Similarly, holders who were in loss prior to the retest can react by selling, fearing that the asset will drop again in the future.
Considering these effects, the $111,000 may be considered a key support cushion for Bitcoin, while $117,000 a resistance barrier. “This range defines the current battleground between recent buyers and profit-takers,” noted Glassnode.
It now remains to be seen which level BTC will visit next and how its retest will go. “A break in either direction could set the tone for the next major move,” explained the analytics firm.
In some other news, the Stablecoin Supply Ratio (SSR) Oscillator has been sitting at cycle lows recently, as Glassnode has pointed out in another X post. This oscillator is based on the SSR, which compares the Bitcoin circulating supply against the supply of the stablecoins.
The SSR Oscillator is sitting at a low level at the moment, which indicates that the BTC supply is low compared to stablecoin liquidity. “Historically, such periods precede stronger bid-side support when market confidence returns,” said the analytics firm.
BTC Price
Bitcoin saw a retrace toward $113,500 earlier, but the coin has been quick to bounce back as its price has returned to $115,400.
Market expert VirtualBacon recently suggested that the most significant event for the crypto industry this year is not the Bitcoin (BTC) Halving or the approval of exchange-traded funds (ETFs), but rather a potential shift in Federal Reserve (Fed) liquidity policy.
After 18 months of tightening measures, the Fed is reportedly preparing to pause its quantitative tightening (QT) and may even initiate stealth quantitative easing (QE) once again.
What’s Next For The Crypto Market
In a recent post on social media platform X, VirtualBacon laid out a compelling argument linking liquidity pivots to altcoin cycles. In 2019, the Fed halted QT, which resulted in a rally for altcoins. Conversely, in 2022, when the Fed began QT, altcoins peaked.
Now, as the Fed is expected to end QT in 2025, VirtualBacon anticipates a similar surge for altcoins. The correlation is clear: when the Fed increases liquidity, altcoins tend to rise. The pressing question now is when exactly QT will come to a close.
While the Fed may not explicitly label a shift as QE, the expert notes that the pivotal moment will arrive when they remove the language regarding “reducing the size of the balance sheet.”
The last notable instance of this was during the 2019 repo crisis, when banks faced immediate cash shortages, prompting the Fed to inject $75 billion into the financial system. Although Powell claimed it was “not QE,” it effectively was, and following that intervention, Bitcoin tripled in value within months.
CME FedWatch Tool Shows High Probability Of Rate Cuts
Major financial institutions are already making predictions, with Goldman Sachs stating that the October meeting is the base case for QT to end, Bank of America expecting QT to cease by month-end, and Evercore indicating that the Fed is likely to signal an end to QT this week.
The same indicators that caused market disruptions back in 2019 are signaling distress now. Regardless of official statements, it appears QT is nearing its conclusion, with stealth QE on the horizon.
This shift would facilitate a return of liquidity to the markets, which historically has driven crypto prices. Liquidity acts as the fuel for market movements, and the Fed is poised to refill this tank.
The CME FedWatch tool currently indicates a 96.7% probability of a rate cut this month and an 87.9% chance of another cut in December. Powell recently hinted that QT would conclude “in the coming months,” signaling an imminent pivot.
M2 Money Supply Signals Upcoming Bitcoin Surge
Despite the current market uncertainty, VirtualBacon asserts that Bitcoin has not reached its peak. Out of 30 historical indicators that typically signal a bull market peak, none have activated yet, with data indicating there is still room for growth.
The global M2 money supply continues to rise, which historically leads Bitcoin prices by 10 to 12 weeks. The expert added that since the beginning of the month, this money supply has been increasing.
This development indicates that Bitcoin’s next upward movement is already in the pipeline, albeit lagging behind the liquidity curve. Additionally, VirtualBacon forecasts that once the Fed pivots, a new altcoin season may commence.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
The Australian Securities and Investments Commission (ASIC) has issued a major update to its Info Sheet 225. Notably, the new move expands how financial services laws apply to digital-asset products and platforms.
A prominent community figure who goes by the pseudonym UnknowDLT has expressed strong optimism about the future of XRP. In a recent commentary, UnknowDLT projected that XRP will eventually become one of the greatest opportunities not only of this lifetime, but even for future generations.
Crypto commentators are again mocking XRP holders as Western Union moves to deploy blockchain solutions on Solana instead of the XRP Ledger. On Tuesday, the world’s largest money transfer company, Western Union, announced it will launch its U.S.
A recent report expanding on the performance of XRP and the XRP Ledger (XRPL) in the third quarter of the year shows an obvious ecosystem growth. The “State of the XRP Ledger Q3” report from prominent analytical firm Messari shows the XRP ecosystem made reasonable progress in key metrics and other areas, such as stablecoins and RWAs.
Nate Geraci, a popular ETF expert and president of NovaDius Wealth Management, expresses confidence that upcoming XRP ETFs will match or exceed Bitwise's Solana ETF's record debut. Geraci made the bold prediction after Bitwise’s Solana Staking ETF (BSOL) posted the highest first-day trading volume of any ETF launch this year.
The Ripple CTO, David Schwartz, recently humorously suggested that he may not ask his younger self to buy XRP, as it could "trigger a paradox." Schwartz mentioned this during a light-hearted conversation in the crypto community. Notably, media outlet CoinDesk triggered this conversation with an age-old question surrounding early crypto investments.
Ripple-supported startup Evernorth Holdings has accumulated over $1 billion worth of XRP. This significant investment makes it one of the largest institutional holders of the cryptocurrency to date.
XRP price is holding steady near $2.60 as a key sell signal tests its recent rally, with whales and possible exchange-traded fund approvals anchoring market confidence. XRP slipped 0.4% over the past 24 hours to trade at $2.63 at press…
World Liberty Financial’s token debuts on Binance US for spot trading today. Will WLFI price recover to pre-October 10 crash levels? World Liberty Financial (WLFI) price is attempting a recovery following the sharp October 10 flash crash, having established a…
BitMine is strengthening its position as the world’s largest corporate Ethereum treasury holder as market volatility continues. BitMine Immersion Tech recently acquired 27,316 ETH worth $113 million, according to on-chain data from Lookonchain. This latest addition brings the mining and…
Visa will add support for four new stablecoins on its settlement platform after the payments giant witnessed a spike in demand for stablecoin-linked card services. During the company’s fourth-quarter earnings call, CEO Ryan McInerney told investors that Visa plans to…
Dogecoin (DOGE) price is flashing a major bullish signal as the broader crypto market steadies ahead of this week’s highly anticipated FOMC meeting. Bitcoin (BTC) continues to consolidate around the $113,000 mark, while Ethereum (ETH) holds near $4,000, both awaiting fresh cues from the Federal Reserve’s policy outlook. Amid this cautious sentiment, DOGE has emerged as a standout performer, reclaiming key support levels and showing signs of renewed momentum.
With rising trading volumes and improving technical structure, analysts believe DOGE could be gearing up for a decisive move toward the $0.215 resistance zone this week.
On the other hand, the top memecoin is also displaying a bearish divergence, which needs to be considered ahead of the incoming volatility. Ever since the infamous crash fueled by the US-China trade war, the DOGE price has remained stuck within a narrow range. However, the price continued to form constant higher highs and lows, which raised the possibility of securing above the local resistance at $0.21. However, the technicals suggest the price may experience a notable pullback, preventing a rise above this range.
The Dogecoin (DOGE/USDT) daily chart reveals a cautious yet potentially bullish setup. After breaking below its ascending trendline, DOGE has entered a consolidation phase near the $0.19 level, maintaining support above the $0.18 zone. The Bollinger Bands show price compression, indicating reduced volatility and a possible buildup for the next move. However, a downward arrow suggests a short-term correction toward the $0.16–$0.17 support range if the current support fails.
The RSI hovers around 42 with a visible descending trendline, reflecting weakening momentum but also hinting at a potential reversal if it breaks above resistance. Sustaining above $0.19 could open the path toward $0.21–$0.215, while rejection may trigger a retest of lower support levels.
In conclusion, Dogecoin’s price action suggests a make-or-break zone near $0.19. A confirmed rebound above this level could trigger a short-term rally toward $0.21 and potentially $0.215. However, failure to hold above the current support may drag the price back toward the $0.17–$0.16 demand zone before any bullish reversal attempts. Overall, DOGE remains range-bound but poised for a decisive breakout in the coming sessions.
Wall Street just opened a new chapter for altcoins. The first-ever spot exchange-traded funds (ETFs) for Solana (SOL), Hedera (HBAR), and Litecoin (LTC) officially began trading this week, pulling in nearly $65 million in first-day trading volume.
According to Bloomberg ETF analyst Eric Balchunas, the final tally for day one came in at:
$BSOL (Solana ETF): $56 million
$HBR (Hedera ETF): $8 million
$LTCC (Litecoin ETF): $1 million
Balchunas said that $BSOL’s $56 million debut is the strongest ETF launch of the year, surpassing several earlier products and even outperforming some Ethereum-related launches. He added that the fund was seeded with about $220 million, meaning the total invested capital could have reached around $280 million if all initial seed funds had been deployed on Day One.
A Big Moment for Altcoin ETFs
The strong performance shows growing institutional interest in regulated crypto exposure beyond Bitcoin and Ethereum. The Bitwise Solana Staking ETF, listed on the NYSE Arca, offers 7% annualized staking rewards with zero management fees, making it particularly attractive to yield-seeking investors.
Canary Capital’s Litecoin and Hedera ETFs, meanwhile, are listed on Nasdaq, both backed by tokens held in custody with BitGo and Coinbase Custody. This transparent setup gives traditional investors direct access to real tokens without the need for self-custody or on-chain management.
Eyes Now Turn to XRP
The success of the Solana, Hedera, and Litecoin ETFs has put attention on the next big contender: XRP. Seven U.S. XRP ETF filings are currently awaiting SEC review, with decisions expected between October 18 and November 14.
Market analysts say that XRP could dwarf the early success of SOL, HBAR, and LTC. Steven McClurg, CEO of Canary Capital, said XRP ETFs could attract $5 billion to $10 billion in inflows within the first month of trading.
Backing this projection, JPMorgan forecasts up to $8 billion in inflows during the first year, while CryptoQuant’s head of research Julio Moreno estimates that 1% to 4% of XRP’s total supply—worth $1.8 billion to $7.2 billion at current prices, could be absorbed by ETFs in the same period.
In an interview with Cryptoslate, Moreno said that such inflows would “significantly improve liquidity and cement XRP as a credible institutional asset.”
Could XRP Set a New Benchmark?
According to Bitget CMO Jamie Elkaleh, inflows could reach $4 billion to $8 billion in the first year, potentially driving XRP’s price into the $4 to $8 range by year-end.
JPMorgan’s altcoin ETF outlook predicts:
XRP ETFs: $8 billion potential inflows
Solana ETFs: $6 billion potential inflows
Analysts say that if this trend continues, crypto ETFs could collectively pull in over $50 billion in institutional capital within months, marking a new era for the digital asset market.
How does Noomez work? That’s the question many traders are asking today as the Noomez ($NNZ) presale officially goes live.
Built on Binance Smart Chain, Noomez introduces one of the most structured and transparent systems in the meme-coin space.
The project is built on fixed-supply mechanics, real-time on-chain tracking, and a verified framework that anyone can review before investing.
How Does Noomez Work: The 28-Stage Presale Framework
Noomez uses a 28-stage presale system to structure its token launch, rewarding early participants while maintaining transparency.
Each stage runs for up to seven days or until sold out. Token prices start at $0.00001 in Stage 1 and rise gradually to $0.0028 by Stage 28, forming a clearly defined 280× curve.
Fixed Supply: The total supply is locked at 280 billion $NNZ, with 50% allocated to presale.
Automatic Burns: Unsold tokens at the end of each stage are permanently burned, reducing circulation and driving long-term scarcity.
Noom Gauge Tracking: A live tracker called the Noom Gauge updates in real time, showing the exact progress of each presale phase.
Such a model ensures every transaction, burn, and stage update is visible to the public, a rarity in meme token launches.
Token Utility and On-Chain Visibility
Every $NNZ token serves a functional role within the ecosystem. During the presale, purchases activate progress in the Noom Gauge, trigger vault events, and contribute to deflationary burns.
Once the presale ends, these tokens transition into the broader Noom Engine, an automated framework that distributes rewards, partner tokens, and staking yields.
All smart contracts are open-source and auditable, allowing any user to verify distribution schedules, vesting periods, and liquidity lock details directly on-chain. The team behind Noomez is KYC-verified, adding another layer of accountability rarely seen in early-stage meme projects.
Pro Tip: Before joining any presale, always check whether token supply, burns, and vesting are publicly verifiable; Noomez has each one on record.
Vault Events and Deflationary Model
Another key element in understanding how does Noomez work is its Vault system, which introduces milestone-based rewards during the presale.
Stage 14 Vault: Triggers a strategic burn and airdrops 14 million $NNZ to one verified wallet.
Stage 28 Vault: Unlocks 28 million $NNZ, USDT rewards, and first-edition NFTs while initiating the countdown to launch.
The events are programmed into verified smart contracts to ensure execution without manual interference. Each Vault completion also adds deflationary pressure by removing unsold tokens and permanently reducing supply.
Security and Long-Term Design
Noomez implements safety measures from the start, including audits and locked liquidity.
15% of the total supply is locked for liquidity via a third-party locker.
Team tokens (5%) follow a strict 6-12 month vesting schedule.
Presale staking offers up to 66% APY, with 2× rewards for early stages (1-7).
Post-launch, the Noom Engine distributes partner tokens while staking continues and planned burns occur in accordance with stage milestones.
So, on-chain tracking, verified contracts, and deflationary logic are core security and transparency features of Noomez.
Building a Transparent Ecosystem
To understand how Noomez works means recognizing its approach to visibility. From the live Noom Gauge to open contract verification, every system is measurable. It gives investors data, not speculation, and proof instead of promises.
As the presale is now live, early participants can see progress in real time, stake, and take part in one of the most transparent meme token ecosystems designed for 2025.
XRP is finally having its breakout moment on Wall Street. Since the launch of XRP ETFs in March 2025, over $1 billion has flowed into these funds, showing strong demand from both institutions and retail investors.
With the SEC expected to decide on multiple spot XRP ETF applications soon, Ripple’s native token is positioning itself for a potential big breakout.
Strong Inflows Drive XRP ETF Growth
XRP ETFs have seen remarkable growth, attracting over $1 billion in inflows since their launch, including about $350 million in July alone. Leading funds like the Rex Osprey XRP ETF and Teucrium’s leveraged XRP ETF have driven much of this momentum, with assets surpassing $100 million and $366 million, respectively.
These numbers are similar to the early days of Ethereum and Solana ETFs, showing that XRP is becoming a top choice for serious investors.
The steady money coming in shows people are thinking long-term, supported by XRP’s growing use in global payments and Ripple’s network of over 300 financial institutions.
Road to a Spot XRP ETF
At present, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) is expected to rule on at least seven spot XRP ETF applications between October 18 and November 14, including Grayscale’s highly anticipated proposal.
Meanwhile, Polymarket, a well-known Prediction market, shows a 99% probability that the SEC will approve a spot XRP ETF by the end of 2025.
These decisions could bring billions more from institutional investors, boosting XRP’s price and ETF activity. However, JPMorgan estimates $4– $8 billion in the first year, while some analysts see potential inflows up to $20 billion as XRP adoption grows.
XRP Price Analysis
As of now, XRP price is trading around $2.62, slightly down in the last 24 hours. Thus, renowned chart analyst Ali Martine sees potential for a bullish breakout, projecting prices could rise to the $3.40–$4.20 range in the coming months, particularly if ETF approvals come through.
The introduction of XRP ETFs would not only open new investment opportunities but also bring more stable, institutional-driven liquidity to the XRP market.
The Pi Network community is turning optimistic again after months of decline. Pi Coin (PI) has staged a strong comeback, jumping over 15% in the past 24 hours and gaining more than 30% weekly, as traders eye a breakout above $0.28. The surge follows Pi’s official inclusion in the ISO 20022 group, aligning it with global payment leaders like Ripple (XRP) and Stellar (XLM), a move that could redefine its place in the financial ecosystem.
Why ISO 20022 Matters?
ISO 20022 is reshaping how global payments work. It introduces a unified messaging standard that lets banks and payment providers exchange rich, structured data, such as sender, receiver, and payment details- securely across borders.
The shift is already underway, with SWIFT and the US Federal Reserve’s Fedwire moving toward full ISO 20022 adoption by November 22, 2025. After this date, most global financial institutions will use the standard, setting a new benchmark for speed, transparency, and efficiency in international payments.
Pi Coin Price Gains Momentum
Pi Coin’s price recovery marks a strong return from its $0.19 low earlier this month, finding support near $0.20 and surging to a three-week high above $0.25 before stabilizing around $0.61. Analysts note that the token’s rebound signals growing confidence among traders.
Market analyst Devid James highlighted that while the overall trend looks bullish, $0.36 remains a key resistance. A rejection there could cause a pullback to $0.23, but sustained momentum may push Pi toward a new growth phase.
Joining the ISO 20022 framework puts Pi Network alongside compliant assets like XRP and XLM, opening doors to banking integration and cross-border payment compatibility. This move could make Pi more accessible to institutional players and help it gain recognition within traditional finance, improving its credibility and adoption potential.
What’s Next for Pi Coin?
Pi Network’s growth continues beyond price action. Over 3.36 million users have now completed KYC verification, boosting trust and participation in the ecosystem. Meanwhile, the upcoming Protocol 23 upgrade, set for Q4 2025, aims to enhance scalability and transaction speed, preparing the network for mainstream adoption.
With rising momentum, banking alignment, and a growing user base, Pi Coin is showing signs of real progress. If bulls manage to break past $0.28, Pi could enter a stronger uptrend, marking a major leap toward becoming a key player in crypto-integrated global finance.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What is ISO 20022 and why is it important for Pi Coin?
ISO 20022 is a global payment standard improving speed and security in financial messaging. Pi’s inclusion boosts its credibility and integration potential.
How does joining ISO 20022 benefit the Pi Network?
It positions Pi for smoother banking and cross-border payments, aligning it with trusted networks like Ripple and Stellar for better financial interoperability.
What’s next for the Pi Network in 2025?
The Protocol 23 upgrade will enhance speed and scalability, while rising KYC users and ISO 20022 compliance could drive wider adoption and trust.
It’s again an FOMC day, and again Bitcoin prices have begun to consolidate ahead of the meeting, reflecting the prevailing uncertainty within the markets. The selling pressure has piled up during the last trading day, dragging the levels close to $112,000 from the intraday highs above $116,000. Although the bears have not held a tight grip over the rally, the hawkish stance of the Fed chairman could weaken the bulls. This could further cause more harm to the BTC price rally in the short term.
Bitcoin price has retraced a bit ahead of most of the FOMC meeting, which has largely resulted in a strong breakout. The token recently rebounded before hitting the lower liquidity levels around $111,000, wherein over $100 million in longs were piled up. The trade is still active, suggesting the traders still look out for an entry at this point, while they are unsure above $114,000, as more than $121 million in shorts have already accumulated around this range.
The liquidity levels suggest indecisiveness among the traders as the price remains consolidated between the piled longs and shorts. So in this case, how FOMC may impact the prevailing accumulation, as a rise above $114,000 may trigger shorts, while a drop below $111,000 could liquidate the longs.
Where Will Bitcoin (BTC) Price Head Next?
Regardless of the FOMC volatility, the BTC price largely remains within a bullish structure, a rising parallel channel. The lower-timeframe chart displays a strong rebound from support after a pullback. However, the result of the upcoming FOMC meeting could have a significant impact on the rally, which may either rise above the average zone of the parallel channel or break the support.
Bitcoin is showing immense strength in the hourly chart, validated by the recent rebound, which was much above the pivotal support zone around $110,000. We had some volume spikes, but more importantly, the hourly MACD is about to turn bullish. This suggests the buying volume is slowly superseding the bears. On the other hand, the stochastic RSI just rebounded from the oversold zone, indicating a continued rise for the new hours.
Final Take: Will FOMC Push the Bitcoin Price Above $115,000?
Bitcoin appears to be consolidating within a rising channel, with price action currently testing mid-range support near $112,500. The chart highlights a potential bounce toward the $115,000–$117,000 zone if bulls hold this level, which also aligns with the mid-channel Fibonacci retracement. However, failure to defend the support trendline and the nearby CME gap could trigger a sharp decline toward $108,000–$106,000, marking a deeper correction. The upcoming FOMC decision will likely determine which scenario unfolds.
The next crypto bull run is taking shape amidst bullish CPI data talks. Institutional and retail money are at their peak, as savvy investors seek undervalued cryptos that are flashing early breakout signals. Led by the viral meme token Little Pepe (LILPEPE), here are the three best under-$1 cryptos to buy this cycle for potential explosive gains.
Little Pepe (LILPEPE): The Meme Layer 2 That’s Redefining Utility and Momentum
Little Pepe has become the biggest presale story of 2025, raising over $27.2 million and selling 16.5 billion tokens at $0.0022 in its Stage 13 presale round, a 120% increase from its starting price. That’s not just hype; it’s proof of investor conviction. What sets Little Pepe apart from every other meme project is its cutting-edge Layer 2 chain, explicitly built for memes. It’s sniper-bot resistant, fast, and secure, with zero buy/sell tax and near-zero trading fees, making it the most efficient meme ecosystem in development. The project’s strict vesting schedule eliminates pump-and-dump fears, while high-staking APY rewards long-term holders.
Little Pepe also plans to host new meme projects through its meme-only launchpad, turning LILPEPE into the backbone of an expanding ecosystem rather than a single hype token. With a CertiK audit, Mega Giveaway (15 ETH in rewards), and the $777K campaign still live, Little Pepe is blending strong fundamentals with viral meme energy. If there’s one token that could pull off a 10x to 20x breakout after launch, it’s this one. Verdict: LILPEPE ranks high among the top cryptos under $1 to invest in for 2025, combining tech, trust, and meme virality in one package.
Hedera is quietly shaping up for a significant comeback. The token has rebounded 67% from recent lows, driven by new staking incentives and a 92% surge in stablecoin market cap across its network.
The Hedera Foundation assigned 250 million HBAR tokens to its staking pool, valued at more than $40 million. This benefits those who hold long-term and helps secure the Hedera network. Other technical indicators suggest an inverse head-and-shoulders pattern for the coin. The immediate breakout target is $1, roughly 600% higher than current prices. If the HBAR ETF is confirmed, Hedera may receive a significant increase in institutional investments, making it one of the top cryptos for 2025 in terms of long-term potential and reduced volatility.
Cardano Technical Structure Points Toward a Major Breakout
Following weeks of consolidation, Cardano now boasts one of the strongest technicalsamong the top 20 assets, with ADA trading around $0.65 in a multi-year trading range. Analysts believe a move to $2.50-$2.70 is likely after the pattern concludes.
Cardano has one of the most active communities. It ranks #2 in community engagement among cryptocurrencies. This strong base of loyal holders adds to the stability of ADA’s ongoing recovery. If ADA can defend its $0.60–$0.65 support range and reclaim $0.90, technical targets between $1.20 and $2.50 come into play, making it one of the most undervalued blue-chip cryptos under $1 heading into 2025.
2025 Could Belong to the Smart Early Investors
Each token, Little Pepe, Hedera, and Cardano, represents a unique value play for 2025. ADA offers structure and community strength, HBAR delivers institutional-grade fundamentals, but LILPEPE brings the energy, innovation, and meme-fueled potential this next bull cycle craves. As meme coins evolve into meme ecosystems, Little Pepe’s Layer 2 architecture, sniper-bot-resistant chain, and zero-tax design put it in a class of its own. With its presale momentum and utility-driven ecosystem, LILPEPE could easily become the standout crypto under $1 heading into 2025’s bull run. Join the Little Pepe Presale Today:https://littlepepe.com
For more information about Little Pepe (LILPEPE) visit the links below:
The global financial markets are bracing for a historic shift as the U.S. Federal Reserve is widely expected to begin a new cycle of rate cuts, marking the start of what analysts call a “new era of monetary easing.” The move could ignite a powerful rally across risk assets, with Bitcoin and Ethereum likely to be among the biggest beneficiaries.
FOMC Meeting and FED Rate Cuts
All eyes are on the Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) meeting, set to conclude today, with the Fed almost certain to announce a 25-basis-point rate cut, the first in a series expected to extend well into 2026. According to CME Fed Watch data, there is a 99.4% probability of a 25 bps cut, while just 0.6% expect the Fed to hold rates steady.
Fed Chair Jerome Powell will hold a press conference at 2:30 a.m. ET after the meeting. Investors watch to see if the Fed plans to cut rates in the coming months. More rate cuts are expected on December 10 and January 2026, as the Fed begins lowering rates to support the economy during uncertain times.
Impact on the Global Financial Market
Wall Street veteran Dan Niles believes this cycle could kick off what he describes as a “period of insane wealth creation” across markets. “We’ve seen this playbook before,” Niles said, pointing to the 2021 rate cycle, when inflation surged from 1.4% to 7% and the S&P 500 jumped 27%.
“Everybody’s going to win because you’ve got this easy money,” Niles noted. “Enjoy the party while it lasts.” However, he warned of a 30–50% correction in tech and AI-related stocks by late 2026, predicting that the euphoria could give way to a market “hangover.”
Markets at Record Highs Ahead of Decision
The Dow Jones, S&P 500, and Nasdaq all closed at all-time highs ahead of the Fed’s decision. Traders have already priced in the base-case scenario of a 25 bps cut, while a surprise 50 bps move would send shockwaves through global markets.
A controlled 25 bps cut would reinforce the Fed’s data-dependent approach, while a larger move would signal deeper concern about growth amid a government shutdown that has paused key economic data releases.
If the Fed fails to cut, markets could react sharply — stocks may sell off, bonds could rally, and volatility in the dollar, gold, and crypto would likely spike as investors seek safe havens.
Crypto and Gold Set to Shine
If the rate cut proceeds as expected, liquidity-driven momentum could push Bitcoin and Ethereum higher. Historically, lower interest rates and a softer dollar have favored hard assets and digital stores of value, making crypto a key beneficiary.
“Monetary easing periods tend to fuel speculative assets,” analysts said. “With liquidity returning and yields falling, Bitcoin could reclaim its leadership role as a hedge and growth asset.”
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What is the FOMC meeting and why is it important for crypto investors?
The FOMC is the Federal Reserve’s policy-setting committee. Its decisions on interest rates directly influence market liquidity and investor risk appetite, which are major drivers of cryptocurrency prices.
How do Fed rate cuts impact Bitcoin and other cryptocurrencies?
Lower rates reduce yields on savings, making riskier assets like Bitcoin more attractive. They can also weaken the dollar, often pushing investors toward cryptocurrencies as alternative stores of value.
When will the Federal Reserve announce its interest rate decision?
The announcement is expected today, with Fed Chair Jerome Powell’s press conference following at 2:30 PM Eastern Time. This is when official confirmation of any rate change occurs.
What happens if the Fed does not cut rates as expected?
A surprise hold on rates could trigger a sharp sell-off in stocks and crypto, as it signals a less supportive monetary policy. Investors might flock to safe-haven assets, causing market volatility.
After weeks of sideways trading, veteran trader VirtualBacon believes the crypto market is standing on the edge of something massive, a full-blown liquidity-driven rally. He believes the Federal Reserve’s quiet shift toward ending quantitative tightening (QT) marks the beginning of the next major “crypto melt-up”, sending Bitcoin and altcoins soaring once again.
Fed’s Liquidity Shift Begins
According to VirtualBacon, the biggest event for crypto this year isn’t the Bitcoin halving or ETF approvals, it’s the Federal Reserve’s liquidity pivot.
For over 18 months, the Fed has been in Quantitative Tightening (QT) mode, reducing its $7 trillion balance sheet to fight inflation. This tightening drained cash from markets, pressuring Bitcoin and altcoins.
Fed Liquidity is Here: The Crypto Melt-Up Starts Now
The Fed is on the verge of ending QT, just like 2019 and that means one thing: Liquidity is coming back.
If you know what this means for #Bitcoin and altcoins, you should be excited.
Now, signs indicate this phase may end soon, potentially refilling liquidity and sparking the next crypto rally. Major banks like Goldman Sachs, Bank of America, and Evercore expect QT to conclude by November or December, setting the stage for renewed market momentum.
History Shows Liquidity Drives Crypto Cycles
According to VirtualBacon, every major crypto bull run has aligned with periods when the Fed loosened liquidity.
In 2019, when the Fed prints money, investors rush back into risk assets like Bitcoin, which tripled within months. And when QT stopped, altcoins soared.
In 2022, QT restarted, and altcoins began to tumble.
Now in 2025, as QT comes to an end again, the setup looks strikingly similar to 2019, the year Bitcoin tripled in price.
When central banks inject money, investors typically turn “risk-on,” favoring volatile assets like crypto. The pattern is simple: when the Fed prints, altcoins pump.
Economic indicators are flashing familiar warning signs. Bank reserves are falling, stress in the repo market is rising, and the U.S. Treasury recently added $800 billion to its cash account, temporarily removing liquidity from the system.
This mirrors 2019, when the Fed quietly injected cash in a move called “stealth QE.”
Supporting this outlook, the CME FedWatch tool shows a 99.9% chance of a rate cut this month and an 87.9% chance of another in November or December, pointing to a clear move toward easing.
How This Will Impact Bitcoin and Altcoins
VirtualBacon points out that Bitcoin hasn’t topped yet, and none of the 30 historical peak indicators have triggered. He believes this is a mid-cycle phase, not a market top. With global M2 money supply already rising, and gold leading the way, Bitcoin could soon follow with a sharp move higher.
If liquidity indeed returns, VirtualBacon believes Ethereum, Solana, XRP, and BNB could be the first to surge, paving the way for another broad-based crypto rally.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What does the end of the Fed’s Quantitative Tightening mean for crypto?
It signals rising liquidity, which often boosts Bitcoin and altcoins as investors shift toward riskier assets.
Why does liquidity have such a big impact on Bitcoin and altcoins?
When the Fed adds liquidity, money flows into risk assets like crypto, driving prices higher across major tokens.
Could ending QT trigger the next crypto bull run?
Yes, many analysts believe more liquidity could ignite a new rally, similar to Bitcoin’s surge after 2019’s easing.
How might the Fed’s upcoming rate cuts affect the crypto market?
Rate cuts lower borrowing costs and increase liquidity, creating a favorable environment for Bitcoin and altcoins to rise.
Today pi coin price has stirred up excitement with a sharp jump. After trading sideways, Pi price suddenly broke out on strong trading volume and is trending higher. The catalyst? Pi Network just joined the ISO 20022 group, a move that caught the market’s attention.
This fresh alignment with global banking standards, coupled with a big reduction in tokens on exchanges. Moreover, a technical breakout, has transformed pi coin’s near-term outlook. As curiosity around ISO 20022 and pi coin price today grows, I’ll walk you through what’s driving this run and whether momentum can last.
Pi Coin Price Analysis
The Pi price has been on a roll, gaining +15.4% over the past 24 hours and +29.69% for the week. Today Pi Network price is $0.2638, rebounding after dipping to a 24 hour low of $0.2276 and peaking at $0.2706. The daily market cap stands at $2.18 billion, while trading volumes have cooled to $94.31 million, down 15.58% as some traders take profits.
On the technical side, the Pi network price had been stuck in a week-long range. Squeezed between key support at $0.23 and resistance at $0.28. As the ISO 20022 news landed, buyers overwhelmed the sell wall at $0.28, pushing the price to new short-term highs.
Supporting this bullishness is a sharp drop in exchange supply. Data shows that roughly 10 million PI tokens left exchange wallets, which typically signals stronger hands are accumulating and less coin is available for quick sale. This supply crunch can amplify price swings.
Can the rally continue? Momentum looks healthy for now, but Pi coin faces the next resistance at $0.3626. If broader crypto markets cooperate and the project delivers further institutional progress, today Pi coin price could grind higher. Watch $0.23 as critical support if the rally fades, but so far, sentiment feels upbeat.
FAQs
Why is Pi Coin price going up?
Pi Network’s price jump was driven by Pi Network joining the ISO 20022 banking standards group. Combined with a technical breakout above $0.28 resistance and a shrinking exchange supply.
How important is ISO 20022 compliance for Pi Coin?
ISO 20022 aligns Pi Network with global banking systems, putting it in the same league as XRP and Stellar.
Is now a good time to buy Pi coin?
Momentum is currently strong thanks to bullish news and shrinking sell-side supply. However, the market remains volatile, so it’s wise to watch for a confirmed trend.
Record XRP and Solana futures activity pushed open interest on the derivatives giant’s platform to roughly $3 billion, signaling renewed retail and institutional appetite for altcoin exposure.
After a quick jump toward $116,094 faded, buyers showed up near $112,500 while analysts watched $120,000 as the level that could clear the way toward $143,000.
Ethereum’s Fusaka update has debuted on Hoodi, its final testnet, and is slated to bring several security and scalability improvements to the blockchain’s mainnet.
Bitcoin is showing early signs of recovery after a volatile month, with data from Binance hinting that market sentiment may be turning in favor of buyers. Bitcoin traded near $113,060 at press time, down 0.7% in the past 24 hours,…
Ethereum’s Fusaka upgrade has gone live on the network’s final testnet, Hoodi, as developers prepare for the mainnet launch slated for December. According to the team at Nethermind, an Ethereum execution client, the Hoodi Fork was “successfully completed” on Oct.…
Crypto.com has partnered with Pineapple Financial to provide custody and staking infrastructure for its INJ treasury, adding to its growing roster of institutional custody clients. Crypto.com and NYSE-listed Pineapple Financial Inc. have entered a strategic partnership under which Crypto.com will…
Australia is tightening its grip on the crypto industry as regulators move to redefine what falls under financial oversight. The Australian Securities and Investments Commission (ASIC) has broadened its regulatory scope on digital assets. On Wednesday, October 29, the commission…
South Korean BDACS’ official stablecoin, KRW1, will be issued on Circle’s blockchain Arc. This marks the second integration for the stablecoin after its initial launch on Avalanche. According to a recent report by Yonhap News, South Korean digital asset company…
Hedera price is close to confirming a death cross on the daily chart, following the launch of its first spot ETF. According to data from crypto.news, Hedera (HBAR) has dropped 34% from its July high and nearly 50% from its…
U.S. tech firm Cybastion hosts Mauritania for digital transformation, while Vietnam's agriculture embraces digital technologies for sustainable growth.
Solana failed to stay above $200 and corrected gains. SOL price is now trading below $200 and might decline further if it dips below $192.
SOL price started a downside correction below $200 against the US Dollar.
The price is now trading below $198 and the 100-hourly simple moving average.
There was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $198 on the hourly chart of the SOL/USD pair (data source from Kraken).
The pair could extend losses if it dips below the $192 zone.
Solana Price Corrects Some Gains
Solana price started a decent increase after it settled above the $192 zone, beating Bitcoin and Ethereum. SOL climbed above the $198 level to enter a short-term positive zone.
The price even smashed the $200 resistance. A high was formed near $205 and the price recently corrected some gains. There was a move below the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the upward wave from the $177 swing low to the $205 high.
Besides, there was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $198 on the hourly chart of the SOL/USD pair. Solana is now trading below $198 and the 100-hourly simple moving average.
On the upside, the price is facing resistance near the $198 level. The next major resistance is near the $200 level. The main resistance could be $205. A successful close above the $205 resistance zone could set the pace for another steady increase. The next key resistance is $212. Any more gains might send the price toward the $220 level.
More Losses In SOL?
If SOL fails to rise above the $200 resistance, it could start another decline. Initial support on the downside is near the $192 zone and the 50% Fib retracement level of the upward wave from the $177 swing low to the $205 high. The first major support is near the $188 level.
A break below the $188 level might send the price toward the $180 support zone. If there is a close below the $180 support, the price could decline toward the $166 support in the near term.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for SOL/USD is gaining pace in the bearish zone.
Hourly Hours RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for SOL/USD is below the 50 level.
Dogecoin saw a sharp jump in trading activity on Tuesday, but prices did not follow immediately. Volume over the last 24 hours rose by 60%, pushing total traded value above $2 billion, according to CoinMarketCap.
Yet the token traded near $0.21 at the time of the report, down about 0.18% in the day and down 12% so far this month.
Trading Volume Surges
According to CoinMarketCap data, the sudden spike in volume shows many more hands moving DOGE than usual. Reports have disclosed that this wave of trades coincides with renewed interest among retail buyers and larger holders.
Data shows that October has historically been a strong month for Dogecoin, with modest gains of 30% to a more impressive 101% from 2021 up to 2024. Those past returns help explain why some traders expect a positive close this month.
Whales Move, Exchanges See Flow
Reports have disclosed several large transfers tied to the surge. One report described a dormant whale with a 36 DOGE seed reactivating and making a transfer valued at $26.8 million to Binance.
Another dormant wallet reportedly moved 15.115 million DOGE, valued at about $2.95 million, out of the same exchange. These movements drew attention because big transfers can change where liquidity sits and how quickly prices move when buying or selling picks up.
Another dormant wallet reportedly moved 15 million DOGE, valued at about nearly $3 million, out of Binance. These movements drew attention because big transfers can change where liquidity sits and how quickly prices move when buying or selling picks up.
Macro Drivers And Market Sentiment
The volume surge came as major cryptocurrencies showed strength. Reports have disclosed Bitcoin moving higher toward $115,000 while Ethereum traded near $4,200.
That broader rally can lift smaller tokens as traders rotate capital across markets. Still, metrics are mixed: one recent forecast predicted DOGE could rise by 13% to $0.22 by November 27, 2025, while technical indicators flagged the current sentiment as Bearish and the Fear & Greed Index sat at 50.
Outlook And Risks Ahead
The picture is straightforward and messy at the same time. Higher volume suggests interest; price action says caution. Whale transfers can both fuel rallies and add selling pressure, depending on intent.
Traders watching the symmetrical triangle will likely wait for a clear break up or down before making bigger bets. Those looking at seasonal trends may find hope in October’s past strength, but historical gains do not guarantee future returns.
Featured image from Unsplash, chart from TradingView
XRP price started a fresh increase above $2.550. The price is now facing hurdles above $2.650 and at risk of another decline in the near term.
XRP price gained pace for a move above $2.60 and $2.620 before the bears appeared.
The price is now trading below $2.60 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average.
There was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $2.6350 on the hourly chart of the XRP/USD pair (data source from Kraken).
The pair could start a fresh increase if it stays above $2.50.
XRP Price Retreats Lower
XRP price started a fresh increase after it settled above $2.50, like Bitcoin and Ethereum. The price surpassed the $2.550 and $2.60 resistance levels.
The bulls were able to push the price above $2.650. A high was formed at $2.6972 and the price recently started a downside correction. There was a move below the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the recent move from the $2.327 swing low to the $2.6972 high.
Besides, there was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $2.6350 on the hourly chart of the XRP/USD pair. The price is now trading below $2.60 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average.
If there is a fresh upward move, the price might face resistance near the $2.620 level. The first major resistance is near the $2.650 level, above which the price could rise and test $2.6880. A clear move above the $2.6880 resistance might send the price toward the $2.720 resistance. Any more gains might send the price toward the $2.7650 resistance. The next major hurdle for the bulls might be near $2.80.
More Losses?
If XRP fails to clear the $2.650 resistance zone, it could start a fresh decline. Initial support on the downside is near the $2.5650 level. The next major support is near the $2.550 level.
If there is a downside break and a close below the $2.550 level, the price might continue to decline toward $2.5120 or the 50% Fib retracement level of the recent move from the $2.327 swing low to the $2.6972 high. The next major support sits near the $2.450 zone, below which the price could continue lower toward $2.40.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for XRP/USD is now gaining pace in the bearish zone.
Hourly RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for XRP/USD is now below the 50 level.
Ethereum-focused treasury company ETHZilla said it has sold roughly $40 million worth of ether to fund ongoing share repurchases, a maneuver aimed at closing what it calls a “significant discount to NAV.” In a press statement on Monday, the company disclosed that since Friday, October 24, it has bought back about 600,000 common shares for approximately $12 million under a broader authorization of up to $250 million, and that it intends to continue buying while the discount persists.
ETHZilla Dumps ETH For BuyBacks
The company framed the buybacks as balance-sheet arbitrage rather than a strategic retreat from its core Ethereum exposure. “We are leveraging the strength of our balance sheet, including reducing our ETH holdings, to execute share repurchases,” chairman and CEO McAndrew Rudisill said, adding that ETH sales are being used as “cash” while common shares trade below net asset value. He argued the transactions would be immediately accretive to remaining shareholders.
ETHZilla amplified the message on X, saying it would “use its strong balance sheet to support shareholders through buybacks, reduce shares available for short borrow, [and] drive up NAV per share” and reiterating that it still holds “~$400 million of ETH” on the balance sheet and carries “no net debt.” The company also cited “recent, concentrated short selling” as a factor keeping the stock under pressure.
The market-structure logic is straightforward: when a digital-asset treasury trades below the value of its coin holdings and cash, buying back stock with “coin-cash” can, in theory, collapse the discount and lift NAV per share. But the optics are contentious inside crypto because the mechanism requires selling the underlying asset—here, ETH—to purchase equity, potentially weakening the very treasury backing that investors originally sought.
Death Spiral Incoming?
Popular crypto trader SalsaTekila (@SalsaTekila) commented on X: “This is extremely bearish, especially if it invites similar behavior. ETH treasuries are not Saylor; they haven’t shown diamond-hand will. If treasury companies start dumping the coin to buy shares, it’s a death spiral setup.”
Skeptics also zeroed in on funding choices. “I am mostly curious why the company chose to sell ETH and not use the $569m in cash they had on the balance sheet last month,” another analyst Dan Smith wrote, noting ETHZilla had just said it still holds about $400 million of ETH and thus didn’t deploy it on fresh ETH accumulation. “Why not just use cash?” The question cuts to the core of treasury signaling: using ETH as a liquidity reservoir to defend a discounted equity can be read as rational capital allocation, or as capitulation that undermines the ETH-as-reserve narrative.
Beyond the buyback, a retail-driven storyline has rapidly formed around the stock. Business Insider reported that Dimitri Semenikhin—who recently became the face of the Beyond Meat surge—has targeted ETHZilla, saying he purchased roughly 2% of the company at what he views as a 50% discount to modified NAV. He has argued that the market is misreading ETHZilla’s balance sheet because it still reflects legacy biotech results rather than the current digital-asset treasury model.
The same report cites liquid holdings on the order of 102,300 ETH and roughly $560 million in cash, translating to about $62 per share in liquid assets, and calls out a 1-for-10 reverse split on October 15 that, in his view, muddied the optics for retail. Semenikhin flagged November 13 as a potential catalyst if results show the pivot to ETH generating profits.
The company’s own messaging emphasizes the discount-to-NAV lens rather than a change in strategy. ETHZilla told investors it would keep buying while the stock trades below asset value and highlighted a goal of shrinking lendable supply to blunt short-selling pressure.
For Ethereum markets, the immediate flow effect is limited—$40 million is marginal in ETH’s daily liquidity—but the second-order risk flagged by traders is behavioral contagion. If other ETH-heavy treasuries follow the playbook, selling the underlying to buy their own stock, the flow could become pro-cyclical: coins are sold to close equity discounts, the selling pressures spot, and wider discounts reappear as equity screens rerate to the weaker mark—repeat.
That is the “death spiral” scenario skeptics warn about when the treasury asset doubles as the company’s signal of conviction.
Ethereum price started a downside correction from $4,250. ETH is moving lower below $4,000 and might decline further if it trades below $3,920.
Ethereum started a downside correction below $4,150 and $4,050.
The price is trading below $4,050 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average.
There was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $4,100 on the hourly chart of ETH/USD (data feed via Kraken).
The pair could continue to move down if it trades below $3,920.
Ethereum Price Starts Downside Correction
Ethereum price extended gains above the $4,050 level, like Bitcoin. ETH price even surpassed $4,200 before the bears appeared. A high was formed at $4,252 and the price recently started a downside correction.
There was a move below the $4,120 and $4,050 levels. The price dipped below the 50% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $3,708 swing low to the $4,252 high. Moreover, there was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $4,100 on the hourly chart of ETH/USD.
Ethereum price is now trading below $4,080 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average. If there is another increase, the price could face resistance near the $4,040 level. The next key resistance is near the $4,080 level.
The first major resistance is near the $4,120 level. A clear move above the $4,120 resistance might send the price toward the $4,200 resistance. An upside break above the $4,200 region might call for more gains in the coming sessions. In the stated case, Ether could rise toward the $4,240 resistance zone or even $4,250 in the near term.
More Losses In ETH?
If Ethereum fails to clear the $4,080 resistance, it could start a fresh decline. Initial support on the downside is near the $3,950 level. The first major support sits near the $3,920 zone and the 61.8% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $3,708 swing low to the $4,252 high.
A clear move below the $3,920 support might push the price toward the $3,880 support. Any more losses might send the price toward the $3,840 region in the near term. The next key support sits at $3,780.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for ETH/USD is gaining momentum in the bearish zone.
Hourly RSI – The RSI for ETH/USD is now below the 50 zone.
XRP hovers at a key resistance, signaling a crucial decision point. With momentum building, traders now wonder, will one final dip come before the next major breakout?
XRP Faces A Crucial Decision Zone Amid Ongoing Range
CasiTrades, in a recent market update, highlighted that XRP continues to range within a critical zone, keeping its setup for a potential final wave down valid. The analyst noted that the price remains at a key decision point, with ongoing tests of the Wave 4 highs acting as a firm ceiling against further upside movement.
According to CasiTrades, the pivotal level to watch is $2.82 on Binance. A confirmed breakout and sustained hold above this resistance would invalidate the bearish setup and signal renewed bullish momentum. However, XRP has so far failed to push through, maintaining a range-bound structure between support and resistance, a sign that the market has yet to commit to a clear directional trend.
The analyst emphasized that a V-shaped recovery typically breaks through resistance with strong conviction, but such a move has not been seen here. Instead, XRP’s hesitancy indicates that selling pressure may still be present, preventing a clean continuation to the upside.
Exchange Variations Add Complexity To Market Analysis
CasiTrades went on to explain that most major exchanges are now aligning around their key Fibonacci retracement levels, particularly the 0.618 zone. On Binance, this range sits between $1.35 and $1.46, which the analyst identified as the area where the next corrective wave could complete. According to the expert, this move would finalize the macro Wave 2 correction, paving the way for a powerful Wave 3 impulse that might propel XRP toward $6.50 or even $10.
The analyst emphasized that these lower price levels shouldn’t be viewed as a cause for concern but rather as valuable accumulation opportunities for long-term investors. Historically, zones like these have marked points of strong institutional buying and major trend reversals, presenting some of the best risk-to-reward setups before a large bullish expansion.
CasiTrades also noted that exchange discrepancies add a layer of complexity to the analysis. For instance, during a recent liquidation event, Binance briefly fell to $0.77, while Coinbase never reached its .618 retracement. This variation means traders should always chart on the specific exchange they plan to execute trades on, as price reactions can differ slightly between platforms. In conclusion, the analyst noted that until XRP breaks and holds above $2.82, the market structure still supports the idea of one final downward wave before a major upward cycle begins.
Bitcoin price is correcting gains below $113,500. BTC could continue to move down if it stays below the $114,200 resistance.
Bitcoin started a downside correction below the $114,200 support.
The price is trading below $114,000 and the 100 hourly Simple moving average.
There was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $114,050 on the hourly chart of the BTC/USD pair (data feed from Kraken).
The pair might continue to move down if it trades below the $112,000 zone.
Bitcoin Price Starts Pullback
Bitcoin price extended gains above the $113,500 zone. BTC gained pace for a move above the $115,000 pivot level. The price even spiked above $116,200 before the bears appeared.
A high was formed at $116,309 and the price is now correcting some gains. There was a move below the $114,200 support zone. The price dipped below the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $106,718 swing low to the $116,309 high.
Moreover, there was a break below a bullish trend line with support at $114,050 on the hourly chart of the BTC/USD pair. Bitcoin is now trading below $114,000 and the 100 hourly Simple moving average.
Immediate resistance on the upside is near the $113,650 level. The first key resistance is near the $114,200 level. The next resistance could be $115,000. A close above the $115,000 resistance might send the price further higher. In the stated case, the price could rise and test the $116,200 resistance. Any more gains might send the price toward the $117,500 level. The next barrier for the bulls could be $118,000.
More Losses In BTC?
If Bitcoin fails to rise above the $114,200 resistance zone, it could continue to move down. Immediate support is near the $112,000 level. The first major support is near the $111,500 level or the 50% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $106,718 swing low to the $116,309 high.
The next support is now near the $110,500 zone. Any more losses might send the price toward the $110,000 support in the near term. The main support sits at $108,500, below which BTC might struggle to recover in the short term.
Technical indicators:
Hourly MACD – The MACD is now gaining pace in the bearish zone.
Hourly RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for BTC/USD is now below the 50 level.
Major Support Levels – $112,000, followed by $111,500.
Are investors ready for Uptober rallies, or are Fed rate concerns causing jitters? The hunt for top cryptos to invest in today has intensified as institutional inflows and ETF developments drive market optimism. Sub-dollar tokens, presales, and meme coins are stealing attention for accessibility, upside potential, and hype. Strategic early entry is vital to maximize gains, as timing, conviction, and momentum determine returns. Social engagement, scarcity mechanics, and staking incentives are key to positioning for success in volatile markets, ensuring early participants in top crypto presales capture multi-fold opportunities in 2025.
BullZilla embodies this high-potential strategy. Built on Ethereum, it merges cinematic storytelling, deflationary mechanics, and staking rewards. Each lore chapter triggers Roar Burns to shrink supply, rewarding holders. Stage 8 (Echoes of the Bull), Phase 2, has raised over $980,000, with 31 billion tokens sold to more than 3,300 holders. Referral bonuses encourage community growth with 10 percent extra on $50+ purchases and earnings from friends’ buys. With automated price surges every $100,000 or 48 hours, BullZilla stands among the most compelling top cryptos to invest in today.
“Don’t miss BullZilla at $0.00019906, claim your early stake before the next Roar Burn ignites!”
Bitcoin declined 1.18 percent to $114,149.11 despite renewed optimism for a US-China trade deal. Treasury Secretary Scott Bessent announced a “very substantial framework” ahead of the APEC summit. Bitcoin surged above $116K in reaction to improved sentiment. Twenty-four-hour trading volume jumped 87.11 percent to $62.55 billion, with total market cap climbing 1.95 percent. Futures open interest reached $76.18 billion, while short sellers faced $123.3 million in liquidations, showing strong long investor positioning. Institutional confidence and global optimism continue supporting BTC, highlighting why it remains a prime contender among the top cryptos to invest in today.
Market participants are closely watching Thursday’s Trump–Xi meeting in South Korea. On-chain data shows BTC fluctuating between $113,015.30 and $116,273.31 since Sunday, indicating volatility. Long-term holders continue leveraging dips for accumulation. Stocks also rallied alongside BTC, reflecting broader market optimism. This combination of institutional positioning, market metrics, and macroeconomic catalysts reinforces Bitcoin’s status as a key benchmark in early-stage presales and emerging high-momentum coins. Investors seeking the top cryptos to invest in today can monitor these developments to strategically time entries and maximize potential upside.
Frequently Asked Questions About Bitcoin
Why did Bitcoin dip to $114,149.11?
Bitcoin fell 1.18 percent due to profit-taking and market adjustments following recent gains. Despite the dip, US-China trade optimism and institutional accumulation support long-term confidence and potential for early presale and token investment opportunities.
How does US-China trade news impact Bitcoin?
News of a substantial trade framework lifted market sentiment. Optimism around the Trump–Xi meeting encouraged institutional inflows, supporting Bitcoin’s price stability and growth potential among top cryptos to invest in today.
BullZilla: Top Crypto to Invest in Today
BullZilla is among the top cryptos to invest in today, combining cinematic narrative, scarcity mechanics, and high-yield staking. Each lore chapter triggers Roar Burns, reducing supply. The HODL Furnace delivers 70 percent APY for long-term holders, while referral bonuses promote community growth. Its presale stages, automated price surges, and multi-layered ecosystem create a unique investment opportunity, blending hype and utility. With over $980,000 raised and 3,300 holders, BullZilla demonstrates measurable growth, making it a standout in the top cryptos to invest in today for both early believers and strategic investors.
BullZilla Targets 2,548% ROI While Bitcoin Faces 1.18% Dip and Bitcoin Cash Stays Resilient: Top Cryptos to Invest in Today 23
Stage 8 (Echoes of the Bull), Phase 2, sees BZIL trading at $0.00019906. ROI from Stage 8B to listing at $0.00527 is projected at 2,548.15 percent, while early participants enjoy 3,361.91 percent. A $3,000 investment secures 15.069 million tokens. Referral bonuses add 10 percent extra for $50+ purchases, with friends’ buys contributing additional earnings. Price surges occur every $100,000 raised or 48 hours. The combination of scarcity, staking, and community-driven growth positions BullZilla as one of the top cryptos to invest in today.
$3,000 Investment Scenario: Ride the Roar to Massive Returns
A $3,000 investment in BullZilla at $0.00019906 provides 15.069 million tokens. At listing, the projected value exceeds $79,400, excluding referral and staking rewards. Roar Burns shrinks supply, amplifying scarcity and potential ROI. Strategic entry timing maximizes advantage. Early participation blends momentum, loyalty, and foresight, making this presale rocket fuel for early believers. For investors seeking the top cryptos to invest in today, BullZilla combines fun, utility, and measurable growth potential in a high-impact presale environment.
How to Join BullZilla Presale
Connect a compatible wallet, select your investment, and confirm before the next price trigger. Purchases over $50 earna 10 percent bonus, plus 10 percent from friends’ buys. Rewards unlock after two weeks. Price rises every $100,000 or 48 hours, creating urgency. This structure ensures scarcity, momentum, and community engagement. Joining BullZilla’s presale offers strategic access to one of the top cryptos to invest in today while securing staking opportunities, referral rewards, and early participation benefits for maximum potential growth.
Roar Burn Mechanism (8 B Tokens)
BullZilla’s Roar Burn reduces 8 billion tokens as each lore chapter progresses. Supply decreases permanently, boosting scarcity and value. Combined with staking and referrals, this mechanism incentivizes long-term holding and amplifies investor ROI. The live burn events enhance transparency, creating excitement in the community. This unique approach positions BullZilla as a standout among the top cryptos to invest in today, blending scarcity, utility, and hype into a measurable growth engine that rewards both loyalty and strategic presale participation.
FAQs About BullZilla Presale
What makes BullZilla different from other crypto presales?
BullZilla combines cinematic storytelling, Roar Burns, staking, and referrals. Its structured presale, scarcity mechanics, and community engagement make it a top crypto presale for measurable returns and long-term growth.
What ROI can investors expect from BullZilla?
Stage 8B participants project 2,548.15 percent ROI to listing. Early believers, plus staking and referral bonuses, can achieve even higher gains, making BullZilla one of the top cryptos to invest in today.
When do referral rewards unlock?
Referral bonuses unlock two weeks post-purchase to ensure liquidity and fair distribution, reinforcing investor confidence and rewarding early presale participation in BullZilla’s ecosystem.
Educational Insight: Why Presales Can Be Life-Changing Investments
Presales offer early access to tokens before public listings, allowing investors to benefit from low entry prices, referral bonuses, and staking rewards. Structured presales like BullZilla provide scarcity, momentum, and measurable ROI. Early participation builds community influence while compounding potential returns. Timing, research, and strategic engagement are crucial. Understanding tokenomics, vesting schedules, and ecosystem mechanics ensures informed decision-making. Presales can transform modest investments into significant portfolios when combined with scarcity-driven mechanisms. They are especially valuable in high-momentum markets, positioning investors for maximum gains. For those seeking the top cryptos to invest in today, presales remain a key strategic tool.
“Secure Your BullZilla Tokens Now, the 3.35% Price Surge is Approaching Fast, and Early Believers Always Roar Louder!”
Bitcoin Cash ($BCH) , Price Adjusts to $555.54
Bitcoin Cash decreased 0.84 percent to $555.54 amid market corrections. Despite this, network adoption and merchant use remain steady. Daily transaction volumes indicate consistent usage, and liquidity remains strong. Analysts see the dip as a short-term entry point for strategic investors. BCH continues to attract attention in the payments space, maintaining relevance alongside emerging presales like BullZilla. Price adjustments reflect natural volatility, while long-term growth potential remains supported by network utility and infrastructure development. Investors tracking the top cryptos to invest in today consider BCH as a complementary, stable exposure.
Short-term price action provides accumulation opportunities for investors. BCH’s robust blockchain, low transaction fees, and increasing adoption in the retail sector support long-term prospects. Market observers highlight its value as a stable alternative amid high-volatility altcoins. Combined with emerging presales, BCH allows diversified entry strategies. Understanding network fundamentals, adoption trends, and ecosystem upgrades helps investors make informed decisions. Strategic positioning in BCH complements high-momentum presales like BullZilla, aligning risk management with growth potential for those seeking the top cryptos to invest in today.
Frequently Asked Questions About Bitcoin Cash
Why did Bitcoin Cash fall 0.84 percent?
Bitcoin Cash declined 0.84 percent due to short-term market corrections and profit-taking. Despite the dip, adoption and liquidity remain strong, supporting its status among top cryptos to invest in today.
Bitcoin Cash still a good investment?
Yes. BCH’s network utility, merchant adoption, and low fees make it appealing for strategic investors. It complements high-potential presales like BullZilla for portfolio diversification and long-term growth.
BullZilla Targets 2,548% ROI While Bitcoin Faces 1.18% Dip and Bitcoin Cash Stays Resilient: Top Cryptos to Invest in Today 24
Conclusion
The top cryptos to invest in today require careful analysis of market trends, adoption, and institutional support. Bitcoin showed minor corrections amid US-China trade optimism, while Bitcoin Cash demonstrated steady adoption and utility. Investors seeking high-potential entries can combine stablecoins with emerging presales for diversification, timing, and growth potential. Early positioning and strategic engagement remain essential for maximizing ROI, particularly in volatile markets where momentum and scarcity define success.
BullZilla exemplifies the most compelling presale opportunity with Stage 8 metrics: over $980,000 raised, 31 billion tokens sold, and 3,300 holders. ROI to listing at $0.00527 is projected at 2,548.15 percent, with additional gains from staking and referrals. Automated Roar Burns and scarcity mechanics enhance value while preserving liquidity. Combining high-yield mechanics, community growth, and timing, BullZilla continues to dominate as one of the top cryptos to invest in today, offering measurable potential and strategic exposure for early believers.
“BullZilla’s Presale is Climbing Rapidly, Join Today and Ride the Wave Before the Next Historic Milestone!
BullZilla Targets 2,548% ROI While Bitcoin Faces 1.18% Dip and Bitcoin Cash Stays Resilient: Top Cryptos to Invest in Today 25
Cryptocurrency investments are subject to market risk. This content is for informational purposes only and should not be taken as financial advice. Always DYOR before investing.
Amid the emergence of XRP treasury companies, the XRP price could react favorably if these firms scale up to amass up to 15% of the total XRP supply. Notably, a growing number of companies have started building XRP treasuries this year as regulatory clarity improves in the United States.
XRP technical analyst 24hrscrypto1 has reignited optimism across the XRP community by declaring that “something big is going on.” He went on to add that the price of XRP will reach $100 way before 2030. The statement comes just days after he reaffirmed his firm belief that XRP will hit $100 by 2030.
Crypto prices today are drifting lower ahead of the U.S. Federal Reserve’s policy update. The total market capitalization has slipped 1.5% to $3.88 trillion, with most major tokens posting slight losses. At press time, Bitcoin trades at $112,831, down 1%…
Bitcoin is fighting to close October in positive territory, a key historical signal.
The month has been highly volatile, with a 13% correction at one point.
A series of technical indicators are now pointing to a bullish short-term structure.
It has been an up-and-down and often frustrating month for Bitcoin traders, a period of wild price swings that has put the seasonal promise of an “Uptober” rally to a severe test.
Now, with just a few days left in the month, a tense battle is underway as the bulls fight to keep the world’s leading cryptocurrency in positive territory, a goal that could have significant implications for the rest of the year.
Historically, October has been a powerful launchpad for Bitcoin, delivering average gains of more than 20%. But this year has been a different story.
After spiking above $123,000 early in the month, the market was hit by a brutal 13% correction that saw prices plummet to $107,000.
Since then, the bulls have been in a grinding, hard-fought recovery, with the price currently hovering around $115,000, a meager 1.14% gain for the month.
A powerful macro tailwind provides support
This fragile recovery is being supported by a powerful macroeconomic tailwind.
Traditional markets are firing on all cylinders, with the S&P 500 hitting fresh record highs as investors confidently price in a quarter-point interest rate cut from the Federal Reserve this week.
This dovish monetary policy, combined with an easing of US-China trade tensions, has propelled a “risk-on” sentiment that typically benefits assets like crypto.
Adding another layer of support is a renewed wave of institutional interest.
Spot Bitcoin ETFs have now recorded their third consecutive day of inflows, a clear signal of conviction from the market’s larger and more influential players.
The view from the charts: a bullish structure takes shape
A deep dive into the technical charts reveals a bullish short-term structure that suggests the path of least resistance is now to the upside.
The Average Directional Index (ADX), a key measure of trend strength, is sitting at a strong 32.14, a reading that suggests the current upward momentum is likely to persist.
At the same time, the Squeeze Momentum Indicator is flashing a “bullish Impulse,” a high-probability signal that directional movement to the upside is just beginning.
The Ichimoku Cloud analysis also shows Bitcoin trading above the clouds, another classic indicator of trend continuation.
The final hurdle: a pivotal Fed decision
While the technical and macro pictures are aligning in favour of the bulls, a major and binary risk event looms on the horizon: the Federal Reserve’s policy announcement on Wednesday.
While the market is pricing in a 25-basis-point cut, any hawkish language about the future path of interest rates could easily trigger a wave of short-term volatility.
The key for the bulls will be whether Bitcoin can maintain its critical support above the $114,000 level through any Fed-related turbulence.
If it can, then this “Uptober,” while not as explosive as many had hoped, may still end in the green, setting the stage for a potentially powerful final two months of the year.
The first-ever spot ETFs for Solana (SOL), Litecoin (LTC), and Hedera (HBAR) began trading on Wall Street yesterday, marking a big moment for altcoins. But as these products go live, many investors are asking one question: when will XRP ETFs arrive?
According to the report, seven U.S. spot XRP ETF filings are currently under review by the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). The agency is expected to make decisions between October 18 and November 14, following its September approval of new generic listing standards for spot crypto ETFs.
Market data platform Polymarket now shows a greater than 99% probability that the SEC will approve a spot XRP ETF by the end of 2025. That level of confidence suggests strong institutional expectation that XRP will soon follow Bitcoin, Ethereum, and Solana in joining the U.S. ETF market.
Futures Listing Clears an Important Regulatory Path
Ripple’s report points out that XRP has now met a key regulatory condition for ETF approval. The SEC’s updated listing framework requires a minimum of six months of regulated futures trading before any spot crypto ETF can be listed.
XRP futures began trading on Coinbase Derivatives Exchange on April 21, 2025, and later on the CME Group on May 18, 2025. Based on this timeline, XRP completes its six-month futures requirement by late November, allowing for potential SEC approval and a U.S. spot XRP ETF launch by the end of 2025.
Global Launches Strengthen XRP’s Case
While the U.S. review continues, international markets have already moved ahead. Three spot XRP ETFs launched in Canada in June 2025, while Hashdex introduced the world’s first XRP spot ETF in Brazil in April.
These developments add pressure on U.S. regulators to follow suit, especially now that ETFs for Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera are trading actively on Wall Street.
Ripple-SEC Case Officially Closed
The legal uncertainty around XRP has also been resolved. On August 7, Ripple and the SEC jointly dropped their appeals in the Second Circuit Court. This confirmed Judge Analisa Torres’ July 2023 ruling as the final judgment in the case.
That ruling stated that Ripple’s programmatic sales of XRP on retail exchanges did not violate securities laws, though institutional sales did. Ripple agreed to pay a $125 million civil fine to close the matter.
With the case now legally settled, Ripple says the company is “well-positioned to support regulated financial products built on XRP,” hinting that ETF approval may only be a matter of time.
Maple Finance is taking a major step toward sustainability as its community backs a proposal to end SYRUP staking and shift to a revenue-driven buyback model. Maple Finance is preparing to end staking rewards for its SYRUP token under a…
World Liberty Financial has unveiled a new rewards initiative aimed at recognizing early participants in its USD1 stablecoin ecosystem. World Liberty Financial has announced a new rewards initiative for early adopters of its USD1 stablecoin. According to an Oct. 29…
The Bank of Korea should make clear rules for stablecoin issuers, allowing banks and non-banks to issue the tokens, says Kaia DLT Foundation chair Dr. Sangmin Seo.
The Dogecoin price is fighting to hold the psychological $0.20 support as large investors continue offloading holdings and leveraged traders exit the market. The Dogecoin price briefly traded above $0.21 earlier this week, but has since slipped by more than 2%, highlighting the mounting selling pressure in the market.
According to on-chain data, whales have sold over 500 million DOGE tokens in the past week, fueling fears of further downside. The selloff coincides with a sharp 61% drop in futures open interest, plunging from $5.03 billion to $1.95 billion, signaling widespread position liquidations and trader fatigue.
Futures Liquidations and Weak Technicals Weigh on Momentum
Derivatives data show declining participation across major exchanges, with traders closing out long positions rather than adding new exposure. Meanwhile, Dogecoin’s 24-hour trading volume surged 17.5% to nearly $2 billion, a sign that sellers remain in control even as overall market recovery stalls.
Technical indicators paint a similarly cautious picture. On the daily chart, the Dogecoin price is forming a potential “death cross” between the 50-day and 200-day exponential moving averages, a bearish pattern that often precedes a further drop.
If sustained selling continues, analysts warn the Dogecoin price could fall toward the $0.166 support, which aligns with the lower boundary of its long-term ascending trendline.
However, this same trendline has historically triggered strong rebounds. Previous retests have led to price recoveries of nearly 100%, leaving some traders optimistic that a similar setup could emerge if support holds firm.
Consolidation or Collapse? Key Dogecoin Price Levels to Watch
Currently, Dogecoin price hovers near $0.20 with a market cap of $30.3 billion, holding above the critical psychological zone but struggling to regain upward momentum. The immediate resistance lies between $0.204 and $0.210, while a decisive close below $0.19 could accelerate losses toward $0.18–$0.166.
For now, the balance between whale distribution and new buyer demand will determine DOGE’s next move. If fresh inflows return and futures activity stabilizes, a recovery toward $0.23–$0.25 remains possible.
But without renewed conviction from large holders, the Dogecoin price risks extended consolidation, or a deeper retracement before the next bullish wave begins.
Cover image from ChatGPT, DOGEUSD chart from Tradingview
An analyst has explained how Solana could decide its next big move after rising to $210, the resistance level of a Parallel Channel.
Solana Has Been Trading Inside A Parallel Channel Recently
In a new post on X, analyst Ali Martinez has talked about how the trajectory of Solana is looking from the perspective of a technical analysis (TA) pattern. The pattern in question is a Parallel Channel, which forms whenever an asset’s price trades between two parallel trendlines.
The upper line of the channel is considered a source of resistance, meaning that tops can be probable to appear on retests of it. Similarly, the lower level is assumed to provide support to the price, helping it to arrive at bottoms. A breakout of either of these bounds can signal a continuation of the trend in that direction. That is, a surge above the Parallel Channel can be a bullish signal, while a drop under it may lead to bearish action.
There are a few different types of Parallel Channels, depending on how the channel is oriented with respect to the graph axes. Channels that have a positive slope are known as Ascending Channels, while those that slope downward are called Descending Channels.
In the context of the current topic, the third and simplest type is the one of interest: a Parallel Channel that’s also parallel to the time-axis. This case corresponds to a phase of true sideways consolidation in the asset.
Now, here is the chart shared by Martinez that shows the Parallel Channel that the 4-hour price of Solana has been stuck inside for the last couple of weeks:
As displayed in the above graph, Solana retested the lower level of the Parallel Channel last week and successfully found support. The cryptocurrency has since been rising and nearing the resistance level, located at $210. Considering the coin’s current trajectory, the analyst has noted that its price may be heading for a retest at $210 before making its next big move. However, the direction of such a move, if one happens, remains uncertain.
Given that the $210 level corresponds to the resistance line of the Parallel Channel, it’s possible that a retest could reject Solana all the way back down to the support level around $176. It’s also possible, though, that this retest could instead lead to a breakout. In this case, SOL could naturally see a sustained bullish push. It now remains to be seen which of the two scenarios will play out for the asset if the Parallel Channel holds and a retest takes place.
SOL Price
At the time of writing, Solana is floating around $200, up over 7.5% in the last seven days.
The Solana decentralized finance (DeFi) ecosystem just gained another powerful addition with the launch of SolsticeFi. This innovative new platform is poised to introduce a much-needed layer of risk-controlled yield generation, directly addressing one of the primary concerns for users venturing into the safety of their deposited capital.
SolsticeFi is reimagining how investors earn on Solana by introducing a defensively engineered approach to yield, one that directly protects the value of user deposits. According to crypto commentator Madissa’s post on X, one of SolsticeFi’s most compelling features is its ability to allow users to continue earning staking rewards while keeping their assets liquid and usable across the broader DeFi ecosystem.
How SolsticeFi Balances Risk While Generating Yield
This innovation created continuous opportunities for user to deploy their capital in other protocols without interrupting their base yield, instead of locking up funds. SolsticeFi platform is designed to prioritize full transparency and validator diversification, minimizing exposure to single-validator risks and opaque yield platforms. Furthermore, depositing capital into SolsticeFi provides support for SOL’s network security while generating sustainable returns for users.
Crypto analyst Hokage has also mentioned how Solana is improving and completely revolutionizing financial transaction speeds in traditional finance (TraFi), where transfers take days, settlements drag, and middlemen slow everything down.
SOL has changed the game by creating a new block every 400 milliseconds, and currently, the central to this acceleration is Bam, the new block assembly marketplace. This Bam will speed up how quickly user transaction gets picked up and integrated into a block, and slash inclusion times to an astonishing 50-100 milliseconds. Building on this is Alpenglow, which takes finality down to an incredible 100-150 milliseconds faster than a blink, and the point where the network confirms the user transaction is 100% done and irreversible.
One project that stands out in these ultra-fast ecosystem steps is SolsticeFi’s USX, a stablecoin specifically built to move at that speed, which enables users to send dollars, deploy capital, and settle instantly. Hokage concluded that “while these advancements might sound like pure sci-fi, if you’ve been around the SOL ecosystem, you would know it’s not.”
Market Confidence Returns To Solana
While SolsticeFi provides speed and reduces risk to Solana yield platforms, KOLS Manager at Binance, investor, and trader BitGuru, has noted that SOL’s price is currently showing a strong bullish setup, after following a steady downtrend and now stabilizing near key support.
As a result of that action, the SOL market is now pulling back with considerable strength, aiming to break above the critical $210 resistance level, a zone that has capped multiple attempts at recovery. A decisive breakout above $210 would likely trigger SOL’s next leg higher toward $230 and beyond.
The Cardano (ADA) price is flying under the radar amid growing accumulation by large-holders (“whales”) and a technical formation that traders seldom ignore, a symmetrical triangle.
With ADA currently trading around $0.66, after briefly reaching $0.69 earlier in the week, the stage appears set for a breakout, or a breakdown. Analysts suggest that if the bullish scenario prevails, ADA could target $1 and beyond, potentially even reaching $5 or more in a longer-term move.
Whale Accumulation Signals Long-Term Confidence
Despite short-term price softness, on-chain data reveal that wallets holding large quantities of ADA are steadily increasing their positions.
According to recent reports, wallets with 100,000 ADA tokens have been accumulating over the past six weeks, even while retail demand remains lukewarm. This accumulation is taking place as ADA forms a low-volatility consolidation, such behaviour often precedes major market moves.
The divergence is noteworthy. While Open Interest and spot cumulative volume delta (CVD) remain weak, signaling limited retail/speculator engagement, whales are quietly buying the dips.
Enthusiasm among large-holders suggests confidence in ADA’s fundamentals and plays into the bullish thesis that this accumulation could underpin a powerful move once the technical breakout triggers.
Symmetrical Triangle Breakout Offers Route to Major Upside
Technical analysts highlight that ADA has been trading within a symmetrical triangle pattern, a convergence of support and resistance trendlines, typically signalling a buildup of tension before a decisive move.
The crucial support near $0.61 and resistance roughly at $0.70–$0.75 mark the boundaries of this formation. A decisive breakout above the upper trendline could unlock a rally toward $0.80–$0.85, and potentially beyond $1.70 per some projections.
Conversely, a breakdown below the support would invalidate the bullish setup and could see ADA revisit $0.55 or lower. Given the whale accumulation underway, the bullish scenario currently seems favoured, but traders must still watch for confirmation.
Bottom Line
The question now gaining traction is: could ADA eventually hit $5? While the immediate target may be around $1 to $2, some longer-term models based on Fibonacci extensions and structural breakout maths place significantly higher levels on the table.
If ADA converts supply zones into support and elevates its on-chain narrative, the powerful combination of whale positioning + breakout could carry it much higher.
Cover image from ChatGPT, ADAUSD chart from Tradingview
Luxury world is trust-based. When one buys a Gucci bag, Rolex watch, or Louis Vuitton wallet, he or she has the confidence based on the knowledge and understanding that it is genuine. Value is represented by the quality of the style, the logo, the craftsmanship, all that combined. But when the fake luxury market came up with fakes, the trust was cut off. Regrettably, counterfeiting has turned out to be a multi-billion-dollar business.
According to reports from 2025, counterfeit luxury goods alone are estimated to cost brands over 400 billion dollars in lost sales annually. Counterfeiting has become an international issue with fake designer clothes and imitated watches. The counterfeiters are using advanced printing and e-commerce techniques at their disposal, and hence imitations are very hard to spot, and this leaves the consumers and the brands in jeopardy.
Another approach was used in the past, where luxury brands were using a serial number, paper certificates, or unique packaging, and although brands were immensely proud of their capability to prevent counterfeiters by such means, the vast majority of these security measures were reproducible or lost. The introduction of blockchain technology is the place where there is more opportunity to change. Through the development of authentication tokens, luxury brands will now be able to offer an identification of all legitimate products being linked to a digital record that cannot be replicated or modified.
These tokens are helping rebuild trust. They give proof that a product is genuine. They also make it possible to track an item from the moment it is made until it is sold again in resale markets. This blog explains how these luxury goods authentication tokens work, why brands are using them, and what the future looks like for digital proof of luxury ownership.
What Are Luxury Goods Authentication Tokens
Luxury goods authentication tokens are like a digital passport for high-end items. They demonstrate that a product is not a duplicate. The tokens are identifiable such as a fingerprint and are stored safely in a blockchain network.
A luxurious brand sets a new bag, watch or jewelry and gives it a token. The brand name, date of manufacture, materials and serial number are some of the information contained in this token. This information is then written on the blockchain, and it cannot be altered. The token is kept with the item in the course of its life.
In the case of the sale of a product, the ownership of the token also changes. This will aid in monitoring the actual owner and preventing the entry of fake products into the market. The system is not complicated, but solid in usage. Any person who swipes or counterchecks the token can prove that the product is authentic.
Luxury goods authentication tokens are bridges between the online and the real world. They ensure that all products of luxury can be checked anytime. And since the blockchain is transparent and public, it is difficult to cheat the system.
How Blockchain Helps Verify Luxury Items
Blockchain is a digital record-keeping system that allows you to store information securely in blocks. When a block is inserted in the information chain, it cannot be erased or modified. The blocks are linked to the succeeding information. This is what renders blockchain credible to authentication.
Any luxurious item can create a record that captures all the noteworthy features of the product with regard to the user. The record can contain details on the object including identification, place of production, and ownership. Each time a luxury commodity is bought or sold among the owners, we will have a new entry in the book of records and we will be able to construct the whole history of disposition between factory and customer.
Traditional certifications can be lost or counterfeit. The information in blockchain is indefeasible. The token generated about the luxury product can be viewed and tracked by the public, which is completely stored on the blockchain. Thus, the consumer who bought the Prada bag or Rolex watch will simply have to check the authenticity with the help of the blockchain in case they wish to do so.
Here’s a simple comparison to show the difference:
Feature
Paper Certificate
Blockchain Token
Security
Easy to forge
Almost impossible to fake
Storage
Can be lost or damaged
Stored permanently online
Transfer
Manual and slow
Automatic and verified instantly
Transparency
Limited to seller
Visible to everyone
Cost
Extra management cost
Low digital cost
Blockchain makes luxury verification more reliable. It keeps every product’s truth in one safe place. This system gives brands protection and gives customers confidence that what they are buying is genuine.
Why Brands Are Adopting Authentication Tokens
Luxury brands have always been in battle against imitation products. Over the past few years, most individuals have turned to authentication that is based on blockchain as it comes with permanent solutions and not short-term solutions. Digital trust is replacing physical beauty in the luxury market as much as physical beauty is, hence the rapid transition.
The brands that are included in the Aura Blockchain Consortium are Prada, Cartier, and Louis Vuitton. This technology assigns a digital identity to each product and allows consumers to check it at any time. It allows a buyer to determine the date, place of creation and resale of the item.
In the case of luxury houses, it is not only about prevention of fakes. New business opportunities are also created by authentication tokens. Indicatively, when a product is sold in the resale market, the brand continues to remain as part of a transaction. That preserves its worth and relationship.
Here’s a small look at how popular brands are already using this system.
Brand
Blockchain Partner
Product Type
Prada
Aura Consortium
Fashion
Cartier
Aura Consortium
Jewelry
LVMH
Aura Consortium
Handbags
Vacheron Constantin
Arianee
Watches
Breitling
Arianee
Chronometers
These brands have seen that authentication tokens help keep their heritage safe. Buyers feel proud knowing their product has a digital record from the official brand. It’s also helping younger buyers, who are used to digital items, feel more connected to luxury ownership.
Another reason for this move is sustainability. Numerous brands are now demonstrating how the materials for their goods and products are sourced and produced with blocks. This can offer proof of ethically sourced and manufactured products, which is very important to modern luxury consumers today.
How Luxury Goods Authentication Tokens Work
Luxury goods authentication tokens have a simple yet effective process. The objective is to connect each physical item to a digital identity that is ultimately stored forever as part of the blockchain. This digital identity will travel with the product as it crosses owners or geographical locations. The process can be divided into three general facets: the creation of a digital ID, the linking of a token to the ID, and the transfer of ownership.
Digital ID Creation
Every luxury item is produced with a unique digital ID. When a bag, shoe, or watch is produced, its specifications are captured in a digital record. Digital records may include aspects ranging from the specific materials used, color, model number, place of manufacture, and even the code of the artisan. These records are retained in the blockchain immediately, establishing the product’s digital fingerprint.
This means that even if a brand produces hundreds of the same model, no two products will ever be identical because each item is associated with an ID. No two identical items will ever have the same digital signature.
Token Linking
After the ID is created, it gets linked to a blockchain token. This token acts as proof of authenticity. To make the connection real-world, brands use methods like QR codes, NFC chips, or even microchips stitched inside the product. When someone scans the code, they can see the digital record on the blockchain. The connection between the physical product and digital record is what makes counterfeiting extremely difficult.
Ownership Transfer
Once the item is sold, the ownership information is also updated on the blockchain. The token now shows the new owner. This process repeats every time the product changes hands. No paperwork is needed, and ownership can be confirmed instantly.
The steps can be seen in this table below.
Step
Description
1
Digital ID created for each product
2
Token recorded on blockchain
3
Linked to physical item using chip or code
4
Ownership updated during resale or transfer
5
Record stored permanently for verification
This system builds a clear and permanent history for every luxury product. It keeps both the brand and the customer protected. And since blockchain is shared publicly, any person can verify the authenticity without needing to trust only the seller.
Benefits of Authentication Tokens for the Luxury Industry
Luxury brands have started seeing big results from using authentication tokens. These tokens are not only protecting brands from fake products but also changing how customers interact with their purchases. The system brings transparency and long-term value for both buyers and sellers.
The first major benefit is that authentication tokens prevent counterfeit products from proliferating. When each product is assigned a digital ID on blockchain, a counterfeit version cannot be created. The blockchain record demonstrates where the product originated and verifies that it is original. This provides buyers with peace of mind while also strengthening the brand’s reputation.
The second advantage is customer trust. Customers increasingly demand to know where their products come from and how they were created. Blockchain records allow marketers to show consumers the whole lifecycle of a product, from conception to delivery. Allowing customers to see that information for themselves fosters trust and enhances the possibility of repeat purchases. Another advantage for customers is openness in resale markets.
Watches, shoes, and purses are among the many luxury items traded and resold in secondary markets. When each of these products has a blockchain record, the buyer in the resale market can check its history before committing to buy.
This adds value to the secondhand market and encourages more customers to purchase authentically. The final big benefit is that it allows firms that believe in sustainable and ethical fashion practices to demonstrate how they obtain their materials, where they manufacture their products, and how they compensate their employees. This enables brands to communicate data in order to meet sustainability goals while also providing consumers with trust in the products they purchase.
Real-World Examples of Authentication Token Projects
The shift towards authentication tokens is no longer theoretical. Numerous prominent blockchain and luxury consortia projects are fully functional and ongoing around the world.
The, Aura Blockchain Consortium, founded by LVMH, Prada and Cartier provides the largest consortium in terms of legacy luxury in existence, using a blockchain to provide an unverifiable certificate of authenticity for each product. Customers then scan along with being able to even verify real time data of the product’s journey along with sourcing of materials. Aura Blockchain Consortium also connects to resale markets so that second-hand purchasers are receiving verified goods as well.
Another successful project is Arianee, an open blockchain platform utilizing digital identity protocols for luxury products, watch brands such as Vacheron Constantin and Breitling use Arianee to record ownership. Arianee’s open standard makes it simple for brands to adopt, without them having to build new, unique infrastructure.
VeChain is also known for helping track supply chains of luxury products. It places small chips in physical goods that connect to blockchain records. This helps detect fake products even before they reach the market.
Conclusion
Luxury good authentication tokens are changing how consumers think about ownership. They allow the user to prove the authenticity of an item and assist in linking the physical experience to the digital experience. This tokenile system protects brands from counterfeit items and adds confidence to customers that their items are authentic.
Leading luxury brands like Prada and Cartier are ushering in this shift. Blockchain technology has made the verification process safer, more efficient, quicker and more verifiable. Buyers will be able to verify the physical and digital histories of a product in seconds using a simple scan instead of relying on the traditional paper system.
Although there are still barriers, including cost, privacy aspects and education, the direction is clear. The luxury market is embracing a digital future where every product sold will have a verifiable identity.
The idea of using authentication tokens will continue to expand and we will all see a future where every handbag, watch or pair of shoes has a digital twin that tells its story. This is what luxury will become: an increase in transparency and trust in what constitutes exclusiveness and uniqueness.
Frequently Asked Questions
What is a luxury goods authentication token?
A luxury goods authentication token is a digital certificate that proves a product is real. It is stored on blockchain so that no one can copy or change it.
How do these tokens stop fake products?
Each product has a unique digital ID that lives on blockchain. Fake items can’t copy this record, so buyers and brands can confirm authenticity instantly.
Which luxury brands are using blockchain for authentication?
Big brands like Louis Vuitton, Prada, Cartier, and Breitling are already using blockchain-based authentication systems.
Are NFTs and authentication tokens the same thing?
They are similar but slightly different. NFTs represent digital ownership, while authentication tokens connect directly to real physical items.
Is blockchain authentication safe for buyers?
Yes. Since blockchain records cannot be changed, it’s one of the safest ways to verify product authenticity and track ownership history.
Will all luxury brands use tokens in the future?
Most likely yes. As the technology becomes cheaper and easier, more brands will use blockchain to protect their designs and improve customer trust.
Glossary
Blockchain: A digital ledger that keeps records safe and transparent. It is made of connected blocks that store data permanently.
NFT (Non-Fungible Token): A unique digital asset that represents ownership of something special, often used in art and fashion.
Authentication Token: A digital proof stored on blockchain that confirms a luxury product is real.
Digital Twin: A virtual copy of a physical product used for tracking and verification.
Smart Contract: A program on blockchain that runs automatically when certain conditions are met.
Aura Blockchain Consortium: A group of luxury brands using blockchain to verify authenticity, including LVMH, Prada, and Cartier.
Summary
Luxury goods authentication tokens are revolutionizing the way the fashion and luxury industry addresses authenticity. These electronic certificates, built on the blockchain technology, render any counterfeit scenario virtually impossible. They increase trust in resale marketplaces, lead to more sustainable practices, and help develop a stronger relationship between brands and their customers.
With projects like the Aura Consortium, Arianee and VeChain leading the charge, the luxury industry is moving toward a transparent future. Yes, while the technology is still emerging, the opportunity is and can be endless. Soon, there will be many more social networking platforms, And, electronic certificates for every designer bag or high-end watch, if that’s how you want to remember it with digital identity, which could include everything we know about the object from the workbench of the craftsperson to the purchase.
What if the next breakout crypto was already preparing for liftoff, and most investors were still staring at the charts? Every bull run begins with a single moment when conviction pays off, and hesitation costs more than any dip ever could. The search for the best crypto coin to buy now is a game of timing, and right now, the clock is ticking on one presale that’s turning believers into early contenders.
Litecoin and Stellar are generating fresh momentum with ecosystem updates and strong price action that hint at renewed institutional confidence. But MoonBull’s live presale is the one commanding the spotlight. With transparency, real mechanics, and a fast-selling structure, MoonBull is quickly positioning itself as the best crypto coin to buy now for investors who want a blend of meme energy and mathematical precision.
MoonBull’s Engine Powers the Best Crypto Coin to Buy Now
MoonBull ($MOBU) presale isn’t built on hype; it’s powered by design. Its Bull’s Engine redirects every sell order into a closed-loop growth system that strengthens the ecosystem from within. Two percent of each sale is added to liquidity for price stability, another two percent is redistributed to holders as reflections for passive earnings, and one percent is burned forever to reduce supply. The result: a self-reinforcing economy that grows stronger with each transaction, making MoonBull the best crypto coin to buy now for investors seeking conviction over speculation.
Best Crypto Coin to Buy Now? MoonBull Presale Signals 9,256% ROI Potential While Litecoin and Stellar Trend Higher 29
Adding to that power is MoonBull’s referral system, one of the cleanest and most rewarding structures in crypto. Every referral gives both the inviter and invitee a 15% bonus in tokens, instantly. This on-chain mechanism builds organic demand while expanding the community. It’s not marketing fluff; it’s built-in growth logic. These dual systems, The Bull’s Engine and the Referral Engine, position MoonBull among the best crypto coins to buy now, blending DeFi intelligence with community-driven velocity.
Momentum and Early Entry Insights
MoonBull’s numbers paint the full picture. The MoonBull presale is now in Stage 5, priced at $0.00006584, with over $500,000 raised and more than 1,600 holders already on board. Early entrants from Stage 1 have seen returns above 163%, and projections to the $0.00616 listing price suggest a 9,256% potential ROI. Each stage features a 27.40% price increase, building urgency and rewarding quick action.
A $2,000 entry right now could multiply dramatically if the presale continues at its current pace. This moment feels like catching a rocket before ignition, quiet, steady, but loaded with thrust. The design is intentional: it rewards timing, conviction, and patience. Blink, and the next stage may already leave the launchpad.
Litecoin is back in the conversation as institutional players explore new ways to list crypto ETFs tied to major blockchain assets. The recent announcements around possible Litecoin exposure through spot products have fueled renewed optimism, with the token rising 4.36% to $104.36 in the last 24 hours. That move signals growing acceptance from traditional finance circles looking to re-enter crypto markets with established, low-volatility coins.
This wave of institutional attention could strengthen Litecoin’s credibility in mainstream investment portfolios. LTC reinforces crypto’s broader legitimacy. For conservative investors balancing risk and recognition, Litecoin remains a cornerstone asset, but MoonBull offers the high-velocity play.
Stellar ($XLM) News Today: Expanding Ecosystem and Real-World Use
Stellar is gaining traction again as new tokenized assets and cross-border payment initiatives launch on its network. The token climbed 1.06% to $0.3341 in the last 24 hours, supported by optimism around real-world adoption and institutional participation. Developers are also expanding the Stellar ecosystem to bridge traditional finance with decentralized payments, increasing its long-term relevance.
Yet, while Stellar strengthens its ecosystem, its price action remains steady rather than explosive. It’s a reliable builder’s coin, a foundation for innovation, not quick profits. For investors scanning the horizon for the best crypto coin to buy now, MoonBull’s early-stage growth mechanics and presale momentum create a distinctly higher-risk, higher-reward opportunity.
Best Crypto Coin to Buy Now? MoonBull Presale Signals 9,256% ROI Potential While Litecoin and Stellar Trend Higher 30
Conclusion
In a market where Litecoin builds institutional credibility and Stellar focuses on adoption, MoonBull’s presale breaks through as the best crypto coin to buy now. Its liquidity-reflection-burn cycle, referral-based reward engine, and structured 23-stage model create a blend of fairness, growth, and scarcity rarely seen in meme-inspired tokens. It’s more than hype – it’s a smart contract ecosystem designed to scale.
MoonBull’s presale is live now. Stages are filling fast, prices are climbing, and each tick forward raises the entry cost. For investors who understand that opportunity doesn’t repeat, this presale represents a chance to get in before the headlines hit mainstream screens. The bull is moving – those who wait may only see the dust trail.
Best Crypto Coin to Buy Now? MoonBull Presale Signals 9,256% ROI Potential While Litecoin and Stellar Trend Higher 31
Frequently Asked Questions for the Best Crypto Coin to Buy Now
Why is MoonBull considered the best crypto coin to buy now?
MoonBull fuses meme-driven excitement with real tokenomics, liquidity, reflections, burns, and referral incentives. This mix creates sustainable growth, fueling both hype and utility, making it one of the most compelling and balanced crypto investments of 2025.
What makes MoonBull’s presale structure unique?
MoonBull’s 23-stage presale system raises prices by 27.40% each stage, driving urgency and fair valuation. This progressive model ensures transparency, consistent investor demand, and a predictable price trajectory that rewards early believers while maintaining long-term sustainability.
How do referral rewards work in the MoonBull presale?
MoonBull’s referral system gives both the inviter and invitee a 15% token bonus instantly. This dual incentive encourages organic network growth, spreading awareness while rewarding community participation and fostering stronger, community-driven expansion within the ecosystem.
Are MoonBull’s contracts audited and secure?
Absolutely. MoonBull operates on Ethereum’s ERC-20 standard with verified, gas-optimized smart contracts. A professional third-party audit and locked liquidity ensure investor confidence, transparency, and protection against vulnerabilities or manipulation throughout the presale and beyond.
Can MoonBull compete with established coins like Litecoin and Stellar?
Yes, but through innovation rather than imitation. While Litecoin and Stellar emphasize infrastructure and stability, MoonBull thrives on early-stage momentum, massive community engagement, and deflationary design, targeting exponential returns that established projects can rarely match.
Glossary
Presale: Early purchase window before public exchange listing.
Reflections: Auto-rewards to token holders from each transaction.
The market got hit despite realistic recovery attempts that could have switched the narrative. Unfortunately, Bitcoin could not keep up the pace, so the rest of the market did.
The crypto market cap dropped by over 1% to hover around $3.9 trillion on Tuesday, October 28, during the late North American session. Bitcoin (BTC) price led the wider altcoin market in bearish sentiment, having dropped to a local low of about $112,412.
Ethereum (ETH) price slipped over 3% during the past 24 hours to trade at about $3,946 at press time. Nonetheless, the fear of further crypto capitalization has gradually declined as traders await high-impact news from the United States.
Main Reason Why Crypto is Down Today?
Midterm Uncertainty Caused by Wednesday’s Fed Rate Cut
The crypto market experienced higher volatility during the past 24 hours ahead of the upcoming FOMC data. The Fed rate jitters have sent shockwaves to the crypto market amid rising calls for an altseason 2025.
Nonetheless, crypto traders are expecting the bullish outlook to return amid anticipated Fed rate cuts and the onset of Quantitative Easing (QE). Furthermore, the ongoing capital rotation from Gold to Bitcoin will be bolstered by notable cash printing from the Federal Reserve, with experts predicting $1.5 trillion in the near term.
Sell the News Impact After Altcoins ETFs
The wider cryptocurrency market experienced a slight drop following news that spot altcoin ETFs are now live, amid the ongoing U.S. government shutdown. The altcoin ETF hype is gradually getting factored in, as traders await QE and Fed rate cuts.
Longsqueeze Impact Caused by High Liquidations
The crypto market recorded a notable decline on Tuesday, fueled by heavy liquidation of long traders. According to market data from CoinGlass, out of the $567 million liquidated from crypto traders during the past 24 hours, more than $409 million involved long traders.
Bitwise’s Solana staking ETF saw $55.4 million on its first day, the highest of all crypto ETFs this year, alongside the launch of Hedera and Litecoin ETFs from Canary Capital.
The new company will use Near’s blockchain and NVIDIA technology to build privacy-preserving AI infrastructure, while offering exposure to the NEAR token.
Bitcoin hit resistance at $116,000; bulls might not clear the barrier until Wednesday’s Fed announcement on interest rates and this week’s resolution of the US-China trade war.
Bitcoin is showing early signs of strength as it attempts to reclaim the $115,000 level. After weeks of mixed sentiment and heavy selling pressure, momentum appears to be turning slightly bullish. The recent weekly close above $114,500 has confirmed a reclaim of the Short-Term Holder (STH) Realized Price, a key on-chain threshold currently sitting near $113,000. This metric represents the average cost basis of recent market participants and often serves as a pivotal line separating bullish from bearish sentiment.
Top analyst Darkfost shared that this reclaim is an encouraging signal, reflecting renewed buyer confidence after a volatile October. However, he also cautioned that Bitcoin’s position must still be monitored closely. A rejection at current levels could lead to a renewed correction phase, mirroring the pattern seen in 2024, when BTC faced multiple failed attempts before regaining upward momentum.
For now, the market sits at a delicate crossroads — consolidating below resistance while holding critical on-chain support. If Bitcoin can sustain this structure and push convincingly above $115K, analysts believe it could open the door for a broader bullish continuation and potentially a retest of the $120K region in the weeks ahead.
Bitcoin Holds Above Key On-Chain Level
According to top analyst Darkfost, Bitcoin’s reclaim of the Short-Term Holder (STH) Realized Price around $113,000 could mark a crucial turning point for market structure. He notes that during the 2024 correction, BTC faced four failed attempts to break above this same metric. Each rejection was driven by short-term holders selling at their break-even points — a typical psychological reaction that delays trend reversals. Once Bitcoin finally sustained above the STH Realized Price, however, the market quickly regained momentum and entered a new expansion phase.
This time, the dynamic appears similar. If Bitcoin successfully consolidates above this zone, it could pave the way for a strong bullish impulse and potentially a new all-time high (ATH) in the short term. The STH Realized Price acts as a measure of conviction among recent investors; holding above it suggests growing confidence and a shift from capitulation to accumulation.
Darkfost also highlights another critical observation: throughout the current bull cycle, Bitcoin has never fallen below the yearly STH Realized Price. Each time the price neared that level, a rebound followed — reaffirming it as a structural support for the broader trend.
Still, caution remains essential. A breakdown below the $94,000 mark — the current yearly STH Realized Price — would likely signal a deeper market shift. Such a move could mark the transition from a mid-cycle correction into a more prolonged bearish phase.
For now, the data suggests resilience, not weakness. As long as BTC remains above its short-term realized threshold, the broader uptrend remains intact — with potential for the next major rally if buying pressure continues to build above $115K.
BTC Bulls Defend Key Support While Momentum Cools
Bitcoin is currently trading around $114,360, consolidating after a brief rally that tested resistance near $115,800–$117,500. The chart shows that BTC successfully reclaimed the 200-period moving average (red line) on the 4-hour timeframe, a level that had acted as resistance throughout mid-October. This reclaim is an encouraging short-term signal, but momentum appears to be slowing as traders await the next catalyst.
The $113,000–$114,000 range now serves as immediate support — aligning with the Short-Term Holder (STH) Realized Price, a key on-chain level that reflects the cost basis of recent buyers. Holding this zone could allow bulls to consolidate strength before another attempt at breaking above $117,500, the main horizontal resistance that capped previous rallies.
On the downside, failure to maintain above the 200-MA could trigger a retest of $111,000, where the 100-MA (green line) provides secondary support. Trading volume remains subdued, reflecting investor caution ahead of the Federal Reserve’s interest rate decision later this week.
Bitcoin remains in a constructive phase as long as it holds above $113K. Sustained consolidation above this level would reinforce bullish structure — while a decisive break above $117,500 could open the path toward $120,000+ in the short term.
Featured image from ChatGPT, chart from TradingView.com
Dogecoin (DOGE) is facing a steep market cooldown after weeks of heightened trading activity in early October. Data from CoinGlass shows that both Open Interest (OI) and trading volume for DOGE futures have crashed, indicating a sharp decline in the meme coin’s momentum. The latest figures reveal a significant pullback in derivatives activity and spot market participation, suggesting that traders may be retreating from speculative positions as volatility eases.
Dogecoin Open Interest Crashes Over 60%
Dogecoin’s Open Interest has plunged dramatically from its October highs, reflecting a rapid exodus of leveraged traders from the market. According to CoinGlass, total exchange DOGE futures Open Interest has fallen over 62% from a peak of $5.03 billion on October 7 to $1.88 billion on October 28. This represents a drop to approximately 9.41 billion DOGE, valued at $ 0.20 per token.
Despite the decline in Open Interest, Binance, BitMEX, and Bybit continue to lead as the top exchanges with the highest Dogecoin futures activity. Still, the downturn has been widespread across exchanges. Kucoin recorded the largest drop in recent hours at 3.1%, followed closely by Bitget, which saw a 2.27% decline. Over the last 24 hours, Bitunix recorded the steepest drop in Open Interest, down 15.86%, while Crypto.com saw a 7.36% reduction.
Even Binance, which consistently leads Dogecoin futures trading, has seen a notable pullback. CoinGlass reports that the exchange’s Open Interest peaked at $964.7 million on October 7, marking a monthly high. Since then, it has fallen to $380.29 million (1.9 billion DOGE), representing a staggering 60.6% crash in just over three weeks.
Dogecoin Sees Even Worse Decline In Volume
Trading volume for Dogecoin has mirrored the collapse in Open Interest. CoinGlass data shows that Dogecoin’s futures volume heatmap across major crypto exchanges is in the red zone. Total trading volume had spiked to $20.45 billion on October 11, following the devastating crypto flash crash on October 10, but has since plummeted to $5.31 billion as of October 28. This represents a whopping 74% decline.
On individual exchanges, Binance’s DOGE trading volume dropped by 9.35% in the past 24 hours, while OKX saw a 13.69% decline. CoinEx recorded the largest volume decrease at 26.1%, followed by Gate.io at 23.94%. Popular exchanges like Bitget, Kucoin, and Bitunix also reported varying declines of 4.96%, 20.37% and 13.16%, respectively, as overall market liquidity thinned.
However, a few exchanges bucked the downward trend, recording slight gains. dYdX saw its DOGE volume surge by 167.61%, HTX increased by 49.93%, and Hyperliquid rose by 23.88%. Bybit and MEXC also recorded modest gains of 24.98% and 1.88%, respectively.
Alongside its decline in trading volume, CoinGlass notes that Dogecoin’s price performance has slipped. The meme coin is currently trading at $0.20, down 13.19% over the past 30 days and 2.86% in the last 24 hours.
The XRP price recently saw a sharp drop that was very scary for many traders, and some in the crypto market think the chart looks weak now. However, an analyst on X, Cryptoinsightuk, disagrees. The analyst explains that XRP is not bearish right now, even after the 50% flash crash, and the price can still move higher when liquidity returns.
Low Downside Liquidity And Weekly Chart Still Looks Fine For The XRP Price
Cryptoinsightuk says that XRP has “no downside liquidity.” The analyst explains that sellers are not strong, so there is very little liquidity sitting below the current price level. It does not mean the XRP price will stay still, although it may move up and down for now. At some point, exchanges and market makers may push the price higher into deeper liquidity, where they can make money.
The analyst says that the flash crash does not damage the weekly chart. The weekly picture still shows a normal trend even after the sharp fall. He notes that online discussions are focusing on the monthly chart and using it to claim that XRP is weak, but the monthly chart alone is only one timeframe and not enough to call the price truly bearish. The slight drop shows weakness only on lower timeframes, not in the broader market structure, and Cryptoinsightuk believes the bigger structure is still pointing up, which is a key reason he does not see a bearish trend forming even after the 50% flash crash.
The analyst’s comment about market makers also gives hope to traders who worry that the XRP price will keep falling. When market makers see better opportunities at higher price levels, the price often moves up to where they want to make profits. It gives XRP a path to recovery later, rather than staying low. He keeps pointing to the weekly chart because it shows that XRP still holds its larger bullish setup even after the fear caused by the flash crash.
Higher Timeframes Look Strong, And RSI Fractal Points To A Move Up
Cryptoinsightuk further adds that higher timeframes are always more reliable for reading price trends and recommends looking at the XRP price chart over the past three months. In his view, the three-month chart looks good and supports a strong long-term trend.
He also looks at the daily RSI, and it recently hit an oversold area. When this happened the last time, the XRP price later saw a strong move up. The analyst shared a fractal a few weeks ago that shows what a new “measured move” could look like if this same pattern repeats.
The fractal suggests the XRP price could rise again from here. The oversold RSI signal suggests that buyers could return and push the price higher in the future.
Smart contracts changed how agreements run online. There’s one big gap, though: blockchains do not fetch outside data by themselves. That limitation created an entire discipline blockchain oracle development and it now sits at the heart of serious dApp work.
Think through a few common builds. A lending protocol needs live asset prices. A crop-insurance product needs verified weather. An NFT game needs randomness that players cannot predict. None of that works without an oracle. Get the oracle piece wrong and you invite price shocks, liquidations at the wrong levels, or flat-out exploits.
This guide lays out the problem, the tools, and the practical moves that keep your contracts safe while still pulling the real-world facts you need.
The Oracle Problem: Why Blockchains Can’t Talk to the Real World
Blockchains are deterministic and isolated by design. Every node must reach the same result from the same inputs. That’s perfect for on-chain math, and terrible for “go ask an API.” If a contract could call random endpoints, nodes might see different responses and break consensus.
That creates the classic oracle problem: you need outside data, but the moment you trust one server, you add a single point of failure. One feed can be bribed, hacked, or just go down. Now a supposedly trust-minimised system depends on one party.
The stakes are higher in finance. A bad price pushes liquidations over the edge, drains pools, or lets attackers walk off with funds. We’ve seen it. The fix isn’t “don’t use oracles.” The fix is to design oracles with clear trust assumptions, meaningful decentralisation, and defenses that trigger before damage spreads.
Types of Blockchain Oracles You Should Know
Choosing the right fit starts with a quick model map. These types of blockchain oracles for dApps cover most needs:
1) Software oracles
Pull data from web APIs or databases: asset prices, sports results, flight delays, shipping status. This is the workhorse for DeFi, prediction markets, and general app data.
2) Hardware oracles
Feed physical measurements to the chain: GPS, temperature, humidity, RFID events. Supply chains, pharmaceutical cold chains, and logistics rely on these.
3) Inbound vs Outbound
Inbound: bring external facts on-chain so contracts can act.
Outbound: let contracts trigger real-world actions — send a webhook, start a payment, ping a device.
4) Consensus-based oracles
Aggregate readings from many independent sources and filter outliers. If four feeds say $2,000 and one says $200, the system discards the odd one out.
5) Compute-enabled oracles
Perform heavy work off-chain (randomness, model inference, large dataset crunching) and return results plus proofs. You get richer logic without blowing up gas.
From software to compute-enabled oracles — understanding how each type connects real-world data to smart contracts
Centralized vs. Decentralized: Picking an Oracle Model That Matches Risk
This choice mirrors broader blockchain tradeoffs.
Centralized oracles
Pros: fast, simple, low overhead, good for niche data.
Cons: single operator, single failure path. If it stops or lies, you’re stuck.
Decentralized oracle networks
Pros: many nodes and sources, aggregation, cryptoeconomic pressure to behave, resilience under load.
Cons: higher cost than one server, a bit more latency, and more moving parts.
A good rule: match the design to the blast radius. If the data touches balances, liquidations, or settlements, decentralize and add fallbacks. If it powers a UI badge or a leaderboard, a lightweight source can be fine.
Hybrid is common: decentralized feeds for core money logic, lighter services for low-stakes features.
Top Oracle Providers (What They’re Best At)
Choosing from the best Oracle providers for blockchain developers requires understanding each platform’s strengths and ideal use cases. Here’s what you need to know about the major players.
Chainlink: The Industry Standard
Chainlink dominates the space for good reason. It’s the most battle-tested, most widely integrated oracle network, supporting nearly every major blockchain. Chainlink offers an impressive suite of services: Data Feeds provide continuously updated price information for hundreds of assets; VRF (Verifiable Random Function) generates provably fair randomness for gaming and NFTs; Automation triggers smart contract functions based on time or conditions; CCIP enables secure cross-chain communication.
The extensive documentation, large community, and proven track record make Chainlink the default choice for many projects. Major DeFi protocols like Aave, Synthetix, and Compound rely on Chainlink price feeds. If you’re unsure where to start, Chainlink is usually a safe bet.
Band Protocol: Cost-Effective Speed
Band Protocol offers a compelling alternative, particularly for projects prioritizing cost efficiency and speed. Built on Cosmos, Band uses a delegated proof-of-stake consensus mechanism where validators compete to provide accurate data. The cross-chain capabilities are excellent, and transaction costs are notably lower than some alternatives. The band has gained traction, especially in Asian markets and among projects requiring frequent price updates without excessive fees.
API3: First-Party Data Connection
API3 takes a fascinating first-party approach that eliminates middlemen. Instead of oracle nodes fetching data from APIs, API providers themselves run the oracle nodes using API3’s Airnode technology. This direct connection reduces costs, increases transparency, and potentially improves data quality since it comes straight from the source. The governance system allows token holders to curate data feeds and manage the network. API3 works particularly well when you want data directly from authoritative sources.
Pyth Network: High-Frequency Financial Data
Pyth Network specializes in high-frequency financial data, which is exactly what sophisticated trading applications need. Traditional oracle networks update prices every few minutes; Pyth provides sub-second updates by aggregating data from major trading firms, market makers, and exchanges. If you’re building perpetual futures, options protocols, or anything requiring extremely current market data, Pyth delivers what slower oracles can’t.
Tellor: Custom Data Queries
Tellor offers a unique pull-based oracle where data reporters stake tokens and compete to provide information. Users request specific data, reporters submit answers with stake backing their claims, and disputes can challenge incorrect data. The economic incentives align well for custom data queries that other oracles don’t support. Tellor shines for less frequent updates or niche data needs.
Chronicle Protocol: Security-Focused Transparency
Chronicle Protocol focuses on security and transparency for DeFi price feeds, employing validator-driven oracles with cryptographic verification. It’s gained adoption among projects prioritizing security audits and transparent data provenance.
Oracle Provider
Best For
Key Strength
Supported Chains
Average Cost
Chainlink
General-purpose, high-security applications
Most established, comprehensive services
15+ including Ethereum, BSC, Polygon, Avalanche, Arbitrum
Practical Steps: How to Use Oracles in Blockchain Development
You don’t need theory here — you need a build plan.
1) Pin down the data What do you need? How fresh must it be? What precision? A lending protocol might want updates every minute; a rainfall trigger might settle once per day.
2) Design for cost Every on-chain update costs gas. Cache values if several functions use the same reading. Batch work when you can. Keep hot paths cheap.
3) Validate everything Refuse nonsense. If a stablecoin price shows $1.42, reject it. If a feed hasn’t updated within your time window, block actions that depend on it.
4) Plan for failure Add circuit breakers, pause routes, and manual overrides for emergencies. If the primary feed dies, switch to a fallback with clear recorded governance.
5) Test like a pessimist Simulate stale data, zero values, spikes, slow updates, and timeouts. Fork a mainnet, read real feeds, and try to break your own assumptions.
6) Monitor in production Alert on stale updates, weird jumps, and unusual cadence. Many disasters arrive with a small warning you can catch.
Six essential steps to build, secure, and optimize blockchain oracle workflows in Solidity.
Step-by-Step Oracle Integration in Solidity
Let’s get hands-on with a step-by-step integrate oracle in Solidity tutorial. I’ll show you how to implement smart contract external data oracles using Chainlink, walking through a complete example.
Getting Your Environment Ready
First, you’ll need a proper development setup. Install Node.js, then initialize a Hardhat project. Install the Chainlink contracts package:
npm install –save @chainlink/contracts
Grab some testnet ETH from a faucet for the network you’re targeting. Sepolia is currently recommended for Ethereum testing.
Creating Your First Oracle Consumer
Here’s a practical contract that fetches ETH/USD prices. Notice how we’re importing the Chainlink interface and setting up the aggregator:
// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT pragma solidity ^0.8.19;
constructor(address _priceFeed) {
priceFeed = AggregatorV3Interface(_priceFeed);
}
function getLatestPrice() public view returns (int) {
(
uint80 roundId,
int price,
uint startedAt,
uint updatedAt,
uint80 answeredInRound
) = priceFeed.latestRoundData();
require(price > 0, "Invalid price data");
require(updatedAt > 0, "Round not complete");
require(answeredInRound >= roundId, "Stale price");
return price;
}
function getPriceWithDecimals() public view returns (int, uint8) {
int price = getLatestPrice();
uint8 decimals = priceFeed.decimals();
return (price, decimals);
}
The validation checks are crucial. We’re verifying that the price is positive, the round completed, and we’re not receiving stale data. These simple checks prevent numerous potential issues.
Implementing Request-Response Patterns
For randomness and custom data requests, you’ll use a different pattern. Here’s how VRF integration works:
Deploy to testnet and verify everything works. Use Chainlink’s testnet price feeds, available on their documentation. Test edge cases systematically:
What happens during price volatility?
How does your contract behave if oracle updates are delayed?
Does your validation catch obviously incorrect data?
Are gas costs reasonable under various network conditions?
Only after thorough testnet validation should you consider mainnet deployment.
Best Practices for Production Oracle Integration
Implementing oracle services smart contract integration for production requires following established security and efficiency patterns.
Validate Everything
Never assume oracle data is correct. Always implement validation logic that checks returned values against expected ranges. If you’re querying a stablecoin price, flag anything outside $0.95 to $1.05. For ETH prices, reject values that differ by more than 10% from the previous reading unless there’s a clear reason for such movement.
Implement Time Checks
Stale data causes problems. Always verify the timestamp of oracle updates. Set maximum acceptable ages based on your application’s needs. A high-frequency trading application might reject data older than 60 seconds, while an insurance contract might accept hours-old information.
Design for Failure
Oracles can and do fail. Your contracts must handle this gracefully rather than bricking. Include administrative functions allowing trusted parties to pause contracts or manually override oracle data during emergencies. Implement automatic circuit breakers that halt operations when oracle behavior becomes anomalous.
Optimize for Gas
Oracle interactions cost gas. Minimize calls by caching data when appropriate. If multiple functions need the same oracle data, fetch it once and pass it around rather than making multiple oracle calls. Use view functions whenever possible since they don’t cost gas when called externally.
Consider Multiple Data Sources
For critical operations, query multiple oracles and compare results. If you’re processing a $1 million transaction, spending extra gas to verify data with three different oracle providers is worthwhile. Implement median calculations or require consensus before proceeding with high-value operations.
Monitor Continuously
Set up monitoring infrastructure that alerts you to oracle issues. Track update frequencies, data ranges, and gas costs. Anomalies often signal problems before they cause disasters. Services like Tenderly and Defender can monitor oracle interactions and alert you to irregularities.
Document Dependencies Thoroughly
Maintain clear documentation of every oracle dependency: addresses, update frequencies, expected data formats, and fallback procedures. Future maintainers need to understand your oracle architecture to safely upgrade or troubleshoot systems.
Plan for Upgrades
Oracle providers evolve, and you may need to switch providers. Use proxy patterns or similar upgrade mechanisms, allowing you to change oracle addresses without redeploying core contract logic. This flexibility proves invaluable as the Oracle landscape develops.
Key pillars for reliable oracle integration — from data validation to failure handling and gas optimization.
Real Implementations That Rely on Oracles
DeFi: lending and perps lean on robust price feeds to size collateral, compute funding, and trigger liquidations.
Prediction markets: outcomes for elections, sports, and news settle through verifiable reports.
Parametric insurance: flight delays and weather thresholds pay out without claims handling.
Supply chain: sensors record temperature, shock, and location; contracts release funds only for compliant shipments.
Gaming/NFTs: verifiable randomness keeps loot, drops, and draws fair.
Cross-chain: proofs and messages confirm events on one network and act on another.
Blockchain oracle development is the hinge that lets smart contracts act on real facts. Start by sizing the blast radius: when data touches balances or liquidations, use decentralized feeds, aggregate sources, enforce time windows, and wire circuit breakers. Choose providers by fit—Chainlink for general reliability, Pyth for ultra-fresh prices, Band for cost and cadence, API3 for first-party data, Tellor for bespoke queries, Chronicle for auditability.
Then harden the pipeline: validate every value, cap staleness, cache to save gas, and monitor for drift in cadence, variance, and fees. Finally, plan for failure with documented fallbacks and upgradeable endpoints, and test on forks until guards hold. Move facts on-chain without central choke points, and your dApp simply works.
Frequently Asked Questions
What is a blockchain oracle, in one line?
A service that delivers external facts to smart contracts in a way every node can verify.
Centralized vs decentralized — how to choose?
Match to value at risk. High-value money flows need decentralised, aggregated feeds. Low-stakes features can run on simpler sources.
Which provider fits most teams?
Chainlink is the broad, battle-tested default. Use Pyth for ultra-fast prices, Band for economical frequency, API3 for first-party data, Tellor for custom pulls, and Chronicle when auditability is the top ask.
Can oracles be manipulated?
Yes. Reduce risk with decentralisation, validation, time windows, circuit breakers, and multiple sources for important calls.
How should I test before mainnet?
Deploy to a testnet, use the provider’s test feeds, and force failures: stale rounds, delayed updates, and absurd values. Ship only after your guards catch every bad case.
Glossary
Blockchain oracle development: engineering the bridge between off-chain data and on-chain logic.
Oracle problem: getting outside data without recreating central points of failure.
Inbound / Outbound: direction of data relative to the chain.
Data feed: regularly updated values, usually prices.
Consensus-based oracle: aggregates many sources to filter errors.
VRF: verifiable randomness for fair draws.
TWAP: time-weighted average price; smooths short-term manipulation.
Circuit breaker: pauses risky functions when conditions look wrong.
Summary
Blockchain oracle development is now core infrastructure. The guide explains why blockchains cannot call external APIs and how oracles bridge that gap without creating a single point of failure. It outlines oracle types, including software, hardware, inbound, outbound, consensus, and compute-enabled models. It compares centralized speed with decentralized resilience and advises matching the design to the value at risk. It reviews major providers: Chainlink for broad coverage, Band for low cost, API3 for first-party data, Pyth for ultra-fast prices, Tellor for custom queries, and Chronicle for transparent DeFi feeds. It then gives a build plan: define data needs, control gas, validate values and timestamps, add circuit breakers and fallbacks, test for failure, and monitor in production. Solidity examples show price feeds and VRF patterns. Real uses include DeFi, insurance, supply chains, gaming, cross-chain messaging, and ESG data. The takeout is simple: design the oracle layer with safety first, since user funds depend on it.
Which crypto could turn today’s small investment into tomorrow’s fortune? The market is roaring again, and investors everywhere are hunting for the next big breakout that could rewrite their financial story. From meme coins catching fire on social media to giants reclaiming their dominance, every move counts. Chainlink (LINK) continues to make waves with its rising network activity, and Ethereum (ETH) remains a pillar of strength with a growing ecosystem and impressive live price momentum.
Yet, while these giants battle for attention, a new contender is quietly stirring up excitement, MoonBull ($MOBU). Its presale is live, and the buzz is unlike anything seen in months. Early participants are calling it a once-in-a-cycle opportunity, where timing could make the difference. As whispers grow louder and the entry price remains low, could MoonBull lead among the best cryptos to invest in 2025? Let’s dive in and explore what’s propelling MoonBull, Chainlink, and Ethereum toward the spotlight in this explosive crypto season.
MoonBull Leads Among the Best Cryptos to Invest in 2025 with Explosive Rewards
MoonBull ($MOBU) is setting a new gold standard for transparency and investor trust. Once the final presale stage concludes, MoonBull will transition directly into its launch phase, supplying liquidity to the decentralized exchange immediately. All presale buyers will receive full access to their $MOBU tokens right after, with the liquidity pool funded and locked for 48 hours. No vesting, no waiting, every token becomes claimable the moment liquidity goes live.
Experts Reveal Why MoonBull Dominates the Best Cryptos to Invest in 2025 While LINK and ETH Rally - October 2025 Market Update 19
A unique 60-minute claim delay safeguard ensures that a buy must match any sell, preventing dump pressure and stabilizing the launch price. Alongside this, MoonBull introduces a powerful referral system that actually pays: both referrers and invitees earn 15% bonuses instantly, with the top three referrers rewarded monthly with 10% USDC bonuses. In comparison, 4th and 5th places earn 5%. Backed by an 11% referral allocation totaling $8.05 billion $MOBU, this ecosystem rewards community expansion and fair access from day one. Clearly, MoonBull leads among the best cryptos to invest in 2025.
MoonBull ($MOBU) Presale Soars Past $500K: Early Investors Eye 9,256% ROI
Don’t blink, the presale of MoonBull ($MOBU) is live and snowballing. At its current Stage 5, the price stands at $0.00006584, presale tally is over $500K, and token holders have surpassed 1,600. With a current ROI of over 9,256% from Stage 5 to the listing price of $0.00616 and an ROI until Stage 5 for the earliest joiners at 163.36%, the surge potential is massive. Price increase in each stage is 27.40% until Stage 22, and the leap to Stage 23 is 20.38%.
At Stage 5, if you invest $500, you will receive 7,594,167.68 tokens, and your earnings at listing will be $46,780.07. The clock is ticking, and this train is leaving the station; miss this and you might regret it. The next wave is coming, and MoonBull leads among the best cryptos to invest in 2025, so act now and ride the frenzy.
Chainlink (LINK) Live Price Today and Market Update
Chainlink (LINK) is trading near $18.72, with a strong 24-hour trading volume of $846 million. As a leading oracle network, Chainlink continues to bridge real-world data with blockchain applications, powering cross-chain interoperability and smart contract reliability.
Its technology plays a vital role in DeFi, gaming, and enterprise integrations, making LINK a consistent performer in the crypto market. With ongoing discussions around crypto price forecasts and future predictions, LINK’s expanding use cases keep it in the spotlight for both institutional and retail investors seeking long-term blockchain utility and sustainable growth in 2025 and beyond.
Ethereum (ETH) Price Snapshot and Future Forecast
Ethereum (ETH) currently trades around $4,147, maintaining dominance with a massive 24-hour volume of nearly $39 billion. As the foundation for decentralized finance (DeFi), NFTs, and smart contracts, Ethereum’s ecosystem remains unmatched in scale and innovation. The ongoing shift to staking and upcoming network upgrades continue to fuel optimism among traders and analysts.
Many crypto price forecasts suggest Ethereum could push to new highs in 2025, supported by robust demand and limited staking supply. ETH’s resilience and steady adoption make it a cornerstone asset for anyone tracking long-term performance in the blockchain and digital asset space.
Experts Reveal Why MoonBull Dominates the Best Cryptos to Invest in 2025 While LINK and ETH Rally - October 2025 Market Update 20
Final Thoughts
Across these three projects, the story is clear: established giants like Chainlink and Ethereum carry weight, live price momentum, and credible ecosystems. Yet, given the explosive potential of early-stage investment, MoonBull ($MOBU) stands out as the presale opportunity designed for impact.
The launch mechanics, referral rewards, and presale structure combine to make MoonBull the smartest bet for those seeking breakout gains. With its presale live, the urgency to act is real, and the chance to capture something big is here. Don’t let this chance slip. The MoonBull presale is the call to action, and MoonBull leads among the best cryptos to invest in 2025.
Experts Reveal Why MoonBull Dominates the Best Cryptos to Invest in 2025 While LINK and ETH Rally - October 2025 Market Update 21
MoonBull ($MOBU) is considered a 1000x crypto to buy due to its structured presale, limited supply, and high ROI potential for early investors. Which is a top meme coin to buy now?
MoonBull’s presale, staking rewards, and referral bonuses make it a top meme coin to buy now for maximum early-stage gains. Which top meme coin offers the highest ROI?
Stage 5 buyers of MoonBull see projected returns of over 9,256% which ranks it among the top meme coins offering the highest ROI. How can investors secure the next breakout crypto?
By participating in the MoonBull presale, early buyers can claim the next breakout crypto before the price rises.
Which crypto presale provides the best early-stage gains?
MoonBull’s live presale stages with rising prices make it the crypto presale with the best early-stage gains.
Glossary of Key Terms
Presale – Early sale of tokens before exchange listing, which often offers discounted entry.
Liquidity Lock – A Mechanism that ensures the token liquidity pool is locked for a period to protect investors.
ROI (Return on Investment) – The gain or loss generated relative to the amount invested.
Referral Program – An Incentive system where participants earn rewards by inviting others.
Token Claim – The process by which presale participants receive their tokens when released to the market.
Article Summary
The article introduces MoonBull ($MOBU) as a high-potential presale opportunity, detailing its launch mechanics, referral program, and investment structure. It compares MoonBull’s momentum to established coins like Chainlink and Ethereum, providing live price updates and context. With excitement, urgency, and FOMO-style language, it emphasizes MoonBull’s status as the best crypto to invest in, particularly given its presale, live now, and ends with a compelling call to action for early participation.
Disclaimer: This article is for informational purposes only and does not constitute financial advice. Cryptocurrency investments carry risks. Always conduct independent research before investing in any project.
In computing, a denial-of-service attack (DoS attack; UK: /dɒs/ doss US: /dɑːs/ daas[1]) is a cyberattack in which the perpetrator seeks to make a machine or network resource unavailable to its intended users by temporarily or indefinitely disrupting services of a host connected to a network. -The Wikipedia definition of denial-of-service attack.
This is a very basic concept. Someone makes use of their own resources to disrupt the functioning of other machines on a network.
DoS attacks have been an issue for as long as the internet existed. One of the commonly argued “first Distributed Denial-of-service (DDoS) attacks” was against the Internet Service Provider (ISP) Panix in the mid-90s. There were of course many prior technical examples on older internet services, but this was one of, if not the, first major examples of such an attack on the modern World Wide Web.
This attack had numerous computers start to initiate a Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) connection with the ISPs servers, but never finishing the handshake protocol that finalized the connection. This consumes the server’s resources for managing network connections and prevents honest users from accessing the internet through the ISP’s servers.
Ever since this “initial” DDoS attack, they have been as common on the internet as storms are in nature, a regular occurrence that massive pieces of internet infrastructure have been built to defend against.
The Blockchain
The blockchain is one of the core components of Bitcoin, and a required dependency for Bitcoin’s functionality as a distributed ledger. I am sure many people in this space would call so-called “spam” transactions a DoS attack on the Bitcoin blockchain. In order to call it that, you would have to define the “service” that the blockchain is offering as a system, and explain how spam transactions are denying that service to others in a way not intended by the design of the system.
I’d wager a bet that most people who believe spam is a DoS attack would say something like “the service the blockchain offers is processing financial transactions, and spam takes space away from people trying to do that.” The problem is, that is not specifically the service the blockchain offers.
The service it actually offers is the confirmation of any consensus valid transaction through a real-time auction that periodically settles whenever a miner finds a block. If your transaction is consensus valid, and you have bid a high enough fee for a miner to include your transaction in a block, you are using the service the blockchain provides exactly as designed.
This was a conscious design decision made over years during the “Block Size Wars” and finalized in the activation of Segregated Witness and the rejection of the Segwit2x blocksize increase through a hard fork pushed by major companies at the time. The blockchain would function by prioritizing the highest bidding fee transactions, and users would be free to compete in that auction. This is how blockspace would be allocated, with a global restriction to protect verifiability and a free market pricing mechanism.
Nothing about a transaction some arbitrarily define as “spam” winning in this open auction is a DoS of the blockchain. It is a user making use of that resource in the way they are supposed to, participating in the auction with everyone else.
The Relay Network
Many, if not most, Bitcoin nodes offer transaction relay as a service to the rest of the network. If you broadcast your transactions to your peers on the network, they will forward them on to their peers, and so on. Because the peering logic deciding which nodes to peer with maintains wide connectivity, this service allows transactions to propagate across the network very quickly, and specifically allows them to propagate to all mining nodes.
Another service is block relay, propagating valid blocks as they are found in the same manner. This has been highly optimized over the years, to the point where most of the time an entire block is never actually relayed, just a shorthand “sketch” of the blockheader and the transactions included in it so you can reconstruct them from your own mempool. In other words, optimizations in block relay depend on a transaction relay functioning properly and propagating all valid and likely to be mined transactions.
When nodes do not have transactions in a block already in their mempool, they must request them from neighboring nodes, taking more time to validate the block in the process. They also explicitly forward those transactions along with the block sketch to other peers in case they are missing them, wasting bandwidth. The more nodes filtering transactions they classify as spam, the longer it takes blocks including those filtered transactions to propagate across the network.
Transaction filtering actively seeks to disrupt both of these services, in the case of transaction relay failing miserably to prevent them from propagating to miners, and in the case of block propagation having a marginal but noticeable performance degradation the more nodes on the network are filtering transactions.
These node policies have the explicit purpose of degrading the network service of propagating transactions to miners and the rest of the network, and view the degradation of block propagation as a penalty to miners who choose to include valid transactions they are filtering. They seek to create a degradation of service as a goal, and view the degradation of another service resulting from that attempt as a positive.
This actually is a DoS attack, in that it actually is degrading a network service contrary to the design of the system.
Where From Here?
The entire saga of Knotz vs. Core, or “Spammers” vs. “Filterers”, has been nothing more than a miserably ineffective and failed DoS attack on the Bitcoin network. Filters do absolutely nothing to prevent filtered transactions from being included in blocks. The goal of disrupting transaction propagation to miners has had no success whatsoever, and the degradation of block relay has been marginal enough to not be a disincentive to miners.
I see this as a huge demonstration of Bitcoin’s robustness and resilience against attempted censorship and disruption on the level of the Bitcoin Network itself.
So now what?
A BIP by an anonymous author has been put forward to enact a temporary softfork that would expire after roughly a year making numerous ways to include “spam” in Bitcoin transactions consensus invalid through that time period. After realizing the DoS attack on the peer-to-peer network has been a total failure, filter supporters have moved to consensus changes, as many of them were told would be necessary over two years ago.
Will this actually solve the problem? No, it won’t. It will simply force people who wish to submit “spam” to this forked network, if they actually follow through on implementing it, to use fake ScriptPubKeys to encode their data in unspendable outputs that will bloat the UTXO set.
So even if this fork was met with resounding support, activated successfully, and did not result in a chainsplit, it would still not achieve the stated goal and leave “spammers” no option but to “spam” in the most damaging way to the network possible.
Bitcoin price continued its semi-green week for a bit today trading above $115,000 today and briefly reaching $116,077. Since then, bitcoin’s price has dumped to the mid $112,000s, according to Bitcoin Magazine Pro data.
This bitcoin price movement comes as traders weigh the Federal Reserve’s upcoming interest-rate decision and renewed optimism in the U.S.-China trade relations.
Data from Bitcoin Magazine Pro showed a 1.6% daily gain for BTC before the dump in late afternoon.
Despite historical trends of Bitcoin pulling back ahead of major U.S. economic events, the cryptocurrency held steady ahead of Wednesday’s Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) meeting, where a 25-basis-point rate cut is widely expected.
Traders remain divided on near-term price targets. Some believe the market may be bottoming and an uptrend could follow for the rest of the week, while others believe $117,000 as a potential pre-Fed local top before BTC revisits the CME futures gap near $111,000.
The broader macro backdrop also supported risk-on assets. Gold fell to under $4,000 per ounce, its lowest since Oct. 6, helping fuel gains in Bitcoin and altcoins.
Bitcoin price enters tight range
Bitcoin’s price has entered one of its tightest trading ranges in history, moving between $106,000 and $123,000 for over four months. This extended calm has driven volatility to record lows on six-month metrics — levels that have historically preceded major directional moves. The weekly Bollinger Band Width, a key volatility indicator, has reached its lowest reading ever, suggesting that a large expansion in volatility could be imminent.
In past cycles, similar compression periods have led to price surges exceeding 65% within 100 days.
Applying those historical patterns implies a potential target of $170,000–$180,000 by 2026 if Bitcoin follows a comparable trajectory. However, these low-volatility phases can persist for months before breaking out, meaning Bitcoin may continue trading sideways into early 2026.
Corporate crypto buying
Corporate and institutional crypto activity is also making headlines. Japanese hotelier-turned-Bitcoin treasury Metaplanet Inc. announced a $500 million share buyback, while Cathie Wood and Ark Invest increased its holdings in Block Inc. by $30.9 million across three ETFs.
Wood, known for her $1.5 million Bitcoin prediction, is one of the most bullish investors in crypto. Through ARK Invest, she has consistently invested millions in major crypto-related stocks.
Her firm held positions in Circle Internet Group, Coinbase, Robinhood, and Bitmine Immersion Technologies.
Recently, ARK expanded its crypto exposure by purchasing about $31 million worth of Block Inc. shares. The ARK Innovation ETF bought 210,916 shares, the ARK Next Generation Internet ETF added 59,827 shares, and the ARK Fintech Innovation ETF acquired 114,842 shares.
U.S. Congressman Ro Khanna (D-CA) is introducing legislation that would prohibit the U.S. President, members of Congress, and their immediate families from owning, trading, or creating cryptocurrencies while in office, according to MSNBC reporting.
Khanna’s bill would mark the first major attempt to separate digital assets from political power.
Early details indicate the measure will bar elected officials and their families from holding or issuing cryptocurrencies and from accepting foreign-backed crypto investments.
The California lawmaker said the initiative aims to rebuild public trust and prevent policymakers from profiting off the very technologies they regulate.
Trump’s Changpeng Zhao pardon
The proposal follows President Donald Trump’s pardon of Binance founder Changpeng Zhao and seeks to eliminate what Khanna calls “blatant corruption” at the intersection of politics and crypto.
“The pardon of Zhao is corrupt,” Khanna said on MSNBC. “You’ve got a foreign billionaire engaged in money laundering and financing terrorism, who supports the president’s son’s cryptocurrency firm, and then the president pardons him. This is corruption in plain sight.”
Zhao, the co-founder and former CEO of Binance, served four months in prison after pleading guilty to violating U.S. banking laws.
His company was accused of allowing illicit money flows linked to child exploitation, drug trafficking, and terrorism. Soon after Zhao’s financial backing of World Liberty Financial — the crypto project founded by Donald Trump Jr. and Eric Trump — was revealed, Trump granted him a pardon.
Khanna’s proposal directly targets that entanglement. By banning crypto ownership and trading among officials, he hopes to draw a clear boundary between public service and private gain.
The measure mirrors previous calls to ban stock trading by lawmakers and follows Senator Adam Schiff’s COIN Act, which specifically sought to limit the Trump family’s crypto activities.
Insider trading in Congress
Lawmakers have long and repeatedly introduced legislation in hopes to curb insider trading among members of Congress.
The STOCK Act, passed in 2012 with broad bipartisan support, was designed to require members to disclose stock trades within 30 days and penalize those who used insider information for personal gain.
Earlier this year, The Preventing Elected Leaders from Owning Securities and Investments (PELOSI) Act (S.1498) was proposed in the U.S. Senate by Senator Josh Hawley (R-MO).
The bill addresses concerns about conflicts of interest and potential insider trading among Members of Congress by prohibiting them and their spouses from holding, purchasing, or selling most individual stocks, security futures, commodities, and similar financial instruments while in office.
Securitize will become a public company in a merger deal with Cantor Equity Partners II.
The tokenization platform is eyeing a $1.25 billion valuation via the SPAC deal.
BlackRock is among top asset managers to use Securitize to bring assets onchain.
Securitize, a pioneering platform in asset tokenization, has announced its intention to go public through a merger with Cantor Equity Partners II, valuing the company at $1.25 billion.
The platform disclosed the strategic move on October 28, 2025, with this set to mark a major development for the tokenization industry.
Securitize is at the forefront of bringing global financial institutions onchain.
Securitize going public at $1.25 billion valuation
The move sees it join a growing number of crypto-focused companies going public across Wall Street and elsewhere.
In its case, the platform, renowned for its role in tokenizing assets for entities such as BlackRock and Apollo, will merge with Cantor Equity Partners II as it eyes the $1.25 billion listing.
Cantor Equity Partners is a special purpose acquisition company (SPAC) sponsored by Cantor Fitzgerald.
The transaction is anticipated to generate up to $469 million in gross proceeds, including a $225 million private investment in public equity (PIPE) financing round.
This capital infusion will enhance Securitize’s ability to scale its operations and advance its mission of making capital markets more accessible and efficient through tokenization.
8/ The deal is expected to deliver $469M of gross proceeds consisting of an upsized $225 million in committed common stock PIPE, anchored by new and existing blue-chip institutional investors, and $244 million of cash held in CEPT’s trust account, assuming no redemptions.
The merged entity, to be renamed Securitize Corp., will list on Nasdaq under the ticker symbol “SECZ.”
Securitize cements industry leadership
Going public sees Securitize cement its position as a leader in the tokenization space.
The platform, which has facilitated over $4 billion in tokenized assets, could attract even more attention as a public entity.
The company’s platform offers a comprehensive ecosystem, integrating with major blockchains and financial institutions.
It stands out as the first vertically integrated, SEC-registered tokenization provider.
BlackRock and Apollo are among firms to tokenize funds with Securitize.
“This is a defining moment for Securitize and for the future of finance,” said Carlos Domingo, co-founder and chief executive officer of Securitize. “We founded this company with a mission to democratize capital markets by making them more accessible, transparent, and efficient through tokenization. This is the next chapter in making financial markets operate at the speed of the internet and is another step in our mission to bring the next generation of finance onchain and tokenize the world.”
The public listing of Securitize is expected to accelerate the adoption of tokenization across traditional financial markets. Cantor Fitzgerald CEO Brandon Lutnick noted:
“We believe that blockchain technology has massive potential to transform finance, and partnering with Securitize underscores our confidence in tokenization as a foundational force in the next era of capital markets.”
The real-world asset (RWA) tokenization market has expanded by 135% over the past year, reaching a total value of $35 billion, according to recent data.
Analysts at Citi project that the tokenized RWA sector could climb to nearly $4 trillion by 2030.
The XRP community has lost a major opportunity to the Solana (SOL) ecosystem. On Tuesday, Western Union announced a strategic partnership with Anchorage Digital to launch a stablecoin dubbed USDPT on the Solana network.
“For 175 years, we’ve been connecting people, moving $150 billion a year. Digital assets are the next evolution. We looked at alternatives and came to the conclusion that Solana was the right choice,” Devin McGranahan, CEO of Western Union, noted.
Notably, Western Union once used Ripple Labs xRapid, which uses XRP, to facilitate cross-border payments. The pilot program between Western Union and Ripple did not gain traction, as it was negatively impacted by the recently concluded lawsuit against Ripple by the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC).
Why Western Union Chose Solana to Build its Stablecoin
Reliable, Tested, and Scalable Smart Contracts
Western Union has joined other institutional investors building on the Solana blockchain, including PayPal and Fiserv. The Solana network has been running for more than a year without any downtime amid its notable scalability and affordability.
The Solana chain is also compliant with existing regulations, including the recently enacted GENIUS Act by President Donald Trump.
Vast Community to Adopt Its Stablecoin
The Solana’s global community has grown in the past years, fueled by its high throughput and cheap transaction rates. As such, Western Union will reach more global markets and users for its USDPT stablecoin.
Market Impact
The market impact of Western Union launching its stablecoin on Solana has a mutual benefit to both parties. As for Solana, the demand for SOL to facilitate USDPT payments will bolster its macro bullish sentiment.
On the other hand, Western Union has a higher chance of thriving in cross-border payments in the future, thus bolstering its stock market.
Tether's gold-backed token swelled above $2 billion market cap, driven by record prices and surging retail demand, CEO Paolo Ardoino said in an interview.
Nvidia closed in on a $4 trillion market cap amid CEO Jensen Huang's keynote speech at a tech conference, seemingly sucking capital out of crypto on Tuesday afternoon.
SharpLink said it will use Anchorage Digital to deploy ether on Linea, combining ether.fi staking and EigenCloud restaking to seek yield under institutional controls.
Reform needs to happen before the Bank Secrecy Act gets to celebrate its next big milestone, argues Nicholas Anthony, a policy analyst at the Cato Institute.
Tether Gold now represents over $2 billion in value, cementing its role as a foundational asset that merges the security of physical bullion with the operational ease of a digital token for a new class of investor. On Oct. 28,…
Wall Street was upbeat Tuesday, with Dow Jones Industrial Average rising more than 150 points and S&P 500 and Nasdaq jumping to record highs as Nvidia and a Microsoft-OpenAI deal boosted US stocks. With the Federal Reserve interest rate decision…
Blockchain prediction platform Polymarket is set to disrupt the U.S. sports betting market, with stocks already reacting. Polymarket is planning its U.S. return, with its eyes on the sports betting market. On Tuesday, October 28, Bloomberg reported that the prediction…
CryptoProcessing unveils revamped website focused on speed, utility, and global crypto business adoption. CryptoProcessing has rolled out a new version of its website. The upgrade reflects the company’s focus on utility, speed, and real-world use by businesses that work with digital…
Western Union is tapping the Solana blockchain to serve as the core rails for its USDPT stablecoin network. The move signals a major enterprise validation of the network’s capacity and reliability. According to a press release dated Oct. 28, the…
Uniswap (UNI) has been consolidating since the October 10 market crash, with price action stabilizing but volatility still lingering. The decentralized exchange (DEX) token has struggled to regain its previous momentum, reflecting the broader uncertainty across the altcoin market. Analysts remain divided on its short-term outlook — some view Uniswap as a key driver of Ethereum’s DeFi ecosystem and a potential leader in the next recovery phase, while others caution that lingering liquidity stress and waning trader activity could spark more turbulence ahead.
Despite this cautious backdrop, new on-chain data suggests a shift may be underway. According to CryptoQuant insights, Binance whales have become increasingly active on UNI, with large transactions and outflows spiking to multi-month highs. Historically, this type of whale behavior — especially when coupled with heavy exchange outflows — has been associated with accumulation phases and strategic repositioning by major players.
As Uniswap’s fundamentals remain solid, with trading volumes and user engagement steadily recovering, the renewed whale activity could indicate that smart money is quietly preparing for the next market leg. Whether this accumulation marks the early stages of a trend reversal or just a temporary pause before further volatility remains to be seen.
Uniswap Exchange Outflows Hit Multi-Month Highs
In recent days, Uniswap’s native token, UNI, has seen a notable uptick in large-scale activity, signaling renewed interest from major market participants. According to on-chain data from CryptoQuant, whale wallets — typically identified by the top 10 largest transactions — have begun moving significant amounts of UNI out of Binance. These outflows represent transfers from exchange wallets to external addresses, a behavior that often indicates accumulation or long-term repositioning by large holders rather than short-term trading.
The data highlights a daily peak of 17,400 UNI withdrawn from Binance, alongside a monthly peak of 5,250 UNI, marking a three-month high in whale activity. Historically, such outflow spikes tend to occur during accumulation phases, as whales seek to reduce exposure to centralized exchanges and secure tokens for longer-term holding or staking opportunities.
This renewed movement comes at a time when UNI is still digesting the market correction that began in July, with prices stabilizing but failing to regain strong upward momentum. Analysts interpret this surge in whale activity as a potential early indicator of confidence returning to the asset. If sustained, it could mark the beginning of a structural reversal — a shift from post-crash consolidation to the early stages of renewed accumulation and recovery.
UNI Price Analysis: Consolidation Persists as Whales Reenter the Market
Uniswap (UNI) continues to consolidate near the $6.50 level after a sharp correction that began in July 2025. The weekly chart shows a prolonged period of sideways movement following a breakdown from the $12 resistance zone, where bullish momentum previously failed to sustain. Despite multiple attempts to rebound, UNI remains below the 50-week and 200-week moving averages, both of which now act as dynamic resistance levels.
The recent price action reflects investor hesitation, with the broader market still digesting the effects of the October 10 crash. However, volume analysis indicates that selling pressure has started to decline, suggesting that sellers may be exhausting and that accumulation could be forming at current levels.
From a technical perspective, the $6.00–$6.20 zone serves as immediate support, while a decisive reclaim above $8.00 would be required to shift market structure toward a potential mid-term recovery. Interestingly, the recent whale accumulation reported by on-chain data aligns with this stabilization phase — a pattern often seen near cyclical bottoms.
If Uniswap maintains support and market sentiment improves, UNI could attempt to retest the $10–$12 zone in the coming months. Conversely, a failure to hold above $6 could open the door for a retest of the 2024 range lows around $4.
Featured image from ChatGPT, chart from TradingView.com
A recent debate on the social media platform X has drawn attention to XRP’s long-term price outlook after an XRP enthusiast, Crypto Bitlord, proposed a rather wild scenario where the cryptocurrency teleports to $500 instantly. His post, which imagined XRP being used by the US government to pay off its $35 trillion debt, caused some reactions across the XRP community.
In response, well-known crypto analyst ChartNerd stepped in to temper expectations, explaining that while XRP’s future is bright, such a leap to $500 is far from realistic this market cycle.
ChartNerd’s Take On Realistic XRP Targets
ChartNerd’s comments immediately stood out for their grounded tone, especially amongst reactions filled with predictions of explosive, instant gains. Responding directly to Bitlord’s vision of XRP rocketing to $500, ChartNerd clarified that XRP’s price will not trade at that price target this cycle. “$XRP will not teleport to $500,” he said.
Instead of a three-digit price, the analyst noted that the XRP price can only realistically reach the double-digit threshold in this cycle. “Realistically, it could definitely teleport to $13-$27 this cycle,” he continued.
This double-digit price target, although very bullish compared to XRP’s current price action, pales in comparison to other bullish projections from other crypto analysts, with many anticipating triple-digit price targets and others even predicting a run to $1,000 and beyond.
As conversations around potential XRP ETFs continue to gain momentum, one commenter asked ChartNerd whether his projections accounted for the billions in possible ETF inflows and the tokens expected to be locked in treasury funds and liquidity pools over the next few months.
His response showed that his analysis was not detached from these developments. ChartNerd explained that even if XRP captured half of Bitcoin’s ETF trading volume from the past two years, the result would still translate to a market capitalization of roughly $1.2 trillion, bringing the price closer to his $27 upper target rather than $500.
Most ultra-bullish XRP price predictions are contingent on the cryptocurrency gaining adoption among banks and players in traditional finance. However, adoption models grow over years, not weeks, with ChartNerd adding that “these developments take time, and triple digits are not possible until many a year down the line.”
Staying Grounded Amid Bold Predictions
Another user remarked that Bitcoin once faced similar disbelief before breaching $100,000, meaning that XRP could surprise skeptics in the same way. ChartNerd, however, maintained his cautious stance with the response, “Highly unlikely imo, we shall see. I’ll stick to double digits.”
Such comparisons overlook the fundamental differences between Bitcoin’s and XRP’s market dynamics, especially when it comes to their circulating supplies.
At the time of writing, XRP is trading at $2.66, a 1% increase in the past 24 hours and a 9.2% rise over the last seven days. To reach the hypothetical $500 level, XRP would need to surge by roughly 18,690% from its current price. By contrast, hitting $13 or $27 would represent gains of approximately 388% and 915%, respectively.
The recent Dogecoin market action has seen its price now hovering below $0.20 after surging to $0.208 in the past 24 hours. Despite the consolidation, analysts and traders are watching the meme coin closely, believing that the next major move could redefine its long-term trajectory.
Among those voices is crypto analyst EtherNasyonaL, who predicted that Dogecoin’s third and most powerful bullish phase is still ahead. His technical analysis on the monthly chart presents a structure that reveals the groundwork for another massive uptrend to above $0.8 is already in motion.
Dogecoin’s First Two Bull Waves Set The Stage
The monthly candlestick price chart shared by EtherNasyonaL calls attention to Dogecoin’s cyclical nature since 2014, showing two completed bull waves and a third one forming. Each of these bullish waves was formed after Dogecoin broke above and then retested the upper trendline of a descending channel of lower highs that had confined its price action in the preceding years. This retest was also highlighted by a confluence of the 25 Moving Average (MA) indicator.
The first wave, which began in 2017, caused Dogecoin’s earliest exponential rise from near-zero levels, right when the meme coin entered into popular crypto discussions. The second, and far more explosive, bull wave occurred between 2020 and 2021, when Dogecoin surged from under $0.003 to an all-time high of $0.7316, which has stood until now.
Each bull run started once Dogecoin reclaimed its 25-month moving average as support, following extended consolidation periods that spanned multiple months. The current setup reflects the same condition, as the 25MA line has once again turned upward, and Dogecoin has successfully retested the upper trendline of its previous descending channel, as shown in the chart below.
The analysis reveals that Dogecoin has recently broken free from a long-term downtrend that spanned between mid-2021 and early 2025. Notably, recent crypto market liquidation events in October have seen the Dogecoin price complete a successful retest of the resistance level, now turned support, around the $0.17 to $0.20 price range.
This successful retest also coincides with a simultaneous bounce off the bottom trendline of an ascending channel. EtherNasyonaL describes the current price action as Dogecoin “accumulating strength in the lower band of a years-long ascending channel.”
The projected trajectory on the chart above shows Dogecoin following its established pattern by moving from the lower region of the ascending channel to its upper boundary. If the third bull wave plays out as the previous two did, Dogecoin’s price could challenge its $0.73 all-time high and break into new price territories. The first price target in this case is the $0.8 mark, and then as high as $4 in the long term.
Institutional staking infrastructure platform Figment, which boasts over $18 billion in assets under stake, has partnered with Coinbase to expand its solution. Figment’s expansion is via a strategic integration with Coinbase Prime, a full-service prime brokerage service. The platform announced…
DJT stock price remains in a tight range near its all-time low, but this could change soon as it formed a highly bullish chart pattern. Trump Media was trading at $16.30, down by 62% from its highest point this year.…
Institutional crypto demand is losing momentum amid ongoing regulatory uncertainty. Delayed ETF approvals have further slowed capital inflows into non-Bitcoin assets.
Despite overall market resilience, the latest CoinShares report reveals that institutional crypto demand for major altcoins such as Solana, Cardano, and Sui has cooled sharply in recent weeks.
Institutional Crypto Demand for Altcoins Sees Sharp Decline
CoinShares’ weekly data highlights a pronounced drop in institutional crypto demand across several leading altcoins. Solana recorded inflows of $29.4 million, while XRP saw $84.3 million, both far below their October peaks.
Just weeks ago, Solana saw a record-breaking $706.5 million in inflows that highlighted just how fast institutional sentiment can change. Cardano saw a flip from $3.7 million in inflows to $0.3 million outflows, as Sui slid into redemptions of $8.5 million.
Analysts observe that a lot of funds are dialing back on accumulation plans. Until they have a clear picture as to when ETFs will be approved and warn that institutional demand for crypto could continue to tread water in the short term.
Bitcoin Strengthens Amid Uncertainty
With altcoins in the struggle, Bitcoin maintains its grip on global investment. Institutional crypto demand for Bitcoin soared last week, with inflows totaling $921 million.
Investors appear increasingly confident in Bitcoin’s ability to perform as a macro-hedge as inflation cools and the Federal Reserve prepares for another rate cut.
This renewed confidence has lifted cumulative Bitcoin investments to $9.4 billion since the last rate adjustment, highlighting how institutional crypto demand remains concentrated in the world’s largest digital asset.
Ethereum Faces Temporary Setback
Ethereum’s performance diverged from Bitcoin’s strength. After five consecutive weeks of positive inflows, Ethereum recorded $169 million in outflows, suggesting that institutional crypto demand for the asset is fading.
U.S. spot Ethereum ETFs also reported three straight days of net outflows, even as ETH briefly rallied above $4,200 before traders locked in profits. Market strategists link Ethereum’s weakness to regulatory uncertainty and profit-taking after its recent rally.
Regional Breakdown
The U.S. remained the leader in institutional crypto demand, recording $843 million in inflows. Germany followed with a record-high $502 million, indicating sustained institutional participation in Europe’s largest economy.
Switzerland, however, registered $359 million in outflows, a figure analysts say largely reflects internal asset transfers rather than outright selling. These patterns illustrate a split market: strong institutional crypto demand in the U.S. and Germany versus cautious positioning in Switzerland and other European regions.
Despite lower institutional inflows, Solana continues to display technical strength. The token trades near $199, up 3.5% for the week.
Analyst curb.sol noted that Solana’s breakout from the $200 resistance zone signals a potential macro expansion, with long-term price targets near $1,000 and $2,000. If institutional crypto demand improves, Solana could spearhead the next phase of altcoin growth, much like its explosive rally in 2021.
Analyst Crypto Patel maintains a bullish long-term perspective. He projects that Solana could replicate its earlier 27,560% growth cycle, potentially reaching $9,200 by 2029. Patel described the current market as a Wyckoff-style accumulation phase.
He emphasized that a rebound in institutional crypto demand will likely depend on ETF approvals and renewed macroeconomic stability, both of which could trigger a strong capital rotation back into altcoins.
Despite weakness in altcoins, global crypto funds saw a combined inflow of $921 million last week. Daily data from Farside showed that Bitcoin exchange-traded products attracted $477 million on October 21 alone.
Global trading volumes remained high at $39 billion, indicating strong market activity. Liquidity and participation stay healthy even as institutional crypto demand cools temporarily.
Conclusion
The drop in institutional crypto demand also highlights a market that continues to be highly sensitive to U.S. regulatory news. EOS, ADA and Sui lost short-term momentum altcoins like Solana, Cardano andSUI have lost short-term resistance is possible profit taking into Bitcoin.
Analysts expect institutional crypto demand to return as ETF approvals advance. As monetary policy settles, paving the way for a fresh boom in the digital-asset space.
Institutional Crypto Demand – Investment interest and capital inflows from large financial institutions into digital assets. ETF – A regulated investment vehicle that tracks the price of an asset, such as Bitcoin or Ethereum. Altcoins – Cryptocurrencies other than Bitcoin, including Solana, Cardano, XRP, and Sui. Inflows/Outflows – The amount of money entering or exiting crypto investment products over a given period. Regulatory Uncertainty – Lack of clear government policies affecting crypto investment decisions. Liquidity – The ease with which assets can be bought or sold without affecting their price.
Frequently Asked Questions About Institutional Crypto Demand
1. What does institutional crypto demand mean?
It refers to investment activity from large financial institutions, including hedge funds, asset managers, and banks, allocating capital to cryptocurrencies.
2. Why is institutional crypto demand slowing?
Delays in ETF approvals and regulatory uncertainty have reduced confidence among major investors, leading to temporary pullbacks in altcoin investments.
3. Which cryptocurrencies are most affected?
Solana, Cardano, Sui, and XRP have seen the largest drops in institutional crypto demand in recent weeks.
4. Is Bitcoin still attracting institutions?
Yes. Institutional crypto demand for Bitcoin remains robust, as it’s viewed as a stable and liquid hedge during market uncertainty.
Liquidity-driven DeFi continues to become more sophisticated, and finding the best yield farming platforms for 2025 is more crucial now than ever. With the total value locked (TVL) in yield-farming protocols already reaching hundreds of billions of dollars; identifying platforms that strike a good balance between reward and safety is a top priority.
How Yield Farming Works – The Basics
Yield farming; also known as liquidity mining, is the process of locking or staking cryptocurrency on a protocol in return for rewards; usually in the form of interest; governance tokens; or a share of transaction fees.
This process involves supplying liquidity to pools on decentralized exchanges (DEXs); or lending assets on money-markets. To stand out from the crowd; the best yield farming platforms need to offer high yields; audited smart contracts, and transparent tokenomics.
Yield farming is increasingly becoming an integral component of decentralized finance (DeFi); and a growing demand for structured exposure through high-quality yield farming platforms is being seen.
Top 5 Platforms to Consider
Here are five leading yield farming platforms worth evaluating in 2025:
Platform
Network(s)
Why It Stands Out
Aave
Ethereum; Polygon; Arbitrum
Robust lending/borrowing framework with large TVL.
Curve Finance
Ethereum; Arbitrum; Base
Stable-coin pools offer lower risk; and steady returns.
Yearn Finance
Ethereum
Automated vaults optimize returns across strategies.
PancakeSwap
BNB Chain
High-yield farming and simple user interface for retail users.
Uniswap
Multi-chain
Leading AMM enabling LP rewards and farming on varied tokens.
Choosing the Right Yield Farming Platforms
When it comes to selecting a standout platform; one can’t just look for the highest APY. It is important to focus on security and yield optimization. Top analysts at DeFiLlama and industry insiders; agree that protocols with audited contracts; transparent team governance, and high TVL are the ones worth keeping an eye on.
For instance; Hacken’s smart-contract risk report drives home the point that even a high APY isn’t enough to outweigh weak audits or opaque token emissions.
As the yield farming landscape continues to evolve; the best yield farming platforms are starting to develop into “yield aggregators” that automatically optimize strategies.
When choosing the best yield farming platforms; consider the following criteria:
Security and audit track record – Protocols that have been audited by reputable firms and have a clear governance and transparent operations; are generally more trustworthy.
Total Value Locked (TVL) and liquidity depth – A higher TVL is a good indicator of user confidence and protocol stability; and indicates lower risk.
Yield sustainability and tokenomics – A platform that offers elevated yields without a clear reward mechanism or token model is likely to present some hidden risks.
Chain compatibility and fee efficiency – Lower transaction costs and cross-chain support can help reduce the barriers to entry for a larger user base.
Transparency of mechanics – The best platforms clearly publish how yield is generated; reward distribution mechanics, and any potential risks involved.
In a nutshell; when it comes to picking the best yield farming platforms; it is important to focus on the ones that offer large; diverse liquidity, a trustworthy audit history; manageable tokenomics, and open transparency.
Risks and Mitigation in Yield Farming
Despite the upside; yield-farming comes with real risks that need to be managed:
Impermanent loss: This occurs when an LP token’s fundamental assets diverge in price; more relevant in volatile token pairs than stablecoin pools.
Smart contract vulnerabilities: Even mature protocols can have bugs, exploits or governance attacks, audits don’t eliminate risk entirely.
Tokenomics dilution and reward inflation: High-yield offers might be token reward inflation rather than sustainable yield from protocol operations.
Liquidity risk / exit risk: Low-TVL pools can hinder withdrawal or expose users to more volatility when large withdrawals happen.
Chain- and protocol-specific risks: Fees, network congestion, chain hacks or bridge exploits can affect yields or access.
Mitigating measures are diversifying across protocols, using audited platforms, favoring high-TVL pools and being aware of protocol governance and reward token models.
Conclusion
While high APYs are attractive, the real value is in choosing platforms where long-term security and protocol credibility match yield potential.
The universe of yield farming platforms in 2025 offers many opportunities for passive yield generation in crypto. But the focus has shifted from just getting high APYs to choosing platforms based on security; liquidity, transparency and risk tolerance.
Aave; Curve, Yearn, PancakeSwap and Uniswap; stand out for being functional and reliable. Success in yield-farming will favor disciplined strategy; continuous monitoring and understanding what drives yield; not chasing headline percentages.
Glossary
DeFi (Decentralized Finance): Financial systems and protocols on blockchain; without centralized intermediaries..
Liquidity Provider (LP): Someone who deposits assets into a pool; and earns rewards from trades or protocol activity.
APY (Annual Percentage Yield): The annualized interest rate when interest is compounded.
TVL (Total Value Locked): The total amount of assets in a DeFi protocol. It’s a measure of its size and trust.
Impermanent Loss: Loss for LPs when price changes of assets in a pool; cause value to diverge from just holding them.
Yield Aggregator: A protocol that optimizes yield across many pools and platforms.
Frequently Asked Questions About Best Yield Farming Platforms
What is yield farming and how is it different from staking?
Yield farming is depositing crypto into DeFi protocols; like liquidity pools or lending platforms; to earn interest or tokens.
Staking is locking coins to secure a blockchain and earn rewards; less complex; often lower return and lower risk.
Are yield farming platforms safe?
Top platforms have audits and large TVL; but risks like smart-contract bugs; impermanent loss; token emission dilution and market volatility remain. Always use protocols with transparent history and manage risk.
How do the best yield farming platforms offer high returns?
They reward liquidity providers via fees; governance tokens or interest from lending pools. Auto-compounding and leveraged strategies also boost returns.
Can beginners use yield farming platforms?
Yes; but start with simple pools (e.g. stable-coin pairs); on trusted platforms like Curve or PancakeSwap. Ensure to understand fees, locking terms and risks like impermanent loss. Don’t use complex strategies until comfortable with DeFi.
What is impermanent loss and how does it affect farming?
Impermanent loss is when one provides liquidity in a pool and asset prices diverge, reducing value compared to just holding.
It’s a big risk for LPs; so many of the best yield farming platforms now offer stable-coin only pools or optimized LP strategies to reduce this.
This article was first published on The Bit Journal. Bitcoin surged past $116,000 on Monday morning after U.S. Treasury Secretary Scott Bessent announced a “very substantial framework” for a trade agreement between Washington and Beijing.
Although a video of 79-year-old President Donald Trump dancing when he landed in Malaysia caught social media attention throughout the weekend, it was the words of Bessent that led to the optimistic reaction of global markets and investors, which boosted both stocks and cryptocurrencies.
Bitcoin Surge Mirrors Global Market Optimism
The Bitcoin surge was accompanied by an increase in traditional markets, as stocks also opened higher in Asia and the U.S, reflecting renewed optimism on reducing trade tensions between the two largest economies in the world.
Trump arrived in Kuala Lumpur on Sunday to pay a visit to the 47 th Association of Southeast Asian Nations (ASEAN) summit where his delegation is said to have assisted in brokering a peace deal between Cambodia and Thailand. Bessent, in the meantime, had signed various memorandums of understanding (MOUs) with Asian collaborators on rare earth mineral cooperation the strategic victory at a time of continued global realignments of supply chains.
U.S.-China Talks Spark Global Market Optimism
Nevertheless, the greatest achievement was the behind-the-scenes talks made by Bessent with the Chinese officials, which led to a tentative framework of trade that sought to end months of trade stalemate. Bessent said during an interview on NBC:
“We’ve created a framework for the two leaders to discuss on Thursday in Korea.I think it will be fantastic for U.S. citizens, for U.S. farmers, and for our country in general.”
The markets reacted quickly to the announcement. Bitcoin surge momentum drove the price to $114,217.55 at the time of writing, a 1.93 percent rise on the last day and 4.73 percent on the week, respectively. The cryptocurrency has been ranging between $113,015.30 and $116,273.31 since Sunday, which is one of the most stable and bullish weekends of the cryptocurrency in the last several months.
Bitcoin Surge Fuels Derivatives Market Expansion
Trade activity increased accordingly. The 24-hour trading volume of Bitcoin increased by 87.11 percent to reach $62.55 billion, and market capitalization increased by 1.95 percent. The crypto market dominance of the asset did not significantly change at 59.63, increasing by a small margin of 0.01%.
The enthusiasm was reflected in derivatives markets. According to Coinglass data, open interest in Bitcoin futures rose 3.05 to $76.18 billion and total liquidations reached $140.97 million. Bitcoin surge had a big impact on short positions where they sustained a loss of $123.30 million and long traders suffered a relatively small loss of $17.67 million.
Bitcoin Surge Momentum Builds Ahead APEC
The most recent Bitcoin boom, analysts argue, highlights the extent to which cryptocurrency markets are following macroeconomic trends and geopolitical changes. The recent surge of Bitcoin demonstrates how vulnerable the digital goods are to conventional market drivers such as trade policy and diplomatic co-operation, according to one Singapore-based trader.
The following week may be a key one. On Thursday, Donald Trump and Chinese President Xi Jinping will hold an initial meeting on the Asia Pacific Economic Cooperation (APEC) summit in South Korea where both the leaders are likely to agree on the specifics of the proposed trade setup.
Should the discussions lead to tangible gains, analysts foresee the potential further increase of the Bitcoin surge and even new all-time highs by early November.
Conclusion
As global markets ride a wave of optimism, all eyes now turn to Thursday’s APEC summit in South Korea. The anticipated Trump–Xi meeting could determine whether the current Bitcoin surge and stock market rally evolve into sustained economic momentum or fade with unmet expectations.
Follow us onTwitter andLinkedIn, and join ourTelegram channel to be instantly informed about breaking news!
Summary
Bessent announced a major U.S.-China trade framework during Trump’s ASEAN visit.
The news sparked a Bitcoin surge past $116,000 and boosted global stocks.
Bitcoin trading volume jumped 87%, with futures and market cap rising.
Focus shifts to the APEC summit for Trump–Xi trade discussions.
Glossary of Key Terms
Bitcoin Surge: Rapid rise in Bitcoin’s price.
Scott Bessent: U.S. Treasury Secretary behind the trade deal news.
Japan’s financial infrastructure is entering a new era as TIS Inc., the nation’s largest payments processor, officially launches its Multi-Token Platform on Avalanche. For decades, TIS has powered the core of Japan’s financial operations.
The Nasdaq-listed company will allocate 5.6% of its $3.57 billion Ether treasury through ether.fi and EigenCloud on Linea, marking one of the largest corporate DeFi deployments to date.
Shares of TeraWulf (NASDAQ: WULF) jumped more than 25% Tuesday morning after the company announced a pivot to AI.
TeraWulf, one of the largest publicly traded bitcoin miners, is accelerating its shift into artificial intelligence infrastructure through a new joint venture with AI cloud provider Fluidstack.
The companies plan to build 168 megawatts (MW) of high-performance computing capacity at TeraWulf’s Abernathy, Texas, campus under a 25-year hosting agreement valued at roughly $9.5 billion in contracted revenue.
TeraWulf will hold a 51% stake in the venture and retain exclusive rights to participate in Fluidstack’s next ~168 MW project on similar terms. Construction is expected to be completed in the second half of 2026, with the total project costing $8 million to $10 million per MW, the company announced.
To support project financing, Google has committed to back about $1.3 billion of Fluidstack’s long-term lease obligations, improving the credit profile of the joint venture’s debt structure.
No equity issuance or warrants were included as part of the deal.
The announcement expands TeraWulf’s contracted high-performance compute pipeline to more than 510 MW and supports an updated growth strategy targeting 250 MW to 500 MW of new contracted capacity annually.
The company, best known for its bitcoin mining operations, has increasingly leaned into AI-focused data center development amid a market shift toward GPU-based compute demand.
“Securing more than 510 MW of critical IT load in the past 10 months provides a direct proof-point of our growth strategy,” CEO Paul Prager said.
Alongside the expansion, TeraWulf reported preliminary third-quarter revenue of $48 million to $52 million — up roughly 84% from a year earlier — and adjusted EBITDA of $15 million to $19 million.
Bitcoin miners are pivoting to AI
Leading Bitcoin mining companies are switching over to AI on top of their mining efforts. Firms like Marathon Digital, Riot Platforms, and CleanSpark are seeing strong stock gains but are also pivoting toward Artificial Intelligence and High-Performance Computing (HPC), leveraging their large-scale energy and data infrastructure.
This transition positions miners as emerging technology players beyond cryptocurrency, attracting investor interest.
Other companies, including Core Scientific, Bitdeer, and Hut 8, are following suit — Bitcoin miners are becoming key contributors to the AI-driven digital economy while maintaining exposure to Bitcoin.
According to their website, TeraWulf is a U.S.-based digital asset technology company that owns and operates sustainable data centers for high-performance computing (HPC) and bitcoin mining.
A pro-crypto bill will be tabled today in the French Parliament by the center-right Union of the Right and Centre (UDR) party, led by lawmaker Éric Ciotti, marking the first time such a comprehensive legislative proposal on cryptocurrency has been introduced in France.
The initiative calls for a national Bitcoin Strategic Reserve and aims to position the cryptocurrency as a form of “digital gold” to strengthen financial sovereignty.
The proposed legislation would see France aim to acquire up to 2% of Bitcoin’s total supply — roughly 420,000 BTC — over the next seven to eight years, according to journalist Gregory Raymond.
To manage the reserve, the bill envisions the creation of a Public Administrative Establishment (EPA), similar in structure to France’s gold and foreign-currency holdings.
Funding for the Bitcoin reserve would come from multiple sources. Surplus nuclear and hydroelectric energy would power public Bitcoin mining operations, with adapted taxation for miners to encourage domestic participation.
BREAKING: French politician Éric Ciotti introduced a bill to adapt “the new monetary order by embracing Bitcoin and crypto.” pic.twitter.com/fS7ILfhPq3
Back in July, French lawmakers submitted a proposal to convert surplus electricity into economic value through Bitcoin mining. The bill outlined a five-year experimental program allowing energy producers to use excess power — particularly from nuclear and renewable sources — for mining.
The July initiative aimed to tackle France’s recurring issue of energy overproduction, as producers were often forced to sell surplus electricity at a loss due to limited storage. The proposal described this as an “unacceptable economic and energy loss.”
This new bill would also allow France to retain crypto seized during legal proceedings, and a quarter of funds collected via popular savings schemes, such as the Livret A and LDDS, would be allocated to daily Bitcoin purchases — approximately 15 million euros per day, or 55,000 BTC per year.
Pending constitutional approval, citizens could also pay certain taxes in Bitcoin.
France explores stablecoins for payments
The bill also emphasizes the use of euro-denominated stablecoins for everyday payments, recognizing them as a credible alternative to traditional payment networks.
Transactions under €200 would be exempt from taxation and social contributions, and payment of taxes in euro stablecoins would be allowed.
To support industry development, the legislation proposes adapting electricity taxation for mining through a progressive excise duty and flexible tariffs for data centers. It also encourages institutional adoption of Bitcoin and other crypto-assets via Exchange Traded Notes (ETNs) and calls for revisions to European prudential rules, which currently impose high risk-weightings on certain crypto-assets, limiting the use of crypto as collateral for “Lombard” loans.
Despite its ambitious scope, the bill faces steep political hurdles. The UDR holds only 16 of 577 seats in the National Assembly, making adoption unlikely without broader support, per Raymond.
SoFi Technologies (NASDAQ: SOFI) raised its full-year profit forecast on Tuesday after reporting record third-quarter results that beat Wall Street expectations, driven by fee revenue and more user growth across its financial products.
CEO Anthony Noto said the company remains on track to launch crypto trading by the end of the year, with plans to roll out its own SoFi USD stablecoin in the first half of 2026 — marking its biggest step yet into the digital asset economy.
SoFi said adjusted revenue climbed 38% year-over-year to $950 million, surpassing analyst estimates of $886.6 million.
This move echoes that of banking giant Morgan Stanley. Earlier this quarter, Morgan Stanley announced plans for crypto trading for retail clients on its E*Trade platform, partnering with Zerohash for liquidity, custody, and settlement.
Adjusted profit for SoFi more than doubled to $0.11 per share in the three months ended September 30, topping expectations of $0.08 per share. Shares of SoFi rose 3.8% in pre-market trading following the announcement, according to Reuters reporting.
Founded as a student loan refinancing startup, SoFi has evolved into a full-scale financial services platform offering products ranging from IPO investing to credit cards and high-yield savings accounts.
The company now boasts a market capitalization of roughly $36 billion, cementing its position among the leading players in the fintech sector.
Earlier this year in June, SoFi announced that it had reintroduced spot crypto trading and launched plans for a blockchain-based global remittance service after halting crypto services in 2023 due to regulatory constraints.
The company said SoFi members would again be able to buy, sell, and hold cryptocurrencies such as Bitcoin within its platform.
In addition to reinstating crypto trading, SoFi revealed a new self-serve international money transfer feature, expected to go live soon.
The service would let SoFi Money users send funds across dozens of countries directly from the SoFi app, with transfers conducted over secure blockchain networks.
Recipients would receive local currency instantly, with full fee and exchange-rate transparency provided upfront and 24/7 access to transactions.
Back in June, CEO Anthony Noto said SoFi viewed blockchain and crypto as central to the future of financial services, emphasizing the company’s goal of offering members more control and flexibility across their financial lives.
Bitcoin priceis once again testing the patience of traders, moving within one of the tightest percentile price ranges in its history. For more than four months, BTC has traded between roughly $106,000 and $123,000. This period of quiet has pushed volatility to its lowest level ever recorded on six-month metrics. Each time in the past that volatility has fallen to similar depths, it has been followed by a major trending move.
Bitcoin Price Volatility Compression
The current lull stands out even compared to previous phases of consolidation in this cycle. Despite occasional liquidations and sharp wicks, the broader price structure has barely shifted since June. One of the most telling metrics is the weekly Bollinger Band Width — the indicator has now reached its lowest weekly reading ever. In every past instance that Bitcoin’s bands have squeezed to this degree, bitcoin price volatility expansion followed shortly after.
When Bitcoin Price Volatility Returns
Periods of ultra-low volatility have never lasted long. In this cycle alone, there have already been five examples where similar consolidations ended with significant moves exceeding 65% gains within 100 days. Averaging those historical fractals to today’s setup would imply a potential bitcoin price target between $170,000 and $180,000 by 2026 if the next expansion phase mirrors prior behavior.
However, bitcoin price volatility compression does not guarantee immediate upside. Previous examples have shown that these low-volatility periods can extend for several months before a breakout occurs. Bitcoin could continue to trade sideways through late Q1 2026, oscillating within the current range before direction is decided.
Macro Catalysts for Bitcoin Price Volatility
Several macro factors could serve as a catalyst for renewed bitcoin price volatility. The Federal Reserve is expected to announce another rate cut, which markets currently price at near-certainty. Gold’s recent reversal after setting new highs also hints at potential capital rotation. If even a small fraction of that capital migrates toward Bitcoin amid falling rates and renewed risk appetite, the effect could amplify any breakout once volatility expands.
Conclusion: The Next Big Bitcoin Price Move
Volatility naturally declines as Bitcoin matures from a multi-billion to a multi-trillion-dollar asset, but the cyclical nature of expansion and contraction remains. The current compression phase has lasted unusually long, and historically such conditions have preceded powerful multi-month trends.
The final months of 2025 and early 2026 may test this pattern once again. With bitcoin price volatility metrics at record lows, macro conditions turning supportive, and market sentiment subdued, Bitcoin appears poised on the edge of its next major move.
Disclaimer: This article is for informational purposes only and should not be considered financial advice. Always do your own research before making any investment decisions.
SBI Holdings CEO Yoshitaka Kitao shares on X about Ripple's latest move, which will significantly boost both XRP and Ripple USD (RLUSD) stablecoin utility.
SOL founder Anatoly Yakovenko cheers Solana's remarkable comeback story, as the sixth-largest cryptocurrency by market cap sees its first US ETF launch.
XRP futures market posted an absurd 293,152% liquidation imbalance as overleveraged longs collapsed on a tiny 0.4% dip, only for the token's price to rebound and set a new daily high.
Ozak AI and BlockchainFX Impress, But BlockDAG’s Coinbase & Kraken Listing Leaks Starts Whale Frenzy!
Lately, Ozak AI and BlockchainFX have dominated crypto-chatter, one promising an AI-driven trading ecosystem that’s already pulled millions in funding, the other pushing a cross-market super-app connecting DeFi, forex, and equities. Both are fueling discussions about what the next generation of presale crypto coins could look like. But if these projects are setting the stage for innovation, what happens when a network built for speed, scalability, and real utility suddenly steps into the exchange spotlight?
That’s exactly what’s unfolding with BlockDAG (BDAG). According to the tweet from Crypto Rover, its listings on Coinbase and Kraken aren’t speculation, they’re structured, confidential, and virtually ready to launch. The crypto space might just be standing on the edge of its next breakout moment.
BlockDAG: The Leak That Set the Market Buzzing
When Crypto Rover hinted that internal documents confirming BlockDAG’s listings on Coinbase and Kraken had surfaced, the community lit up. The leaks show this isn’t rumor, it’s paperwork. Coinbase has already outlined trading pairs like BDAG/USDT and BDAG/USD, along with in-app promotions and banner placements. Kraken’s cooperation file reveals $300,000 set aside for liquidity and another $300,000 for marketing campaigns, including token disbursements. Together, they paint a picture of a project entering the exchange arena with precision and preparation.
This leak hit right as presale crypto coins were competing for attention, and BlockDAG instantly stole the spotlight. Its presale has raised over $430 million across 31 batches, selling more than 27 billion BDAG coins to 312,000+ holders. The final TGE code still allows late investors to access the presale price of $0.0015, with the mainnet launch price expected at $0.05. Few presale crypto coins have shown this level of traction before listing day, and that’s exactly why this leak feels monumental.
Add to that over 20,000 mining rigs sold, audits from CertiK and Halborn, and a multi-year F1® partnership, and you’ve got a project that looks ready for its big exchange debut. Rover’s leak might have just signaled the countdown.
Ozak AI: The $4M Presale Turning Heads in 2025
Ozak AI has become one of the most talked-about new tokens of late, especially after its presale crossed the $4 million mark. Priced around $0.012 per token, the project claims to be building a decentralized AI ecosystem powered by Prediction Agents that let users create or use trading models without coding.
It’s built around a DePIN-based streaming network that handles low-latency data and runs on decentralized compute infrastructure. Partnerships with Pyth Network, Dex3, Hive Intel, and SINT have helped boost its visibility, while its integration plans suggest practical use cases in analytics and on-chain data services.
Much of the hype around Ozak AI comes from its positioning as a utility-driven token rather than a speculative one. The presale phase allocates 30% of its 10-billion supply, with the rest split between ecosystem development, liquidity, and reserves. Its backers claim it could reach $1 if the roadmap holds a, bold projection that reflects both optimism and risk. With several promotional articles calling it the “AI-crypto of 2025,” the project now sits among the year’s most watched early-stage tokens, especially as investors weigh how far its claimed technology can really go.
BlockchainFX: The $7M Presale Building a Multi-Asset Super App
BlockchainFX has turned heads by raising over $7 million in its presale and positioning itself as a bridge between traditional finance and crypto. The project aims to create a multi-asset platform where users can trade more than 500 instruments, from cryptocurrencies to stocks, forex, ETFs, and commodities, all from a single app.
Its token, BFX, is priced between $0.019 and $0.023 in the current presale phase, with an expected listing target around 0.05. Reports also mention daily USDT rewards for stakers and redistribution of 70% of platform trading fees back to the community, showing how the token is built around active ecosystem use.
What makes BlockchainFX stand out is its attempt to merge DeFi tools with everyday trading functionality. The roadmap mentions Visa card integration for crypto payments and ongoing audits by firms like CertiK and Coinsult. The presale has attracted over 8,500 investors, thanks to its focus on accessibility and cross-market exposure. While much of the buzz is driven by promotional coverage, the idea of a single gateway that connects digital and traditional assets has made BFX one of 2025’s most closely watched presale projects, especially as it edges toward its public launch.
Why BlockDAG Tops the Chart Among the Best Presale Crypto Coins
Ethereum’s steady upgrades and Solana’s strong developer traction have both reinforced their positions as key market leaders. Yet, even with network expansions and rising transaction activity, both continue to face limitations, Ethereum in speed and costs, Solana in stability during surges. As investors look for newer ecosystems that combine both reliability and scale, attention is shifting toward projects offering stronger fundamentals before listing.
That’s where BlockDAG has gained an edge. Unlike Ozak AI and BlockchainFX, which are still deep in their development phases, BlockDAG already has tangible progress, with $430 million raised, 312,000 holders, and confirmed listing agreements with Coinbase and Kraken. Among all presale crypto coins right now, BDAG’s blend of technology, transparency, and readiness makes it the project everyone’s watching heading into 2025.
Disclosure: This is a sponsored press release. Please do your research before buying any cryptocurrency or investing in any projects. Read the full disclosure here.
Prague, Czech Republic – October 2025 — Every ambitious trader asks the same question: What’s the fastest way to scale? Should you grind through endless two-step challenges, or go straight for instant funding?
The choice is more than technical. For thousands of traders worldwide, it’s the difference between finally breaking through — or burning out before the journey even starts.
The Hidden Trap of Two-Step Challenges
For years, two-step challenges were sold as the “fair test” of a trader’s skill. In reality, they’ve become a money-printing machine for firms — and a graveyard for traders’ dreams.
Here’s the truth:
Over 80% of traders fail challenges before ever reaching live capital.
Time wasted: weeks or even months grinding demo accounts with no real payout.
Moving goalposts: some firms quietly change risk rules mid-way, making “success” nearly impossible.
Emotional burnout: by the time traders pass, they’re drained — and many blow up under pressure.
As one trader described it:
“Passing the challenge was harder than trading real markets. It felt like a game designed for me to lose.”
This is the dark side of the two-step model — and why so many traders are turning to instant funding.
The Rise of Instant Funding
Instant funding flips the model. No months of hoops, no simulated games — just real capital from day one.
Why it matters:
Real payouts, faster — profits in weeks, not months.
Less stress, more focus — discipline built around live markets, not demo gimmicks.
Career acceleration — scaling from $5,000 to $40,000 instantly is possible.
If you want a clear comparison of top firms offering instant funding vs. two-step evaluations, explore our breakdown of the Best Crypto Prop Trading Firms of 2025.
Martin’s Story: From Burnout to Breakthrough
Martin, a 29-year-old trader from Germany, nearly gave up on his dream.
He spent six months and over $2,000 trying to pass multiple two-step challenges at offshore firms. Each time, he got close — only for the rules to shift or the payout to vanish. By the end, he wasn’t just broke; he was broken.
“I felt like I was gambling against the house. Even when I passed, they always found a reason not to pay. I told myself: maybe trading isn’t for me.”
Then Martin found Mubite. He applied for Instant Funding, got $20,000 in capital on day one, and within four weeks, withdrew his first profit — real money, on time, no excuses.
Now, just three months later, Martin has scaled to a $60,000 account and says he finally feels like a professional:
“Mubite gave me what others never could: trust. For the first time, my effort actually mattered.”
Mubite’s Hybrid Model: Choice + Trust
Unlike offshore firms, Mubite gives traders both options:
Whether it’s instant funding or two-step evaluations, the truth is this: the model means nothing if the firm doesn’t pay.
That’s why Mubite puts trust first:
Clear rules — no moving targets.
Verified payouts — $500k+ documented.
Independent proof — 4.9 on Trustpilot.
As Mubite’s CEO explains:
“The model is only half the story. The other half is trust. We built Mubite so traders know: if they perform, they get paid. Period.”
What’s Next: Scaling Beyond Models
Mubite’s vision is bigger than instant funding or challenges. The firm is building the world’s first global trading tribe — a network where 100,000 traders can scale capital, compete in tournaments, and grow together.
With live events planned in Dubai, Asia, and Latin America, plus online competitions for traders worldwide, Mubite is turning crypto prop trading from a lonely grind into a global movement.
Final Thoughts
The choice is clear:
Two-step challenges drain your time, your money, and your energy.
Instant funding accelerates your career.
Mubite proves that with transparency, fast payouts, and a real trading community, scaling doesn’t take months of games — it starts today.
Because trading should be about your skill — not their games.
Disclosure: This is a sponsored press release. Please do your research before buying any cryptocurrency or investing in any projects. Read the full disclosure here.
GIP-140 revamps GnosisDAO voting with on-chain and beacon data.
GNO price dips amid profit-taking and technical resistance.
Liquidity limits and stablecoin rules may influence short-term sentiment.
The Gnosis price has experienced modest volatility following the passing of the GnosisDAO GIP-140 proposal, a major governance update aimed at overhauling the platform’s voting mechanisms.
The GIP-140 initiative replaces the current subgraph-based GNO strategy with a suite of strategies that read blockchain state directly from both the execution and beacon layers.
The proposal’s approval marks a significant step toward enhancing the accuracy and reliability of Snapshot voting while adding support for StakeWise tokens and reducing dependency on external data providers.
GIP-140: revamping voting for accuracy and inclusion
GIP-140’s passage reflects a broad consensus among GnosisDAO participants, with 82 votes cast, overwhelmingly in favour of the measure.
The core objective is to eliminate the subgraph dependency, which has historically caused delays and inaccuracies in voting power calculations.
The new system attributes voting power to GNO balances across both the Gnosis Chain and Ethereum, locked GNO holdings, validator balances, and StakeWise’s sGNO and osGNO tokens.
By pulling data directly from on-chain and beacon chain sources, the proposal seeks to create a more robust and transparent voting environment that can better reflect actual stakeholder influence.
The technical implementation involves updating Snapshot’s configuration via a SafeSnap transaction, pointing to aggregator contracts deployed on both Gnosis Chain and Ethereum, as well as a new beacon-chain strategy for staked GNO.
Delegation mechanisms have also been updated to integrate these new sources, ensuring a seamless transition for DAO members accustomed to existing workflows.
The changes position GnosisDAO to handle complex governance requirements while reducing reliance on third-party indexers like The Graph, which previously introduced inconsistencies.
Surprisingly, following the approval of GIP-140, the Gnosis price has seen a slight pullback, falling 0.89% over the past 24 hours and underperforming the broader crypto market, which gained 0.06%.
The price movement aligns with profit-taking behaviour after GNO achieved a 7.98% weekly gain and an 8.3% rise during October.
Technical indicators suggest the market is testing resistance around the 30-day simple moving average of $137.93 and the 61.8% Fibonacci retracement level at $138.47.
While the RSI remains neutral at 53.42, a bearish divergence in the MACD hints at potential short-term consolidation.
In addition, liquidity pressures stemming from CoinDCX’s June 2025 delisting continue to weigh on GNO trading activity.
Despite being months old, the delisting reduced retail access to the token, and the 24-hour turnover ratio of 1.08% remains relatively low compared with broader DeFi sector averages.
Regulatory uncertainties surrounding stablecoins, particularly the relaunch of USDS under the stricter US GENIUS Act, may also indirectly influence sentiment toward Gnosis Chain assets.
Nevertheless, milestones like Gnosis Pay’s $100 million transaction volume suggest that ecosystem adoption could counterbalance some of these headwinds.
Looking ahead
The combination of technical consolidation, lingering liquidity constraints, and regulatory considerations creates a cautious but watchful environment for Gnosis price movements.
Holding the $135–$137 zone could provide the stability needed for renewed momentum, particularly as GnosisDAO’s upgraded Snapshot strategies begin to reflect more accurate voting power across multiple token types.
In the coming weeks, the Gnosis price may respond to both market dynamics and the tangible impact of GIP-140’s execution, particularly if the changes enhance voting accuracy and encourage broader participation in the DAO.
For now, the community appears aligned, and the successful passage of GIP-140 represents a meaningful milestone that could shape GNO’s trajectory in both governance and market performance.
The blockchain ecosystem continues to expand rapidly but for many users, it still feels fragmented. Managing wallets, switching gas tokens, and handling liquidity across multiple chains creates friction that slows adoption.
Mono Protocol enters this space with a mission to redefine blockchain interaction. It focuses on bringing users, assets, and applications together under one simplified framework.
Currently in Stage 15 of its presale, the project has already secured $2.8 million, signalling strong interest from the Web3 community.
This growing momentum underscores the need for infrastructure that reduces complexity and builds confidence in decentralised finance.
Unifying blockchain experiences into one connected flow
For years, blockchain users have had to navigate a disjointed landscape — multiple wallets, isolated balances, and incompatible ecosystems. These technical hurdles often make blockchain feel less accessible than it should be.
Mono Protocol tackles this challenge through unified balances that allow assets from various chains to appear in one account. Instead of tracking which network tokens belong to, users interact through a single, connected interface.
This results in a fluid, intuitive experience that minimises failed transfers and offers consistent transaction outcomes. The system’s guaranteed settlement layer enhances reliability, allowing both users and developers to operate across networks with greater confidence.
By simplifying complex interactions, Mono Protocol sets a new standard for how Web3 can function as one cohesive ecosystem.
Building momentum through a utility-driven presale
While many blockchain presales emphasise speculation, Mono Protocol’s presale stands out for its focus on tangible innovation. The ongoing Stage 14 offers an entry point for participants who recognise the value of chain abstraction, MEV-resistant execution, and liquidity locks.
These technical foundations ensure transactions settle efficiently and securely across multiple networks. The presale follows a successful $2 million private round, underscoring consistent investor confidence in the project’s utility-driven roadmap.
Beyond funding, this progress strengthens Mono Protocol’s capacity to deliver on its promise — building an infrastructure that makes Web3 interaction more natural and reliable. Each presale milestone contributes to refining features that address real pain points rather than adding unnecessary complexity.
With nearly full funding achieved in the current stage, the project is positioned as one of the most credible new crypto presales in today’s oversaturated market.
Universal gas, governance, and guaranteed settlement
Gas fees remain one of blockchain’s biggest usability challenges. Mono Protocol introduces a universal gas model, allowing users to pay fees using any token, eliminating the constant need to hold native chain assets.
Its governance framework aligns stakeholders across the ecosystem. Token holders can participate in decision-making while staking MONO to enhance security and support validator stability.
Meanwhile, the protocol’s execution bond mechanism ensures dependable transaction settlement. Under the Resource Locks model, solvers and routers stake MONO to guarantee that every confirmed transaction executes promptly and securely.
These innovations demonstrate a clear focus on real-world usability, addressing the most common frustrations of DeFi with infrastructure that prioritizes efficiency and trust.
The road to launch: Key Mono Protocol events ahead
The coming weeks bring milestone moments for Mono Protocol. Starting October 30, the Smart Contract Audit will strengthen the platform’s foundation with enhanced security and trust.
On November 7, the Launch Beta begins, opening access to a new phase of user interaction and testing. Then, on November 13, the CEO AMA will provide fresh insights into Mono’s roadmap and next major updates.
Together, these milestones reflect steady growth and community-focused innovation.
Earn more every day with the MONO Reward hub
Mono Protocol’s Reward Hub is an interactive platform for earning $MONO while supporting Web3 growth. From presale and social quests to referral missions, each action brings exclusive rewards and opportunities.
Stay active through daily and weekly events to gain levels and unlock higher bonuses. It’s designed for users who want to engage meaningfully while growing alongside Mono’s expanding ecosystem.
Join today, complete your first quest, and start turning participation into progress in the MONO Reward Hub.
A clear path toward a more connected Web3
Blockchain’s true potential depends on removing the fragmentation that divides it. Mono Protocol’s ongoing presale showcases how this can be achieved with a unified, interoperable approach.
By merging balances, simplifying gas payments, and ensuring instant settlement, the project moves beyond conceptual fixes toward practical solutions that work in real-world environments. Its vision isn’t about hype, it’s about making decentralized systems usable for everyone.
With $2.6 million already secured, Mono Protocol is on the verge of closing another strong chapter in its presale journey. Its progress reinforces a broader industry shift toward projects that deliver genuine value, transparency, and scalability.
If blockchain is to feel connected, accessible, and ready for mass adoption, Mono Protocol offers a blueprint for how that transformation begins.
The partnership focuses on decentralized finance with key being institutional liquidity.
POL token traded near $0.20 amid the news.
Polygon Labs has announced a strategic partnership with Manifold Trading as it looks to boost Polygon’s decentralized finance (DeFi) ecosystem.
The platform revealed the integration with the quantitative trading firm via a press release on October 28, 2025.
The news came as POL, the native token of the Polygon network, gained amid broader market optimism.
At the time of writing, POL hovered above $0.20.
Polygon partners with Manifold
Institutional-grade execution is the main take of Polygon Lab’s partnership with Manifold.
According to the announcement, the integration represents a deliberate effort to elevate the infrastructure of DeFi platforms within Polygon’s ecosystem.
At its core is Manifold’s proprietary quantitative models and high-frequency trading algorithms.
The integration brings the firm’s institutional infrastructure and experience to Polygon.
The alliance focuses on integrating Manifold’s execution engine directly into Polygon’s AggLayer, with Manifold deploying its sophisticated order routing and market-making tools tailored for DeFi environments to the Ethereum scaling solution’s network.
“Access to deep, stable liquidity is foundational to any mature financial system,” said Maria Adamjee, head of investor relations at Polygon Labs. “Manifold’s ability to actively manage spreads, size, and responsiveness across multiple venues makes them an ideal ecosystem partner as we continue scaling institutional-grade DeFi across the Polygon ecosystem.”
This integration is expected to roll out progressively.
Institutional liquidity comes to Polygon’s DeFi ecosystem
At the centre of this partnership is the infusion of institutional liquidity into the DeFi ecosystem, addressing longstanding challenges such as fragmented pools and volatile pricing.
Manifold’s quantitative models excel in providing deep liquidity through automated market-making and predictive analytics, which can dynamically adjust to market conditions.
“Polygon has become one of the most active venues for DeFi innovation,” said Noah Hanover, quantitative developer at Manifold. “We’re focused on supporting market stability and depth at scale, so that traders, protocols, and capital allocators can operate in a liquid, reliable environment.”
The integration aligns with broader market and regulatory trends.
Many top platforms are incorporating features such as on-chain proof-of-reserves and compliance hooks to appeal to enterprise adopters.
Polygon, which recently activated its Rio upgrade to boost network transaction speed, efficiency, and cut fees, is one of the platforms eyeing greater traction.
Part of the growth has earned recognition. Ethereum co-founder Vitalik Buterin recently lauded Polygon’s role in pioneering zero-knowledge proofs.
Polygon price
POL is the native token that powers the Polygon ecosystem.
It functions as the platform’s native gas and staking token, which means it helps to secure the network as well as allow users access to the growing number of apps built on Polygon.
This marks POL as a token with real utility, a factor that has seen its price grow significantly amid both retail and institutional demand.
At the time of writing, POL traded above $0.20, a key level for bulls following recent declines
US regulators have greenlighted SOL, LTC, and HBAR ETFs.
Crypto sees institutional demand as mainstream players seek blockchain exposure.
Official Trump surges after optimistic developments.
Digital assets performed well on Tuesday as Bitcoin reclaimed $117,000.
The broader sector has turned bullish amid optimistic updates and tomorrow’s Fed decision on interest rates.
In a groundbreaking move that has stirred the altcoin space, US regulators have reportedly approved exchange-traded funds linked to Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera.
This marks a crucial moment for the digital assets industry, with diversified ETF offerings beyond Bitcoin and Ethereum.
Enthusiasts can now access Bitwise Solana, Canary HBAR, and Canary Litecoin exchange-traded funds on the New York Stock Exchange.
The decision follows the new policies that allow issuers to evade the lengthy review procedures by the SEC.
The new financial products are experiencing significant investor appetite.
According to ETF analyst Eric Balchunas, the Bitwise SOL staking ETF saw its trading volume hit $10 million within the first 30 minutes.
It has eclipsed Hedera and Litecoin at $4 million and $400k, respectively.
Meanwhile, the approval will boost investor exposure in SOL, LTC, and HBAR through regulated channels.
That eliminates the complexity of navigating wallets and finding legitimate brokers.
The new funds have already debuted on leading United States exchanges as the gap between DeFi and TradFi blurs.
Institutional interest hits the altcoin sector
The latest approvals increase alternatives for investors.
Until recently, institutional players remained restricted to Bitcoin and Ethereum-related financial products.
Now, the landscape has transformed dramatically.
Solana, known for speed and its vibrant DeFi, meme token, and NFT ecosystem, has been among the hottest blockchains in the past few months.
With SOL ETFs live, the project can anticipate remarkable liquidity and market stability.
Such fundamentals can help Solana cement its status as a serious “Ethereum Killer.” SOL is trading at $199 after gaining more than 3% the past week.
The OG Litecoin has remained relevant through the years due to its constant network uptime and strong fundamentals.
An LTC ETF approval confirms that regulators still perceive Litecoin as a time-tested token that can serve conservative investors navigating cryptocurrencies.
LTC is trading at $98, bracing for impressive upside breakouts.
Finally, Hedera’s exchange-traded fund offers an opportunity for individuals exploring the blockchain role in tokenized assets, sustainability, and business solutions.
HBAR gas soared over 10% the previous day to $0.2018.
TRUMP rallies on positive sentiments
Donald Trump’s meme token led the gainers today. TRUMP gained more than 14% the past 24 hours to $7.11.
Trump Media’s deal with Crypto.com to launch Truth Predict is fueling TRUMP’s surges.
NEW: 🇺🇸🎥 President Trump’s Truth Social has partnered with #Crypto.com to launch “Truth Predict.”
The new feature will make Truth Social the world’s first social media platform to offer federally compliant prediction markets on politics, economics, and sports. pic.twitter.com/7GUWns4AvB
Under the agreement, Truth Social will channel event contracts through CDNA, a CFTC-registered exchange and clearinghouse.
The partnership provides the platform with a federally compliant framework to offer prediction markets tied to elections, economic data, commodity prices, sports results, and other real-world events.
Trump Media is promoting the initiative as the first instance of a publicly traded social media company integrating prediction markets directly into its platform.
The new feature will display real-time market pricing, allowing users to respond to live developments.
Social elements will be integrated alongside trading functions, enabling users to discuss positions, share forecasts, and trade simultaneously.
User engagement will be directly linked to trading activity — participants who earn “Truth gems” through interactions can convert them into CRO digital tokens, which can then be used to purchase event contracts.
Vladislav Ginzburg, founder and CEO of OneSource, says that blockchain gaming is ready to move past the hype. Once hailed as the future of play, blockchain gaming has spent the last few years in the shadow of its own hype.…
The U.S. Federal Reserve will announce its latest interest rate decision at the FOMC meeting today, October 28. The market expects a decent 25 basis point rate cut, a move already priced in by most investors. For that reason, the immediate impact on crypto markets may be limited.
At the time of writing, XRP is trading at $2.65, down about 1% over the last 24 hours. While price action remains muted, traders are closely watching how XRP might react once the rate decision is official.
Calm Before Movement
The broader crypto market has been relatively quiet this week. XRP, in particular, has lagged behind some altcoins that recently surged following ETF approvals, such as Hedera (HBAR) and Litecoin (LTC).
Hedera, for example, jumped nearly 10% in a day after confirmation of its upcoming ETF. That strong move caught many off guard, as the approval was widely expected but apparently not fully priced in. The sharp rally has led some analysts to believe the same could happen with XRP once its own ETF finally gets approval.
Why the FOMC Meeting Matters for XRP
A rate cut generally increases liquidity across markets, encouraging investors to move money into risk assets, including cryptocurrencies. If today’s decision confirms the expected cut, it could support a gradual rebound in XRP and the broader market.
Still, analysts warn that the scale of XRP’s next move will depend on how investors interpret the Fed’s tone. A more uncertain outlook from the central bank could limit gains in the short term.
Short-Term Outlook
From a technical standpoint, XRP faces strong resistance near $2.75 to $2.80, levels that it needs to reclaim to build upward momentum. Some short-term downside toward $2.55 remains possible before a new leg higher.
However, sentiment is improving as market conditions stabilize and excitement builds around a future XRP spot ETF. If fundamentals continue to strengthen, XRP could target the $3 mark soon.
The first-ever spot exchange-traded funds (ETFs) for Solana (SOL), Litecoin (LTC), and Hedera (HBAR) have officially begun trading on Wall Street, marking a historic moment for digital assets beyond Bitcoin and Ethereum.
Early Trading Shows Strong Interest
In the first 30 minutes of trading, Bitwise’s Solana ETF ($BSOL) recorded over $10 million in volume, while Hedera’s $HBR ETF traded $4 million and Litecoin’s $LTCC ETF saw $400,000.
Alt szn catalyst?
SOL, HBAR, and LTC spot ETFs launched with $14.4M in first-hour volume.
BTC moves modestly with ETF flows (0.42 corr), while ETH’s nearly double (0.79).
If these mirror ETH, altcoins could soon move with TradFi money. Watch institutional flows. pic.twitter.com/WqVxbO5mKx
Bitwise’s Solana ETF stands out for offering 7% annualized staking rewards with zero management fees, a move designed to attract long-term institutional investors. The underlying SOL tokens are held in secure custody with Coinbase Custody and BitGo, ensuring transparency and compliance with regulatory standards.
How These ETFs Got Approved
This sudden wave of approvals followed a quiet but important change in SEC regulatory guidance earlier this month. As explained by Bloomberg analyst, the update appeared in a Q&A issued by the SEC’s Division of Corporate Finance, specifically Question 11 of 22, which altered the language around the registration process for securities. While the text referenced initial public offerings, ETF issuers interpreted it as a green light for spot crypto funds.
Canary Capital was the first to apply this revised framework on October 7, filing for both its Litecoin and Hedera ETFs. Bitwise followed on October 8 with the Solana Staking ETF, and Grayscale submitted its $GSOL filing the next day. Bloomberg analyst Eric Balchunas confirmed that the SEC’s swift certification of Form 8-A filings was the final step before listing.
Despite the partial U.S. government shutdown, these approvals moved quickly, meaning the SEC’s ETF review pipeline has become more efficient and perhaps more open to digital assets.
What It Means for the Market
The arrival of these altcoin ETFs marks the first big expansion of regulated crypto investment products since the approval of Bitcoin and Ethereum spot ETFs. For the first time, institutional investors can gain direct exposure to blockchain networks that power smart contracts, payments, and decentralized applications beyond the two dominant cryptocurrencies.
The next major wave in finance might not come from banks. It may come from bold crypto platforms poised at the intersection of payments, banking, and blockchain. With the Federal Reserve signaling interest-rate cuts and global liquidity expanding, the stage is being set for a real banking boom.
A project named Digitap ($TAP) is getting investor attention. With a working Visa card with no KYC, deflationary tokenomics, and global reach, analysts forecast that Digitap could absorb trillions in payments volume. And $TAP is projected to reach a price target of $18 by 2026.
Why Rate Cuts Matter: The Macro Tailwind for Digitap
An interest rate cut by the Federal Reserve will make borrowing cheaper, increase the volume of business activities, and encourage financial innovations. A Fed decision to lower rates signals more money in the economy, which in turn supports fintech and payment innovation.
As these factors put pressure on traditional banks to maintain tight margins, crypto-based fintech platforms are in a winning position. Digitap is right there in the middle of this perfect storm. It is not dependent on a future event to take off; it is already operational worldwide and looking for growth.
While traditional banks are busy trying to upgrade their systems, Digitap provides a simplified, borderless solution based on crypto and fiat interoperability.
Digitap: The Platform Ready for the Banking Boom
Digitap is the one-stop money platform that allows users to exchange, save, send, and spend both crypto and fiat. This is possible through cards, wallets, and offshore accounts. The card is powered by Visa and supports Apple Pay and Google Pay.
Advanced AI-powered tools allow users to switch between cards, wallets, and accounts effortlessly. The product’s privacy-first approach means no one is tracking, everything is encrypted, and the user has complete control.
Anything done within the Digitap platform is a value-add for platform holders: the platform automatically purchases and burns $TAP tokens with a portion of its revenue.
Thus, it reduces the supply and eventually brings scarcity of the tokens. With the global payments market expected to reach over $250 trillion by 2027, even a small share of that market represents significant potential.
Trillions in Flow: How Digitap Could Capture the Wave
The payments industry is in a position to be transformed by the rate cuts that bring about lower borrowing costs and easier money movement. Traditional banks get trapped in their old ways, while Digitap offers instant settlement with 1% remittance fees. Digitap is one of the top crypto coins, leading the way in 2025.
Digitap has its worldwide card network, multi-currency accounts, and no-KYC onboarding in place. It is capable of attracting freelancers, international businesses, and expats who require quick and cost-effective cross-border access. As payment flows shift away from legacy rails and towards crypto-enabled rails, $TAP will be well positioned to gain both volume and value.
That’s the way analysts come up with their forecast. By calculating Digitap’s increasing share of the global money-movement market, it is ready for exponential gains in the future.
Tokenomics and Target: $18 by 2026
The tokenomics of Digitap help tell the story of its long-term value. The total number of $TAP tokens is limited to 2 billion. Every transaction on the platform has an auto-buy-back and burn event. Therefore, holders are rewarded through staking, cashback, and referral programs. All measures are put in place to encourage the ecosystem’s volume rather than speculation.
Observing the presale round, the analysts note that the present pricing is still very close to the expected listings, but at a very low level.
With more than $1 million brought in the current presale and tokens priced at about $0.0194, the current entry position offers a huge upside potential. Analysts predict that Digitap could reach $18 per token if the platform starts generating significant payment volume from early supporters.
The Quiet Giant of the Next Money Shift
The next banking boom will happen with the platforms that can move money instantly, cheaply, and privately. Digitap is one of these platforms with 100% security approved by audits from Solidproof and Coinsult.
When the Fed starts cutting rates and liquidity is flowing freely again, money will be on the move. Digitap is a crypto coin that can best facilitate that. The prediction of $18 per $TAP token is not just an exaggeration but a logical result of its design and total addressable market. This is because they have a working Visa system, worldwide coverage, and a deflationary model in their favor.
For investors looking beyond short-term stunts and meme plays, Digitap offers one of the most interesting bets in this cycle.
Discover how Digitap is unifying cash and crypto by checking out their project here:
After a sharp rally that sent the Official Trump (TRUMP) price token soaring in recent sessions, the momentum now appears to be cooling as the market enters a phase of equal bullish and bearish pressure. Traders are closely watching whether the token can sustain its gains or face a short-term correction amid broader market uncertainty. As buying momentum slows, the next few trading sessions could decide whether TRUMP’s price resumes its uptrend or confirms a near-term pullback.
Ecosystem Expansion and Massive Earnings Drive Official Trump Token’s Momentum
The Official Trump (TRUMP) token has captured market attention once again, surging nearly 30% after the announcement that USD1, a Trump-linked stablecoin, will launch on the Enso Chain. The move is seen as a key step in expanding the Trump crypto ecosystem, potentially enhancing TRUMP’s real-world utility and investor confidence. This expansion comes as momentum traders position for further gains, though short-term consolidation remains likely amid rising market volatility.
Adding to the buzz, a Reuters investigation revealed that the Trump Organisation generated approximately $802 million from crypto-related ventures between January and June 2025—surpassing its traditional business income during the same period. Of this, nearly $336 million reportedly originated from the TRUMP token, spotlighting the financial weight of the Trump-backed digital asset. However, the findings have reignited debate over governance, transparency, and political influence in crypto markets, with regulators and investors alike watching closely how the ecosystem evolves in the coming weeks.
TRUMP Price Analysis: Is A Bullish Monthly Close on the Horizon?
The Official Trump (TRUMP) token is showing signs of renewed strength after months of steady decline. Following a sharp rebound from its October lows, the price has broken above a key descending trendline for the first time since May, signalling potential bullish reversal momentum. Trading volume has spiked notably, reflecting increased investor interest. However, with the token now hovering near critical resistance around $7.20–$7.30, traders are watching closely to see if this breakout holds or fades into consolidation.
The chart shows TRUMP testing a long-term descending resistance trendline, with current price action slightly above the $7.20 resistance zone. The DMI indicator reveals tightening pressure between bulls (DI+) and bears (DI–), suggesting balanced momentum. Meanwhile, the RSI at 57 signals moderate bullish strength but not yet overbought, implying room for upside continuation. A decisive close above $7.30 could confirm a breakout toward $8.50, while rejection here may lead to a retest of the $6.20–$6.40 support region.
Conclusion—Will OFFICIAL TRUMP Reach $10?
The Official Trump (TRUMP) token’s recent rebound above its long-term trendline has re-energized bullish sentiment, but a sustained rally toward $10 will depend on continued ecosystem growth and broader market stability. A confirmed breakout above $7.50 could open the path toward $9.80–$10.00, especially if momentum strengthens alongside renewed buying volume. However, failure to hold above $6.20 may trigger another correction phase. For now, TRUMP stands at a crucial inflexion point—where market conviction will determine whether the next move is a breakout or a fade.
Hedera (HBAR), the native cryptocurrency of the Hedera Hashgraph network, has stunned the crypto world with a sharp 15% jump in just 24 hours, hitting the $0.20 mark. The sudden surge has reignited investor excitement and placed one of today’s top gainers.
With growing institutional interests, traders believe more 50% to 60% gain is coming for HBAR’s token?
Here’ Why HBAR’s Price Jumping
Here’s the key reason why HBAR token price is jumping today, while other cryptocurrency struggling to surge.
Launch of the First HBAR ETF
The main driver behind HBAR’s rally is the launch of the Canary HBAR ETF on Nasdaq. This marks the first-ever exchange-traded fund offering direct exposure to HBAR, allowing large investors to buy the token in a regulated and secure way.
The fund holds real HBAR tokens in custody with BitGo and Coinbase Custody, providing assurance for institutions concerned with compliance and security.
Expansion in Stablecoin Utility
Adding more momentum, the Hedera Foundation announced that USDC, one of the largest stablecoins, is now available on Bybit. This expansion enhances liquidity and trading opportunities within the Hedera ecosystem, solidifying HBAR’s position in stablecoin-powered payments and DeFi activities.
Major Network Upgrades and Partnerships
Hedera has recently rolled out key network upgrades aimed at improving speed, scalability, and transaction efficiency. Alongside this, several new DeFi and NFT integrations have expanded its ecosystem.
Strategic partnerships and ongoing developer initiatives have also increased attention toward HBAR’s real-world applications, further boosting investor sentiment.
HBAR Price Outlook
The HBAR ETF listing opens a new era for Hedera, as greater Wall Street interest could further boost price and profile while validating the project’s long-term potential.
At the same time, several pseudonymous crypto traders believe HBAR is on the edge of a major price breakout. Based on current chart patterns, they predict a 50–60% price surge could soon follow.
The accompanying chart shows a clear bullish setup, suggesting that HBAR may be preparing for a sharp upward move as momentum continues to build.
Bittensor (TAO) price surged over 10% in the past few hours, climbing above the $450 mark as renewed demand for its subnets and rising speculative activity fuelled fresh optimism in the AI crypto sector. The decentralized machine-learning network has seen a sharp spike in trading volumes and open interest, signalling growing investor confidence. As TAO breaks key resistance levels, traders are now eyeing the $500 milestone—raising the question: can this AI-powered blockchain sustain its bullish momentum?
Why Bittensor Price Is Rising?
Bittensor’s sharp rally can be attributed to a confluence of bullish technical and fundamental factors. The most immediate catalyst is the surging demand for Bittensor’s subnets, which recorded an 11% jump in market cap within 24 hours, reflecting growing usage and developer activity. On top of that, futures open interest spiked nearly 19%, signalling strong speculative participation.
Technically, TAO has broken above a long-term descending trendline, marking a key bullish reversal pattern. The breakout has drawn renewed attention from traders who see Bittensor as one of the most promising plays in the AI + crypto narrative, especially with major institutional interest brewing in decentralized machine learning networks.
Bittensor (TAO) Technical Outlook
From a technical standpoint, Bittensor’s breakout above $434 has flipped a crucial resistance level into support, confirming a bullish reversal on both the 4-hour and daily timeframes. The price has consistently formed higher highs and higher lows, signaling sustained buying momentum. Analysts point to $466–$475 as the next critical resistance zone, beyond which TAO could target $500 in the short term.
Bittensor (TAO) is showing strong bullish momentum, rebounding from the $280–$300 support zone and now testing the key resistance near $470. The price has surged above both the 50-day and 200-day moving averages, with the two lines converging—hinting at a potential golden cross, a classic bullish signal that often precedes strong upward trends. Rising volume confirms growing momentum, while the RSI near 63 suggests steady buying pressure. A breakout above $470could pave the way toward $500, with support around $360.
Conclusion
Bittensor’s recent price rally underscores growing confidence in both its AI-driven narrative and improving on-chain fundamentals. With rising subnet activity, expanding trading volumes, and a potential golden cross on the horizon, TAO appears technically well-positioned for further upside. However, the $470–$480 range remains a critical barrier that must be cleared for continuation toward $500 and beyond. As momentum builds, traders should watch for sustained volume and confirmation above resistance to validate the next phase of Bittensor’s bullish trend.
Circle has officially launched the public testnet for Arc, an open Layer-1 blockchain network built to support developers and companies, driving more economic activity onchain.
The New Economic “OS” For Internet
This is a major milestone for Circle and it’s already attracting participation from over 100 companies across the financial and technology sectors.
Arc is now available for developers and enterprises to deploy, test and build on what Circle describes as the new Economic Operating System (“OS”) for the internet.
CEO Jeremy Allaire said that the testnet is “seeing remarkable early momentum”, as leading companies, protocols, and projects begin to build and test.
He highlighted that these participants collectively serve billions of users and handle trillions in assets worldwide, underscoring Arc’s goal to connect local markets to the global economy. He described Arc as enterprise-grade infrastructure designed to enable a more open, inclusive, and efficient financial system built natively on the internet.
The Arc Ecosystem is Taking Shape
With today’s public testnet launch, we’re proud to share that leading companies across major sectors of the global financial system and onchain economy are already engaging in the early Arc ecosystem.
— Jeremy Allaire – jda.eth / jdallaire.sol (@jerallaire) October 28, 2025
Arc is a big step toward building a more open and programmable financial infrastructure for the global economy. It is designed to make onchain transactions faster, smarter, and easier to use, with predictable dollar-based fees, sub-second transaction finality and opt-in configurable privacy.
With its integration to Circle’s full-stack platform, Arc enables a wide range of use cases across lending, capital markets, foreign exchange and global payments.
Institutional Partners
Leading capital markets firms engaging with Arc include Apollo, BNY, Intercontinental Exchange, and State Street.
Other participating banks, asset managers, and insurers include Absa, Clearbank, BlackRock, Goldman Sachs, HSBC, Deutsche Bank, Standard Chartered, Invesco, SBI Holdings and others.
Circle notes that payments are emerging as one of Arc’s most powerful use cases, making it easy for people and businesses to move money instantly and without friction. The same infrastructure also supports AI-driven systems that can autonomously send and settle value in real time.
Technology and Fintech Partners
The technology and payments firms engaging with Arc, include AWS, Mastercard, Visa, Cloudflare, Brex, Nuvei, among others. Stablecoin issuers from various regions are also active on the testnet.
Infrastructure Providers and Developers
Arc is also partnering with leading developers and infrastructure providers including MetaMask, Ledger, Fireblocks, Alchemy and Chainlink.
Anthropic is enhancing the developer experience on Arc with Claude code-powered builder tools. Crosschain partners include Across, Wormhole and Stargate while Elliptic, Quicknode, and TRM will ensure that Arc stays fast, secure, and reliable.
Arc is bringing together leading players from across the digital asset ecosystem, from decentralized and centralized exchanges to market makers, lenders, and custodians. DEXs like Uniswap and Curve provide onchain liquidity, while Coinbase, Kraken, and Robinhood expand global access.
Major market makers like Galaxy Digital, Wintermute, and GSR enhance liquidity, and lending platforms such as Aave and Maple support credit and capital efficiency. Custodians like BitGo and Zodia Custody help keep assets secure.
The First Step to Shared Governance
Circle notes that the testnet launch marks the beginning of a network designed to evolve into a distributed, community-driven system.
Over time, it plans to expand validator participation, introduce transparent governance models, and involve the community in its evolution.
Securitize is targeting a $1.25 billion Nasdaq listing to redefine public share ownership, using its tokenized equity model to merge traditional markets with blockchain’s potential. According to an Oct. 27 filing with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, Securitize has…
Digitap presale surges past $1m as whales eye trillion-dollar cross-border payments market. Markets move fast, and investors always have to be ready to flip bullish. Bitcoin caught a fresh bid, and as animal spirits awakened again, SOL bounced 8% past…
Despite her social-media suggestions that President Donald Trump let the rapper out earlier from her Bitfinex hack sentence, an official said that's not the case.
Traders face a mixed outlook, with BNB's deflationary mechanics potentially leading to a boost if demand grows, but technicals show the price stuck in a narrow range.
Donald Trump's demolition of the White House's East Wing for a new ballroom was partly backed by high-profile crypto folks who aren't keen on talking about it.
BOB’s new system enables bitcoin holders to borrow stablecoins against their BTC, keeping assets secured on Bitcoin and addressing a major obstacle to Bitcoin DeFi.
XRP price market info The XRP price is trading at approximately $2.66, within a range of $2.30–$2.70, with resistance near $2.70–$3.00 and support around $2.20–$2.30. Despite recent volatility, its market value is close to $158 billion, indicating that investor interest…
Oracle has announced the upcoming launch of Digital Assets Data Nexus, an enterprise-grade platform aimed at helping banks and financial institutions to tap into crypto and asset tokenization. Digital Assets Data Nexus is designed to help banks and financial institutions…
Little Pepe warns investors to avoid fake tokens as imitations appear across multiple blockchains. Safety should be a top priority when purchasing presale coins. Little Pepe (LILPEPE) is a trendy memecoin of 2025, having raised $27.25 million in its current…
Trump Coin price has rebounded by double digits as whale buying continues and exchange balances retreat ahead of the Federal Reserve interest rate decision. Official Trump (TRUMP) jumped to a high of $8.17 on Monday, Oct. 27, up by 78%…
Investors are worried about increasing government debt and debasement and are flocking to gold and crypto, says Larry Fink. Bitcoin’s credibility as a macro hedge just got a major boost. On Tuesday, October 28, BlackRock CEO Larry Fink put the…
As Reuters tallies over $800 million in crypto income for the Trump family in six months, Trump Media is expanding into a sector flush with speculative enthusiasm backed by billions of dollars. Truth Predict could embed financial risk-taking deeper into…
The gathering brought together decision-makers, investors, and innovators for a night of discussions, celebrating Gibraltar’s role as a hub for fintech.
Polygon is integrating Manifold Trading, an institutional-grade quant firm to tap into data-driven liquidity and institutional-grade execution features for its decentralized finance ecosystem. Polygon Labs announced its move to join forces with the quantitative investment firm Manifold via a press…
Shares of Trump-linked American Bitcoin are still up 20% over the week as the company nears the 4000 BTC mark. Despite Bitcoin trading close to its historic highs, treasury companies continue to accumulate Bitcoin. Still, on Tuesday, October 28 shares…
Pi Network price shows a strong bullish reaction from the 0.618 Fibonacci Golden Pocket, forming an engulfing candle that signals a reversal toward the $0.29 resistance. Pi Network (PI) has shown early signs of recovery after finding strong support at…
A widely shared seasonality snapshot is making the rounds ahead of month-end: a Coinglass heat map of Bitcoin’s monthly returns, reposted by trader Daan Crypto Trades. The table spans 2013–2025 and shows November as the statistical outlier in Bitcoin’s calendar—both for eye-popping gains and for sharp drawdowns in certain years.
Bitcoin November Preview
“November is Bitcoin’s best month based on historical performance. By far,” Daan wrote on X, pointing to an average November change of +46.02% across the dataset. That figure is visibly distorted by November 2013’s +449.35% surge, the single largest monthly move on the board. He added: “The average gain over all these months is +46.02%. But this is heavily skewed by a single monthly gain in November 2013. Bitcoin went up +449.35%!! that month.”
The raw counts back up the reputation without the hyperbole. Out of the 12 Novembers listed (2013–2024), 8 finished green—2013 (+449.35%), 2014 (+12.82%), 2015 (+19.27%), 2016 (+5.42%), 2017 (+53.48%), 2020 (+42.95%), 2023 (+8.81%), and 2024 (+37.29%)—while 4 were negative—2018 (-36.57%), 2019 (-17.27%), 2021 (-7.11%), and 2022 (-16.23%).
The median November change sits at +10.82%, a more conservative central tendency that dampens the 2013 effect. Excluding 2013 entirely, the simple average for November drops to roughly +9.35% across the remaining 11 years, underscoring how one month can skew mean-based seasonality.
Context from the broader table matters. November’s average is the highest of any month on Coinglass’s grid, ahead of October’s +20.30% average, while December shows a far more mixed profile with a +4.75% average but a -3.22% median—an imbalance consistent with outlier-driven months.
September, long maligned by traders, retains a negative average (-3.08%) over the full period. The 2024 row itself captures the push-and-pull of this cycle’s narrative: double-digit gains in February, March, May, October, and November, offset by meaningful drawdowns in April, June, and August, and a negative December print to close the year (-2.85%).
Lessons From Prior Cycles
Daan’s framing extends beyond simple seasonality. “November & December is when the 2013, 2017 & 2021 cycles topped out. It’s also where the 2018 & 2022 cycles bottomed out,” he noted. That observation lines up with the historical inflection points most market participants remember: the late-2013 mania and subsequent crash, the December 2017 peak, the November 2021 all-time high, and the December 2018 and November 2022 washouts.
The Coinglass grid cannot timestamp intramonth highs or lows, but the clustering of major pivots into the final two months of the year is consistent with the market’s folklore and with the returns pattern that shows both exceptionally strong up months and some of the cycle’s most punishing down months in this window.
The practical takeaway—again in Daan’s words—is not categorical bullishness, but regime risk: “All in all, an eventful last 2 months of the year generally speaking. Whether it’s on the bullish or bearish side, volatility and big market pivots have been the theme into the end of the year.” The heat map supports that characterization.
November’s distribution spans the widest extremes on record—from +449.35% at the top to -36.57% on the downside—with a two-thirds hit rate for green months and a median gain in the low double digits. December, by contrast, has produced both cycle tops and cycle bottoms despite a modest average, a reminder that average and median statistics can obscure the path risk that defines Bitcoin’s fourth quarter.
Seasonality is not destiny, and the sample is limited. Still, the data-backed message is clear: as November approaches, Bitcoin’s historical pattern has been less about quiet trend continuation and more about variance—the kind that has marked both euphoric blow-offs and capitulation lows.
Crypto analyst CasiTrades has predicted that the XRP price could still crash to $1.4 in the final wave of this downtrend. This comes despite bullish catalysts such as the Fed rate cut, which could lift the altcoin to new highs.
Analyst Predicts XRP Price Crash To $1.4
In an X post, CasiTrades stated that exchanges are aligning toward their .618 retracements, with Binance showing a crash to between $1.35 and $1.46 for the XRP price. She noted that this next wave down would complete the macro Wave 2 correction, setting the stage for the next Wave 3 impulse that could send XRP toward $6.50 or $10.
This came as the analyst remarked that the XRP price was at a major decision point, with the price continuing to test the Wave 4 highs. She noted that this resistance is making another wave down a possibility. To invalidate the move down, CasiTrades stated that XRP needs to break and hold above $2.82 on Binance.
However, so far, the XRP price hasn’t done so, with CasiTrades noting that the price is still ranging between support and resistance. She explained that this leans toward this being a Wave 4, with the altcoin one final move lower before the next macro impulse. The analyst ruled out a V-shaped recovery, noting that price typically breaks through resistance immediately and decisively, which is not happening with the current price action.
She further remarked that the hesitation suggests that selling pressure isn’t fully exhausted for the XRP price. However, CasiTrades assured that the deeper support levels aren’t a reason to panic, as they are high conviction accumulation zones. Meanwhile, the analyst highlighted a discrepancy in the price action on different exchanges.
She noted that the XRP price on Binance wicked to $0.77 during the $19 billion liquidation event, while on Coinbase, XRP never reached its .618 retracement level. CasiTrades then reiterated that until $2.82 breaks, the price action favors one final wave down before the next major move up.
XRP’s Bull Run Isn’t Over
Crypto analyst Egrag Crypto has assured that the bull run isn’t over for the XRP price, despite predictions that the top may be in. He stated that as long as XRP holds above $2.20 and $1.97 as monthly closes, then there is no structural break. He also believes that the altcoin and other risk assets are about to “roar.”
Egrag Crypto noted that quantitative tightening is still active and that Fed rate cuts are just beginning. In line with this, he declared that the last leg up is still waiting to play out. He claimed that cycles don’t end when 50% of traders are cautious, but do when everyone is “drunk on euphoria.”
At the time of writing, the XRP price is trading at around $2.6, down in the last 24 hours, according to data from CoinMarketCap.
Trump-backed American Bitcoin ($ABTC) surged 11% after adding 1,414 $BTC ($163M) to its treasury, bringing total holdings to roughly 3,865 $BTC worth $446M.
The company, backed by Donald Trump Jr. and Eric Trump, uses a novel Satoshis per Share (SPS) metric to show investors exactly how much $BTC backs each share.
Among the best altcoins to watch in this rotation are Bitcoin Hyper ($HYPER), a Bitcoin Layer-2; PepeNode ($PEPENODE), a mine-to-earn meme project; and World Liberty Financial ($WLFI), the Trump-themed DeFi ecosystem.
The Trump family has made another bold move in the corporate crypto world as the publicly listed treasury and mining firm American Bitcoin (ABTC) announced a 1,414 Bitcoin addition to its holdings.
That’s roughly $163M at current prices and brings $ABTC’s total stash to about 3,865 BTC – approximately $446M.
Backed by Donald Trump Jr and Eric Trump, American Bitcoin is the public-facing vehicle formed after a merger between Canadian miner Hut 8 Corp and Gryphon Digital Mining.
In a media release, American Bitcoin emphasized that its business model goes beyond simply buying $BTC; it also mines the cryptocurrency directly, which the company says gives it a cost advantage over peers that purely purchase from the market.
To drive the point home, ABTC relies on a metric called ‘Satoshis per share,’ or SPS. With 100M Satoshis per Bitcoin, ‘sats’ are the smallest unit of value in $BTC. By dividing the number of shares by the total number of sats in the Bitcoin it holds, ABTC can tell shareholders exactly how much $BTC their holdings represent.
Following the announcement, ABTC’s stock rose by more than 11% in a single session, as the news resonated with investors hungry for exposure to public company-level crypto strategies.
Bitcoin is up by around 4.7% in the past week, and sits just under $115K, near a two-week high.
ABTC forms part of the growing push for crypto treasuries, and signals confidence in Bitcoin’s near-term trajectory. That trajectory bodes well for key altcoins as well. Even as ABTC amasses Bitcoin, tokens like $HYPER, $PEPENODE, and $WLFI are emerging as the best altcoins to buy right now.
Bitcoin Hyper ($HYPER) plans to introduce a next-gen Layer-2 ecosystem that will address Bitcoin’s biggest pain points – slow speeds, high costs, and smart-contract compatibility.
And the project will do this by merging Bitcoin’s monetary dominance with Solana’s high-performance virtual machine (SVM) environment.
The Hyper Layer-2 will use a Canonical Bridge architecture on the SVM that allows native $BTC to be minted, wrapped, and deployed across a fast, low-fee ecosystem. And with zero-knowledge proofs and final settlement on the original Bitcoin Layer-1, it will all be executed without compromising Bitcoin’s top-tier security model.
Bitcoin Hyper enables real-time payments, DeFi participation, and on-chain micro-transactions that unlock Bitcoin’s liquidity for practical utility.
The project’s hybrid framework positions it as a natural upgrade to Bitcoin, capable of scaling transaction speeds from Bitcoin’s current seven transactions per second to multiple thousands, courtesy of the SVM. Meanwhile, its native token, $HYPER, will power validator staking, bridge operations, and ecosystem governance.
Discover more about this exciting Layer-2 project in our detailed Bitcoin Hyper review.
The combination of new utility and proven reliability bode well for $HYPER’s performance, which is why it’s no surprise that the Bitcoin Hyper surpassed the $25M milestone yesterday.
It’s also part of the reason our $HYPER price prediction shows that the token could potentially increase from its current price of $0.013185 to $0.08625 by the end of 2026 – for 554% gains. To get in now, check out our step-by-step guide to buying $HYPER.
Being a presale, though, its price rises in stages, while the staking APY decreases as more holders stake their tokens. With little over one day left before the next price increase – and staking APY currently at 47% – there’s no time like the present to join the presale at its early-bird price.
2. PepeNode ($PEPENODE) – ‘Mine-to-Earn’ for Bigger Gains and Meme Coin Rewards
PepeNode ($PEPENODE) deploys an innovative ‘mine-to-earn’ infrastructure play that transforms how meme coin culture and the blockchain intersect.
With a virtual server-room model, you’ll be able to use your $PEPENODE tokens to buy mining rigs and nodes to outfit your server rooms. And the more nodes you have, the more $PEPENODE you’ll mine.
Rewards are also up for grabs courtesy of this gamified project – and they’re not limited to $PEPENODE. Rewards include other popular meme coins like $PEPE and $FARTCOIN.
This novel platform brings together the fun of blockchain gaming and the raw potential of meme coins. For PepeNode investors, mine-to-earn opens the door for several ways to earn from the project:
$PEPENODE token price increases:Our PepeNode price prediction shows the token could potentially go from $0.0011227 to $0.0077 by the end of 2026, a 585% increase.
Staking and $PEPENODE rewards: The dynamic staking APY currently stands at 653%, while mine-to-earn rewards will be available after the project launches post-TGE.
Other meme coin rewards: Earning $FARTCOIN and $PEPE adds another way to benefit from the project.
The PepeNode presale has already raised $1.9M+, despite the presale only recently being launched. We expect that figure to ramp up considerably, placing $PEPENODE among the next altcoins to potentially explode.
3. World Liberty Financial ($WLFI) – Centerpiece of Donald Trump’s Crypto Empire
World Liberty Financial ($WLFI) – like all Trump projects – is as politically charged as it is business-motivated. Launched in parallel with Donald Trump’s pro-crypto policies, World Liberty Financial includes the $WLFI token as well as stablecoins like $USD1.
$WLFI blends meme-coin energy with a treasury-backed investment protocol tied to the Trump movement’s populist narrative. Its mission is to empower holders through decentralized finance, tokenized assets, and a particular brand identity.
$WLFI recently gained viral traction after a White House-themed tweet referenced GameStop and crypto freedom and sent trading volume surging past $220M in a single day.
Currently trading at $0.1465, $WLFI is up by more than 14% in the past week, reflecting an appeal that lies partly in its growing ecosystem and partly in political mood affiliation.
To recap: American Bitcoin’s $163M bet on Bitcoin highlights just how much institutional corporate interest there is in the crypto space. Projects like $WLFI show how that interest bridges from corporate projects to leading altcoins, and $HYPER and $PEPENODE stand to benefit.
Always do your own research; this isn’t financial advice.
Strategy Inc., the company led by Michael Saylor that rebranded from MicroStrategy, was hit with a junk credit grade on Monday as S&P Global Ratings flagged its heavy concentration in Bitcoin and weak dollar liquidity.
According to S&P, the firm’s balance sheet is tied closely to the price of Bitcoin and carries risks that traditional ratings models find hard to treat as stable collateral.
Bitcoin Holdings Drive The Score
Based on reports, Strategy’s Bitcoin stack is enormous — about 640,808 BTC on its books — worth roughly $73 billion to $74 billion at recent prices.
S&P said that while the company owns a large digital-asset hoard, the volatility of that asset and the company’s limited cash flow make it risky under S&P’s credit rules.
S&P assigned a B- issuer credit rating and kept the outlook stable. That B- places the company squarely in non-investment-grade territory, signaling a higher chance of stress if markets turn against it.
S&P Global Ratings has assigned Strategy Inc a ‘B-‘ Issuer Credit Rating (Outlook Stable) — the first-ever rating of a Bitcoin Treasury Company by a major credit rating agency. https://t.co/WLMkFqkkCb
Reports have disclosed that S&P was particularly concerned about a mismatch: most obligations are owed in US dollars, but most of the company’s value sits in Bitcoin. This gap can force the sale of Bitcoin to meet dollar payments if prices slide.
Analysts and commentators pointed to sizable convertible securities and preferred-stock commitments that add cash demands on the company. According to filings and market write-ups, the firm faces billions of dollars in convertible and preferred obligations spread over coming years.
Saylor and Strategy have made repeat purchases of Bitcoin as part of their stated plan. Those buys have created big unrealized gains on paper, but S&P’s methodology largely treats the token differently from traditional equity when measuring risk-adjusted capital.
Liquidity, Access To Markets
S&P noted that, for now, Strategy still has access to capital markets, which is why its outlook is stable rather than immediately negative.
But the rating agency warned that a sharp drop in Bitcoin’s price or any sudden tightening of funding channels could trigger a further downgrade.
Market participants will watch funding costs, preferred dividend payments and convertible notes for signs of stress.
Investors reacted with mixed signals in early trading. Some buyers treated the downgrade as a formal recognition of a known risk, while others judged the move as a calibration that won’t stop Saylor’s accumulation strategy if markets stay calm.
Trading volume and price swings in both Strategy shares and Bitcoin may rise as traders reassess odds.
Featured image from Gemini, chart from TradingView
In a bid to dethrone Wikipedia, Elon Musk’s xAI has launched Grokipedia, an AI-generated online encyclopedia. With over 885,000 articles, xAI Grokipedia promises to deliver faster and more factual information.
According to recent reports, xAI, the company behind Elon Musk’s Grok platform, gave birth to a rival to the online knowledge powerhouse. The tech billionaire claims that the platform will be a “massive improvement over Wikipedia,” addressing it as a “woke” Wikipedia.
xAI Grokipedia Launch Sparks Enthusiasm
Tech billionaire Elon Musk launched xAI Grokipedia, an alternative to the uncontested titan, Wikipedia. Criticizing Wikipedia for harbouring “editorial bias” and “ideological narratives,” Musk intends to position his platform to provide fast, factual, and less biased information. In a September X post, Musk wrote,
“We are building Grokipedia @xAI. Will be a massive improvement over Wikipedia. Frankly, it is a necessary step towards the xAI goal of understanding the Universe.”
Despite initial technical hiccups, xAI Grokipedia went live at grokipedia.com on Monday. The platform, powered by Grok, aims to transform the way online knowledge is created and shared. After launching in the afternoon, the site experienced a brief outage due to high traffic, but was restored by the evening.
Grokipedia vs Wikipedia
Notably, Grokipedia, the AI-powered online encyclopedia, boasts around 885,000 articles, a significant difference from Wikipedia’s vast repository of over 7 million articles in English alone. While Wikipedia has a more extensive collection, Grokipedia’s AI-driven approach enables faster updates and potentially more objective information.
Elon Musk’s xAI Grokipedia
Both platforms differ significantly in their approaches to content generation, editing access, and neutrality. Grokipedia uses anAIsystemin xAI’s Grok model to create and edit articles, using AI technology toupdatearticlesmorequickly and withlesspotentialbiasthanhumaneditingallows. Ontheotherhand, Wikipedia isentirelydependent on human volunteers to research, create, and edit entries.
While Grokipedia provides users theability to submit feedback, theeditingfunctionislessavailable, whereas Wikipedia allowsarticleeditingandcontributionsfromanyone.
According to Musk’s Twitter post, even in its early stage, Grokipedia is superior to Wikipedia; he noted that “version 0.1” is “better than Wikipedia,” promising that “Version 1.0 will be 10X better.”
Significantly, the xAI Grokipedia launch stems from Elon Musk’s long-standing criticism of Wikipedia. He believes that the latter is dominated by “far-left activists” and has an “extremely left-biased” editorial approach.
Musk has repeatedly expressed concerns about Wikipedia’s editorial bias, transparency, and potential manipulation of information. In a December 2019 post, he noted,
“Just looked at my wiki for 1st time in years. It’s insane!…Btw, can someone please delete ‘investor’. I do basically zero investing.”
Currently, many of the articles on the new platform appear to be derived from the existing online encyclopedia. But Musk aims to transition away from relying on Wikipedia’s content by the end of the year, leveraging xAI’s Grok model to generate articles instead. In his recent statement, reiterating the vision of xAI Grokipedia, the tech leader stated,
“The goal of Grok and Grokipedia is the truth, the whole truth and nothing but the truth. We will never be perfect, but we shall nonetheless strive towards that goal.”
Conclusion
To summarize, Grokipedia, an xAI initiative from Elon Musk, has launched with more than 885,000 articles and intends to compete with Wikipedia. Technical issues were apparent in the early experience, but the platform is billed as more regular and frequent, with quality articles produced faster.
Despite Grokipedia’s capacity to produce overwhelming amounts of information with an AI model, there are still considerable concerns about the potential for bias and whether it is factually correct. Moving forward, it will be interesting to see whether xAI can improve Grokipedia by balancing rapid updates with building reliability and trust with users; all attempts at launching in Version 1.0 are pointed to being ’10X better.’
Frequently Asked Questions
What is Grokipedia? An AI-driven online encyclopedia founded by xAI and Elon Musk, designed to produce information faster and factual with less quality issues.
How does Grokipedia differ from Wikipedia? Unlike Wikipedia’s human-edited model, Grokipedia uses xAI’s Grok model to automatically generate and update articles.
How many articles does Grokipedia currently have? Grokipedia currently hosts over 885,000 AI-generated articles
Glossary
xAI: Elon Musk’s artificial intelligence company that developed Grok and Grokipedia.
Grok: An AI chatbot by xAI that powers Grokipedia’s content generation.
Grokipedia: An AI-driven online encyclopedia created by xAI as an alternative to Wikipedia.
Wikipedia: A free, human-edited online encyclopedia known for its collaborative content model.
AI-generated content: Information or text created automatically by artificial intelligence rather than human writers.
XRP closed October with a mixed tape, yet the setup for November looks constructive. A repeatable price pattern, a genuine supply squeeze on exchanges, and a new institutional treasury building a billion dollar position all point to one thing: higher probability of topside tests.
A recent analysis mapped a close above 2.77 as the trigger that can open Fibonacci targets in the 2.75 to 3.00 area, with stretch room if momentum accelerates.
XRP price November outlook: upside paths, downside traps
For search clarity and reader intent, the XRP price November discussion starts with levels. The first inflection is 2.77 on a daily close. Hold above that pivot and the classic 0.5 to 0.618 retracement zone lines up around 2.75 to 3.00, where sellers usually test the bid.
If liquidity thins and momentum runs hot, prior impulses have reached into the low 3s, which keeps 3.20 to 3.40 alive as a secondary path. The baseline case is more modest, but still positive, because the structure respects higher lows and a tightening range into that 2.77 gate.
The XRP price November story is not only technical. On chain flows set the tone. Data aggregators tracked one of the largest two day exchange outflow events on record around Oct. 19 to Oct. 20, with more than 2.6 billion XRP leaving centralized venues. Heavy withdrawals reduce near term sell supply and often precede relief rallies when bids reappear. The signal is not perfect, but combined with price holding support, it tilts odds toward upside follow-through.
XRP price November
A billion-dollar buyer changes the conversation
New corporate demand shapes the XRP price November narrative as well. A Ripple-affiliated venture called Evernorth plans to become the largest publicly traded XRP treasury via a listing that aims to raise more than 1 billion dollars for accumulation.
The rationale is simple to understand and hard to ignore. A permanent buyer with a mandate to add on weakness can smooth drawdowns and intensify rallies. Reuters reported that the deal is expected to close in the first quarter of 2026, with strategic backers across crypto finance.
The team has been vocal in public.
“I am proud to share that we have launched Evernorth, a first of its kind institutional vehicle built to accelerate XRP adoption,” said CEO Asheesh Birla in a post on X, linking to the treasury’s introduction video. In a later update he added, “We are combining institutional discipline with on chain innovation to grow XRP per share and redefine what a digital asset treasury can be.”
Both messages underline a long horizon and an intent to keep accumulating.
XRP price November: Source, X
Crypto market strategists have weighed in on flows across assets. “Inflows into altcoins seem to be confined to SOL and XRP at present,” wrote a leading European research head in a public thread, echoing a broader rotation into higher liquidity names while smaller tokens lag. Stronger breadth in these flows would further support the XRP price November case, but concentration in the leaders often comes first.
What the indicators actually say
Good price calls do not rely on one data point. The XRP price November framework tracks several inputs. Exchange reserves trended lower into late October, consistent with those outflows. If reserves keep falling while open interest rises at a measured pace, price can pop on relatively small buy programs. If open interest spikes too quickly, unwinds can wash out gains.
Funding remains the real-time compass. Modest positive funding with rising spot volume is healthy. Aggressive positive funding without spot confirmation often precedes a shakeout. For short-term traders, derivative heat maps show a pocket of resting short-side liquidity just below the first resistance cluster, which can create a fast move if price rips through overhead levels.
Macro still matters. Digital asset products drew hefty weekly inflows in late October, a sign that investors continue to add exposure even after sharp swings. A sustained bid across the complex would support the XRP price November roadmap, especially if the pace of inflows persists as policy clarity improves. If flows stall, risk assets can slip back into chop.
XRP price November
Scenario planning for editors and investors
Map three paths. In the base case, the XRP price November move respects the 2.77 trigger, grinds into 2.90 to 3.00, and consolidates while funding stays contained. In the bullish case, spot demand from treasuries and advisors aligns with falling exchange supply, extending the push toward 3.20 and possibly 3.40 if breadth improves.
In the risk case, a failed breakout below 2.77 meets a burst of positive funding and crowded longs, knocking price back toward the mid 2s. None of these paths require perfection. They require discipline about levels and respect for the data in front of the market.
Public voices will continue to influence tone. One high-profile trader on X said, “New all-time highs in November,” summarizing the current optimism in a single line. Whether that proves prescient or just enthusiastic color matters less than the sequence of daily closes and the behavior of flows. Long term holders look at the broader adoption arc and the entry of corporate treasuries. Short-term traders watch the gate at 2.77. Either way, the XRP price November discussion is now in the driver’s seat.
Conclusion
The market likes simple stories. The XRP price November story blends a familiar breakout pattern with tangible supply dynamics and a new corporate accumulator. It will not be a straight climb. It rarely is. But if price clears 2.77 and the outflows persist while institutional demand scales, higher prints are reasonable. If those conditions fade, the trade becomes range bound again. Clarity lives in the data. The next daily closes will tell the tale.
Frequently Asked Questions
What is the key level to confirm momentum in November? Analysts watch a daily close above 2.77 to validate upside targets in the 2.75 to 3.00 band derived from the 0.5 to 0.618 retracement.
Why do exchange outflows matter for price? Large withdrawals reduce immediate sell supply. The Oct. 19 to Oct. 20 window saw more than 2.6 billion XRP leave exchanges, which historically improves the odds of relief rallies.
How does Evernorth influence market structure? A dedicated treasury with a mandate to accumulate creates steady bid support. The initiative targets more than 1 billion dollars for XRP purchases as it prepares a public listing.
Are fund flows supportive into November? Yes, late October showed sizeable inflows into digital asset products, which helps overall risk appetite if sustained.
Glossary of key terms
Exchange reserve depletion A trend where coins move from exchanges to self custody or treasuries, shrinking near term sell pressure and often tightening available liquidity for spot buyers.
Fibonacci retracement zone A technical range, commonly the 0.5 to 0.618 band of a prior move, used to estimate probable resistance and profit taking zones after a rebound. In this case it aligns with 2.75 to 3.00.
Institutional crypto treasury A publicly traded or regulated vehicle that accumulates a specific digital asset as a balance sheet holding, potentially buying on weakness and influencing market microstructure over time.
Derivative liquidation pocket A cluster on heat maps where forced buy or sell orders may trigger if price touches certain levels, often accelerating moves and creating slippage in thin conditions.
This article was first published on The Bit Journal: Why did the MSTR stock price double despite being given a dismal S&P credit rating, and what does that say about the status of Bitcoin as a financial asset?
The world’s leading Bitcoin treasury firm, Strategy, saw its MSTR stock price double despite receiving a dismal S&P credit rating of B-. The firm maintained that Strategy’s weak liquidity and narrow focus could easily lead to its future collapse.
According to a post by Strategy on the social media platform X, S&P Global Ratings placed the Bitcoin treasury firm in speculative, non-investment-grade territory — aka “junk-bond” status — despite the outlook remaining stable. However, Strategy CEO Michael Saylor noted that his company was the first digital asset treasury to receive an S&P credit rating, which, he said, was a clear indication of the company’s ongoing success.
Confidence in Strategy’s Long-Term Strategy
Despite the low rating, which indicates a lack of confidence, Strategy’s MSTR stock price turned positive, rising 2.27%, implying about 114% upside from Friday’s close and suggesting that investors had confidence in the firm’s long-term Bitcoin strategy. The special attention from investors at a time when the S&P credit rating took a dim view could serve as a milestone for the cryptocurrency industry.
The firm defended its decision to give a poor S&P credit rating, citing Strategy’s balance sheet as overwhelmingly tied to Bitcoin and stating that its low dollar liquidity and negative risk-adjusted capital outweighed strong access to prudent debt management and capital markets. S&P opines that the company’s structure creates an inherent currency mismatch: most assets are held in bitcoin, while debt and dividend obligations are denominated in U.S. dollars. Commenting on their report, the firm stated in their press release:
“We view Strategy’s high bitcoin concentration, narrow business focus, weak risk-adjusted capitalization, and low U.S. dollar liquidity as weaknesses.”
Facts the S&P Credit Rating Overlooked
In reaction to the rating, Matthew Sigel, head of digital assets research at VanEck, posted on X saying:
“The company can service debt for now, but is vulnerable to shocks.”
However, crypto economics are known to live and die on community hype, and Strategy’s branding could be an “X factor” that the S&P credit rating may not have incorporated into its system. Even now, new digital asset treasury firms are still referred to as “MicroStrategies,” a nod to the original company’s outsized reputation. Also, the S&P credit rating may have overlooked that TradFi is increasingly integrated with the broader crypto industry.
Conclusion
Despite the firm’s dismal S&P credit rating, Strategy assigned it a stable outlook, citing its past success in maintaining access to capital markets and managing debt maturities. With the next major maturity date set for 2028, the Bitcoin treasury firm has room to improve, as long as Bitcoin’s price doesn’t collapse.
Glossary of Key Terms
Strategy: A company that has a dual business model: it sells AI-powered enterprise analytics software, but its primary Strategy is to hold a large amount of Bitcoin on its balance sheet.
MSTR: MSTR is the stock ticker for Strategy Inc. (formerly MicroStrategy).
Bitcoin treasury firm: A publicly traded corporation that holds a significant amount of its corporate assets in Bitcoin as part of its treasury strategy.
Frequently Asked Questions about Strategy and Bitcoin Treasury Companies
What is Strategy (MicroStrategy) famous for?
Initially, the company focused on developing software for data mining and business intelligence. Currently, the firm’s Strategy involves leveraging its balance sheet to acquire BTC as a primary treasury reserve asset.
How do Bitcoin treasury companies work?
At their core, Bitcoin treasury companies are firms dedicated to accumulating a digital asset, regardless of whether that was the business’s original intent.
What is MicroStrategy’s Bitcoin Strategy?
MicroStrategy raises capital through convertible notes to buy Bitcoin, which helps Bitcoin’s price rise as they buy a lot of it. The MSTR stock price rises as the value of their bitcoin assets increases, and with a higher stock price, Strategy can raise even more money and buy more bitcoin.
Ever wondered which cryptocurrency could redefine your portfolio in 2025? Investors are buzzing as MoonBull ($MOBU) takes center stage, promising unprecedented gains and a thrilling early-stage opportunity.
While XRP trades live at $2.64 with a daily volume of over $4.1 billion, and Polygon (previously MATIC) shows a live price today of $0.2043, crypto enthusiasts are racing to claim a stake in the next potential 1000x project. The excitement is palpable, and missing out on MoonBull ($MOBU) presale at its current stage could be a regret many won’t forget. MoonBull stands out as the next crypto to buy and hold, offering unmatched early-stage rewards. This article will cover the developments and updates of all three coins: MoonBull ($MOBU), XRP, and Polygon.
MoonBull ($MOBU) Staking and Tokenomics Make MoonBull the Next Crypto to Buy and Hold
MoonBull ($MOBU) stands out as the next crypto to buy and hold, introducing a game-changing staking program at Stage 10 of the presale that offers holders an impressive 95% APY. Tokens can be staked anytime through the MoonBull dashboard, with rewards calculated daily, while a 2-month lock-in ensures structured growth without restricting flexibility. A dedicated pool of 14.6 billion $MOBU sustains the system, promoting stability, long-term engagement, and rewarding early believers for their commitment to the project.
Top Crypto Updates - Is MoonBull Poised to Eclipse XRP and Polygon as the Next Crypto to Buy and Hold in 2025? 21
With a total supply of 73.2 billion tokens, MoonBull’s 23-stage presale leverages strategic lock-ups, auto-liquidity, reflections, burns, and referral incentives. 50% fuels presale stages, 10% ensures liquidity, 20% supports staking, 11% powers referrals, 5% drives community incentives and burns, and 2% each secures influencers and team alignment. Unsold tokens will be burned, maximizing scarcity and rewarding early believers. MoonBull stands out as the next crypto to buy and hold.
Stage 5 Investors Eye $46,780 From $500 Investment
The MoonBull ($MOBU) presale is live, and the frenzy is real. Currently in Stage 5, the price sits at $0.00006584, with a presale tally surpassing $500K and over 1,500 token holders. Stage 5 investors are enjoying an
ROI of 163.36%, with a total projected ROI from Stage 5 to the listing price at 9,256%. A $500 investment now would secure 7,594,167.68 tokens, potentially worth $46,780.07 at listing. Price increases are projected at 27.40% per stage until Stage 22 and 20.38% in Stage 23. Every passing moment without participation risks missing an explosive surge. The MoonBull presale is the gateway for early believers to secure massive rewards in the next crypto sensation. Don’t let this opportunity slip away.
XRP Price Today Holds Strong at $2.64
The live XRP price today is $2.64, reflecting stability with a 24-hour trading volume of over $4.1 billion. Crypto price forecasts suggest XRP could maintain its bullish momentum in the short term, making it a strong candidate for investors looking for steady gains.
XRP’s price prediction highlights moderate growth potential, making it a reliable choice for portfolio diversification. For traders eyeing live prices and short-term fluctuations, XRP remains one of the most watched cryptos this week, offering insight into the broader market sentiment.
Polygon, previously known as MATIC, trades at a live price today of $0.2043 with a 24-hour trading volume of $110,140,007.52. Analysts’ crypto price predictions indicate a potential for incremental gains, supported by the network’s scalability solutions and increasing adoption.
The Polygon crypto price forecast positions Polygon as a practical option for investors seeking exposure to Ethereum layer two solutions. While gains may not match the explosive potential of meme coins, Polygon offers steady growth and reliable market presence, appealing to long-term crypto holders.
Top Crypto Updates - Is MoonBull Poised to Eclipse XRP and Polygon as the Next Crypto to Buy and Hold in 2025? 22
Conclusion
MoonBull ($MOBU) presale is shaping up as the most talked-about event in crypto this month. While XRP holds steady at $2.64 and Polygon trades at $0.2043, MoonBull’s 23-stage presale, staking rewards, and referral bonuses create an irresistible scenario for early investors. The project’s total supply and tokenomics are structured to reward believers while ensuring liquidity and market stability.
Investors eager to ride the next wave of crypto mania should act fast, as the MoonBull presale is gaining momentum rapidly. Don’t miss the chance to be part of a project where every token counts and massive gains await. MoonBull ($MOBU) is the next crypto to buy and hold. So, secure your stake now before it rockets.
Top Crypto Updates - Is MoonBull Poised to Eclipse XRP and Polygon as the Next Crypto to Buy and Hold in 2025? 23
MoonBull ($MOBU) presale offers early access with over 9,000% projected ROI, making it one of the best cryptos to buy now for early-stage investors seeking maximum rewards.
What are the top cryptocurrencies to invest in this week?
MoonBull’s structured presale stages, staking program, and referral bonuses make it a top crypto to invest in this week with high-profit potential.
Which high-profit cryptos offer the biggest early gains?
Stage 5 participants in MoonBull ($MOBU) enjoy a projected ROI of 9,256%, ranking it among high-profit cryptos for early investors.
How can you find the next 1000x crypto?
By joining the MoonBull presale, investors can secure tokens early and ride the next 1000x crypto wave before prices surge in the market.
Which crypto presale provides the best early-stage rewards?
MoonBull ($MOBU) presale with 23 stages, staking, and referral incentives provides the best early-stage rewards for ambitious crypto enthusiasts.
Glossary of Key Terms
Presale: Early phase of token sale offering discounted rates and exclusive rewards. APY: Annual Percentage Yield, representing staking returns over a year. Tokenomics: Structure of a cryptocurrency’s supply, distribution, and incentives. ROI: Return on investment, measuring the potential gains from holding a token. Liquidity Pool: Funds reserved to ensure smooth trading and reduce volatility
Summary MoonBull ($MOBU) presale is now live, capturing the attention of crypto enthusiasts worldwide. Spanning 23 stages, it offers early investors the chance to secure tokens at the lowest entry price while enjoying the potential for massive ROI. With an incredible 95% APY staking program and a well-structured tokenomics, MoonBull delivers both rewards and stability. While XRP trades at $2.64 and Polygon at $0.2043, MoonBull emerges as the next crypto to buy and hold, blending scarcity, community engagement, and explosive early-stage opportunities for maximum excitement and growth.
Disclaimer: This article is for informational purposes only and does not constitute financial advice. Cryptocurrency investments carry risks. Always conduct independent research before investing in any project.
BitMine Immersion Technologies has jumped into the top tier of institutional crypto treasuries with total crypto, cash and “moonshot” investments of $14.2 billion, anchored by a whopping 3,313,069 ETH position; seemingly the largest Ethereum treasury in the world.
Chairman Tom Lee has described the strategy as pursuing what the firm calls its “alchemy of 5%” of Ethereum’s total supply.
For BitMine Ethereum holdings, this means $ETH is no longer just a speculative token, but a corporate reserve asset.
BitMine Ethereum Holdings Scale
BitMine’s recent announcement divulged that they now hold 3.31 million ETH tokens, or roughly 2.8% of Ethereum’s total supply.
The breakdown includes 192 BTC, $305 million in unencumbered cash, plus their “moonshot” investments, all totaling $14.2 billion.
Earlier in August, they reported 1.71 million ETH and crypto + cash assets of $8.8 billion.
How BitMine Built Its ETH Treasury
BitMine’s ETH strategy started with a $250 million private placement announced on June 30 2025, specifically for ETH accumulation.
From there; they scaled fast and by July; they had over 300,000 ETH worth over $1 billion.
By early August, they had 833,137 ETH ($2.9 billion). By August 24th; they had 1.71 million ETH with $8.8 billion in assets.
BitMine’s move resonates with a trend in corporate treasuries where instead of just Bitcoin, Ethereum is becoming a reserve asset. By holding ETH as a core treasury holding, BitMine is signaling that they believe in ETH’s role in decentralized finance, staking, smart-contracts and tokenization.
Tom Lee drew a historical parallel, calling the ongoing evolution: “[The] end of Bretton Woods … as transformational to financial services in 2025 as ending Bretton Woods was 54 years ago.”
Market and Investor Impacts
BitMine’s ETH accumulation has had effects. Their stock (BMNR) has gone up big time and is now one of the most traded stocks in the US with daily volumes in the billions.
Big investors like ARK Invest, Bill Miller III, Founders Fund (via Peter Thiel) and others are also reportedly behind the strategy.
For ETH markets, big public-treasury holders like BitMine set a new precedent: corporate accumulation, staking and ecosystem integration are part of how ETH is valued.
Conclusion
Going forward, market observers could monitor include how BitMine manages and deploys its ETH; whether it stakes, uses it for DeFi yield or holds it passively. The firm’s target of 5% of ETH supply is ambitious.
Also; how other companies respond; will more firms add ETH to their reserves? The whole ecosystem may change if BitMine Ethereum holdings becomes the corporate crypto strategy.
Finally; how this accumulation impacts ETH tokenomics, staking; supply concentration and market perceptions will make headlines.
Glossary
Ethereum (ETH): a crypto-asset used for the Ethereum blockchain; for smart contracts; staking and DeFi.
Treasury holdings: assets held long-term by a company for reserve or strategic purposes; not for short-term speculation.
Staking: locking cryptocurrency to support blockchain operations; and earn rewards.
Tokenization: converting real-world assets or rights into digital tokens on a blockchain.
Circulating supply: total number of tokens available in the market; for a given cryptocurrency.
Private placement: issuing securities directly to a limited number of investors; often used to raise capital for strategic initiatives.
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs)
How much ETH does BitMine hold?
As of October 27, 2025; BitMine holds approximately 3,313,069 ETH.
What is the total value of BitMine’s crypto and cash holdings?
$14.2 billion in crypto, cash and “moonshots.”
What percentage of the total ETH supply does BitMine own?
BitMine says its holdings are about 2.8% of the total ETH supply.
Who are the major investors in BitMine’s strategy?
ARK Invest, Founders Fund (via Peter Thiel), Bill Miller III, Pantera Capital and Galaxy Digital.
What is BitMine’s target for its ETH holdings?
The company’s internal target is 5% of the total ETH supply, its “5% alchemy” goal.
The crypto market is heating up fast as 2025 approaches, and investors are hunting for the Top cryptos with 100x potential before the next big rally. From powerful layer-one ecosystems to meme-driven legends, this lineup blends narrative, fundamentals, and adoption. Each coin on this list brings innovation, growing networks, and a loyal community base that could drive extraordinary gains. These are the projects analysts believe could deliver life-changing returns once momentum reignites across global crypto markets.
Amid this surge of opportunity, BullZilla ($BZIL) stands out as the apex meme beast roaring across Ethereum. It merges mathematical precision with cinematic storytelling, capturing investor attention everywhere. Alongside Avalanche’s speed, MoonBull’s fairness, and La Culex’s humor, the list also features giants like Hyperliquid, Cardano, Binance Coin, Stellar, and Sui. Together, they represent the Top cryptos with 100x potential that balance innovation, utility, and hype, ready to roar when the next bull cycle begins.
1. BullZilla ($BZIL): The Investor’s Dream
At Stage 8, BullZilla ($BZIL) trades near $0.0001924, with its Mutation Mechanism increasing price every 48 hours or each $100K raised. The Roar Burn Mechanism reduces supply, while The HODL Furnace yields a fiery 70% APY. With a listing target of $0.00527141, early believers eye over 2,600% ROI potential. This mix of mythic storytelling, deflationary mechanics, and Ethereum security cements BullZilla’s place among the Top cryptos with 100x potential, where math meets meme and belief meets blockchain.
Santa's Secret List? Analysts Reveal the 6 Top Cryptos with 100x Potential Before Christmas Day 18
BullZilla’s blueprint is pure conviction: Zilla DNA divides 50% presale, 20% staking, 20% vault, 5% burn, 5% team, all locked, transparent, and fair. The Zilla Launch Sequence extends through 2026, combining lore, liquidity, and trust. Its automatic stage-based price rises create structured FOMO. This is more than a meme coin, it’s an engineered ecosystem of narrative-driven growth. Among the Top cryptos with 100x potential, BullZilla roars the loudest.
Roar to Riches: Why BullZilla Leads the 100x Hunt
When emotion fuses with engineering, legends are born. BullZilla’s investor appeal lies in certainty: price hikes are coded, burns are automatic, and staking yields are real. Its deflationary model tightens supply as the community grows stronger, transforming entertainment into equity. Each stage feels like a countdown to a historic launch, where conviction becomes currency. Early entrants are not just buyers, they’re believers fueling the loudest presale in crypto, where every roar signals rising value across Ethereum’s blue-fire ecosystem.
When in doubt, zoom out: the roar is just getting started!
Frequently Asked Questions About BullZilla
What makes BullZilla different from other meme coins?
BullZilla unites cinematic storytelling, automated burns, and high-yield staking under one Ethereum framework. It delivers emotional engagement plus tangible on-chain mechanics that strengthen value and community conviction across every presale stage.
How does the Roar Burn Mechanism work?
Each completed lore chapter triggers a live token burn, permanently removing $BZIL from supply. This automatic deflation increases scarcity, creating continuous upward pressure on price while showcasing transparent blockchain activity.
Is BullZilla audited and KYC-verified?
Yes. BullZilla’s smart contract is audited, and its team is verified for transparency and investor safety. Built on Ethereum, it ensures trust, security, and credibility through open-source compliance and rigorous verification.
2. Avalanche ($AVAX): The Lightning-Fast Layer-1 Contender
Avalanche ($AVAX) dominates blockchain innovation with near-instant finality, eco-efficient validation, and cross-chain interoperability. Its developer-friendly environment keeps attracting tokenized finance, NFT projects, and enterprise partnerships. Avalanche combines low fees with institutional scalability, making it ideal for real-world applications. As DeFi ecosystems and gaming platforms expand, AVAX remains a core infrastructure asset. Analysts continue ranking it among the Top cryptos with 100x potential for 2025 because it solves congestion, reduces costs, and delivers sustainability without sacrificing speed or security.
MoonBull ($MOBU): The Fair-Presale Challenger
MoonBull ($MOBU) reshapes meme-coin fairness through its 23-stage structured presale model. By limiting whale influence and ensuring transparent pricing, it builds equitable access for retail investors. MoonBull’s Ethereum-based framework combines 2% liquidity, 2% reflections, and 1% burn for steady supply control. Staking launches later with a powerful APY, encouraging long-term holding. Its community-voting system and educational focus help differentiate it from speculative memes, cementing MoonBull’s status as one of the Top cryptos with 100x potential in the 2025 cycle.
Frequently Asked Questions About MoonBull
What defines MoonBull’s fair-presale model?
Each presale stage has fixed pricing and duration, guaranteeing equal access. This transparent structure minimizes manipulation, ensuring fairness for every participant and rewarding conviction over timing.
When will MoonBull staking begin?
MoonBull’s staking starts at Stage 10 with 95% APY, letting holders earn daily rewards while boosting ecosystem liquidity and strengthening long-term community engagement.
3. La Culex ($CULEX): The Upcoming Meme Swarm
La Culex ($CULEX) is the upcoming viral swarm uniting humor and resilience. Modeled after mosquito persistence, it symbolizes unstoppable community energy. With its low-supply structure and high-engagement branding, Culex seeks to recreate the organic buzz that made Dogecoin legendary. Its marketing emphasizes participation and creativity over speculation, empowering holders to shape campaigns themselves. As it prepares for launch, analysts expect La Culex to inject fresh life into meme culture and secure a spot among the Top cryptos with 100x potential.
Frequently Asked Questions About La Culex
What does La Culex represent?
It symbolizes persistence and humor in crypto culture, rallying investors through collective energy and meme engagement, a swarm built for viral growth and strong community identity.
When is La Culex expected to launch?
Official dates remain unannounced, but social leaks hint at a late-2025 debut. Early followers anticipate its community campaigns will mark one of the year’s most talked-about meme launches.
4. Hyperliquid ($HYPE): The DeFi Exchange Disruptor
Hyperliquid ($HYPE) redefines on-chain trading by combining institutional-grade speed with DeFi freedom. Its transparent order books and low latency deliver centralized-exchange performance without custodial risks. As traders seek efficiency and security, Hyperliquid offers a next-generation experience for perpetual contracts and spot markets. Continuous volume growth and cross-chain support signal expanding demand. With on-chain derivatives set to boom, Hyperliquid is widely ranked among the Top cryptos with 100x potential, bridging professional liquidity and Web3 innovation.
5. Cardano ($ADA): The Academic Titan of Blockchain
Cardano ($ADA) continues to deliver scientific development and governance precision. Its Hydra scaling solution and peer-reviewed protocols maintain security while expanding throughput. Cardano’s focus on education, sustainability, and real-world deployments in Africa and Latin America sets it apart from competitors. With governance voting and DeFi growth accelerating, ADA demonstrates longevity and utility rather than speculative flashes. These qualities secure its ranking among the Top cryptos with 100x potential, where patient innovation consistently outperforms short-term hype.
6. Binance Coin ($BNB): The Utility Powerhouse of Web3
Binance Coin ($BNB) remains the heartbeat of the largest crypto ecosystem, fueling exchange operations, DeFi apps, and payments. Its automatic burn program reduces circulating supply quarterly, driving long-term value. BNB’s integration across the Binance Smart Chain and global merchant platforms cements its relevance. With massive user adoption and utility spanning multiple industries, BNB stays resilient through market shifts. Its sustainable tokenomics and Web3 expansion keep it securely listed among the Top cryptos with 100x potential for the upcoming bull run.
7. Stellar ($XLM): The Bridge Between Banks and Blockchain
Stellar ($XLM) bridges traditional finance and blockchain efficiency through affordable, instant cross-border payments. Its partnerships with financial institutions and government projects demonstrate mainstream utility beyond crypto trading. By focusing on financial inclusion and remittance innovation, Stellar proves blockchain can simplify global commerce. As regulators embrace tokenized money, XLM’s reputation for security and speed strengthens its appeal. Its consistent progress and real-world impact cement Stellar as one of the Top cryptos with 100x potential in the coming year.
8. Sui ($SUI): The Next-Gen Scalable Chain for Web3 Apps
Sui ($SUI) revolutionizes scalability through parallel transaction processing and object-based architecture. Designed by former Meta engineers, it delivers speed, security, and simplicity for NFTs, gaming, and DeFi. Its developer ecosystem grows rapidly thanks to easy smart-contract tools and low fees. Sui’s focus on user experience and real-time performance positions it to support mainstream apps on Web3. These technical advantages make Sui one of the Top cryptos with 100x potential, uniting scalability and accessibility for mass adoption.
Santa's Secret List? Analysts Reveal the 6 Top Cryptos with 100x Potential Before Christmas Day 19
Conclusion: The Age of Roaring Gains
From narrative brilliance to engineered scarcity, BullZilla stands as the apex of the meme-coin revival. Its automatic price escalations, 70% APY staking furnace, and Ethereum foundation merge entertainment with real investment strategy. Each stage strengthens conviction, creating a community that thrives on both story and sustainability. BullZilla isn’t merely a token; it’s an evolving ecosystem designed to reward belief and precision. With every roar and burn, the beast redefines what it means to hold conviction in crypto’s volatile arena.
While MoonBull champions fairness and La Culex delivers humor, BullZilla unites both elements into one dominant force. It’s mathematical precision wrapped in mythic storytelling, transforming meme culture into tangible wealth potential. Holders aren’t chasing hype, they’re fueling history. As Ethereum’s flames forge every transaction, BullZilla’s rise becomes inevitable. The future isn’t just bullish; it’s BullZilla-shaped, where belief meets blockchain, ROI meets narrative, and every stage becomes another chapter in crypto’s loudest, most legendary success story to date.
Santa's Secret List? Analysts Reveal the 6 Top Cryptos with 100x Potential Before Christmas Day 20
The roar isn’t hype, it’s history in the making. Don’t miss your chapter
This article is for informational purposes only and not financial advice. Cryptocurrency investments involve substantial risk and volatility. Always perform independent research and consult a licensed financial professional before investing. Past results do not guarantee future performance.
XRP could become a potential go-to tool for FX hedging amid the growing need to hedge against FX fluctuations among corporate treasuries. For context, foreign exchange (FX) hedging is a practice that helps companies and investors manage the risks that come from currency fluctuations.
BlackRock CEO Larry Fink has continued to recommend exposure to Bitcoin and cryptocurrencies, calling them assets of fear. Fink appeared at the 9th edition of the Future Investment Initiative in Saudi Arabia and preached the virtues of Bitcoin ownership to one of the world's biggest investors.
Well-known Bitcoin leveraged trader James Wynn has now joined the XRP Army. He announced the move in a recent tweet, revealing his decision to invest a “significant portion” of his portfolio into XRP.
Bitcoin price rose suddenly on Tuesday, Oct. 28, hitting a high of $116,200 as traders waited for the upcoming interest rate decision and Trump’s meeting with Xi Jinping. Bitcoin (BTC) has jumped by over 11% from its lowest level this…
The move formalizes OpenAI’s ties with Microsoft, granting the tech giant long-term access to its AI models while locking in a $250 billion Azure commitment.
With the right workflow, data feeds and prompts, ChatGPT can generate structured market summaries, flag risk clusters and support smarter decision-making.
Truth Social wants to “democratize information” for its 6.3 million users with a social media prediction platform developed in collaboration with Crypto.com.
BlackRock was the only reason Bitcoin ETF investments didn’t turn negative in 2025, raising concerns for altcoin ETF performances without the asset manager.
Institutional crypto yield demands regulatory compliance, not just attractive returns. Market consolidation will separate compliant providers from speculators.
As Pi Network prepares to align with ISO 20022 by November 2025, can it truly stand beside the XRP Ledger and the Stellar Network in cross-border finance?
Coinbase has completed more than 40 high-profile mergers and acquisitions, investing billions of dollars in promising cryptocurrency startups and unicorns.
Circle’s new Arc blockchain testnet launches with participation from more than 100 institutions, including BlackRock, Goldman Sachs, Visa and Mastercard.
CreditBlockchain enables eco-friendly crypto mining through renewable-powered data centers worldwide. CreditBlockchain provides individuals and organizations with a convenient way to mine cryptocurrency without having to purchase or maintain hardware. Leveraging data centers powered by solar, wind, and hydroelectric power, the…
The leading cryptocurrency, Bitcoin, may be on the verge of a 40% run in November, according to price history. Could the "Santa rally" of 2025 come early?
Kraken co-CEO David Ripley is set to make an appearance at Ripple's most important event of the year, Swell, sparking anticipation in the crypto community.
XRP sits at 0.0000231 BTC against Bitcoin, trapped in a razor-thin Bollinger Bands range. A breakout here could determine whether the altcoin survives or sinks.
Binance founder Changpeng "CZ" Zhao has reacted to recent speculation of having a net worth of 190 billion yuan, per a rich list that ranks the richest individuals.
181M tokens unlocked, raising dilution and sell-off fears.
Technical analysis shows weak momentum but hints at a possible rebound.
The GRASS price is under heavy pressure as the market braces for a massive GRASS token unlock event.
With 181 million new tokens — worth more than $80 million — set to flood the market today at 1:30 PM UTC, investors are watching closely to see whether this move signals a deeper downturn or a short-lived shakeout before recovery.
Built on Solana, the Grass network powers a decentralised data infrastructure where users share idle bandwidth to support AI and web-scraping applications.
But despite its strong fundamentals, the latest unlock threatens to overshadow its long-term potential with short-term volatility.
GRASS price struggles under selling pressure
Over the past 24 hours, the GRASS price has fallen by 2.9% to trade near $0.41, underperforming the broader crypto market, which slipped only 0.56%.
The token is now down more than 50% in the past 30 days, reflecting rising investor anxiety ahead of the unlock.
Notably, the upcoming token release will increase the circulating supply by nearly 58%, from 243 million to roughly 424 million tokens.
This surge in available coins raises significant dilution concerns, particularly in a market already grappling with low liquidity.
Unfortunately, data shows that trading volume has dropped by more than 25% over the past week, suggesting thin demand to absorb the incoming supply.
Historically, token unlocks of this magnitude have triggered immediate price declines of 10–30% or more, as early investors and contributors take profits.
GRASS’s decline of nearly 50% over the last month fits that trend, reinforcing the perception that the market has been pricing in the unlock for weeks.
The token unlock has overshadowed Grass’s funding optimism
Earlier this month, Grass secured a $10 million funding round led by Polychain Capital and Tribe Capital to expand its decentralised AI data network.
The investment validated the project’s DePIN model and its 8.5 million active users, but market reaction was subdued.
Instead of fueling a rally, the news coincided with a 6% drop in GRASS’s value as investors focused on the looming unlock.
Part of the concern stems from the nature of the funding, which included token allocations that may add to near-term selling pressure.
As a result, even fundamentally positive developments are being viewed through a bearish lens, with traders preferring to stay on the sidelines until the post-unlock price action stabilises.
Technical outlook hints at fragile stability
Technically, GRASS remains in a pronounced downtrend.
The token trades below all major moving averages, with its 7-day SMA near $0.4266 and 30-day SMA at $0.6243.
Momentum indicators confirm weakness — RSI sits around 35, signalling oversold conditions, while MACD is attempting a modest bullish crossover.
Chart patterns point to a large descending triangle formation, with GRASS hovering close to its lower boundary.
The next major support lies at $0.3126, marking the 2024 low, while resistance is seen near $0.4694 and more prominently at $0.9 — the key point of control (POC) on the Volume Profile indicator.
A breakout above this zone could mark the beginning of a recovery phase, but until volume returns, upside potential remains limited.
However, follow-through buying has been muted, suggesting that traders are still cautious ahead of the unlock.
What to expect after the GRASS token unlock?
The immediate aftermath of the GRASS token unlock will determine whether this event deepens the sell-off or serves as a reset for future growth.
If selling pressure spikes, GRASS could test new lows below $0.31.
However, if buyers absorb the new supply and RSI begins to recover, a short-term rebound toward resistance near $0.47 may follow.
While GRASS’ fundamentals, anchored in decentralised AI data infrastructure, remain solid, the market’s focus is squarely on supply dynamics and investor sentiment for now.
As the flood of tokens hits exchanges, GRASS will need a compelling proof of demand to convince traders that the worst is behind it.
KernelDAO price jumped to highs of $0.23 amid Upbit listing news.
The KERNEL token reached an all-time high above $0.46 in April, and it could target this mark next.
Gains across the crypto market will catalyse an uptick for the token.
KERNEL, the native token of restaking protocol KernelDAO, spiked more than 25% to hit highs of $0.23 early Tuesday.
While bulls are battling to hold onto the gains, the uptick saw the token rank among the top performers across the crypto market.
Given overall crypto sentiment, could Upbit listing help KERNEL price extend its upward momentum amid interest in restaking protocols?
Upbit listing propels KERNEL to $0.23 high
As noted, the catalyst for KERNEL’s vertical price ascent today is likely trader reaction to Upbit’s announcement.
On October 28, 2025, the leading South Korean crypto exchange confirmed the token’s listing on its KRW market, adding support for trading on the Ethereum network.
The listing ignited immediate buying pressure, with KernelDAO daily volume spiking as bulls propelled KERNEL from lows of $0.16 to an intraday peak of $0.23 as of writing.
Notably, daily volume stood at over $316 million, up a staggering 1,540% in the past 24 hours.
With gains of over 20%, KERNEL ranked among the few top altcoins with double digit price movements on the day.
KernelDAO price hovered in the list of top gainers alongside Hedera’s HBAR, Pump.fun’s PUMP and Bittensor’s TAO tokens.
Why such interest in KernelDAO?
KernelDAO is a leading restaking protocol behind a $1.7 billion total value locked ecosystem.
The YZi Labs-backed project is live across top blockchains, including Ethereum and BNB Chain.
Notably, it boasts key products like Kernel, Kelp, Gain, and Kred, a recently introduced product focused on real-world assets.
Upbit’s listing is the latest in bullish support for the KERNEL token, with the South Korean crypto exchange known for its active trading community.
The listing not only boosts KERNEL’s visibility but also taps into fresh liquidity pools.
KernelDAO is a restaking infrastructure platform that provides a range of staking-related services.
It enables restaking on the BNB Chain, supports BNB Liquid Restaking Tokens (LRTs), and offers Bitcoin (BTC) restaking opportunities.
In addition, the project operates an Ethereum-based restaking protocol that runs directly on the Ethereum network.
This system includes a vault-style smart contract designed to manage staked ETH, rsETH, and liquid staking token (LST) assets.
The platform’s native KERNEL token serves multiple purposes, including governance, restaking, and slashing insurance within the ecosystem.
KernelDAO bulls target $0.50 next
KERNEL price reached an all-time high of $0.46 in April 2025, and while it dropped to lows of $0.09 in June, it has recovered by more than 115% since.
Current prices around $0.19 means bulls are about 57% off the all-time peak.
As the broader cryptocurrency market rebounds amid various catalysts, including renewed institutional interest, regulatory clarity in key regions, and macroeconomic shifts favoring risk assets, KernelDAO looks set to benefit.
DeFiLlama shows the protocol’s total value locked (TVL) has pumped to over $1.7 billion.
As such, gains across the restaking sector could add further fuel to KernelDAO’s ecosystem.
Targets on the upside include the ATH and a breakout above $0.50.
On the downside, buyers need robust activity around $0.18 and $0.16.
Router Protocol completes migration with an airdrop on Ethereum.
ROUTE price gains momentum as the Router App launch boosts interest.
Analysts see breakout potential but warn of post-airdrop volatility.
Router Protocol is entering a decisive phase as two major developments converge: the token migration completes with an airdrop for unmigrated balances, and the Router App — powered by the project’s Open Graph Architecture — has gone live.
These events could reshape liquidity, user flows, and market sentiment for the ROUTE token.
Airdrop seals migration
Router Protocol confirmed that unmigrated ROUTE tokens on the legacy Router Chain will be distributed to eligible Ethereum wallets via an airdrop on October 28, 2025.
The team published the eligible-wallet list and framed the distribution as the final step in consolidating the token on Ethereum.
ROUTE Migration Update
As part of moving all ROUTE tokens from Router Chain → Ethereum, the below addresses have unmigrated tokens and hence will receive their tokens via airdrop on Ethereum chain.
Market participants typically react to migration completions in two ways: some see it as a trust-building milestone that simplifies token management and encourages broader exchange support, while others treat airdrops as near-term sell pressure events when recipients liquidate allocations.
That tension — immediate selling versus longer-term confidence — is why observers expect heightened volatility around the airdrop date.
The migration also follows a larger strategic pivot by the project away from maintaining an independent L1 towards providing cross-chain infra via OGA.
The sunset of Router Chain and consolidation on Ethereum removes fragmentation and ends on-chain inflation tied to validator rewards, according to community commentary.
Router Protocol’s Router App goes live
On August 28, the team launched the Router App, a cross-chain swapping interface built on Open Graph Architecture.
The App aggregates bridges and DEX liquidity across EVM and non-EVM chains, promising smarter routing and the ability to split and reassemble trades in real time.
The announcement positions Router App as the consumer-facing layer of a broader routing standard.
Technically, the Router App’s value proposition is twofold: it offers immediate utility by improving swap efficiency across many chains, and it signals a productization of Router Protocol’s core infra, which may attract both retail users and protocol integrators.
Early adoption metrics, and whether users move meaningful TVL into the App, will matter for price and perception.
ROUTE price reaction: analysts eye a potential breakout
As Router Protocol completes its migration and launches the Router App, analysts and traders are closely watching the ROUTE price for confirmation of a possible breakout.
The token has already shown early signs of strength, maintaining steady gains in recent weeks as attention builds around these milestones.
At press time, ROUTE traded at $0.004541, up 11.7% in 24 hours after hitting a low of $0.003865.
Crypto analyst Chetan has been among the most vocal, noting that ROUTE remains up over 70% since his initial call and is now breaking above a key trend line that has held since November 2024.
Chetan suggests that if the breakout sustains, ROUTE could climb to a minimum target between $0.033 and $0.039, with a maximum upside around $0.10–$0.11.
Chetan frames the setup as a high-risk, high-reward scenario — roughly 50% downside risk versus 5x to 15x potential reward — but stresses the need for patience, saying he’s watching how the quarterly candle closes before adding more.
$ROUTE still up 70% since the buy…. and nearly 2x since its lows…
and now breaking out first time from its November 2024 trend-line….
if the breakout happens then its a possible sign for continuation to 0.033$ – 0.039$ minimum…
At the same time, community member Jel has expressed renewed optimism, calling the potential “comeback of $ROUTE” “yuge”, reflecting growing bullish sentiment among long-term supporters.
Jel’s remarks echoed those of Ram from Router Protocol’s core team, who emphasised that the migration marks a fundamental reset for the ecosystem — validator rewards are ending, inflation is dropping to zero, and ROUTE is consolidating fully on Ethereum via Nitro.
Ram also noted that with consolidation complete, centralised exchanges are expected to fully support ROUTE on Ethereum, which could strengthen liquidity and accessibility.
The majority believe that completing the migration and delivering a live, functional cross-chain product could help the token rebuild credibility and attract more trading activity.
However, many warn that immediate volatility is likely after the airdrop as some recipients may take profits.
But if momentum continues alongside growing Router App adoption and Ethereum-based liquidity, the token could confirm its recovery narrative and extend its move higher.
Maja Vujinovic, CEO of FG Nexus, explains why institutions will have to tap into Ethereum or other public chains. Across the world, financial systems are quietly undergoing one of the most significant disruptions in decades. Payments, settlements, and custody are…
CoinTerminal executive Maximiliano Stochyk breaks down the key factors that make a DeFi project successful. Token launches are easier than ever, which makes good projects harder to spot than ever. As capital becomes more selective, investors are going back to…
Mono Protocol’s presale gains momentum as it builds a community-driven future for DeFi and web3 innovation. Mono Protocol is emerging as one of the next potential big presale crypto projects shaping the future of web3 and decentralized finance. With a…
Aster price establishes a double bottom at $1.04, a key high-timeframe support aligned with the value area low and 0.618 Fibonacci, signaling potential for a bullish reversal. Aster (ASTER) price has established a significant technical structure as price forms a double…
Chainlink price has bounced back by over 24.70% from its lowest point this month. This rebound could be short-lived despite some positive developments in the network. Chainlink (LINK) token rose to $18.72, up by 25% from its lowest point this…
Investors in the crypto market are always searching for the next big crypto that brings both innovation and stability. In 2025, one project is drawing serious attention for its blend of real-world use and long-term potential — Mutuum Finance (MUTM). Built as a decentralized lending protocol, it is developing a foundation that promises steady demand, active rewards, and transparent governance. Analysts tracking its presale growth already project a climb toward $3 post-listing, placing it among the most anticipated entries in upcoming crypto charts.
Phase 6 Presale: Smart Entry Before the Next Jump
Mutuum Finance (MUTM) is now in Phase 6 of its presale, offering tokens at $0.035. Out of the 170 million tokens allocated for this round, most are already sold. The project has attracted more than 17,500 holders and raised around $18 million across all phases. The next phase will raise the price to $0.040, marking a 15% step-up as the presale progresses toward the final price of $0.06.
The total supply of 4 billion tokens is carefully distributed across 11 phases, allowing gradual onboarding before listings begin. With this structured release, investors get clear visibility into the project’s growth timeline and capital distribution.
Mutuum Finance (MUTM) will introduce a dual-layer lending system that blends automation with flexibility. The Peer-to-Contract model will connect borrowers and lenders instantly through smart liquidity pools. Meanwhile, the Peer-to-Peer system will allow direct lending agreements for those seeking custom terms and higher control.
As per projects team on X, its first protocol rollout is scheduled for the Sepolia Testnet in late 2025. This version will feature mtTokens, Debt Tokens, and an automated Liquidator Bot, supporting ETH and USDT pairs for lending/borrowing and collateral activities. These modules will lay the groundwork for Mutuum’s future ecosystem, bringing real lending activity into decentralized finance.
Building a Utility Engine Through Stablecoin Innovation
One of Mutuum Finance (MUTM)’s biggest upcoming features will be its decentralized stablecoin. Designed to maintain a steady $1 peg, it will be created only when users borrow against approved collateral like ETH. When loans are repaid or liquidated, the stablecoin will automatically be burned, maintaining balance in the system.
This stablecoin will not depend on speculation but on actual borrowing and repayment activity, forming a consistent cycle of demand. Each approved issuer will have a capped limit, ensuring borrowing activity remains controlled. Governance will regulate interest rates to keep the peg close to $1 — lowering rates when the price moves above and raising them when it drops below. Arbitrage traders will help maintain that balance through natural market movements.
Open Market MUTM Buybacks and Chainlink Feeds
This cycle of borrowing, minting, and repaying will keep liquidity circulating within the ecosystem. It will also generate continuous protocol revenue that connects directly to MUTM’s reward system. As revenue builds, the platform will use it to buy back MUTM from the open market and distribute rewards to mtToken stakers. This mechanism will drive long-term token engagement, making the system self-sustaining and community-powered.
Mutuum Finance (MUTM) will also integrate Chainlink data feeds to ensure fair and accurate pricing for assets. These oracles will track asset values in real time, preventing manipulation and inaccurate liquidations. Backup oracles and on-chain price metrics will further secure the process, allowing investors to trust the platform’s reliability. Such transparency will attract larger lenders and DeFi treasuries looking for predictable outcomes. The growth in total value locked and transaction activity will expand protocol earnings — which, in turn, will strengthen demand for MUTM.
Security, Transparency, and Long-Term Growth
Mutuum Finance (MUTM) has already completed a comprehensive CertiK audit. The review included manual testing and static analysis, producing a Token Scan Score of 90.00 and a Skynet Score of 79.00. The audit, first requested in February 2025 and updated in May 2025, reinforces the team’s commitment to safety and clarity.
To complement that, the project has introduced a $50,000 USDT Bug Bounty Program that rewards community members who identify vulnerabilities. Critical findings earn up to $2,000, while smaller discoveries receive tiered rewards. This open structure keeps security continuous and transparent.
Market experts analyzing crypto charts compare Mutuum Finance (MUTM)’s early-stage setup to top lending platforms like Aave and MakerDAO during their initial years. One senior analyst who previously forecast XRP’s breakout in 2017 now projects MUTM to reach $3 by mid-2026 — representing an 85x return from the current $0.035 presale price and a 50x rise from the final presale stage.
This projection is built on real mechanics rather than speculation. As the platform’s stablecoin gains adoption, loan activity increases, and buybacks distribute more MUTM to stakers, demand for the token will keep rising. That cycle of participation, revenue, and reinvestment defines Mutuum Finance (MUTM)’s growth path.
Final Outlook: A Long-Term Utility Gem in the Making
Mutuum Finance (MUTM) is emerging as one of the most promising defi projects of 2025. Its model combines a lending framework, stablecoin system, and on-chain rewards in one unified ecosystem. With over 17,500 holders already on board and Phase 6 nearing completion, the presale offers a final low-cost entry before the next price move.
For investors searching for the next big crypto with genuine utility and long-term growth, Mutuum Finance (MUTM) stands out. It blends the best of decentralized credit, staking rewards, and stable liquidity. As the platform moves toward its Testnet launch and eventual listings, the current $0.035 stage marks a rare opportunity — one that forward-looking investors are treating as a timely entry into a project built for the future.
For more information about Mutuum Finance (MUTM) visit the links below:
Pleasing International, a licensed precious-metals enterprise based in Hong Kong, is working with LayerZero and Chainlink to launch Pleasing Golden, an RWA platform redefining how precious metals are traded, invested, and settled on-chain.
Starting with deployments on Arbitrum and ApeChain, Pleasing Golden bridges traditional commodities with blockchain technology, creating a transparent, efficient, and inclusive market for both institutional and retail participants.
Empowering a Frictionless Precious Metals Economy
Pleasing Golden’s vision is to make gold ownership open, liquid, and collaborative. Through tokenization and a suite of liquidity-sharing programs—including DeFi liquidity leasing and Tokenization-as-a-Service—the brand transforms slow, closed markets into dynamic, programmable assets that can circulate instantly among builders, traders, and holders.
For years, Pleasing International has been a cornerstone of Asia’s physical gold market. Now, through Pleasing Golden, that expertise moves on-chain—delivering institutional-grade metals trading with real-time transparency, shared liquidity, and community participation accessible to anyone, anywhere.
Pleasing Gold (PGOLD): A Digital Token Fully Backed by Physical Gold
PGOLD is the flagship token of Pleasing Golden, each representing one troy ounce of LBMA-certified physical gold. Since 2023, Pleasing International has built an integrated ecosystem of vaulting, refining, logistics, and distribution, partnering with leading operators across the APAC region.
Unlike traditional gold-backed products, PGOLD brings physical ownership on-chain, powered by LayerZero’s omnichain framework for cross-chain interoperability. Holders can acquire PGOLD through a Chainlink-powered spot market (public launch in late Q4) or by trading directly on decentralized exchanges.
Each PGOLD token provides verifiable ownership of real gold while enabling holders to share in:
Warehouse and redemption fees from physical operations
Institutional turnover revenues from B2B circulation
On-chain trading fees from liquidity pools
The instant settlement between PGOLD and PUSD lets users switch seamlessly between gold and dollar exposure—eliminating traditional delays and unlocking real-time capital efficiency across global markets.
Strategic Advantage: The Gold Corridor Connecting Asia and the Middle East
While most gold-backed tokens originate in Western markets, global demand for physical gold is increasingly shifting east. A major opportunity lies in creating a compliant and efficient gold-token bridge between Asia and the Middle East—the world’s two most active bullion centers.
Headquartered in Hong Kong and connected through established networks across Dubai and the broader APAC region, Pleasing Golden sits at the heart of this emerging Gold Corridor. PGOLD is designed to power this next era of digitized real-world gold through:
Direct physical ownership: each PGOLD represents 1 oz of LBMA-certified gold securely stored in institutional vaults.
Unlimited physical redemption: holders can redeem PGOLD for allocated bars of nearly any size in Hong Kong, with expansion planned across greater APAC and Dubai.
Fractional access and 24/7 liquidity: trade gold globally from as little as 0.01 oz, powered by Chainlink data and infrastructure.
Instant settlement: PGOLD can be converted into stablecoins in real time, providing seamless transitions between gold and stable exposure.
Transparent reserves: real-time proof-of-reserve, independent verification, and institutional-grade custody.
By connecting regulated bullion markets with blockchain networks, PGOLD transforms gold—long seen as a static, siloed asset—into a globally programmable store of value for institutional finance and the next generation of digital-native users.
Pleasing USD (PUSD): A Synthetic Dollar Financing the Precious Metals Economy
PUSD is Pleasing Golden’s synthetic stablecoin connecting on-chain liquidity with the physical gold ecosystem. Backed by a hybrid reserve of USDT collateral and tokenized metal exposure, PUSD enables real-time financing and settlement throughout the network.
The model connects:
Depositors — deposit USDT, receive PUSD, and stake it into sPUSD for yield.
Investors — traders or asset managers seeking stable liquidity with gold-linked returns.
Operators — metals participants using PUSD to unlock working capital and accelerate settlement.
The PGOLDPUSD loop allows 24/7 convertibility, enabling instant movement between stable and metal-backed value—reducing settlement times from days to seconds. PUSD is fully redeemable for USDT at any time, ensuring stability and flexibility while maintaining a direct bridge between blockchain liquidity and real-world assets.
Together, PGOLD and PUSD form a real-time financial rail where gold and dollar liquidity coexist—powering a new cross-regional economy spanning Asia and the Middle East.
From Web2 Leadership to Web3 Innovation
With Pleasing Golden, Pleasing International evolves from a traditional metals leader into a Web3 innovator shaping the future of real-world assets. By combining trusted infrastructure with decentralized technology, the company enables anyone to trade, invest, and earn from gold—anytime, anywhere.
The synergy between PGOLD and PUSD delivers what legacy systems never could: instant settlement, shared liquidity, and borderless participation in real value.
About Pleasing Golden
Pleasing Golden is an RWA platform that transforms precious metals into liquid, yield-generating tokens accessible to anyone, anywhere.
The year is about to close in the next two months, which has piqued the curiosity of market participants for a much-missed altcoin rally. As a reason SUI price prediction 2025 narrative is in trend. The SUI is among the top coins that have previously displayed massive gains and have the capability to achieve similar or higher gains again.
Looking at SUI specifically, then its price action is entering a decisive stage as the asset consolidates within a broad symmetrical triangle after a historic rally in late 2024. With ecosystem metrics booming and on-chain activity reaching record highs, the coming months could determine whether SUI crypto reclaims its previous all-time highs.
SUI Price Action: From 950% Rally to Tight Consolidation
The second half of 2024 was nothing short of extraordinary for the SUI price, as it skyrocketed over 950% from $0.49 to an all-time high of $5.32. However, 2025 presented a different story. Following the euphoric rally, the SUI price chart displayed movements confined within a multi-month symmetrical triangle, indicating mounting accumulation.
As the trading range narrows, it reflects growing optimism and strengthened network fundamentals. Such consolidation phases often precede significant moves.
Currently, the $2 support level acts as the key area to watch. A breakdown below this threshold could open doors to a deeper correction toward $0.49, while holding this zone keeps bullish hopes alive.
Ecosystem Growth Bolsters SUI Price Forecast
Despite the choppy SUI price USD action, the project’s fundamentals remain remarkably strong. On-chain data shows the SUI crypto ecosystem continues to thrive. The network recently achieved an all-time high of 225 million total accounts, a clear sign of rising engagement and user participation.
Even more impressive, October 28th witnessed 923,966 new accounts created in a single day, showcasing rapid adoption momentum. This consistent expansion in network activity underlines investor confidence and reinforces the long-term viability of SUI’s ecosystem.
Additionally, SUI’s Total Value Locked (TVL) stands firm at around $1.89 billion, after touching an ATH of $2.62 billion earlier in October.
Stablecoin Market Cap Growth Fuels Optimism
Another key aspect of the current SUI price analysis is the notable uptick in stablecoin inflows in october. The stablecoin market cap surged from a dip around $560 million to $1.15 billion at the time of writing. This is reflecting increasing liquidity and ecosystem utility.
Rising stablecoin activity often signals deeper adoption, as users engage more with decentralized applications, yield protocols, and staking opportunities.
This gradual yet firm rise in stablecoin dominance reflects investor confidence in the network’s resilience, suggesting that the groundwork for the next bullish phase may already be underway.
SUI Price Prediction 2025: A Crucial Setup Before the Breakout
The SUI price prediction 2025 framework points to a decisive few months ahead. If aggressive buying emerges, a breakout from the symmetrical triangle could send prices surging back toward $5.32 before the year closes, possibly forming strong Marubozu candles on the SUI price chart.
However, a more gradual buildup could delay the explosive move to the first half of 2026, allowing the asset to consolidate between its triangle borders. Either way, the tightening pattern and strong on-chain foundation make SUI crypto one of the most intriguing assets to watch in the DeFi landscape.
The SUI price is expected to reach a high of $7.01 in 2025.
With a potential surge, the price may reach $23.77 by 2030.
SUI, a next-gen Layer-1 blockchain, is rapidly gaining traction with its focus on scalability, seamless user experience, and Web3 integration via ZkLogin. Sui has quickly gained a strong position in the crypto market. Recently, Grayscale expanded its focus on the Sui ecosystem by launching two new trusts, DeepBook and Walrus. These products give accredited investors direct exposure to tokens within Sui’s DeFi ecosystem.
After a terrifying run due to token unlocks and broader market turmoil. Sui has made an impressive comeback on its price chart and is now changing hands at $2.63, which is 1.48% higher than its previous day’s value.
What Is CoinPedia’s Sui Price Prediction for November 2025?
The price of 1 Sui token could surge to a maximum of $3.42 by the end of November 2025.
Sui is trading near $2.63 after a sharp breakdown below both the middle and lower Bollinger Bands. Technicals indicate:
Key Support: $2.3550 (recent wick low), $2.70 zone (current price reaction) Resistance: $2.8012 (middle Bollinger Band), $3.3322 (20-day SMA), $3.8631 (upper Bollinger Band) Indicators: RSI at 31.25 signals oversold conditions, with a steep downward slope showing strong bearish momentum.
Sui Short-Term Price Prediction
Sui Price Prediction November 2025
Sui is likely to remain volatile in November 2025 amid recent bearish momentum and oversold RSI readings. Expected price range: potential low near $2.115, average around $2.91, and possible high at $3.42 if buyers return. Unless a reversal occurs, price action may struggle above $3.00, with ongoing downside risks in the near term.
Month
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
November
$2.115
$2.91
$3.42
Sui Price Prediction 2025
ETF interest is also rising. The SEC moved forward with Canary Capital’s proposal, while 21Shares is also under review. Though decisions are delayed until January 2026, the ongoing discussions could heat up if the U.S. takes a crypto-friendly regulatory path.
Sui Network plans a $320 million token unlock by the end of 2025. The forecast of this altcoin for 2025 suggests a new all-time high with a potential high of $7.01, assuming the bullish sentiment sustains. However, with a short correction, it may reach a potential low of $3.84, making an average of $5.42.
The SUI coin token projection for the year 2026 could range between $5.16 to $9.26, and the average price of the altcoin could be around $7.21.
Sui Price Target 2027
SUI crypto price for the year 2027 could range between $6.39 to $11.94, and the average price of this crypto token could be around $9.16.
Sui Long-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2028
7.98
12.68
15.38
2029
9.47
14.58
19.69
2030
12.63
18.20
23.77
Sui Coin Price Forecast 2028
Sui project can make a potential high of $7.98in 2027, with a potential low of$15.38, leading to an average price of $12.68.
Sui Token Price Prediction 2029
The forecast of this token for the year 2029 could range between $9.47 to $19.69, and the average coin price could be around $14.58.
Sui Price Prediction 2030
With an established position in the market, altcoins’ potential high for 2030 is projected to be $23.77. On the flip side, a potential low of $12.63 will result in an average price of $18.20.
SUI Price Prediction 2031, 2032, 2033, 2040, 2050
Based on the historic market sentiments and trend analysis of the altcoin, here are the possible Sui price targets for the longer time frames.
Coinpedia’s price prediction for SUI is highly bullish as the price is displaying a constant uptrend. This suggests that the price may reach new swing highs during the upcoming time.
With the ongoing Sui crypto update, the price is predicted to be a high of $7.01, with an average price of $5.42.
CoinPedia expects the Price to reach $7.01 by the year-end.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$3.84
$5.42
$7.01
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Is Sui cryptocurrency a good investment?
Yes, the SUI blockchain is one of the most prominent projects and is projected to gain significant value in the coming time.
Will SUI reach $10 in 2025?
With a bullish surge, the altcoin may hit a high of $7.01 this year.
Sui price prediction for the next 5 years?
Considering the Sui long-term price prediction, it may reach a high of $23.77 by 2030.
Does Sui have a future?
With the rising popularity of the Sui token, this project may achieve the $23.77 mark by 2030.
What is the price prediction for the Sui coin?
The Sui project is targeted to conclude the year 2028 with a trading price of $15.38.
Will Sui Cryptocurrency rise?
With active development on the SUI coin exchange, this crypto token is predicted to outperform some major cryptocurrencies in the coming years.
How much would the price of SUI be in 2040?
As per our latest Sui price analysis, the SUI could reach a maximum price of $178.84.
How much will the Sui coin price be in 2050?
By 2050, a single SUI price could go as high as $1,107.73.
Securitize, a leading platform for tokenizing real-world assets, is set to go public through a merger with Cantor Equity Partners II (CEPT), a SPAC backed by Cantor Fitzgerald, at a $1.25 billion valuation.
The move will make Securitize the first public company focused entirely on tokenized securities, marking a major step forward for the growing tokenization industry.
A Big Step for Tokenized Finance
Once the deal is complete, the combined company will trade on Nasdaq under the ticker “SECZ.”
Existing investors – including ARK Invest, BlackRock, Blockchain Capital, Hamilton Lane, Jump Crypto, Morgan Stanley Investment Management, and Tradeweb Markets – will roll over 100% of their shares into the new entity.
No one is cashing out, which is a clear sign of long-term confidence in the company’s future.
The merger could bring in around $469 million in gross proceeds. That includes $225 million from a fully committed PIPE led by top institutional investors such as Arche, Borderless Capital, Hanwha Investment & Securities, InterVest, and ParaFi Capital, along with $244 million from CEPT’s trust account, assuming no redemptions.
“This is a defining moment for Securitize and for the future of finance,” said Carlos Domingo, Co-Founder and CEO of Securitize. “We founded this company with a mission to democratize capital markets by making them more accessible, transparent, and efficient through tokenization.”
The news are out! @Securitize has filed to go public in Nasdaq via a merger with Cantor Equity Partners II lead by @Brandonlutnick at a $1.25B valuation
In a first for the finance industry, Securitize plans to tokenize its own equity, showing how a public company’s shares can exist and trade onchain.
Brandon Lutnick, Chairman and CEO of Cantor Fitzgerald, called blockchain “a foundational force in the next era of capital markets,” highlighting growing institutional belief in tokenization as the next big step in finance.
Securitize’s technology integrates with 15 blockchains. The company sees itself playing a key role in a $19 trillion market opportunity as more real-world assets move onchain.
The transaction, already approved by both boards, is expected to close in the first half of 2026, subject to regulatory approvals.
Solana coin price could reach a potential high of $400 in 2025.
With a potential surge, the SOL price could hit $1,351 by 2030.
Solana has been quietly building momentum, proving that its network strength is not just hype but backed by real numbers. Over the last quarter, its DeFi ecosystem expanded rapidly, drawing strong attention from investors.
Talking about Solana news, Grayscale has opened up staking for its Solana Trust (GSOL), which lets its investors earn SOL rewards via conventional brokerage accounts. This, coupled with Q3 network upgrades, monthly DEX volumes, and a TVL surge, these developments are fueling bullish momentum and positioning Solana as a top Ethereum alternative.
Following this, crypto investors are storming Google with questions like “Will Solana Go Back Up?” or “How high can Solana go?” and “Will SOL price reach $500 this altcoin season?” To answer more such questions, we bring to you our latest Solana price prediction 2025, 2026 – 2030.
Solana (SOL) is currently trading near $202, having recently retraced from highs around $211.11. Technicals indicate:
Key support is at $181, resistance zones are at $212 and $244.
Price remains below 50-day ($212) and 200-day ($172) moving averages
RSI at 43.5 signals neutral-to-weak buying pressure.
MACD stays bearish, highlighting further downside risk.
A move above $212 could revive bullish sentiment
Solana Short-Term Price Prediction
Solana Price Prediction for November 2025
SOL price is showing strength after winning over key levels. The RSI signals weak buying conditions, suggesting potential short-term pullback. If $200 breaks, the next support lies near $187.43. The resumption of the uptrend could push prices toward $252.01, then eventually to $270.41.
Month
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
November
$187
$210
$229
Solana Price Prediction 2025
Looking ahead, the Alpenglow upgrade, expected late 2025 or early 2026, will finalize blocks in about 150 milliseconds and simplify Solana’s consensus process. This could unlock real-time settlement for payments and derivatives, though short-term risks remain given past network stability issues.
Institutional players are already taking positions. Companies like Bit Mining, Upexi, and DeFi Development Corp together hold over 3.5 million SOL, worth more than $591 million. With technical upgrades, new partnerships, and rising investor interest, analysts see 2025 as a year of major potential.
If the market favors the bulls, the Solana coin price could breach its current all-time high and head toward a new high of $400. Conversely, stricter regulations or a network congestion setback could pull the price toward its annual low of $250. Considering the present market sentiment, the SOL crypto could settle with an average trading price of around $325.
By the Solana Price Prediction 2026, the potential low price of Solana crypto could be $310, with an average price projected at $410 and a potential high of $510.
SOL Price Analysis 2027
Moving on to Solana Price Prediction 2027, the potential low price for SOL is estimated at $389, while the average price is predicted to be around $506. The potential high price for SOL in 2027 is projected to reach $623.
Solana Long-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2028
476
622
769
2029
597
772
948
2030
716
1,033
1,351
Solana Coin Price Prediction 2028
As per the Solana Price Prediction 2028, the potential low price for SOL is expected to be $476, with an average price of $622. Further, the potential high price for SOL during this year is projected to reach $769.
SOL Coin Price Prediction 2029
Looking ahead to 2029, the Solana price targets a potential low of $597, with an average price of $772. Moreover, the potential high price for SOL in 2029 can reach $948.
Solana Price Prediction 2030
For Solana Price Prediction 2030, we estimate a potential low at $716, with an average price of $1,033. The potential high price for Solana in 2030 is projected to reach $1,351.
Raoul Pal’s Bold Outlook: Solana Price Prediction Of A Potential 20X Rally:
Raoul Pal, founder of Real Vision, predicts a potential 20x rally for Solana. He attributes this to Solana’s advanced blockchain technology, growing ecosystem, and rising investor interest.
If Pal’s prediction holds true, Solana’s price could exceed $400 in the coming months, a significant surge from its previous peak. Despite market trends, Solana has shown resilience, maintaining a strong performance with consistent buying pressure.
CoinPedia’s Solana (SOL) Price Prediction
With the improving network conditions of Solana and the slow but steady rise in the DeFi sector, the SOL prices project a bullish future.
According to CoinPedia’s formulated Solana price prediction 2025, the price might surge to $400. On the flip side, a failure to sustain recovery will plunge Solana prices to $250 during that year.
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Will Solana reach a new ATH in 2025?
According to our Solana price prediction 2025, the altcoin might chug up to a maximum of $400 by 2025.
Could Solana reach $1,000 by 2030?
As per our Solana price prediction 2030, with a potential surge, the price of SOL could reach a maximum of $1,351.
Will Solana reclaim its crown of being an Ethereum killer?
Solana stock, with its strengths in fundamentals, still holds significant prominence. That said, we can expect its glory to shine brighter with resolutions to shortcomings and major Solana news.
Will Solana enter the top-3 cryptos in terms of market capitalization in 2025?
Solana holds the potential to climb higher on the market cap rankings. The digital asset could make it to the target if it does not fall to negative criticism.
What is the Solana Foundation?
The Solana Foundation is dedicated to growing the Solana network into the world’s most decentralized and censorship-resistant blockchain.
How much would the price of Solana be in 2040?
As per our latest SOL price analysis, Solana could reach a maximum price of $11,698.
How much will the SOL price be in 2050?
By 2050, a single Solana price could go as high as $72,459.
The BNB price prediction anticipates a potential high of $2,292 in 2025.
Binance price may reach a maximum of $17,085.94 by 2030.
Binance Coin, after facing the brunt of the crypto market downturn, has made fresh highs to mark a new all-time high at $1370.55. Successively, at the time of press, BNB coin is being sold across exchanges for $1090.42
Amid the changing landscape, the Binance Coin fundamentals remain solid.However, the underlying uncertainties amid the global tensions raise questions like, “Is Binance safe or not?” or “Will Binance go higher in 2025?”
To answer these questions and provide a clear view of the BNB price action, we present our latest Binance Coin (BNB) Price Prediction 2025, 2026 – 2030.
Resistance levels stand near $1,370 as the recent peak, with further resistance around $1,400.
Key support is identified around $1,000, where a breakout occurred.
The 50-day moving average is climbing steadily at approximately $941.76, while the 200-day average also trends upward near $736.19, indicating strength in both short and long terms.
Overall, the short-term outlook favors continued gains, but the elevated technical readings call for caution as a pullback could happen near resistance.
Binance Coin Short-Term Price Prediction
BNB Coin Price Prediction for November 2025
BNB is showing strong bullish momentum, if buyers sustain above $1,300, the next upside targets are $1,462 and $1,624. However, rejection from the current trend channel could trigger a short-term pullback toward $1,226 or even $1,083. Overall, the October 2025 outlook stays bullish as long as BNB holds above $1,200, with a potential low at $1,180, an average near $1,350, and a high around $1,620.
Month
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
November
$1180
$1350
$1620
Binance Coin Price Prediction 2025
Now, attention has shifted to VanEck’s proposed BNB ETF in the U.S. If approved by late 2025 or early 2026, it could attract both institutional and retail investors, fueling more demand. With over 5,000 dApps and $8.1 billion in total value locked, the chain continues to grow.
That being said, the investors can anticipate the BNB coin price reaching a new All-Time High of $2,292. On the flip side, the Binance crypto may experience a low of $761 during that year. Considering the buying and selling pressure, the 3rd largest cryptocurrency could conclude the year 2025 with an average price of $926.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$761
$926
$2,292
Curious if Bitcoin will hit $100K as the crypto bull run begins? Find out more about Coinpedia’s Bitcoin price prediction.
BNB Crypto Medium-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2026
1,125
2,250
3,375
2027
1,687.50
3,375
5,062.50
Binance Coin Price Forecast 2026
By late 2026, BNB’s price could climb to a high of $3,375. However, the price might dip to $1,125, with an average value of $2,250 throughout the year.
BNB Coin Price Prediction 2027
In 2027, BNB’s price is anticipated to hit a peak of $5,062.50. On the downside, the price could fall to $1,687.50, with an average of $3,375.
Binance Coin Long-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2028
2,531.25
5,062.50
7,593.75
2029
3,796.88
7,593.75
11,390.63
2030
5,695.31
11,390.63
17,085.94
Binance Crypto Price Projection 2028
By the close of 2028, BNB’s price may reach a high of $7,593.75. If market conditions worsen, it could drop to $2,531.25, with an average price of $5,062.50.
BNB Crypto Price Prediction 2029
In 2029, BNB could continue its upward momentum, potentially reaching $11,390.63. However, it may see a low of $3,796.88, with an average price of $7,593.75.
Binance Coin Price Prediction 2030
As 2030 begins, BNB crypto could hit a new high of $17,085.94. Conversely, it may bottom out at $5,695.31, with an average price of $11,390.63.
Based on the historic market sentiments and trend analysis of the altcoin, here are the possible BNB coin price targets for the longer time frames.
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2031
8,542.97
17,085.94
25,628.91
2032
12,814.45
25,628.91
38,443.36
2033
19,221.68
38,443.36
57,665.04
2040
145,519.24
291,038.49
436,557.73
2050
1,131,478.37
2,262,956.73
3,394,435.10
What Does The Market Say?
Firm Name
2025
2026
2030
Changelly
$608.66
$1,219
$6,344
Coincodex
$1,119.10
$592.92
$1,305.46
Binance
$608.63
$639.06
$776.79
CoinPedia’s Binance (BNB) Coin Price Prediction
Despite the growing troubles of workforce reduction, regulatory scrutiny, and frequent executive departures, the Binance ecosystem is expanding. With its research in product innovations and new token listings, Binance Exchange has the highest trading volume.
As per CoinPedia’s Binance (BNB) coin price prediction, the price of $BNB crypto will increase to $2,292 in 2025.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$761
$926
$2,292
Is BNB a Profitable Investment?
Yes, BNB crypto is a profitable investment for the long term. Several initiatives, such as the auto-burn mechanism, contribute to reducing its supply and potentially increasing its value over time.
CoinPedia has dedicated a team of expert analysts to cover the possible crypto price prediction and sum it all up in one place, just for you!
Key Factors & Risks
Regulatory scrutiny of Binance operations globally poses ongoing compliance and legal challenges.
Expanding the BNB Chain ecosystem demands continuous innovation to maintain a competitive advantage.
Network upgrades like Lorenz and Maxwell forks enhance scalability but require successful implementation.
Market shifts, including macroeconomic trends and institutional demand, impact BNB price volatility.
Concentrated BNB holdings by Binance create potential supply and liquidity risks.
Investor sentiment and social media hype contribute to price swings and short-term volatility.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What was the initial price of Binance Coin (BNB)?
The initial price of Binance Coin (BNB) at the time of the ICO was $0.15.
What is the all-time low (ATL) price of Binance Coin (BNB)?
The all-time low price of Binance Coin was $0.09611 on August 01, 2017.
What could be the maximum trading price of Binance Coin by the end of 2025?
As per our BNB price prediction 2025, the maximum trading price of $BNB could potentially reach $2,292 in 2025.
How high could the BNB price reach by the end of 2030?
The price of the digital asset could reach a potential high of $17,085.94 by 2030.
What is the all-time high (ATH) price of Binance Coin (BNB)?
The all-time high price of Binance Coin was $793.35 on December 04, 2024.
Is BNB a good investment?
Yes, BNB is a profitable investment for the long term. With initiatives such as auto-burn, numerous projects, and growing prominence, we could find it bearing fruit.
How much would the price of Binance be in 2040?
As per our latest BNB price analysis, Binance could reach a maximum price of $436,557.73.
How much will the BNB price be in 2050?
By 2050, a single Binance price could go as high as $3,394,435.10.
ETH price with a potential surge could hit $6,925 in 2025.
The price of Ethereum could reach a high of $15,575 by 2030.
Amidst the turn of events, most cryptocurrencies are riding the bullish wave. And Ethereum, too, is receiving volumes. The Ethereum price today is $4150, with an intraday price change of -0.27%. Curious about where the ETH price is heading in the long run? Read our latest Ethereum price prediction for potential price targets.
What will be the ETH Price tomorrow?
Based on the current price trend, the ETH price tomorrow could range between $4,000 and $4,200.
Ethereum is trading short of its strong resistance at $5,000 and $5,250, while support holds at $3,762. For November 2025, if bullish momentum continues, ETH could test $5,250 as the potential high. On the downside, if selling pressure intensifies, the price might revisit $4,144 as a potential low. Considering the current trend and RSI near 46.5, the average price is expected to be around $4,700, assuming consolidation within the current range before a major breakout.
Month
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
November
$4,144
$4,700
$5,250
Ethereum Price Prediction 2025
A spot-ETH ETF could be the next major milestone. If approved, it may attract billions in capital. On top of that, institutional activity is growing. Layer-2 growth and big firms like State Street and PayPal are also building on Ethereum. The next big step is the Fusaka upgrade, coming in November 2025. Before that, Pectra will roll out in Q4, with long-term changes like Verkle Trees and danksharding ahead. These will make Ethereum faster and cheaper.
Ethereum price has been trading in a symmetric triangle pattern since early 2021, a breakout could lead to the ETH coin price hitting a new all-time high of $9,428.11. Conversely, rising uncertainty or any unfavorable global economic events could pull the ETH price toward its annual low of $3,142.70. That being said, it could average out at around $6,285.41.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$3,142.70
$6,285.41
$9,428.11
Ethereum Medium-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2026
4,714.05
9,428.11
14,142.16
2027
7,071.08
14,142.16
21,213.24
ETH Price Prediction 2026
By 2026, the value of Ethereum is expected to reach a high of $14,142.16. On the other hand, the Ethereum price might drop to $3,142.70, with an average of $6,285.41.
Ethereum Price Forecast 2027
The Ethereum 2027 forecast expects the ETH coin price to make a new all-time high at $21,213.24. However, a correction based on market shortcomings may drive the ETH crypto to $7,071.08, with an average of $14,142.16.
Ethereum Long-Term Price Prediction
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
2028
10,606.62
21,213.24
31,819.86
2029
15,909.93
31,819.86
47,729.79
2030
23,864.90
47,729.79
71,594.69
ETH Price Prediction 2028
In 2028, the chances of Ethereum dominating the crypto market rise as the ETH price potentially makes a new high at $31,819.86. On the other hand, the altcoin might fall to $10,606.62, making an average of $21,213.24.
Ethereum Price Forecast 2029
Approaching its all-time high of $47,729.79 in 2029, the Ethereum price is expected to surpass the psychological barrier of $40,000. In case of a correction, $ETH may reach a low of $15,909.93, with an average price of $31,819.86.
Ethereum Price Prediction 2030
As per our Ethereum Price Prediction 2030, the ETH crypto price is projected to reach a new all-time high of $71,594.69 in 2030, with a potential low of $23,864.90 and an average price of $47,729.79.
Based on the historic market sentiments and trend analysis of the largest altcoin by market capitalization, here are the possible Ethereum price targets for the longer time frames.
Year
Potential Low
Average Price
Potential High
2031
35,797.35
71,594.69
107,392.04
2032
53,696.02
107,392.04
161,088.06
2033
80,544.03
161,088.06
241,632.09
2040
~1,376,550
~2,753,110
~4,128,680
2050
~79,396,500
~158,793,000
~238,189,500
CoinPedia’s Ethereum Price Prediction
With factors like the growing Ethereum network, rising inflows, broader market recovery, and increased adoption, the ETH price will likely give multi-fold returns in 2025.
As per CoinPedia’s Ethereum price prediction 2025, the Bulls can hit $9,428.11 in 2025. Conversely, a rise in FUD amongst investors and a lack of updates could curb the value of 1 ETH at $3,142.70.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$3,142.70
$6,285.41
$9,428.11
Market Analysis
Firm Name
2025
2026
2030
Changelly
$4,012.41
$5,375
$24,196
Coincodex
$6,540.51
$3,816.62
$6,660.08
Binance
$3,499.54
$3,674.52
$4,466.40
VanEck
$6,000
–
–
Ethereum price could shoot to $5,500 soon and $12,000 by 2025
-Tom Lee
*The Ethereum forecast mentioned above is the average targets set by the respective firms.
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
Key Factors & Risks
Regulatory uncertainty from SEC delays and new global frameworks.
Centralization risk driven by institutional validators and staking growth.
Rapid ecosystem expansion with security token adoption and active staking.
Vulnerability to macroeconomic shifts like Fed policy changes and market sentiment.
Ongoing privacy and censorship risks from stricter compliance protocols.
FAQs
What is the ETH price prediction for 2025?
As per our Ethereum price forecast 2025, the ETH price could reach a maximum of $9,428.11.
What will Ethereum be in 5 years?
According to our Ethereum Price Prediction 2030, the ETH coin price could reach a maximum of $71,594.69 by 2030.
Is it better to buy Bitcoin or Ethereum?
While Ethereum is trusted for its stout fundamentals, Bitcoin continues to dominate with its widespread adoption.
Will Ethereum Go Back Up?
The $ETH price is expected to go up as the FUD settles and the altcoin season kicks off.
What is Ethereum 2.0?
Ethereum 2.0 is an updated version of the existing Ethereum blockchain, which aims to increase the efficiency, scalability, and speed of the Ethereum network.
Is ETH a good investment?
As the altcoin season begins, the short-term gains make Ethereum a lucrative buying option. However, the long-term promises of this programmable blockchain make it a viable long-term crypto investment.
How much would the price of Ethereum be in 2040?
As per our Ethereum price prediction 2040, Ethereum could reach a maximum price of $4,128,680.
How much will the ETH coin price be in 2050?
By 2050, a single Ethereum price could go as high as $238,189,500.
Circle has launched the public testnet for Arc, a Layer-1 blockchain designed to bring real-world financial activities onchain. Major firms like BlackRock, Visa, HSBC, AWS, and Anthropic are participating. Arc features USD-based fees, sub-second settlement, and optional privacy controls. Circle plans to decentralize Arc gradually by opening validator roles and governance to the community, aiming to build a decentralized, efficient global financial infrastructure.
Trump Media’s Truth Social is launching “Truth Predict,” the world’s first social media prediction market platform in exclusive partnership with Crypto.com. Users can trade contracts on events like politics, economics, and sports, converting in-app rewards called Truth gems into Crypto.com’s CRO token. Beta testing is coming soon, followed by a full U.S. launch and plans for global expansion. This move aims to combine social engagement with real-time market insights.
SharpLink is executing a complex treasury strategy that moves beyond simple staking. Its capital will flow through Consensys’ Layer 2 to EigenLayer, actively securing new services like verifiable AI and generating yield. According to a press release dated Oct. 28,…
WLFI price consolidates near $0.15, showing signs of accumulation that could spark a bullish expansion toward the $0.19 resistance zone. WLFI (WLFI) price is showing early signs of strength as price action consolidates near the $0.15 level, forming what appears to…
Truth Predict will let users bet on elections, Fed moves and more via a CFTC-registered exchange, making Truth Social the first social platform with native prediction markets.
The Wall Street broker said Hut 8’s shift to energy infrastructure from bitcoin mining makes it a unique bet on AI, HPC and future power-hungry technologies.
Mono Protocol enters Stage 15 with a $2.8m raise, Smart Contract Audit, and Reward Hub launch, paving the way for safer, more connected web3 and DeFi experiences in 2025. #partnercontent
Shiba Inu price is on the verge of a bullish reversal, as momentum picks up after the recent SHIB burn, with a potential for 25–35% gains from current levels. Shiba Inu price technical analysis Shiba Inu (SHIB) recently conducted another…
Bitget Wallet has fully integrated HyperEVM, giving users seamless access to Hyperliquid’s $5 billion DEX ecosystem, cross-chain transfers, and HYPE token utilities. In a press release shared with crypto.news, Bitget Wallet has announced its full integration with HyperEVM, the Ethereum-compatible…
a16z leads a funding round for a startup that is exploring the use of stablecoins in Pakistan and other emerging countries through neighborhood stores. According to a recent report from Bloomberg, Andreessen Horowitz is spearheading funding for a fairly new…
The People’s Bank of China has officially established the Digital RMB Operation and Management Center as the nation prepares its digital currency for widespread adoption. According to a recent report by Chinese media Capital Finance, the Governor of the central…
Circle is witnessing a rapid consolidation of financial heavyweights around its Arc testnet, as competitors from Goldman Sachs to Visa begin aligning on a common technological standard for the future of money movement. On Oct. 28, USDC issuer Circle announced…
The latest round of spot crypto ETFs went live on major exchanges, advancing under existing SEC rules despite the U.S. government shutdown. NYSE opens the door to new crypto ETFs On Oct. 27, the New York Stock Exchange quietly marked…
XRP is trading near $2.64 as traders turn their attention to today’s Federal Reserve interest-rate decision, one of the most market-moving macro catalysts left this quarter. Will a supportive Fed spark a breakout toward $3.00, or will a more cautious…
PayPal has announced a new partnership with OpenAI, marking a major leap in the fusion of AI and fintech. Online payment giant PayPal has become the first wallet integrated into ChatGPT following an exclusive partnership with OpenAI, paving the way…
Cantonese Cat used his October 28 video to zero in on the Dogecoin market structure, arguing that the meme-coin is nearing the end of a multi-year accumulation phase—and that the recent washout was a feature, not a bug, of that process. While he declined to publish numeric price targets in the video, he made the case that DOGE’s setup is maturing in lockstep with broader “risk-on” signals, with a familiar lag to Ethereum that historically precedes Dogecoin’s larger moves.
When Will Dogecoin Rally Again?
On structure, he was explicit. “Just looking at Doge here, you can see how […] Doge has been forming a cup over here for close to four and a half, five years now […] it’s just been building a big giant base.” In his read, the rounded bottom is the defining pattern of this cycle for DOGE, and it remains intact despite recent volatility.
He framed the sharp drawdown two weeks ago as necessary positioning rather than a break in trend: “You just had a great deleveraging event […] I’m not going to look at a lower low and think the trend is broken […] These are very healthy deleveraging before the next move up as far as I’m concerned.” He highlighted “a big giant wick” and “a lot of demand down below,” pointing to what he sees as resilient spot support through the base.
Timing, not targets, was the centerpiece. He reiterated that Dogecoin typically follows Ethereum with a delay once ETH clears its own major resistance bands. “Whenever we get closer to the end of the rounded bottom […] that’s when Ethereum breaks out above the resistance zone and goes up a lot higher. Thus, Doge runs together with Ethereum,” he said, adding: “There is a lag. I would say the lag is probably maybe a couple months between Ethereum breaking up and Doge finally breaking above this rounded bottom here and going up.”
He made a similar observation using risk proxies, noting that DOGE moves have historically trailed small-cap-led risk cycles by several months, though he cautioned that the exact interval can vary. Via X, he added “DOGE lags behind IWM [iShares Russell 2000 ETF] all-time-high breakout by about 2 to 4 months before it takes off.”
Cantonese Cat also pushed back on the view that a sequence of lower lows automatically invalidates the DOGE setup, arguing that this occurred in prior cycles just before outsized rallies. “A lot of people look at this, ‘that’s a lower low […] the cycle is over.’ Well, it doesn’t work that way. That’s a lower low right there. Next thing you know, it just went a lot higher,” he said, tying the observation to the current “healthy deleveraging” and the persistence of the rounded-bottom structure.
If the video offered the structural blueprint, his same-day post on X clarified his stance on headline targets. “I realize that it’s stupid to call for DOGE to $2 or $4 when price is at 20 cents. If I was smart like others, I should just call for DOGE to $2 or $4 when it’s $2 or $4.” The comment is consistent with his prior price predictions.
Inside the video update, the analyst instead emphasized the sequence he expects to matter—ETH strength first, DOGE follow-through second, with the magnitude determined by how far the broader risk cycle runs once momentum rotates.
The next Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) meeting is fast approaching, and the bets are already pouring in as to what it would mean for the Bitcoin and crypto industry. The last FOMC meeting took place in September, when the Federal Reserve ended up cutting rates down to 4-4.25% after months of no rate cuts. With this setting the tone, the expectations that another rate cut could be on the way are getting louder, with the FedWatch Tool showing a high percentage.
Market Expects Another Rate Cut To 3.75-4%
The next FOMC meeting is scheduled for Wednesday, October 29, 2025, and there is already a major clamor around what the Fed is planning on doing. The current market headwinds point to a favorable outcome for risk assets such as Bitcoin and other cryptocurrencies, with expected rate cuts.
Currently, the CME FedWatch Tool is showing that the probability of a rate cut has risen to 98.3% as of the time of this writing. This leaves only a 1.7% chance that the Federal Reserve will actually leave rates at their current levels, and there is zero chance that there will be a rate hike.
A reduction in the rate cuts is good for businesses all around, as lower interest rates mean better loan terms and increased spending and borrowing. Thus, it will increase the participation in the markets, from consumer goods to the stock market, and then make its way into newer markets such as Bitcoin and crypto.
Expectations For Bitcoin And Crypto Are Getting Higher
A rate cut by the Federal Reserve aligns with the more pro-crypto stance that the United States has been moving in since President Donald Trump was elected. Last week, the president pardoned the Founder and former CEO of the Binance crypto exchange, Changpeng Zhao, after he previously pled guilty to money laundering violations back in 2024. Zhao has since served a 4-month stint before the pardon from Trump came.
With the US embracing Bitcoin and crypto again, a rate cut will only further the ascent, allowing more investors to get into the market as liquidity frees up. The initial announcement has been known to trigger a rapid increase in the market. But as the news settles, the crypto market is expected to continue to rise in response.
However, nothing is certain until the FOMC meeting is complete and the announcement is made. For the Bitcoin and crypto market to remain bullish, inflation will also have to be reduced, as an increase could trigger more conservative stances from investors.
$135 Litecoin price prediction hits the market ahead of the Litecoin ETF (LTCC) reaching Nasdaq today.
Litecoin is already bullish, after briefly breaking above $105 and consolidating around the $102 mark in preparation of the SEC’s decision.
PEPENODE ($PEPENODE) reaches $1.96M in presale thanks to its mine-to-earn mechanics and community support.
$PEPENODE could deliver an ROI of 585% in 2026, without counting the staking APY of 653%.
A $135 price prediction for Litecoin appears more than feasible ahead of its spot ETF, which is ready to launch on Nasdaq today with the ticker LTCC.
Litecoin has been experiencing a notable increase over the last week, following a 10.44% surge that took it from $ 90.50 on October 23 to a high of $105.25 today.
The main catalyst is the SEC’s imminent favorable decision, which would greenlight Canary Litecoin, Canary HBAR, and Bitwise Solana ETFs today.
Bloomberg analyst, Eric Balchunas, confirmed the news on X, saying: ‘Assuming there’s not some last min SEC intervention, looks like this is happening’.
The news is understandably bullish for Litecoin, as the Nasdaq listing would open the asset to investors who don’t necessarily want to buy it. Long-term, this will boost liquidity, improve Litecoin’s legitimacy, and increase adoption at retail and, hopefully, institutional level.
Projects like PEPENODE ($PEPENODE) also stand to gain thanks to its on-chain utility and meme value. PEPENODE allows early adopters to buy mining nodes and build their own virtual coin mining facility, minus the electricity costs and expensive mining equipment.
Can Litecoin Push to $135?
The momentum is there for a $135 push, especially considering the network activity, as shown by Santiment. Litecoin’s price spiked on October 9 and crashed soon after; the window was too short for investors to capitalize on it.
There was an attempt, but it fizzled out as Litecoin was already in free fall.
If investors had capitalized on it, the momentum might have held, increasing the opportunity window and potentially triggering a consolidation phase above $130.
But we’re not in that timeline.
Fortunately, we may be looking at a strong reset, as $LTC is already showing signs of consolidation above $101 after briefly popping its head above $105.
And this time, investors are not willing to miss the opportunity window again. The 24-hour transaction volume is up 69.41%, a clear indication that momentum is building ahead of the SEC’s decision later today.
We then have the Relative Strength Index, which currently stands at 64.77 points. For reference, the bull zone begins at a price above 50.
The community is clearly hyped up, $LTC shows growing potential, and investors are ready. In this context, a breakout above $135 is more than achievable if LTCC performs well following its Nasdaq listing.
If $LTC meets the bullish expectations, another project that stands to gain significant attention is PEPENODE ($PEPENODE), with its presale already at $1.96M.
How PEPENODE Rewards Early Adoption
PEPENODE ($PEPENODE) encourages participation in its presale with the help of its innovative mine-to-earn mechanics.
The project addresses the main problems associated with crypto presales today: the lack of participation incentives. In short, presales don’t incentivize investors to buy in early, which leads to poor presale performances, which inadvertently lowers the coin’s visibility post launch.
PEPENODE’s mine-to-earn mechanics offer an exciting alternative in the form of virtual mining facilities. The concept is straightforward: purchase mining nodes, upgrade them, build your own virtual mining facility, activate it, and watch your rewards accumulate.
The earlier you buy, the stronger your nodes, the faster you mine, and the more you can earn. This translates to higher post-TGE rewards, which include actual meme coins, such as $FARTCOIN and $PEPE.
The 653% staking APY is an additional incentive for early adoption.
$PEPENODE now sits at $0.0011227 and managed to raise $1,965,327 so far, while the presale is still going. Based on the project’s utility and meme value, the token still has plenty of growth potential.
A realistic price prediction for $PEPENODE puts the coin at $0.0077 by the end of 2026; possibly even higher if the mine-to-earn mechanics catch on. This translates to an ROI of 585%, excluding the staking benefits or the meme coin rewards resulting from your coin-farming.
The crypto market, despite experiencing throughout the year major price fluctuations, security incidents, and legal hurdles, has experienced remarkable growth.
This can be attributed to the expansion of digital asset treasuries (DATs), increased institutional adoption, and new initiatives aimed at integrating digital assets, particularly stablecoins, into traditional financial sectors.
Andreessen Horowitz (a16z) recently shared their projections for the crypto landscape for the remainder of the year and years to come, highlighting nine key trends expected to be major catalysts for the industry.
Key Legislative Changes And Institutional Adoption
Firstly, market structure legislation in the US is expected to emerge as a critical priority for policymakers and Congress, establishing a clear regulatory framework that supports crypto developers.
The passage of the GENIUS Act in July of this year also marked a pivotal moment, garnering bipartisan support and providing builders with much-needed certainty in their endeavors.
Secondly, the adoption of stablecoins is set to accelerate as network effects take hold among financial institutions, merchants, and consumers, thereby enhancing the global standing of the US dollar.
Furthermore, major players like JPMorgan, Citi, BlackRock, and Fidelity are amplifying their crypto offerings through new product launches, partnerships, and acquisitions.
The infrastructure supporting blockchain technology is also advancing rapidly. Current networks can process over 3,400 transactions per second, marking a 100-fold increase over the past five years.
Moreover, a new wave of real-world assets (RWAs) is transitioning onto the blockchain as the worlds of crypto and traditional finance converge. The market for tokenized real-world assets has expanded to nearly $30 billion, with significant contributions from Treasuries, money market funds, and private credit.
The Future Of Crypto
In parallel, the crypto sector is attracting a growing pool of talent, driven by a more favorable regulatory environment and the emergence of new opportunities for developers.
The focus on revenue generation is also shifting within the token ecosystem. More tokens are implementing fee mechanisms, redirecting attention toward fundamental value. In the past year, users have paid $33 billion in fees, resulting in $18 billion for projects and $4 billion for token holders.
Innovative consumer products are also expected to drive the next wave of crypto adoption. Although approximately 716 million people now own cryptocurrency, only 40 to 70 million are considered active users.
Ultimately, 2025 is poised to lay the groundwork and establish the foundations for the years to come. It is expected to be a transformative year for the crypto industry, characterized by widespread institutional adoption, regulatory clarity, and tangible utility.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
The Altcoins ETFs is set to launch this Tuesday, marking a significant moment in crypto investing. According to the source, U.S. exchanges have posted listing notices for spot funds tied to these three tokens.
This move allows everyday investors to gain exposure to Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera without owning the coins directly, opening a new access point in regulated finance.
Listings Go Live What’s Happening
Exchanges such as the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) and NASDAQ Stock Market have posted official listing notices for the Altcoins ETFs suite. Specifically:
The issuer Canary Funds filed ETFs for Litecoin (LTC) and Hedera (HBAR) that will trade on the NASDAQ as early as Tuesday.
The issuer Bitwise Asset Management filed a Solana (SOL) ETF for launch as part of this program.
Current prices at time of writing: Solana (SOL) ~ $199.64, Litecoin (LTC) ~ $100.55, Hedera (HBAR) ~ $0.21. These values reflect the market’s anticipation of the debut of the Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera ETF.
Simplicity: Investors gain exposure to SOL, LTC and HBAR via regulated funds rather than holding the tokens and managing wallets.
Access: For institutions and retail alike, a crypto ETF path offers a familiar format within stock-exchange infrastructure.
Staking feature: At least the Solana component may include staking rewards, letting investors earn while holding through the fund.
Beyond Bitcoin and Ethereum, these altcoin-linked ETFs widen the field. The Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera ETF positions altcoins in a regulated vehicle format for the first time in the U.S..
Regulatory Context and Market Backdrop
The regulatory path for the Altcoins ETFs aligns with evolving U.S. rules. The U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) has dropped delay notices and adopted generic listing standards for spot crypto ETFs, which helped clear the way for this launch. Lower procedural hurdles contribute to the Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera ETF coming into view.
Still, risks remain: trading volumes are unknown, token volatility persists, and early investors will observe how the funds perform once trading begins.
What to Watch After Launch
With the Altcoins ETFs about to trade, key indicators include:
How much money flows into the funds?
Whether SOL, LTC, and HBAR prices react positively once the ETF listing triggers real-world buying.
How the funds’ structure handles staking, custody, and regulatory disclosures.
Good early performance may encourage more altcoin ETFs; weak results may raise questions about execution.
Conclusion
The Altcoins ETFs represents a bridge between traditional finance and altcoins. Investors can now access SOL, LTC, and HBAR via regulated channels rather than buying tokens directly. Provided launch conditions hold, these funds could open the door for further crypto ETF innovations.
As trading starts, the performance of the Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera ETF will test how far the market can move beyond Bitcoin.
Glossary of Key Terms
ETF (Exchange-Traded Fund): A fund traded on stock exchanges that tracks an asset or basket of assets.
Spot ETF: A fund that holds the actual underlying asset (e.g., cryptocurrency), not derivatives.
Staking: Locking up cryptocurrency tokens to earn rewards while helping secure the network.
Altcoin: Any cryptocurrency other than Bitcoin.
SEC: U.S. regulator for securities and ETFs, formally the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.
FAQs About Altcoins ETFs
What is the Solana, Litecoin, and Hedera ETFs?
It is a set of ETFs offering exposure to Solana (SOL), Litecoin (LTC), and Hedera (HBAR) via regulated U.S. exchange-traded products.
When will it launch?
The listing notices indicate trading will start this week, as early as Tuesday.
Why is it important?
It opens regulated access to altcoins beyond Bitcoin and Ethereum through the crypto ETF format.
Will staking rewards be included?
Yes, the Solana component is expected to include staking features within the ETF structure.
U.S. spot Bitcoin ETFs recorded roughly 446 million dollars in net inflows for the week, reversing the prior soft patch and hinting that institutions still buy the dips. Over the same stretch, spot Ether products saw about 244 million dollars in outflows, a notable contrast that kept the market honest after a frantic first half of October.
Daily prints show how quickly sentiment can turn. After four straight sessions of redemptions, Bitcoin funds swung to a single-day net inflow near 477 million dollars as prices steadied, a flip that broke the losing streak and re-anchored flows.
What the divergence actually signals
The split is not just about winners and laggards. Bitcoin’s rebound suggests allocators continue to treat it as the cleanest expression of crypto beta, especially when macro is noisy and liquidity is patchy. Ether’s outflows, meanwhile, reflect a different set of questions that investors still need answered, from staking mechanics inside fund structures to the timing and scope of future product features. The weekly etf total underscores that rotation within crypto is active rather than passive right now.
Context helps. Earlier in October, a monster print north of one billion dollars flowed into Bitcoin ETFs in a single session as price tagged fresh highs, a reminder that headline inflows often cluster near emotionally charged levels. That history makes last week’s steadier, mid-range rebound feel more durable, not less.
Price drivers to watch next
Flows do not move in a straight line. The week’s split sits against a backdrop of macro cross-currents, including intermittent risk-off wobbles and questions about policy data timeliness. Short squeezes and funding resets can add noise. Even so, the path of least resistance remains tied to whether Bitcoin ETFs keep printing green on more days than not, especially if breadth widens beyond a handful of big issuers. Recent records around 125,000 were pinned on ETF demand, so subsequent rallies will likely need the same sponsorship.
Ether’s challenge is more nuanced. Capital wants clarity on product design and the roadmap for yield features. Until those mechanics are settled, Ether funds may trade more like satellite positions in multi-asset portfolios, making them sensitive to weekly rebalancing. That does not preclude sharp risk-on weeks. It simply means the hurdle for sticky inflows is higher.
The bottom line
The week delivered a clean message. Bitcoin ETFs attracted fresh capital while Ether funds leaked. The daily swing back to inflows suggests the buyer is still there, even if conviction arrives in bursts. If the next few prints confirm breadth across issuers and steadier intake, price can follow. If not, expect more chop around well-watched levels while investors wait for the next catalyst.
Frequently asked questions
What exactly changed last week in ETF flows? Bitcoin ETFs added about 446 million dollars for the week that ended 24 October, while Ether funds lost about 244 million dollars, marking a clear divergence between the two largest crypto assets.
Did one big day drive the Bitcoin number? A single day near 21 October saw roughly 477 million dollars in net inflows, which helped flip the weekly tally back to positive after a red streak.
Are large daily inflows reliable signals for price? Huge prints can coincide with local peaks, as seen earlier in October, so traders often look for persistence across multiple sessions rather than one-off spikes.
What are analysts saying publicly? Nate Geraci highlighted multi-billion weekly intake for spot Bitcoin ETFs. Other analysts pointed to advisors dominating known Ether ETF holders, which can magnify tactical shifts.
Glossary of long key terms
Exchange-traded fund (ETF) A regulated fund that tracks an asset and trades on stock exchanges, allowing investors to gain exposure without holding the underlying coins.
Net inflows and outflows The difference between new money entering a fund and money leaving it over a set period. Positive net inflows imply demand, while outflows imply the opposite.
Advisor-dominated holder base A fund ownership profile where registered investment advisors represent a large share of known holders, which can increase sensitivity to model-driven rebalancing.
Product breadth across issuers A sign of healthier demand where multiple funds, not just one or two, attract consistent inflows, reducing reliance on a single vehicle for price support.
As leverage trading takes over the crypto scene in 2025, traders are learning the hard way that big rewards often walk hand in hand with bigger risks, but could smarter risk control finally make leverage safer than ever?
Crypto leverage trading is becoming a popular way to invest in digital markets. It lets traders open larger positions with a small amount of money, which attracts both beginners and experts.
This method allows traders to make more profit when the market moves in their favor. But it can also bring large losses if it is not used with proper care and understanding.
What Is Leverage in Crypto Trading?
Leverage refers to utilizing borrowed capital from an exchange for a larger trade. In crypto leverage trading, a trader with a capital of say $100 can trade as if they had say $1,000, fully using 10x leverage. This can create larger profits if the market goes in their favor.
But, equally important, this can create larger losses if the price moves against them. Leverage allows traders to benefit from even small price changes in coins like $BTC or $ETH. It is helpful for short-term trades and lets traders keep some of their money free for other uses.
But experts warn that leverage is not a guarantee of profit or easy money. Borrowed funds must be handled carefully to prevent losing the entire trade through liquidation.
How Does Crypto Leverage Trading Work?
In crypto leverage trading, the exchange lends money to increase the size of a trader’s position. The trader must keep enough margin in their account to support this larger trade. When the market moves in their favor, profits can grow quickly. But if prices move the other way, losses can rise just as fast.
When a trader’s balance drops below the required margin level, the exchange may automatically close the trade. This is known as liquidation and it often happens when the market moves very quickly.
Understanding how margin works can help traders stay away from liquidation. It is wise to plan every trade with care and know the risks before using leverage.
How to Use Leverage in Crypto Trading Safely?
Using leverage in trading requires a clear plan and a steady approach. Many traders choose to begin with a smaller level of leverage, like 2x or 3x, until they gain more experience. Using very high leverage can make the impact of price changes much stronger.
Taking time to understand the market and manage each position with care usually leads to steadier outcomes. Using stop loss and take profit orders can also bring more structure and safety to crypto leverage trading. They close trades on their own once prices reach a chosen level.
By using them, traders can protect their capital and capture profits even when they are not watching the market. Making these orders part of a plan often brings more order and calm to the trading process.
What Are the Best Risk Management Practices?
Good risk management plays a central role in crypto leverage trading. It is advised that traders use only a small portion of their funds for each trade. This way, a single loss will not affect the entire account.
Experts often suggest risking only one percent of total capital per trade to limit losses. Watching margin levels helps traders avoid liquidation. Closing trades early or adjusting their size can protect funds. Funding fees should also be checked, as they can reduce profit over time.
Why Is Emotional Control Important in Leverage Trading?
Crypto leverage trading can be thrilling but also stressful. Rapid changes in the market can cause traders to react with emotions instead of with logic. This often creates errors, such as adding leverage after a loss or executing trades even earlier than expected.
Keeping emotions in check will allow traders to create rational, unemotional trading decisions. More experienced traders will advise taking a break after a loss to understand what went wrong. Patience and self-control will protect your trading capital better than any strategy.
It is also ok to look and learn from others, but don’t follow blindly from what you see on social media. Each trader must develop their own method based on their experience and what they have researched.
Conclusion
Crypto leverage trading gives traders a way to grow their profits with smaller capital. Traders who understand the risks, manage their positions, and stay disciplined can trade more safely and confidently.
Understanding risk and using tools like stop loss orders help protect funds. In 2025, smart and patient use of leverage remains the key to lasting success in crypto trading.
Glossary
Leverage: Extra money you borrow to increase the size of your trade.
Margin: The small part of your money kept aside to support a trade.
Stop Loss: A safety tool that ends a trade to stop more loss.
Funding Fee: A small cost you pay for keeping a trade open longer.
Short Trade: You sell expecting the crypto price to go down.
Frequently Asked Questions About Crypto Leverage Trading
How does leverage work in crypto?
Leverage helps you trade with more money, so your profit or loss can become bigger.
Why do people use leverage in crypto?
People use leverage to try to make more money from small price changes.
Is crypto leverage trading risky?
Yes, it is risky because you can lose your money very fast if the market goes down.
How can traders stop liquidation?
Traders can stop liquidation by using small leverage and watching their margin level.
What is a good rule for managing risk?
A good rule is to risk only a small part of your money on each trade.
A recent analysis has highlighted key price levels to watch if Shiba Inu rallies from a crucial support area. Shiba Inu has held strong around the current support level around $0.000006 to $0.000010, as its long accumulation phase continues.
Crypto analyst AiMan recently revealed a personal investment of a quarter million dollars in XRP during the latest price dip. The purchase, which he said amounts to about 100,000 XRP, comes as the asset attempts to recover from the dip.
The Human Rights Foundation (HRF) has announced a new wave of funding through its Bitcoin Development Fund (BDF), distributing 1 billion satoshis to 20 projects around the world.
The grants, awarded to developers, educators, and activists spanning Asia, Africa, Latin America, and Europe, aim to strengthen Bitcoin’s role as a tool for human freedom and resistance to financial repression.
HRF has a mission to empower the more than 5.9 million people living under authoritarian regimes through open-source technologies that enable private communication, censorship-resistant finance, and decentralized coordination.
Since launching the Bitcoin Development Fund in 2020, HRF has provided more than $9.6 million in Bitcoin to 319 projects across 62 countries.
The foundation’s approach merges human rights advocacy with technical development, supporting builders who are creating practical tools for dissidents, journalists, and ordinary citizens in repressive environments.
“Bitcoin is more than just a monetary innovation,” HRF said in a statement. “It’s a survival mechanism for billions of people living without political or economic freedom.”
This round of grants supports projects advancing everything from core Bitcoin development and mining decentralization to regional education and financial autonomy programs. Each reflects a piece of a larger puzzle: a global freedom technology ecosystem built on Bitcoin’s permissionless infrastructure.
Human Rights Foundation Grant Recipients
Nymius: Bitcoin’s transparent ledger is essential to its design, but it also exposes dissidents to surveillance from authoritarian states seeking to monitor transactions and networks. Silent Payments enables individuals to receive Bitcoin through unique, one-time addresses derived from a static public key, but its effectiveness depends on wallet adoption. Nymius, a Bitcoin Dev Kit (BDK) contributor, will integrate Silent Payments into the BDK. With this grant, dozens of wallets and applications built with the BDK will be able to offer users greater financial privacy.
Daniela Brozzoni: Bitcoin nodes (computers running the Bitcoin software) reveal user metadata when connecting with one another. This opens the door for regimes or hackers to track or isolate activists and dissidents running Bitcoin nodes. Daniela Brozzoni is a Bitcoin Core developer who has been researching this vulnerability and publishing mitigation proposals to counter the tactics. With this grant, she will gather community feedback and implement fixes to make the network safer.
Build on Bitcoin (BOB) Buidlers Residency: Every day, users often find freedom technologies difficult to use, which limits their accessibility and impact. BOB Buidlers Residency in Bangkok has supported three cohorts of free and open-source developers to advance Bitcoin’s privacy, decentralization, and mining. With HRF’s funding, a fourth cohort of four developers will improve usability across Bitcoin, Lightning, nostr, and ecash, making freedom tech more accessible to those who need it most.
2140 Foundation: Bitcoin developers, especially those in autocratic countries, often struggle with burnout, isolation, and a lack of incentives to complete long-term projects. The 2140 Foundation, founded by open-source developers Josie Baker and Ruben Somsen, is a co-working space in Amsterdam that provides mentorship, collaboration, and employment to global contributors advancing Bitcoin’s long-term security, resilience, and scalability. With HRF funding, the foundation will support the work of developers from authoritarian states to strengthen Bitcoin as a human rights tool.
Cashu for Community Sovereignty: In many parts of Latin America, governments restrict financial flows by blocking payments, freezing accounts, and, at times, disrupting internet access. Cashu for Community Sovereignty, founded by Forte11, addresses this with ecash, which enables quick and private payments that even work offline. The initiative will train 10 communities in authoritarian environments to deploy Cashu mints and Lightning Network nodes. With this funding, communities facing repression will develop a stronger infrastructure for financial freedom.
Bhartiya Bitcoin: As India advances a central bank digital currency (CBDC) and financially represses political opposition, Bitcoin offers a path to financial freedom. However, education is often inaccessible to non-English speakers. Bhartiya Bitcoin produces free, culturally relevant Bitcoin content in Hindi, Marwari, Sindhi, and Assamese. With HRF support, Bhartiya Bitcoin will expand into Marathi, Bengali, Gujarati, Kannada, and Malayalam to make Bitcoin more accessible to the more than 1.4 billion people living under increasingly autocratic rule in India.
Bitcoin Education for Lebanon’s Liberty & Empowerment (BELLE): In Lebanon, a collapsing currency, banking restrictions, and asset confiscations have stripped people of financial stability. The Lebanese Institute for Market Studies is launching BELLE, a project to teach political activists and youth to use Bitcoin to preserve their purchasing power. With HRF support, BELLE will provide Arabic-language workshops, educational videos, and media outreach to strengthen individuals’ ability to resist financial repression and secure their financial futures.
Bitcoin Arusha: Tanzania’s government restricts the use of foreign currency and limits dissidents’ banking access, while the local currency depreciates, leaving many citizens trapped in a cycle of poverty. To alleviate this, Bitcoin Arusha provides culturally rooted, Swahili-language Bitcoin education in northern Tanzania through music, dance, and events. HRF support will strengthen Bitcoin Arusha’s resilience and empower communities through economic opportunities.
Bitcoin for Fairness: Human rights defenders and non-governmental organizations (NGOs) often lack the knowledge to use Bitcoin to bypass repressive financial restrictions. Bitcoin for Fairness (BFF) is an educational initiative that disseminates Bitcoin knowledge to the global majority. In 2026, BFF will focus its initiatives in Zimbabwe, Mozambique, and Zambia – countries scarred by currency crises and periods of one-party rule – and deliver workshops, micro-seed funding, mentorship, and educator training. With HRF funding, BFF will empower activists and civic organizations in Southern Africa with censorship-resistant, permissionless financial tools.
Exile Hub: Burma’s military junta uses financial repression, exile, and imprisonment to crush peaceful resistance. Exile Hub’s Bitcoin for Exiles initiative will pilot a Bitcoin-based financial autonomy program designed to meet the needs of Burma’s democratic movement. With HRF support, the program will offer training, privacy-focused toolkits, and workshops to equip dissidents within Burma and in exile with the tools to survive, organize, and resist the junta’s financial repression.
Pluto Mining: Today, most Bitcoin mining hardware relies on closed-source software that can expose user data and create dependence on third parties. Pluto Mining is the first open-source mining fleet management platform that gives miners control over their operations without third-party dependence. With HRF support, Pluto will empower individuals in repressive environments to mine Bitcoin privately, independently, and securely, further decentralizing the Bitcoin network.
WantClue: Bitcoin mining is dominated by industrial operations that use proprietary hardware and software. Over time, this could put Bitcoin’s decentralization and accessibility at risk. Bitaxe counters this trend by providing an affordable and open-source miner for individuals. WantClue maintains the Bitaxe firmware and produces educational content that makes mining more accessible to dissidents and individuals in closed societies. With HRF support, WantClue will strengthen mining decentralization and expand access to self-sovereign financial infrastructure for those under repression.
Peter Tyonum: Developers in adverse political and economic environments need accessible and secure wallet software infrastructure to build freedom tools. Developer Peter Tyonum contributes to the BDK, which abstracts wallet software into usable plug-and-play components and makes it easier for developers to create censorship-resistant tools. With this grant, Tyonum will continue to help developers worldwide create accessible, permissionless Bitcoin applications.
BitScript: An inclusive developer base is essential to Bitcoin’s long-term decentralization. BitScript, a free, open-source Bitcoin developer education program, trains developers in authoritarian and inflationary environments across Latin America and Africa to build protocol-level freedom technologies. Global development helps ensure that Bitcoin serves as a lifeline for people facing repression. HRF’s grant will help BitScript democratize protocol knowledge to ensure the network reflects global needs.
Code Orange Dev School: Many regions lack the technical education to build, maintain, and use Bitcoin. To address this, the Code Orange Dev School in Indonesia teaches developers and individuals across Asia to contribute to open-source Bitcoin projects, run nodes, and use privacy-enhancing tools like ecash, fedimint, and nostr. HRF’s support will help equip communities with tools to resist authoritarianism.
Demo Lab: As authoritarian governments in Latin America tighten their grip on financial and political power, there is an urgent need for civic and financial education. Demo Lab’s Freedom Academy introduces Bitcoin as a tool for financial independence and teaches practical skills for saving and transacting securely. Through this grant, the Freedom Academy will prepare the next generation of Latin Americans to defend democracy and achieve economic sovereignty.
Nostr under Autocracy: In Venezuela, Nicolás Maduro’s brutal dictatorship restricts traditional communication channels, prevents journalists from exposing the regime’s brutality, and financially suppresses civil society. Nostr under Autocracy, led by democracy activist Jesús González, will train Venezuelan activists and human rights defenders to use the open-source nostr protocol for private, censorship-resistant communication and payments. With HRF support, this project will help Venezuelan dissidents speak freely online and build movements to resist Maduro’s digital and financial repression.
KernelKind: Dictators restrict communication, manipulate online content, and restrict dissidents’ financial access to silence dissent. Notedeck is a Nostr browser created by Damus that makes it easier to build censorship-resistant apps with integrated Bitcoin payments. Its first app, Columns, introduces modular feeds and a marketplace for user-controlled algorithms, while Dmail will enable private, decentralized messaging with email interoperability. With this grant, Notedeck will continue to merge censorship-resistant communication with financial freedom and foster an ecosystem of apps for dissident communications and transactions.
Eric Holguin: Many people living under authoritarian regimes face censorship, Internet shutdowns, and frozen bank accounts that cut them off from communication and commerce. Nostr developer Eric Holguin is working to build censorship-resistant apps with integrated Bitcoin payments by contributing to Damus and Nostr projects that empower individuals to communicate and transact without centralized control. With this grant, he will continue expanding free speech and financial freedom tools for people resisting repression worldwide.
Craig Warmke and Troy Cross: As authoritarian regimes expand financial surveillance and roll out central bank digital currencies (CBDCs), many people remain dangerously unaware of their risks to individual liberties. Transactional Freedom, a forthcoming book co-written by philosophers Craig Warmke and Troy Cross, makes the moral and legal case for recognizing a universal and constitutional right to transact. With HRF support, Warmke and Cross will examine financial repression in authoritarian regimes and its impact on human rights, activism, and financial freedom.
Together, these 20 grantees form a diverse coalition of builders, thinkers, and educators working to fortify Bitcoin’s role as a global freedom network. While their methods vary — from protocol research to street-level education — their shared mission is clear: to ensure that financial and informational freedom remain accessible to everyone, everywhere.
The Tuesday trading session on the crypto market is headlined by Ripple-backed Evernorth crossing $1 billion in XRP, the Litecoin price spiking before its ETF debut and Zcash showing overheated retail signals one should not ignore.
Nasdaq-listed AgriFORCE has shareholder approval to roll out an Avalanche treasury strategy.
The company says it’s eyeing a $700m AVAX treasury strategy.
Avalanche price holds above the $20 mark amid news that Nasdaq-listed company AgriFORCE Growing Systems has secured shareholder support for a bold pivot into the Avalanche ecosystem.
The AVAX token, which has bounced off lows of $18 in the past week, shows notable resilience amid broader market optimism around a potential altcoin explosion.
AgriFORCE eyes $700 million AVAX treasury bet
Nasdaq-listed AgriFORCE, a company traditionally rooted in sustainable agriculture technologies, is eyeing an aggressive pivot into the crypto treasury strategy ecosystem.
Specifically, the company wants to become the first publicly traded entity on Nasdaq dedicated exclusively to the Avalanche blockchain network. AVAX One is the new company.
On October 27, AgriFORCE revealed it had secured special shareholder approval for the initiative .
A $300 million capital infusion and a further $250 million offering are set to fund an aggressive AVAX treasury strategy.
In the process of acquiring and holding AVAX tokens, AgriFORCE is poised to commit up to $700 million in exposure through direct purchases, staking, and ecosystem participation.
Matt Zhang, founder of Hivemind and nominated chairman of the AgriFORCE board, commented:
“With this mandate from shareholders, we can now proceed to close the transaction and begin the focused work of accumulating AVAX strategically and creating the Berkshire Hathaway of the on-chain financial economy.”
AVAX price holds above $20: Is $40 next?
Amid the corporate enthusiasm, the Avalanche native token shows resilience.
While the price of AVAX fell from highs of $21 this week, bulls managed to recover from lows of $18. Maintaining stability above the critical $20 psychological level signals a potential bullish momentum that will align with the broader cryptocurrency market.
If bulls break above $30, the altcoin could target prices above $40. As well as tokenization, catalysts such as institutional inflows and narrative shifts around spot exchange-traded funds are critical.
AgriFORCE’s corporate strategy and market performance also point to what investors may want to look out for in the coming weeks. In its announcement, the company said it will put its plans into action in the coming days.
“The completion of this transaction will position the Company as the first Nasdaq-listed entity with a primary mission centered on the Avalanche ecosystem. The transaction is expected to close on or about October 30, 2025,” it wrote.
AVAX price reached its all-time high of $146 in November 2021.
The current price is well off this peak.
However, bulls have managed to bounce by an impressive 630% since the Avalanche price fell to its all-time low of $2.79 in 2020.
HBAR is up 16% in the last 24 hours, the best performer among the top 20 cryptocurrencies by market cap.
The coin rallied ahead of the Hedera ETF listing on the NYSE.
HBAR outperforms other major cryptocurrencies
HBAR, the native coin of the Hedera blockchain, is the best performer among the top 20 cryptocurrencies by market cap. It added 16% to its value in the last 24 hours, allowing it to cross the $0.20 mark.
The rally comes as the Canary HBAR ETF is set to commence trading on the New York Stock Exchange today. According to Bloomberg’s senior ETF analyst Eric Balchunas, several altcoin-focused crypto ETFs are set to begin trading, including the HBAR Fund by Canary.
The new ETFs will allow institutions to gain more exposure to the cryptocurrency market, with most of them trading Bitcoin and Ethereum-focused funds since the start of the year.
The listing comes as a surprise due to the ongoing U.S. government shutdown, with the Securities and Exchange Commission only retaining a few essential staff during this period.
However, HBAR’s price could rally higher in the near term thanks to this latest development.
HBAR eyes $0.23
The HBAR/USD 4-hour chart is bullish and efficient thanks to the ongoing rally, with the technical indicators suggesting a further upward rally. The MACD lines are within the positive territory, suggesting a bullish bias.
Furthermore, the RSI of 80 means that HBAR is close to entering the overbought region. If the bullish trend continues, HBAR could rally towards the next resistance level at $0.23400 over the coming hours. An extended rally would allow the coin to touch the $0.26 mark for the first time since August 22.
However, if the market undergoes a correction following this rally, HBAR could drop to the $0.18 level to cover the FVG left by the massive push. The low of $0.16 will provide support in the near to medium term to allow the coin to surge higher.
Solana ETFs’ launch has boosted institutional interest and market optimism.
Bulls target $230 as SOL holds strong above the key $200 support zone.
Technical analysis shows rising momentum with resistance near $216–$227.
The long-awaited Solana ETFs have finally been approved, sparking renewed optimism across the crypto market.
The ETFs’ approval has reignited bullish momentum, with analysts believing that the Solana price could soon rally toward $230 and beyond.
Solana ETFs debut fuels optimism
Bitwise and Canary Capital have confirmed that their individual Solana ETFs officially begin trading on October 28 after weeks of regulatory uncertainty.
Bitwise’s product, launched under the ticker BSOL, serves as a gateway for institutional exposure to Solana, featuring staking powered by Helius Labs and a temporary management fee waiver.
– First U.S. ETP to have 100% direct exposure to spot SOL – Maximizing Solana’s 7%+ average staking reward rate* – Targeting 100% of assets staked – Staking through Bitwise Onchain Solutions, powered by… pic.twitter.com/Vo8Ko0qOCn
Grayscale has also moved swiftly, converting its Solana Trust (GSOL) into an ETF holding over $105 million worth of SOL.
Meanwhile, VanEck has also filed its sixth S-1/A amendment, with its Solana ETF status officially changed to “effective” and a 0.3% management fee established.
Adding to the growing momentum, Hong Kong’s first Solana ETF also began trading on Monday, marking Asia’s initial entry into the Solana ETF landscape.
Despite this wave of institutional activity, retail demand for Solana remains subdued.
Futures open interest sits near $9.75 billion — up slightly from the previous day but still below the $10 billion mark — indicating that traders are cautious amid market volatility.
Even so, analysts believe the ETF launches signal a critical turning point for Solana, reinforcing its legitimacy as an institutional-grade digital asset and providing the foundation for its steady hold above $200.
Bulls take charge as momentum builds
While retail demand for Solana remains unresponsive, the Solana price has been climbing steadily from $190 to $205, with short positions fading quickly.
Analysts note that bearish volume profiles are weakening while liquidity accumulates at higher price levels.
This shift has tilted momentum firmly in favour of buyers, with several technical indicators confirming the strength of the ongoing rally.
On the 4-hour chart, Solana trades above both its 50-day and 200-day moving averages, reinforcing the bullish setup.
The Ichimoku Cloud analysis shows a clear breakout, with price holding above key support between $197 and $201 — a signal that often precedes extended upward moves.
The Relative Strength Index (RSI) also hovers near 62, leaving room for additional gains before overbought conditions emerge.
Analysts now eye resistance zones between $204 and $208, followed by key hurdles at $216, $227, and $230.
Notably, a confirmed close above $205 could trigger a sustained rally toward these upper levels.
If momentum continues, higher targets around $237 and $253 come into view, aligning with Fibonacci retracement levels that mark previous swing highs.
Technical patterns hint at a repeat of 2023
Market observers have compared the current structure of Solana’s price chart to its 2023 breakout phase.
Analysts such as GalaxyBTC point to an ascending triangle pattern forming on the weekly chart, defined by a series of higher lows that indicate strong accumulation.
The critical support at $188 remains intact, representing the network’s largest volume cluster where many long-term holders entered the market.
A successful breakout above $200 would confirm the pattern and potentially lead to a test of $215 and $225, echoing the bullish behaviour seen two years ago.
The broader macro picture also appears supportive.
Some traders suggest that if the US Federal Reserve signals an end to quantitative tightening, it could inject much-needed liquidity into the market — providing another tailwind for Solana’s next leg higher.
Long-term outlook stays bullish
Even as short-term traders monitor resistance near $230, long-term analysts remain optimistic about Solana’s broader trajectory.
The asset has maintained a pattern of higher lows since early 2023, and its market structure mirrors the accumulation phase that preceded its previous bull run.
Projections place potential mid- to long-term targets around $300, $390, and even $520 if momentum and institutional demand persist.
In the near term, maintaining support between $198 and $200 is crucial.
If buyers continue to defend this zone, the Solana price could strengthen further, confirming its leadership among major altcoins.
As the first wave of Solana ETFs begins trading, the market’s sentiment has clearly shifted — bears are losing ground, and bulls now have their eyes fixed firmly on the $230 milestone.
Chainlink (LINK) price hovers at $18.50 as cryptocurrencies eye gains.
Big news as Chainlink and Balcony team up to power over $240 billion on the on-chain property assets market.
Price catalysts could include tokenization and spot exchange-traded funds.
Chainlink’s traction in the crypto and blockchain ecosystem sees the oracle network rank as a global standard for decentralized finance and capital markets on-chain.
Part of the growth now has the platform teaming up with Balcony, a leading real estate tokenization firm, to bring more than $240 billion in government-sourced property assets on-chain.
As the market eyes an overall bounce amid other tailwinds, could Chainlink’s native token, LINK, gain further amid the rising institutional adoption?
Chainlink and Balcony team up, eye $240 billion market
Among crypto news today is the announcement that Balcony, recognized as the premier platform for government-sourced real estate tokenization, has forged a pivotal alliance with Chainlink.
The latter is the gold-standard oracle network in the blockchain ecosystem, and the partnership points to growing adoption of Chainlink solutions.
In this case, the two platforms are collaborating via Chainlink’s Runtime Environment (CRE), which is now integrated into Balcony’s Keystone platform.
Chainlink and Balcony will tap into CRE to secure and digitize over $240 billion in on-chain property assets.
With Chainlink, Balcony has the blockchain solution to consolidate fragmented government-sourced property data into a unified, verifiable system.
The move lays the groundwork for compliant and programmable tokenized real estate, the firms said in an announcement.
What does Chainlink’s CRE offer?
At its core, CRE facilitates the seamless on-chain deployment of authenticated parcel data, fostering unparalleled transparency in an asset class that has long been hampered by opaque records and manual processes.
By embedding CRE within Keystone, Balcony unlocks new avenues for liquidity and accessibility, enabling fractional ownership, automated compliance checks, and real-time data verification.
The goal is to address longstanding challenges in real estate, such as fraud risks and inefficient transfers. It also elevates trust in tokenized markets, currently an asset category witnessing staggering growth.
Balcony’s integration of CRE is a clear example of how Chainlink’s industry-standard oracle platform is unlocking the next generation of real-world assets. By bringing government-sourced property data on-chain, Balcony is setting a new standard for transparency and efficiency in real estate. This partnership reflects an accelerating movement to redefine how institutions and market participants interact with tokenized assets in a compliant and verifiable way,” said Colin Cunningham, head of tokenized asset sales at Chainlink Labs.
LINK price outlook
Chainlink’s native token has surged in recent months amid broader market gains.
However, ecosystem developments have buoyed investor sentiment, helping bulls to hold prices above key support levels during profit taking events.
At the time of writing, LINK traded around $18.50, just in the red on the day but up nearly 4% as bulls continue to hold above $18.
Chainlink token’s resilience in the market and platform appeal in a maturing crypto landscape are two factors likely to help bulls eye new highs.
If LINK retests the $20 resistance level, a successful breakout could allow buyers to push for $30 and multi-year highs of $40.
RWA sector traction, DeFi resilience, and spot exchange-traded funds hype may prove key catalysts.
Canary Capital’s HBAR and LTC ETFs approved for launch on Nasdaq.
The ETF approvals have sparked bullish momentum for Hedera and Litecoin prices.
Institutional interest in Hedera has also grown significantly with new global partnerships.
The long-awaited approval of the Hedera ETF and Litecoin ETF has arrived, marking a pivotal moment for both assets.
With trading set to begin on the Nasdaq, investor enthusiasm has driven renewed interest in HBAR and LTC, sending prices higher as markets react to the historic development.
A breakthrough amid a US government shutdown
In a surprising turn of events, Canary Capital confirmed that its spot ETFs tracking Hedera and Litecoin will launch tomorrow on the Nasdaq.
The approval comes despite the ongoing US government shutdown, which many assumed would halt all Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) operations.
However, a recent procedural shift allowed issuers to bypass direct SEC intervention by letting their filings automatically go effective after 20 days.
According to Canary Capital CEO Steven McClurg, both ETFs have met all legal requirements and are ready to trade.
Bloomberg ETF analysts Eleanor Terrett and Eric Balchunas confirmed that the NYSE and Nasdaq have certified the required 8-A filings, the final step before shares can begin trading.
This development follows the model used for previous spot crypto ETFs, including those for Bitcoin and Ethereum, but with an even more dramatic twist, given the timing during a government shutdown.
🚨NEW: @CanaryFunds spot $HBAR and $LTC ETFs are now effective and will begin trading on the NASDAQ tomorrow, according to CEO @stevenmcclurg.
“Litecoin and Hedera are the next two token ETFs to go effective after Ethereum,” McClurg told me in a statement. “We look forward to… https://t.co/tPjsjLEE3R
The approval of the Hedera and Litecoin ETFs has energised the crypto market, sparking fresh optimism among investors who view it as another major step toward mainstream adoption.
Hedera’s native token, HBAR, has rebounded strongly, climbing to around $0.21 at press time and reclaiming critical technical levels.
Notably, HBAR’s rise above its 20, 50, 100, and 200 exponential moving averages signals a decisive bullish shift.
At the same time, the Litecoin price is attempting to break through its stubborn $100 resistance level.
LTC price briefly spiked above the $100 mark following the ETF announcement, reflecting heightened investor interest, though it has yet to confirm a full breakout.
Technical indicators, including the Relative Strength Index (RSI) and Moving Average Convergence/Divergence (MACD), suggest that a sustained move above $100 could mark the start of a broader bullish reversal for Litecoin.
Market data also shows a shift in trading behaviour.
Hedera’s open interest has declined from over $500 million earlier this year to roughly $163 million, indicating reduced speculative leverage.
This suggests that HBAR’s latest rally is being driven more by genuine spot demand than by leveraged futures trading — often a sign of healthier market growth.
Institutional momentum grows for Hedera
Beyond the ETF launch, Hedera’s recent institutional partnerships have strengthened its long-term outlook.
The network has been selected to participate in the Reserve Bank of Australia’s Project Acacia, exploring the use of distributed ledger technology (DLT) in tokenised financial markets.
It has also been chosen by the Bank of England for its DLT Challenge, further cementing Hedera’s position among credible blockchain platforms with real-world use cases.
Meanwhile, asset management giant T. Rowe Price has filed for an actively managed crypto ETF that may include both HBAR and LTC, signalling rising institutional confidence in these networks.
These developments are viewed as reinforcing the credibility of both assets at a time when regulated exposure through ETFs is gaining traction.
What traders should expect
If current momentum holds, Hedera price could test higher resistance zones near $0.25 and even $0.28 in the coming weeks, while Litecoin price may finally break through the $100 ceiling that has capped its rallies for months.
However, analysts maintain that Hedera (HBAR) must stay above $0.21, which has been established as the immediate support, for the bullish momentum to build.
At the same time, Litecoin (LTC) must stay above $99.67 for the $100 to come to effect.
F2Pool co-founder Chun Wang criticized Bitcoin’s BIP-444 soft fork — seeking to curb arbitrary onchain data — as a “bad idea” that he will not support.
Bitcoin’s diminishing returns and growing inaccessibility for average retail investors are threatening the predicted extension of the crypto market cycle, according to 10x Research.
Solana is stepping up to the “big league” thanks to the approval of the first Solana staking ETF, which may bring wider altcoin adoption among yield-seeking institutions, an analyst said.
Metaplanet’s market-based net asset value (mNAV) fell to 0.88 last week, prompting the Tokyo-listed Bitcoin treasury company to launch the Bitcoin-backed share buyback.
XRP price is drawing fresh attention as momentum builds around a pivotal zone that has repeatedly shaped trading this year. At the time of writing, XRP price trades at $2.66, up 1.5% over the last 24 hours and 9.2% on…
Solana price is approaching a bullish breakout from a falling channel as its first U.S. spot ETF goes live. According to data from crypto.news, Solana (SOL) price rose 14% from its Oct. 23 low to an intraday high of $204.48…
Most crypto cards sound great until the moment they don’t work at the checkout. That’s the problem this new wave of altcoins is finally solving. Digitap ($TAP), BNB, and CRO have each created systems that let users pay with stablecoins anywhere Visa is accepted. Their goal is simple: make digital money work as easily as cash.
These altcoins turn wallets into spending tools and give holders a reason to use their crypto, not just hold it. And leading this new wave is Digitap, which has already passed $1 million in its presale – a rare milestone for a project that’s still early but already has a live app.
Digitap Leads the $1M Presale with a Live Visa Card
Digitap is one of the newest names in crypto, but it already looks far ahead of most projects in the space. One of the world’s first omni-banks – a single app where people can hold, send, and spend both crypto and cash. The app is already live on the Apple App Store and Google Play Store, which makes it easy for anyone to download and start using today.
What makes Digitap stand out is that the Visa card connects directly to the user’s balance. There is no need to swap tokens first. Users can shop online or tap in-store just like they would with any regular debit card. The card also connects to Apple Pay and Google Pay, so payments are instant, contactless, and hassle-free.
At the center of the Digitap app is its token, $TAP. It’s what keeps everything running. Holders can stake it to earn rewards, get lower fees, and unlock special perks like higher card limits or concierge services.
What really sets it apart is the way Digitap manages value. Half of all platform profits go toward buying back and burning $TAP, which permanently reduces supply. That means every bit of growth in the app helps make the token more scarce over time. It’s a simple idea — real use creates real demand — and it gives $TAP a reason to exist beyond trading.
The presale has already passed $1 million, which is a strong sign of early support from investors who see real progress. The token is priced at $0.0194 for now, with the next round set to rise to $0.0268. That climb feels well earned — most presale projects never make it this far.
Digitap already has a live, working app in people’s hands, which gives the presale more weight than promises on a roadmap.
BNB Shows How a Top Altcoin Stays Useful
BNB sits comfortably among the top five cryptocurrencies in the world. It trades at around $1,167 and has a market cap of more than $150 billion — proof of how deeply it’s rooted in the market. Even after years of ups and downs, BNB stays at the center of the crypto economy.
The token fuels everything inside the Binance ecosystem — trading, staking, DeFi, and payments. One of its most practical features is the Binance Visa Card, which lets users spend their crypto almost anywhere.
At checkout, the card automatically turns crypto into local currency, so payments feel instant and simple. On top of that, users earn cashback in BNB, giving real value back every time they spend.
BNB’s strength comes from its scale. Binance has tens of millions of users and some of the highest daily trading volumes in the world. The token’s steady value and strong use inside the exchange help it stay resilient even during market slowdowns.
CRO, the native token of Crypto.com, currently trades around $0.15. The token has held steady through recent market swings, supported by the brand’s large user base and active card program.
The Crypto.com Visa Card remains one of the best-known crypto cards in the world. It lets users pay with crypto or stablecoins anywhere Visa is accepted. The app automatically converts digital assets into fiat at the point of sale. Cashback rewards are paid in CRO, and users who stake more CRO receive higher cashback and extra benefits such as airport lounge access.
Crypto.com has built one of the most complete ecosystems in the industry, combining an exchange, NFT marketplace, and DeFi tools. The CRO token sits at the center of it all. It connects users to products and rewards. Its stability and strong branding have helped it keep a loyal following even through volatile market periods.
All three tokens — $TAP, BNB, and CRO — connect crypto to real-world spending. Each has a Visa-backed card that lets users pay at millions of locations. Yet one project clearly leads in innovation and accessibility.
Digitap already runs a live app, not just a website promise. Its card works now, and users can join without complex KYC steps if they choose the privacy tier. The project also burns half of its profits, which supports long-term value for holders.
BNB and CRO are strong, established players, but they serve users mainly inside their own exchange ecosystems. Digitap stands apart as a full financial app built for both fiat and crypto. For anyone looking for the next altcoin that brings stablecoins into everyday life, Digitap looks ready to take that role.
Discover the future of crypto cards with Digitap by checking out their live Visa card project here:
PayPal has teamed up with OpenAI in a major move that could change how people shop and pay online.
Announced on October 28, the partnership will bring instant checkout and agentic commerce to ChatGPT, allowing users to discover and buy products directly through the chatbot, powered by PayPal’s trusted payment network.
Here’s why this is exciting.
ChatGPT Becomes a Marketplace
According to a press release today, PayPal will adopt OpenAI’s Agentic Commerce Protocol (ACP), a new system designed to make online shopping faster and more interactive. Soon, ChatGPT users will be able to find products, choose payment methods, and check out instantly using PayPal without even leaving the chat.
For merchants, the change could be massive. PayPal plans to connect tens of millions of businesses, from small shops to global brands, to ChatGPT’s growing user base.
“Hundreds of millions of people turn to ChatGPT each week for help with everyday tasks, including finding products they love, and over 400 million use PayPal to shop,” said Alex Chriss, President and CEO of PayPal. “By partnering with OpenAI and adopting the Agentic Commerce Protocol, PayPal will power payments and commerce experiences that help people go from chat to checkout in just a few taps.”
What It Means for PayPal, and Possibly for Crypto
This partnership reflects PayPal’s broader shift toward AI-powered commerce and digital innovation. The company has already launched its PYUSD stablecoin and built crypto custody services, showing its growing focus on the digital asset space.
While the announcement didn’t directly mention crypto, this kind of AI-driven payments system could easily become a bridge between fiat and digital currencies in the future.
If PayPal’s ACP platform eventually supports blockchain-based settlements, it could boost the use of PYUSD and other regulated stablecoins in real-world transactions.
“Agentic Commerce” or AI-powered buying and selling could eventually go beyond simple checkouts. With time, it might connect with smart contracts, tokenized assets, or digital identity systems.
And as history shows, every major AI and payments announcement tends to boost interest in related crypto sectors.
Tokens tied to AI, payments, and stablecoins – like FET, AGIX, OCEAN, XRP, XLM, and PYUSD – could all see renewed investor attention.
PayPal’s latest move with OpenAI is exciting and a strong signal that shows us where digital commerce is headed.
The live price of the Cardano token is $ 0.66412299.
ADA Price prediction suggests potential to reach $2.05 by year-end 2025.
Long-term forecasts indicate ADA could hit $10.25 by 2030.
The Cardano price prediction for 2025 is generating significant buzz in the crypto market, particularly as we have entered Q3 2025 with July. The transformative Plomin Hard Fork, implemented in Q1, has played a crucial role in this momentum, especially with the announcement of full decentralized governance.
This landmark upgrade has reinforced Cardano’s commitment to community-driven innovation, leading to a strengthening of its internal ecosystem. Even bigger institutions like Grayscale have been applauding the project’s vision and gave 1/5th allocation in its fund.
Industry leaders like IOHK and EMURGO are also actively advancing the Cardano ecosystem. EMURGO’s partnership with Ctrl Wallet on July 2, 2025, has enhanced Cardano’s interoperability, enabling connections to over 2,300 blockchains.
Moreover, community-driven initiatives focusing on scalability, privacy through the Midnight chain, and integration with Bitcoin DeFi are paving the way for substantial growth.
Additionally, Bloomberg analysts have raised odds of potential spot ADA ETF approvals, and strong technical indicators signaling positive trends, investor enthusiasm is at an all-time high. Questions abound: “Will Cardano spearhead the altcoin movement?” and “What heights can ADA reach by 2050?” Explore this Cardano price prediction for 2025 and beyond, filled with expert insights and ambitious forecasts.
Coinpedia’s Cardano Price Prediction 2025
Cardano (ADA) is predicted to reach a potential high of $2.05 in 2025, driven by hopes of ETF approval, full decentralization after the Plomin Hard Fork, and increasing institutional interest. However, if ADA fails to hold above key support, it may range between $0.85 and $1.25.
ADA’s strong 2025 expectations faltered, with Q1-Q3 dominated by a sustained correction that wiped out most prior gains. This decline has forced price action back to a critical juncture. The recent volatility kicked off in Q4, even pushing ADA sharply down to the crucial $0.60 support level.
Despite this, the optimism remains high due to the technical structure as evidenced on ADA price chart the price action has perfectly performed a retest of the support line of a multi-month symmetrical triangle pattern
This consolidation suggests that the momentum is coiling for a major move. ADA’s immediate fate rests entirely on defending the $0.60 support floor.
That said, a sustained defence of the $0.60 floor and a subsequent breakout above the triangle’s upper resistance could validate the bullish thesis, which could target a significant recovery rally.
For now, November is predicted to be an important month, and $0.85 could be retested; there is also a chance that it might even close above $0.85 on a daily basis in November.
However, if the ADA price dips below the $0.60 level, the symmetrical triangle setup will be invalidated, likely paving the way for a decline toward the long-term low of $0.27.
Price Prediction
Potential Low ($)
Average Price ($)
Potential High ($)
November 2025
$0.25
$0.92
$1.32
Cardano AI Price Prediction For October 2025
Source
Low Price
Average Price
High Price
Gemini
$0.85 – $0.95
$1.00 – $1.20
$1.30 – $1.50+
BlackBox
$0.65
$1.00
$1.50
ChatGPT
$0.75
$0.95
$1.25
ADA Price Prediction 2025
Cardano has long prioritized decentralization, and the Q1 2025 Plomin hard fork pushed it even further. Unlike many blockchains, Cardano places control in the hands of users rather than central entities. This is evident in CoinCarp’s rich list, where the top 100 addresses hold just 22% of the mainnet supply, which is far less than most altcoins.
Technically, if ADA price intends for a long-term rally, then a break above the $1.10–$1.20 range, strong retail participation will be key. A major catalyst could be the approval of an ADA ETF, expected by year-end, which could attract billions in inflows. Another would be a global attraction in the sector with BTC continuing northward moves.
Therefore, if ADA holds above its Q1 2025 high, it has a strong chance of retesting the $2.05 mark before the year ends.
Scenario
Potential Low
Average Price
Potential High
Without ETF Approval
$0.85
$1.10
$1.25
With ETF Approval + Retail Surge
$1.20
$1.65
$2.05
Bullish Breakout (with ETF & macro support)
$1.50
$2.05
$2.80
Cardano (ADA) Price Prediction 2026 – 2030
Price Prediction
Potential Low ($)
Average Price ($)
Potential High ($)
2026
2.75
3.00
3.25
2027
4.50
4.75
5.00
2028
5.25
5.50
5.75
2029
6.75
7.25
7.75
2030
9.00
9.75
10.25
This table, based on historical movements, shows ADA prices to reach $10.25 by 2030 based on compounding market cap each year. This table provides a framework for understanding the potential Cardano price movements. Yet, the actual price will depend on a combination of market dynamics, investor behavior, and external factors influencing the cryptocurrency landscape.
Based on the historic market sentiments and trend analysis of the altcoin, here are the possible Cardano price targets for the longer time frames.
Market Analysis
Firm Name
2025
2026
2030
Changelly
$0.752
$1.18
$6.05
Coincodex
$0.79
$0.53
$0.89
Binance
$0.79
$0.83
$1.01
*The aforementioned targets are the average targets set by the respective firms.
Coinpedia’s Price Analysis provides you with the latest content on the recent market trend that enables you to get closer to the price movements & actions of the various cryptocurrencies.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
How high could Cardano go by the end of 2025?
According to our Cardano price prediction, the altcoin’s price could hit a maximum of $2.05 in 2025.
What is the price of one ADA token?
At the time of writing, the price of 1 Cardano ADA token was $ 0.66412299
Is Cardano a good investment in 2025, amidst newer higher-performing entrants?
Cardano is an underrated investment and has a high chance of performing in the next couple of years, considering the plethora of applications.
Is Cardano dead?
Cardano is not dead, as it is witnessing major developmental upgrades, which could boost ADA’s price in the near future.
Can Cardano overtake Ethereum?
Even the most bullish of Cardano supporters acknowledge that Cardano will only potentially surpass Ethereum within 18 to 20 years.
How much would the price of Cardano be in 2040?
As per our latest ADA price analysis, Cardano could reach a maximum price of $69.33.
How much will the ADA coin price be in 2050?
By 2050, a single Cardano price could go as high as $329.56.
How much is 1 Cardano worth in Canada?
At the time of press, the Cardano price CAD is $0.9141.
The live price of the Polygon coin is $ 0.21819891.
POL price predictions for 2025 suggest potential highs of $0.7655.
Long-term forecasts indicate POL could reach $4.94 by 2030.
Polygon (POL) has a mind-blowing Layer-2 scaling solution project for Ethereum, which is primarily designed to address slow speeds and the network’s high transaction fees.
As a result, Polygon is seen as a revolutionary framework for developers and users, as it attracts by offering a more efficient Ethereum experience, which is the reason contributing to POL’s price value, too.
Through, POL, which is its native token (formerly MATIC), is utilized for transaction fees and network governance, in the framework of interconnected Ethereum-compatible blockchain networks.
Its use case makes it an attractive altcoin, and even its token POL price is attracting attention. The coin is expected to show a surge in the coming sessions, but it would require a technical eye to understand.
Therefore, if you are curious about whether the POL price can rebound to $1. Will Polygon go up? And is Polygon a good investment? We bring our Polygon Price Prediction for 2025 – 2030 to explore the POL price prediction.
Polygon price prediction for November 2025 (POL) suggests that a reversal rally could occur soon, as most of the price action seen in 2025 was a consolidation movement within a range-bound border between $0.16 and $0.26.
Since it has been coiling for many months, price action is critical. The larger the coil, the greater the rally, so November is crucial as it will determine how the year concludes.
Additionally, the $0.26 hurdle is a critical juncture; retesting and breaching it is a key prediction for November. As long as it sustains above $0.26, the target for November would be $0.42.
However, if it fails to retest due to a lack of bullish demand, the consolidation may continue for the remainder of the month.
Month
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
Polygon Price Action November 2025
$0.10
$0.20
$0.40
POL Token Analysis 2025
Throughout 2025, the POL token (formerly MATIC) has experienced a significant downfall, with its price declining by more than 60% from an annual high of $0.76.
This fall was largely influenced by broader macroeconomic shifts, as a result saw its steepest losses in the first half of the year. But the second half of 2025 has marked a change in momentum, as the token has stopped forming new lows.
The bullish hopes for the third quarter are rising as POL is inching higher with a key pattern’s assistance.
Polygon Price Prediction 2025
The majority of 2025 saw Polygon (POL) consolidate within a defined range. Although a bullish awakening occurred in Q3, pushing the price to a high of $0.29 in mid-September, this moment proved brief. As aggressive profit-taking accelerated from mid-September onward, completely reversing the rally and smashing the price down to the range’s lower border by mid-October. This move places POL at a critical juncture, facing a decisive retest of multi-month support.
This is the third time POL has revisited this support block, following successful bounces in both April and June. The established pattern suggests that every previous touch of this lower border has been met with significant demand, pushing the price back toward the upper range boundary at $0.26.
Based on this compelling historical examples of this year, the odds are high that POL will stage another reversal in the remaining days of October, aiming to revisit the $0.26 level. Flipping and sustaining a daily close above this upper border would give the bulls the upper hand and allow POL to target higher resistance levels at $0.4220 and potentially $0.5386 before the end of the quarter.
While the probability of a reversal from this historically strong support is high, the market risk cannot be ignored. The current retest represents a high-stakes scenario. Should the critical support fail and the price mark a new swing low, it would invalidate the current consolidation pattern. In this bearish event, the price could accelerate downward, leading to a new yearly low forming well below the $0.1500 mark.
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
Polygon Price Action 2025
$0.15
$0.26
$0.53
Polygon Price Prediction 2026 – 2030
Year
Potential Low ($)
Potential Average ($)
Potential High ($)
Polygon Price Action 2026
$0.18870
$0.47179
$0.75488
POL Price Prediction 2027
$0.30194
$0.75488
$1.20782
Polygon Crypto Price Forecast 2028
$0.48311
$1.20782
$1.93252
POL Coin Price Projection 2029
$0.77297
$1.93252
$3.09205
Polygon Price Prediction 2030
$1.23676
$3.09205
$4.94729
This table, based on historical movements, shows POL price to reach $4.94 by 2030 based on compounding market cap each year. This table provides a framework for understanding the potential POL price movements. Yet, the actual price will depend on a combination of market dynamics, investor behavior, and external factors influencing the cryptocurrency landscape.
Polygon Price Action 2026
Anticipating further expansion, MATIC’s potential high for 2026 is projected to be $0.75488, while the potential low is estimated at $0.18870, resulting in an average price of $0.47179.
POL Price Prediction 2027
MATIC crypto can make a potential high of $1.20782 in 2027, with a potential low of $0.30194, leading to an average price of $0.75488.
Polygon Crypto Price Forecast 2028
As the POL price progresses, the potential high price for 2028 is projected to be $1.93252, with a potential low of $0.48311, resulting in an average price of $1.20782.
MATIC Coin Price Projection 2029
Polygon coin price potential high for 2029 could be $3.09205, while a potential low of $0.77297, with an average price of $1.93252.
Polygon Price Prediction 2030
With an established position in the market, POL’s potential high for 2030 is projected to be $4.94729. On the flip side, a potential low of $1.23676 will result in an average price of $3.09205.
Market Analysis
Firm Name
2025
2026
2030
CoinCodex
$ 0.71
$ 0.50
$ 0.90
Binance
$0.24
$0.26
$0.31
Flitpay
$6.25
$4
$10.4
CoinPedia’s MATIC Price Prediction
Coinpedia’s price prediction for Polygon is bullish, suggesting the MATIC crypto price may reach new swing highs and possibly surpass its all-time high in the near future.
The Polygon Price Forecast 2025 predicts a swing high of $0.47181, with an average price of $0.29488.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$0.11795
$0.29488
$0.47181
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Is MATIC a good investment?
Yes, it is a profitable investment, but the digital asset should be under due consideration for the long term.
How high can Polygon MATIC price go by 2025?
According to our MATIC price prediction, the altcoin could reach a maximum of $0.47181 by 2025. With a potential surge, the price could go as high as $4.94731 by 2030.
Is Polygon better than Solana?
While it is not a direct apples-to-apples comparison, as one is a layer-2 and the other is a layer-1.
How high can Polygon MATIC transactions go?
At its best, it can process 65,000 transactions per second.
Why Polygon is faster than Ethereum?
The major functionality of this altcoin is to enable the multichain Ethereum ecosystem. It provides a network that offers interoperability between previous and present infrastructure scenarios of Ethereum.
Can polygon hit $100?
As per our MATIC price prediction, $100 dollars target is possible over the next 18 years.
Has MATIC changed to POL?
Yes, MATIC has been upgraded to POL as the network token for Polygon.
Hedera Price prediction highlights HBAR could reach $0.750 by the end of 2025 if bullish trends continue.
The Long-term forecasts suggest HBAR could hit $2.20 by 2030, indicating stable growth potential.
Hedera has been making waves in the cryptocurrency space, with a fast and secure blockchain that offers a distinct approach to transaction processing compared to Ethereum and other smart contract chains. It’s permission-only, meaning the blockchain is managed by private companies. Limiting what types of decentralised applications are allowed is what makes Hedera stand out from the rest.
Having entered the top 20 digital assets by market cap in 2024, it is now eyeing a potential leap into the top 10 by the end of 2025. Hedera has also recently ramped up its development activities for its ecosystem. Its ecosystem is strengthening, despite its capped price action. With increasing real-world use cases, institutional interest, and strategic partnerships, many are closely tracking HBAR price chart 2025 to gauge how high the token can rise.
With major companies like Google, IBM, and Chainlink Labs backing the project, and discussions about SEC approved HBAR ETF would flood string liquidity. Many are intrigued that: Will the HBAR Price Reach $1? Let’s discuss this in our Hedera price prediction 2025 article.
Hedera Price Analysis 2025: A Look Back at HBAR’s Volatile First Half
Hedera price USD began the year on a high note, peaking at $0.40 in mid-January before a steady decline took it to a low of $0.125 in early April. This downturn was caused by external factors and waning investor interest, reflected in a decrease in the Total Value Locked (TVL).
But this tide turned in the second week of April. As a broader crypto market rally helped HBAR price break free from the wedge, it bounced off a significant support zone that had previously fueled a late 2024 rally. This support, confirmed by the Fixed Range Volume Profile (FRVP) indicator, suggested strong institutional buying interest. The momentum propelled HBAR on a remarkable surge of nearly 80%, from $0.125 to $0.228 by mid-May
Unfortunately, this rebound was cut short by escalating geopolitical tensions, which pushed HBAR back to its April lows by the end of June. During this time, the price formed another parallel declining wedge.
Hedera Price Prediction 2025
The second half of the year started strong, with HBAR posting a significant rally in July from the $0.12 to $0.14 demand zone up to $0.30.
However, this upward move was firmly rejected at a critical resistance point, which strongly aligned with the upper boundary of a descending triangle established since early 2025.
This rejection fueled a sharp decline throughout August and September, which worsened further with a critical liquidation event on October 10th, momentarily pushing the price below the demand zone to $0.10.
This dip was quickly absorbed by institutional buyers, leading to a recovery attempt that failed to flip $0.20 psychological resistance, but after a decent consolidation below this hurdle buyers accumulated it and on October 28th it saw an near 20% rise that pushed its price to $0.22, this occurred as the much-anticipated launch of the Canary HBAR ETF (HBR) on Nasdaq opened the doors for institutional investors.
Now, it’s approaching once again the upper border of this multi-month pattern, and odds suggest that if sustained bullish momentum continues, a breakout could occur this time, and November could be the biggest month.
For price to rally, HBAR/USD needs to clear the short-term resistance at $0.24 and aim for $0.30. Once it sustains above $0.30 with a daily close, then the year-end target could be near $0.40.
Conversely, losing the $0.19 recently formed support would indicate that the major demand is present in the $0.12-$0.13 area. However, losing that support level would also confirm a deeper bearish trend, potentially leading to retreats toward $0.07 and, ultimately, the $0.04 support level.
HBAR Price Prediction November 2025: What’s Next for Hedera?
The HBAR price is rising to test the upper border of the multi-month descending triangle after receiving positive news about the HBAR ETF from Canary. It is retreating in October to the key $0.12–$0.14 demand area after its rally stalled at the multi-month descending triangle resistance near $0.30 in July.
This upcoming retest is critical because a successful hold could launch a short-term move to $0.30 in November and potentially $0.40 by year-end. Failure to hold the demand $0.19 could pull its price back to $0.12-$0.13 demand area.
Month
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
HBAR Price Prediction November 2025
$0.125
$0.27
$0.40
HBAR Price Prediction 2026 – 2030
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2026
$0.45
$0.80
$1.05
2027
$0.60
$0.95
$1.20
2028
$0.65
$1.10
$1.40
2029
$0.70
$1.35
$1.60
2030
$0.95
$1.70
$2.20
HBAR Price Prediction 2026
Moving forward to 2026, forecast prices and technical analysis project that Hedera’s price is expected to reach a minimum of $0.45. The price could escalate to $1.05 on the higher end, with an average trading price hovering around $0.80.
HBAR Price Forecast 2027
Looking ahead to 2027, the optimism around Hedera will lead to steady growth. Hence, the HBAR price is forecasted to reach a low of $0.60, with a potential high touching $1.20 and an average forecast price of $0.95.
Hedera Price Forecast 2028
As we advance to 2028, with moderate gains, the HBAR predictions indicate that the price of a single HBAR could reach a minimum of $0.65, with the ceiling potentially rising to $1.40. Within the range, the average price will be $1.10.
HBAR Price Target 2029
By the time 2029 rolls around, it’s predicted that Hedera’s price will maintain its upward trajectory, reaching a minimum of $0.70, with the maximum price possibly reaching $1.60 and an average of $1.35, reflecting cautious optimism.
Hedera Price Prediction 2030
By the end of this decade, HBAR is predicted to touch its lowest price at $0.95, aiming for a high of $1.70 and an average price of $2.20. Hence, the prediction suggests stable long-term growth for Hedera’s market value.
Market Analysis
Firm
2025
2026
2030
Changelly
$0.259
$0.370
$1.74
priceprediction.net
$0.27
$0.40
$1.99
DigitalCoinPrice
$0.43
$0.50
$1.07
Coinpedia’s Hedera Price Prediction
By the end of 2025, the recovery run in HBAR prices is expected to continue with a gradual rise in momentum. Hence, by the end of 2025, Coinpedia’s HBAR price forecast expects a potential high of $0.80 with a solid support at $0.40, making an average of $0.60.
Year
Potential Low
Potential Average
Potential High
2025
$0.40
$0.60
$0.80
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
Is HBAR investment a profitable one?
Yes, the stout fundamentals of the network make HBAR a good investment, but for the long term.
What price can HBAR reach by the end of 2025?
Analysts forecast HBAR could peak at $0.75 by the end of 2025, with averages near $0.40 and lows at $0.15.
How many transactions can Hedera process in one second?
The network can process over 10,000 transactions in one second.
How high will the HBAR price climb by the end of 2030?
By 2030, HBAR is forecast to reach highs of $2.20, averaging around $1.70 with lows near $0.95.
Where can I trade HBAR?
HBAR is available for trade across leading cryptocurrency exchange platforms such as Binance, Coinbase, Zebpay, etc…
Metaplanet, widely known as “Japan’s MicroStrategy”, has taken a major step forward in its long-term strategy by launching a 75 billion JPY share repurchase program.
This comes after the company faced a setback with a decline in its mNAV, and aims to make better use of capital and boost returns for shareholders.
Metaplanet has established a share repurchase program to enhance capital efficiency and maximize BTC Yield. The Board also approved a credit facility to enable flexible execution as part of the company’s capital allocation strategy. https://t.co/zucPBrIqOQ
In its latest disclosure, Metaplanet noted that recent market volatility and a decline in its mNAV have led to its stock being undervalued.
The mNAV compares the company’s enterprise value to the market value of its Bitcoin holdings. When it falls below 1.0x, the company’s shares are seen as trading below their fair value based on BTC reserves.
To address this, Metaplanet launched a capital management plan designed to maximize BTC yield and improve capital efficiency.
Metaplanet’s stock is currently trading at 499 JPY, up 2.5% over the past day and roughly 18% over the last five days. Its mNAV has also recovered to 1.03 as of the time of writing.
The buyback program will cover up to 150 million common shares, representing about 13.13% of its total outstanding shares, excluding treasury shares. It will run from October 29, 2025, to October 28, 2026 and buybacks will be conducted through purchases on the Tokyo Stock Exchange under a discretionary trading agreement.
$500M Credit Line Announced
In order to give the company more flexibility in carrying out the repurchase program, the board has also approved a credit facility with a borrowing limit of up to USD 500 million (around JPY 76.4 billion).
This allows the company to secure funds using its Bitcoin holdings as collateral whenever needed. The funds raised could be used for additional Bitcoin purchases, investments in its Bitcoin Income business, or share buybacks.
The credit line also plays a major role in the Company’s financial strategy and is expected to serve as bridge financing ahead of its planned issuance of preference shares.
Metaplanet’s Capital Allocation Policy
Metaplanet has also created a new Capital Allocation Policy designed to maximize sustainable value creation. It will be guided by three fundamental principles.
Metaplanet plans to actively utilize preferred shares, to strengthen BTC yield and enhance long-term shareholder value. It will avoid new issuances when mNAV is below 1.0x, and pursue them only when mNAV exceeds 1.0x and valuations and strategic conditions clearly support long-term shareholder value.
And if mNAV falls below 1.0x, the Company will actively consider share buybacks to enhance BTC yield and shareholder value.
It also noted that the funding sources for share repurchases may include cash reserves, funds raised from preferred share issuances, credit facilities, or income generated by its Bitcoin-related business operations.
Since April 2025, the company has expanded its Bitcoin Treasury Strategy, now holding 30,823 BTC, making it the fourth-largest public Bitcoin holder globally and the largest in Asia.
The company is also committed to its long-term goal of acquiring 210,000 BTC by the end of 2027.
Despite what appears to have been a setback, Metaplanet continues to show strong conviction in Bitcoin’s long-term potential.
Japan’s leading Bitcoin treasury company, Metaplanet, has announced a bold plan to buy back 13.15% of its outstanding shares. The firm has also secured a massive $500 million credit facility backed by Bitcoin, signaling a deep commitment to integrating digital assets into its corporate growth strategy.
Metaplanet’s 13% Share Buyback Plan
According to the company’s official filing, it will buy back up to 150 million common shares, equal to 13.13% of its total shares (excluding treasury stock). The program will run through October 28, 2026, and the company can use its new credit facility for both share repurchases and additional Bitcoin purchases.
The buyback, supported by a $500 million credit line, shows the company’s confidence in its long-term growth and strong balance sheet.
The company said the goal is to make capital use more efficient and respond to the recent drop in its market-to-net-asset value (mNAV), which compares the market value of the company’s Bitcoin holdings to its overall value.
Bitcoin at the Core of Its Growth Strategy
Metaplanet’s aggressive Bitcoin-focused strategy stands out in the Japanese and global investment landscape. Currently, Metaplanet holds 30,823 BTC, valued at approximately $3.5 billion.
The firm noted that its stock price often trades below the actual value of its Bitcoin holdings, creating an opportunity to increase its “BTC yield per share.”
The company has highlighted its commitment to increasing its Bitcoin holdings, aiming for an ultimate target of holding 210,000 BTC, equal to 1% of the eventual 21 million Bitcoin supply, by 2027.
Metaplanet’s Stock Climbed 2.3%
Following the announcement, Metaplanet’s stock climbed 2.3%, closing at 499 yen. The rally reflects renewed investor optimism fueled by expectations that reduced share supply and an injection of financial flexibility will lift per-share value.
Metaplanet’s buyback initiative signals a broader shift: public companies are increasingly viewing digital assets not just as speculative holdings, but as foundational drivers for capital strategy and market positioning
Noomez ($NNZ) review discussions are starting to dominate crypto forums as traders look for structured alternatives to hype-driven meme coins.
In a market where transparency and real mechanics matter more than marketing, Noomez features a deflationary model, measurable presale stages, and on-chain accountability.
Built on a transparent smart-contract framework, the project introduces a 28-stage presale with automatic burns, live tracking, and a fixed supply designed for scarcity.
Rather than chasing speculation, Noomez focuses on verifiable growth, a possible reason many consider it one of the most structured meme coin launches of 2025.
What Is Noomez ($NNZ)?
Noomez ($NNZ) is a deflationary meme coin built on the Binance Smart Chain, designed to combine entertainment value with measurable token mechanics.
It operates through a 28-stage presale model that allocates 50% of its 280 billion total supply to structured sales rounds.
During these stages, prices begin at $0.00001 in Stage 1 and gradually rise to $0.0028 by Stage 28. They create a clear, verifiable curve that might reward early participation.
Each stage ends with automatic burns of any unsold tokens, permanently reducing circulation before public trading.
Also, progress is displayed through the Noom Gauge, an on-chain tracker that verifies presale milestones in real time.
With KYC-verified founders, 15% locked liquidity, and 6-12-month team vesting, Noomez offers greater transparency than some other meme coins.
The features position it as a structured alternative in a category often ruled by speculation.
Pro Tip: Before joining any presale, verify on-chain proofs for token burns, liquidity locks, and team vesting. Noomez publishes all of these openly, giving buyers real data instead of promises.
Noomez Core Mechanics and Tokenomics
The Noomez ($NNZ) tokenomics are built around fixed supply, stage-based scarcity, and verifiable deflation.
The total supply is 280 billion $NNZ, with 140 billion (50%) reserved for the 28-stage presale.
Each stage lasts up to seven days, starting at $0.00001 and increasing to $0.0028 by the final stage.
To further reward participants, two major Vault Events mark the presale’s progression:
Stage 14 Vault: A 14 million $NNZ airdrop plus a strategic burn.
Stage 28 Vault: A 28 million $NNZ airdrop and NFT minting access before launch.
Unsold tokens at each stage are automatically burned, while supply metrics and stage completions are displayed live through the Noom Gauge.
Beyond the presale, 15 % of tokens remain locked for liquidity, and the core team follows a 612-month vesting schedule.
Why Noomez Stands Out in the Meme Coin Market
The meme coin market has been dominated by viral launches and short-term hype, but Noomez ($NNZ) approaches growth through structure.
Each presale milestone is tracked by the Noom Gauge, allowing investors the ability to monitor token burns, vault airdrops, and total circulation.
Unlike meme coins that rely heavily on post-launch marketing, Noomez integrates accountability from day one through automatic burns, audited contracts, and a deflationary vault system.
Such a design allows value to form from supply logic and participation, not speculation.
Post-Presale Outlook for Noomez (Function, Not Forecast)
After the presale concludes, Noomez ($NNZ) transitions into the Noom Engine, a post-launch framework designed to sustain utility and engagement.
Holders can stake tokens to earn up to 66% APY, with rewards scaling based on early participation. Partner projects will also deposit portions of their supply into the Engine, which are then automatically distributed to NNZ holders as ongoing rewards.
Meanwhile, deflation continues through scheduled burns tied to Vault milestones and the 5% Burn Vault outlined in the whitepaper.
Together, these mechanisms maintain scarcity while supporting active rewards and NFT integrations.
Instead of relying on market hype, Noomez’s function is based on transparent token flows, automated participation, and measurable outcomes.
Bitcoin (BTC) price continues to trade with upward momentum, recently reclaiming levels above $113,000 as market sentiment leans cautiously optimistic. The market has followed suit, with speculation of whether this momentum can be sustained amid tightening liquidity and rising volatility. However, several technical indicators now suggest a potential cool-off phase. This raises concerns of a short-term correction below the $110,000 support zone.
Is BTC Price Heading for a Pullback?
After rebounding sharply from lows near $107,800 earlier this week, Bitcoin has steadily reclaimed lost ground, climbing back above the $113,000 mark. This recovery reflects renewed buying pressure around key demand zones, supported by improving market liquidity and increased spot trading activity. However, BTC now faces a crucial test near the $114,500–$115,000 resistance area, where profit-taking has historically intensified. Momentum indicators hint at potential exhaustion, suggesting that if Bitcoin fails to secure a daily close above this range, a corrective drop toward $110,000—or even lower—could soon follow.
Another major reason to be bearish on Bitcoin is the recently formed CME gap with the lower range close to $110,000.
Bitcoin’s rebound from the $107,800 lows has lifted prices toward $114,600, yet the move now encounters a key CME gap between $110,700 and $113,500, as highlighted on the chart. This unfilled gap has become a focal point for traders, as Bitcoin often revisits these levels before establishing a sustained trend. The Ichimoku Cloud currently acts as dynamic resistance, with the upper boundary near $115,700 aligning with the gap’s top.
Historically, BTC has tended to “fill” such CME gaps before reversing direction, suggesting a possible short-term rejection if momentum weakens. Meanwhile, the RSI around 51 signals a neutral bias, indicating potential consolidation before the next major move.
Wrapping it Up
The recent rebound in Bitcoin (BTC) price underscores improving short-term sentiment, but the broader market remains cautious amid low volatility and mixed macro cues. A decisive move beyond the $115,700 cloud resistance could reignite bullish momentum across major altcoins, fueling renewed inflows into risk assets. However, failure to clear this zone may keep BTC range-bound, with traders eyeing $110,000 as a key defensive level. With upcoming macro events and ETF flows influencing liquidity, Bitcoin’s next move could set the tone for the entire crypto market heading into November.
XRP is showing strong bullish momentum as it pushes toward a key breakout zone, supported by a solid technical structure and growing market confidence. A decisive move beyond critical resistance levels could pave the way for further gains, reinforcing its position as one of the more stable large-cap plays in this rally.
However, while XRP’s upside remains promising, its potential returns may be more moderate compared to early-stage opportunities like Ozak AI, which is still in presale and positioned at a much earlier growth stage. Ozak AI’s AI-driven ecosystem and strategic partnerships give it an asymmetrical edge, attracting investors looking for higher-risk, higher-reward plays.
Backed by partnerships with Perceptron Network and SINT, Ozak AI blends AI-driven predictive infrastructure with blockchain utility, positioning itself for exponential growth. While XRP might deliver solid gains, Ozak AI’s early entry point gives it a realistic pathway to 100x returns if adoption and listings align with market momentum, making it one of the standout opportunities of this cycle.
XRP’s Rally Toward $3
XRP is trading at $2.Fifty four, building momentum after weeks of sustained shopping for pressure and renewed investor confidence. The token has been moving regularly inside a robust uptrend, with key resistance stages forming around $2.72, $three.10, and $three.50. On the disadvantage, solid support zones are keeping at $2.30, $2.05, and $1.82, helping to hold a bullish structure no matter periodic profit-taking.
A clear breakout above $2.72 could set the stage for a rapid push to $3.50—a level not seen since the peak of previous bull cycles. XRP’s rally is being fueled by renewed optimism surrounding its institutional use cases and the growing likelihood of expanded adoption in global payment systems, making it one of the top-performing large-cap assets in this cycle.
Ozak AI’s Early Positioning Offers 100x Potential
While XRP is drawing headlines for its price action, Ozak AI is positioning itself as one of the most explosive early-stage opportunities in the market. Priced at just $0.012 in its sixth OZ presale stage, Ozak AI has already raised over $4.1 million and sold 975 million tokens, reflecting growing confidence from retail and early-stage investors.
Unlike many speculative tokens, Ozak AI has a clear utility layer—it integrates AI-powered predictive intelligence, autonomous agent systems, and real-time data sharing through its partnership with Perceptron Network. This partnership connects the project to over 700,000 active nodes, unlocking large-scale intelligence aggregation that can power on-chain predictive markets.
Partnerships That Strengthen Ozak AI’s Core Narrative
Another major catalyst behind Ozak AI’s rising attention is its strategic alliance with SINT, which brings voice-driven interfaces, cross-chain bridges, SDK toolkits, and over 60K active users into the ecosystem.
This integration aligns perfectly with the continuing narrative of AI-meets-blockchain, a zone projected to dominate innovation cycles in the coming years. Where XRP represents balance and mainstream adoption, Ozak AI represents velocity, agility, and early positioning—presenting retail investors a ground-floor entry into a story that is just starting to boost up.
For XRP, transferring from $2.54 to $5 could mean a kind of 2x return, which is appealing but restrained compared to early-stage initiatives. By contrast, Ozak AI attaining $1 from its $0.012 presale price might represent greater than an 80x to 100x growth—an outcome that turns into increasingly more realistic if the assignment executes its vision, secures important listings, and faucets into the growing AI-blockchain momentum. Investors who struck similar early-level opportunities in previous cycles—whether or not it become meme coins or application tokens—noticed lifestyles-changing returns during breakout runs.
Ozak AI has a compelling mix of low entry price, strong partnerships, and technological utility that positions it well for such a move. XRP may lead this market phase with strength and adoption, but Ozak AI offers the kind of asymmetric upside that traders and early investors often seek when rotating capital from established assets into emerging narratives. As the market matures and liquidity flows deepen, XRP could anchor portfolios while Ozak AI acts as the explosive growth play—making it a powerful combination for those aiming to capitalize on the 2025 bull cycle.
About Ozak AI
Ozak AI is a blockchain-based crypto project that provides a technology platform that specializes in predictive AI and advanced data analytics for financial markets. Through machine learning algorithms and decentralized network technologies, Ozak AI enables real-time, accurate, and actionable insights to help crypto enthusiasts and businesses make the correct decisions.
Kalshi argues that the CFTC has exclusive jurisdiction over derivatives on federally regulated exchanges, and state interference would fragment the system.
Open interest climbing from $25 billion to nearly $30 billion reflects fresh leverage entering the market — a double-edged sword that could amplify upside momentum above $112,000 but heighten liquidation risks below $110,000, an analyst noted.
Agent-based payment protocols like Google's AP2 and Stripe's ACP improve transaction efficiency with verifiable mandates and streamlined authorization.
Hong Kong authorities have concluded the second phase of the e-HKD pilot program, with the central bank digital currency launch mostly aimed at institutional clients. According to a report by local media, the Hong Kong Monetary Authority has completed the…
Binance founder Changpeng Zhao confirms YZi Labs is a minority investor in Opinion, a newly launched decentralized prediction market, amid speculation on Polymarket rivalry. Changpeng Zhao, founder of Binance and head of YZi Labs, has confirmed that his firm holds…
Trump coin price has broken out of a long consolidation, riding on the latest developments surrounding the US-China tariff wars. The Trump coin price has surged 9.1% over the past 24 hours and is up 16% on the weekly chart,…
Altcoins HBAR and LTC are experiencing price rallies as buzz surrounding their ETF launches draws market attention. At the time of writing, HBAR trades near $0.22, up 18.1% in the last 24 hours and about 1.57% higher over the past…
Multiple crypto exchange-traded funds (ETFs) are set to launch this week despite the government shutdown, with investment products based on Solana (SOL), Litecoin (LTC), and Hedera (HBAR) seemingly ready to start trading as soon as Tuesday.
Big Week For Crypto ETFs
On Sunday night, Nate Geraci affirmed that the next two weeks will be key for the long-awaited spot crypto-based ETFs as Solana, XRP, LTC, and other ETF filings are “all lined up & ready for launch.”
Similarly, Bitwise CEO, Hunter Horsley, hinted that this week would be a “Big week,” suggesting progress related to its Solana Staking ETF. It’s worth noting that the crypto community has been awaiting the US Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC)’s approval of the investment products following the numerous ETF applications filed over the past few months.
Between August and September, the regulatory agency postponed the decision deadline of most applications by two months, pushing back the key dates to mid-October and mid-November. However, the government’s shutdown, which started on October 1, reduced the odds of the products receiving a green line during the expected timeline.
On Monday morning, ETF expert Erich Balchunas reported that multiple issuers were looking to launch their crypto-based ETFs this week, despite the government shutdown. According to the Bloomberg analyst, Canary Capital had filed 8-A forms for its spot Litecoin and Hedera ETFs, while Bitwise had filed one for its Solana Staking ETF.
“These are the ones rumored to be poss looking to launch (along w Grayscale solana) this week despite shutdown. Not a done deal but clearly preparations being made. Stay tuned,” Balchunas stated.
Solana, Litecoin, Hedera Products Take The Lead
Later, Balchunas confirmed the reports that the exchange had posted listing notices for Bitwise’s Solana Staking ETF, and Canary’s LTC and HBAR ETFs to launch on October 28, while Grayscale’s Solana trust is set to convert on Wednesday. “Assuming there’s not some last min SEC intervention, looks like this is happening,” the analyst added.
Crypto Journalist Eleanor Terret also shared the news, citing Canary’s CEO, Steven McClurg, who confirmed that the Canary spot HBAR and LTC ETFs will begin trading on Nasdaq on Tuesday.
“Litecoin and Hedera are the next two token ETFs to go effective after Ethereum,” McClurg told the journalist in a statement. “We look forward to launching tomorrow.”
Terret explained that despite the government shutdown, the launch is possible because “the operation of law does not always actually require an open government.”
According to the post, the 8-A forms are “just as important” as the S-1s filings: the former formally registers ETF shares under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, while the latter registers the investment products under the Securities Exchange Act of 1933.
After NYSE certified all the 8-A filings for the ETFs above on Monday, shares can start trading, Terret affirmed, adding:
“Here’s the key: The issuers included language in their amended S-1s that lets them automatically go effective 20 days after filing. Typically, issuers delay S-1s until the SEC takes them effective, but the legal default is that the S-1 goes automatically effective without SEC intervention. That means the agency doesn’t need to approve them manually and the filings can go live on their own, even during the shutdown. So, long story short, all the legal boxes are checked and these ETFs are on track for launch.”
Despite facing criticism for lagging behind the United States in creating a more accommodating environment for cryptocurrency growth and adoption, China reaffirmed its stringent stance on crypto once again this week.
Authorities issued warnings about the alleged risks posed by stablecoins, particularly amid concerns that the US may have solidified its dollar dominance through these digital assets.
US GENIUS Act Vs. China’s Crypto Caution
According to local media reports, Pan Gongsheng, governor of the People’s Bank of China, announced plans to expand the use of the country’s central bank digital currency (CBDC), known as the “e-CNY.”
He remarked, “[Stablecoins] are still in their early stages of development,” emphasizing that financial regulators globally remain cautious about these assets, which are typically pegged to other currencies.
In the United States, however, Trump’s policies toward digital assets have resulted in the passage of the GENIUS Act, as the first crypto bill aimed at laying the framework for the adoption of these dollar-pegged cryptocurrencies.
Yet, Pan highlighted that stablecoins currently fail to meet essential requirements such as customer identification and anti-money laundering (AML) measures, which could allegedly exacerbate gaps in global financial regulation.
He expressed concern that these issues foster a “speculative market atmosphere,” increasing vulnerabilities in the global financial system and affecting the monetary sovereignty of less developed economies.
The central bank plans to collaborate with law enforcement to continue cracking down on domestic operations and speculation related to crypto. “The policies and measures implemented since 2017 to address risks associated with virtual currencies remain in effect,” he stated.
Regulatory Revisions Ahead
Despite China’s continuous crypto crackdown, research on stablecoins is progressing within China. The country’s largest government-backed research fund recently opened applications for studies focused on stablecoins and their cross-border monitoring systems, offering grants ranging from 200,000 yuan (approximately $28,083) to 300,000 yuan ($42,126).
The central bank also plans to optimize the positioning of the digital yuan, allowing more commercial banks to participate in the pilot program that has been running in over two dozen cities since 2019, accumulating a transaction value exceeding 14 trillion yuan.
Zhu Hexin, director of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange, indicated that nine new policy measures would soon be introduced to promote trade innovation and development, with the potential to bring positive developments for the growth of the crypto ecosystem in the Asian country.
Wu Qing, chairman of the China Securities Regulatory Commission, also hinted at the possibility of such measures, stating that the regulator would review listing standards on the Shenzhen Stock Exchange’s ChiNext board to better align with the characteristics of emerging fields and future industries.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
Data shows the Bitcoin Fear & Greed Index has surged back into the neutral zone after the recovery rally in the cryptocurrency’s price.
Bitcoin Fear & Greed Index Now Has A Value Of 51
The “Fear & Greed Index” refers to an indicator created by Alternative that measures the average sentiment present among traders in the Bitcoin and wider cryptocurrency markets. The metric uses the data of the following five factors to determine the investor mentality: trading volume, market cap dominance, volatility, social media sentiment, and Google Trends.
The index uses a numerical scale running from zero to hundred for representing this sentiment. All values above 53 correspond to greed among the investors, while those below 47 to fear. The region between the two cutoffs naturally corresponds to a net neutral mentality.
Now, here is how the current Bitcoin market sentiment is like, according to the Fear & Greed Index:
As is visible above, the indicator has a value of 51, which suggests the trader sentiment is almost exactly in the balance right now. This is a notable change in market mood compared to just a few days ago.
As displayed in the chart, the Fear & Greed Index was inside the fear zone during the past few days. The despair among the traders was a result of the bearish price action that BTC had recently faced.
At one point, the indicator even fell to a low of 22, reflecting a state of “extreme fear.” This zone, which occurs below 25, corresponds to investors being the most bearish toward the market. There is a similar region for the greed side as well, called the “extreme greed,” situated above 75.
Historically, the extreme sentiments have been quite significant for Bitcoin and other cryptocurrencies, as they are where major tops and bottoms have tended to form. The relationship has been an inverse one, however, meaning extreme fear is where bottoms form, while extreme greed facilitates tops.
Since the extreme fear low earlier in the month, BTC has been on the way up, a potential indication that the contrarian signal of the sentiment may once again be in action.
The cryptocurrency has extended its recovery in a sharp manner during the last couple of days, which may be a potential reason why the Fear & Greed Index has surged back to the neutral territory now.
Though, for now, Bitcoin traders are still undecided on whether bullish action will follow next. It now remains to be seen whether they will embrace greed, or continue to be hesitant about the recovery.
BTC Price
At the time of writing, Bitcoin is floating around $114,900, up 3.6% over the last seven days.
Dogecoin struggled to rise above $0.210 and corrected some gains against the US Dollar. DOGE is now consolidating and might decline below $0.1980.
DOGE price started a fresh downside correction below $0.2035.
The price is trading below the $0.20 level and the 100-hourly simple moving average.
There was a break below a contracting triangle with support at $0.20 on the hourly chart of the DOGE/USD pair (data source from Kraken).
The price could aim for a fresh increase if it remains stable above $0.1940.
Dogecoin Price Starts Another Pullback
Dogecoin price started a fresh increase after it settled above $0.1920, like Bitcoin and Ethereum. DOGE climbed above the $0.20 resistance to enter a positive zone.
The bulls were able to push the price above $0.2020 and $0.2050. A high was formed at $0.2094 and the price is now correcting gains. There was a move below the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the upward move from the $0.1843 swing low to the $0.2094 high.
Besides, there was a break below a contracting triangle with support at $0.20 on the hourly chart of the DOGE/USD pair. Dogecoin price is now trading below the $0.20 level and the 100-hourly simple moving average.
If there is another increase, immediate resistance on the upside is near the $0.2020 level. The first major resistance for the bulls could be near the $0.2050 level. The next major resistance is near the $0.210 level. A close above the $0.210 resistance might send the price toward $0.2150. Any more gains might send the price toward $0.2250. The next major stop for the bulls might be $0.2320.
More Losses In DOGE?
If DOGE’s price fails to climb above the $0.2020 level, it could start a downside correction. Initial support on the downside is near the $0.1970 level and the 50% Fib retracement level of the upward move from the $0.1843 swing low to the $0.2094 high. The next major support is near the $0.1935 level.
The main support sits at $0.190. If there is a downside break below the $0.190 support, the price could decline further. In the stated case, the price might slide toward the $0.1840 level or even $0.1780 in the near term.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for DOGE/USD is now gaining momentum in the bearish zone.
Hourly RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for DOGE/USD is now below the 50 level.
What if the next big crypto moonshot is already taking off while most investors are still watching from the sidelines? The search for the top crypto to buy in 2025 is heating up as traders hunt for the next token that could turn a modest investment into life-changing gains.
Everyone wants to be early. The meme culture has turned investing into a mix of hype, humor, and smart tokenomics. Ethereum and BNB are established powerhouses with real updates that keep them relevant, but MoonBull’s presale has caught serious attention. It is pulling in numbers and building energy faster than many expected.
MoonBull ($MOBU): Why This Meme-Mechanics Token Is Among The Top Crypto To Buy In 2025
MoonBull ($MOBU) has quickly become the talk of the town for investors searching for the top crypto to buy in 2025. Built on Ethereum, MoonBull combines meme power with real mechanics designed for fairness, transparency, and community growth. It automatically rewards holders, adds liquidity with every transaction, and burns a portion to increase scarcity. That balance creates a system where every transaction strengthens the ecosystem.
Just Days Left for 27.40% Surge as MoonBull Presale Hits $500K, While ETH and BNB Rally Ahead of Q4 as Top Cryptos to Buy in 2025 24
Two features make MoonBull stand out. First, it has already passed its audit, and liquidity is locked for long-term trust. That means traders can join without worrying about sudden rug pulls. Second, by Stage 12 of its 23-stage presale, MoonBull will activate community voting. Holders will be able to decide on future campaigns, surprise burns, and marketing pushes. It turns investors into decision-makers, a rarity for a meme coin.
MoonBull Presale: Numbers That Speak Louder Than Words
MoonBull’s presale is currently in its 5th stage, priced at $0.00006584, with more than $500,000 already raised and over 1,500 holders onboard. The current ROI from Stage 5 to the listing price of $0.00616 stands above 9,200%, while early supporters have already seen gains of 163.36%. The next price surge is projected at around 27.40%, indicating that each stage is becoming more valuable as momentum builds.
An investment of $20,000 right now would secure 303,766,707.17 MOBU and could be worth about $1,871,202.92 once the listing price hits $0.00616. MoonBull’s mix of staking rewards, referrals, and community voting is making it one of the most hyped tokens in 2025. For anyone looking for the top crypto to buy in 2025, this is where excitement meets opportunity.
Ethereum continues to dominate headlines as one of the top crypto to buy in 2025. Recent updates show renewed whale accumulation, with institutional wallets increasing holdings as price momentum builds. Founder Vitalik Buterin recently warned that blockchain security concerns extend beyond the chain itself, calling for stronger protection for bridges and off-chain systems. His comments reignited debate about network resilience and next-gen infrastructure.
ETH is trading near $4,000, and analysts see a breakout toward $4,550. If resistance breaks, price targets between $5,000 and $7,000 are on the table. Layer-2 scaling, reduced gas fees, and new validator incentives continue to drive adoption. Technical analysts say ETH’s setup looks ready for another run if market sentiment holds..
BNB is back in the news and still one of the top crypto to buy in 2025 after a sudden rally tied to real-world headlines. The token jumped 5 percent after Donald Trump publicly defended the pardon of Binance founder Changpeng Zhao, sparking optimism and heavy buying across exchanges. The renewed confidence helped BNB reclaim the $1,100 mark.
In September 2025, BNB also logged a new all-time high near $1,080, a 70% gain this year. Analysts credit the surge to rising on-chain activity, regulatory clarity, and institutional adoption. The BNB Chain’s expanding ecosystem continues to attract developers, keeping demand high. For investors looking for steady performance with room to grow, BNB remains a staple in any list of the top crypto to buy in 2025.
Just Days Left for 27.40% Surge as MoonBull Presale Hits $500K, While ETH and BNB Rally Ahead of Q4 as Top Cryptos to Buy in 2025 25
Final Thoughts
MoonBull, Ethereum, and BNB each bring something unique to the table. MoonBull offers massive upside with its presale, staking, and community mechanics. Ethereum provides long-term reliability and ecosystem dominance. BNB combines proven adoption with consistent network growth.
Based on research and market trends, MoonBull stands out as the project generating the most excitement. Ethereum and BNB remain strong plays, but MoonBull’s early momentum and reward system give it a different kind of energy. Its presale is live right now, numbers are climbing, and the early window is closing fast. Those looking for the top crypto to buy in 2025 shouldn’t wait until it’s already flying.
Just Days Left for 27.40% Surge as MoonBull Presale Hits $500K, While ETH and BNB Rally Ahead of Q4 as Top Cryptos to Buy in 2025 26
Frequently Asked Questions for Top Crypto To Buy In 2025
Which meme coin is best to buy now?
MoonBull is currently one of the strongest meme coins to watch. It combines staking, referrals, and governance to give holders both fun and function.
How to find presale crypto?
Check official project websites, verified communities, and whitepapers. Look for features like locked liquidity and completed audits.
Do meme coins have a future?
Yes. When built with real mechanics and transparency, meme coins can mature into strong communities with real value.
What is the best crypto presale to invest in 2025?
MoonBull leads current presales with over $500,000 raised, strong tokenomics, and high staking yields.
How to pick a good meme coin?
Review audits, liquidity locks, staking, and referral incentives. MoonBull checks all these boxes and rewards both referrers and buyers.
Glossary of Key Terms
Presale: Early token sale before listing at lower prices.
Liquidity Locked: Prevents token withdrawal to protect investors.
Reflection Rewards: Distributes transaction fees among holders.
Governance: Gives holders power to vote on key decisions.
Staking: Locking tokens for rewards or yield.
Article Summary
MoonBull, Ethereum, and BNB headline the list of top crypto to buy in 2025. MoonBull’s presale, staking, and referral mechanics make it a community favorite. Ethereum continues leading smart contracts, and BNB maintains strong utility and adoption. Each coin serves a different investor profile, but MoonBull’s early momentum gives it an edge for those chasing maximum upside.
Cardano founder Charles Hoskinson recently projected where Cardano would be by 2030, centering around adoption and market penetration. Hoskinson shared this in his conversation with pundit Sujal Jethwani, identifying where Cardano could be in the next five years and what the ecosystem needs to work on to become more competitive.
Carl Higbie, host at Newsmax, recently discussed how cryptocurrencies like XRP could help the U.S. government eliminate its massive $37.8 trillion national debt.
The XRP Stoch RSI has formed a golden cross on the weekly timeframe — an occurrence that previously led to massive price spikes. With XRP currently recovering from the latest market turbulence, multiple market experts believe it could be on the brink of a massive rally.
Cardano consolidates within a symmetrical triangle, and a bullish breakout could spark a strong price rally past the $1 mark. Cardano (ADA) currently trades at $0.66, down 3% over the past 24 hours.
The Ripple CTO, David Schwartz, has confirmed that the company can sell the rights to receive XRP tokens locked in its escrow accounts. He made this clarification during a community discussion that began after software engineer Vincent Van Code raised questions about how crypto data trackers report XRP's circulating supply compared to Bitcoin's.
The host of the Working Money channel recently shared a bullish outlook on XRP, citing multiple experts to make a case for a run to two digits. His commentary suggested that a $15 price for XRP could be feasible in the long run.
Bitcoin price surged to $115,000 on Monday, rising more than 1% in 24 hours, as optimism over easing U.S.–China trade tensions and renewed investor appetite for risk assets lifted global markets.
According to Geoffrey Kendrick, Head of Digital Asset Research at Standard Chartered Bank, Bitcoin price may “never fall below $100,000 again” if this week’s macro tailwinds continue.
In a note to clients, Kendrick said that improving trade relations between Washington and Beijing have flipped last week’s market fear into “hope.”
U.S. Treasury Secretary Scott Bessent’s weekend statement that restrictions on China’s rare earth exports could be postponed for a year, combined with reports that Beijing plans to buy large quantities of U.S. soybeans, sparked a relief rally across equities, commodities, and crypto.
China, U.S trade deals and FOMC rate cuts
The agreement, expected to be finalized after the upcoming Trump–Xi summit in South Korea, has renewed risk appetite and pushed the bitcoin-to-gold ratio back above pre-October 10 levels — the date when 100% tariff threats sent markets tumbling.
Kendrick pointed to fresh inflows into spot bitcoin ETFs as another key signal of strength. Over $2 billion exited U.S. gold ETFs late last week, and if even half of that re-enters bitcoin funds, he said, it would mark a major vote of confidence.
The analyst also highlighted macro tailwinds, including expectations for a 25-basis-point rate cut at Wednesday’s Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) meeting — a move widely seen as bullish for bitcoin.
Meanwhile, investors are watching a packed earnings calendar from both tech and crypto heavyweights. Microsoft, Meta, and Google are set to report on Wednesday, followed by Apple, Amazon, Coinbase, and Strategy (formerly MicroStrategy) later in the week.
“If this week goes well — bitcoin may never fall below $100,000 again,” Kendrick said.
Bitcoin price outlook
While bulls have made modest progress with Bitcoin, stronger resistance remains overhead at $117,600 and $122,000, leaving bears largely in control.
If Bitcoin manages to surpass $122,000, professionals note the next target could be the upper boundary of a broadening wedge pattern at $128,000.
Support levels remain critical for maintaining bullish momentum. The key short-term support at $106,900 held throughout last week, helping stabilize the market.
Falling below this level could open the path toward the $105,000–$102,000 support zone, which has already been tested twice, with a third test raising the likelihood of a breakdown.
Beyond that, $96,000 represents a crucial long-term support level for the broader bull market, acting as a do-or-die floor if prices decline further.
As of press time, bitcoin was trading at $115,041, up 1.22% over the past 24 hours.
Bitcoin’s largest corporate holder just got bigger. Strategy (MSTR.O) added another 390 BTC to its treasury last week, spending $43.4 million at an average price of $111,053 per bitcoin.
The move highlights the company’s consistent buying pattern even as the asset’s 2025 rally shows no signs of slowing down.
According to a post on X, the purchase was completed between October 20 and October 26, funded through proceeds from its STRF, STRK, and STRD series preferred stock issuances.
Bitcoin Holdings Cross 640,000 BTC
As of October 26, 2025, Strategy holds a total of 640,808 bitcoins, the largest corporate Bitcoin treasury globally. The company has spent an estimated $47.44 billion on its cumulative BTC acquisitions, with an average purchase price of $74,032 per coin.
The firm’s BTC yield has reached 26.0% year-to-date, reflecting the impact of Bitcoin’s continued appreciation throughout 2025. Strategy’s relentless accumulation underscores its belief in Bitcoin as a long-term store of value and strategic asset in an inflationary global market.
The 390 BTC acquisition may seem modest compared to earlier buys, but it reinforces a steady accumulation strategy rather than speculative timing. For a company already holding more than half a million bitcoins, even smaller purchases demonstrate conviction, and signal confidence to the broader market.
Building Through Volatility
Strategy’s approach remains consistent: acquire, hold, and wait. Each acquisition pushes its balance sheet deeper into Bitcoin exposure, while the firm’s yield performance continues to validate its “digital gold” thesis.
In a market often driven by short-term hype, Strategy’s consistent purchases stand out. This latest buy adds to a streak of quarterly acquisitions despite fluctuating prices, proving that the company views Bitcoin less as a trade and more as a reserve asset.
The company’s funding model, issuing preferred stock to raise capital, provides a low-risk, flexible way to expand its Bitcoin portfolio without taking on excessive debt. It’s a model that other institutional players are beginning to notice.
The Yield Story
A 26% BTC yield YTD is a remarkable figure, even for an asset that’s outperformed most global equities this year. It points to the effectiveness of Strategy’s treasury management approach. While traditional portfolios rely on bonds and equities for returns, Strategy’s balance sheet now behaves more like a Bitcoin ETF, one that captures both price appreciation and strategic yield.
This yield not only reflects gains from market performance but also the company’s ability to leverage its holdings effectively, signaling operational efficiency and a long-term advantage over competitors who remain on the sidelines.
American Bitcoin Boosts Its Treasury
In parallel, another institutional player, American Bitcoin ($ABTC), has also increased its holdings. The firm recently acquired 1,414 BTC, bringing its total treasury to 3,865 BTC.
American Bitcoin’s strategy differs from pure accumulation. The company combines direct Bitcoin production through mining with periodic market purchases to strengthen its balance sheet. This hybrid model allows it to reduce its average cost per bitcoin, ensuring it remains competitive even as spot prices rise.
Executive Chairman Asher Genoot explained the approach clearly:
“By producing Bitcoin directly, we can reduce our average cost per Bitcoin to drive a cost advantage over vehicles that buy exclusively on the open market.”
This production-based accumulation creates a natural hedge against market volatility. While most public Bitcoin holders rely solely on capital inflows, American Bitcoin generates part of its treasury through self-mining, providing long-term cost stability.
Rising Satoshis Per Share
Another notable metric from American Bitcoin’s update is its Satoshis Per Share (SPS), now reported at 418, marking a 52% increase since September 1. This figure tracks the company’s Bitcoin exposure per share and gives investors a clear view of how effectively treasury growth translates into shareholder value.
The strong SPS growth indicates both aggressive accumulation and disciplined treasury scaling. It also positions the company competitively among institutional Bitcoin holders, where transparency around treasury performance is increasingly valued.
The company’s progress was shared in a post by Treasury Edge, highlighting the alignment between mining expansion, financial strategy, and shareholder impact.
The latest moves from both Strategy and American Bitcoin show that institutional conviction in Bitcoin remains strong even after significant price growth in 2025.
Strategy’s continued buying streak and American Bitcoin’s integrated mining model reflect two sides of the same coin, accumulation through both capital deployment and production efficiency. Together, they illustrate a maturing institutional ecosystem around Bitcoin, where companies view the asset not as speculation but as a strategic treasury reserve.
Long-Term Implications
At a time when central banks debate digital currencies and inflationary pressures persist globally, the continued flow of corporate capital into Bitcoin adds weight to the idea that digital assets are no longer fringe.
With Strategy now holding over 640,000 BTC and American Bitcoin scaling production, the narrative is clear: Bitcoin is becoming an institutional-grade treasury instrument.
As Bitcoin’s supply issuance continues to decline and halving approaches, companies accumulating now are effectively securing their share of a finite asset. The result is a stronger, more mature market structure, one increasingly dominated by strategic, long-term holders rather than speculative traders.
Strategy’s latest 390 BTC purchase reaffirms its role as the world’s leading Bitcoin accumulator, while American Bitcoin’s dual mining-and-purchase strategy sets a cost-efficient precedent for others to follow.
Both stories highlight the same reality: corporate Bitcoin adoption isn’t slowing down. Instead, it’s evolving, from opportunistic buys to structured, yield-driven treasury management.
Bitcoin is no longer just a trade. For these institutions, it’s a strategy.
Disclosure: This is not trading or investment advice. Always do your research before buying any cryptocurrency or investing in any services.
Follow us on Twitter @themerklehash to stay updated with the latest Crypto, NFT, AI, Cybersecurity, and Metaverse news!
Traditional online payment systems are outdated. They’re slow, expensive, and depend heavily on humans.
x402 changes that.
It introduces a new way for developers and AI agents to pay for APIs, software, and services directly with stablecoins, all over standard HTTP connections.
In simple terms, it makes autonomous, instant payments possible between machines, without needing middlemen.
The Problem: Payments That Don’t Match the Internet’s Speed
The digital world moves fast, but today’s payment rails still crawl.
They rely on centralized processors, carry high fees, and take days to settle.
Every API, subscription, or software access comes with friction, recurring billing systems, manual approvals, and regional limitations.
For developers and AI agents that operate in real time, that model doesn’t work anymore.
The Solution: Agent-to-Agent Payments
x402 replaces this outdated setup with an agent-to-agent payment model.
Here’s what that means in practice:
🔹 Payments settle in seconds
🔹 Micropayments are supported natively
🔹 Global access with no currency conversion
🔹 No chargebacks, no middlemen
It’s designed to work across borders and protocols, using stablecoins as the default payment medium.
Think of it as PayPal, but for machines.
How x402 Works
x402 uses the existing HTTP 402 response code, the one originally intended for “Payment Required”, to enable direct payment settlement between two digital agents.
This means that a bot, app, or AI system can automatically pay for an API call or a data request in real time, without needing a human or a credit card.
Payments are made in stablecoins like USDC, achieving instant finality and zero chargebacks.
Each transaction happens seamlessly, fast, compliant, and verifiable on-chain.
The Builders Behind x402
Some of the most active builders on BNB Chain are already bringing x402 to life.
Projects like @unibase_ai, @pieverse_io, @AEON_Community, and @termix_ai are integrating the protocol into their systems to enable autonomous API payments.
BNB Chain describes x402 as an internet-native payment standard, a design built specifically for agents and AI ecosystems, not humans.
Developers can now plug x402 into their applications and allow AI agents to pay directly for what they consume, on demand.
Facilitators: The Gatekeepers of Autonomous Payments
The x402 system also introduces “Facilitators.”
These are the gateways that verify and settle payments made through the protocol.
Entities like PayAI or Coinbase can serve as facilitators, validating payments, ensuring compliance, and maintaining a secure on-ramp between traditional finance and machine payments.
This layer guarantees the same regulatory assurance as human transactions, without slowing down the process.
Why x402 Matters
x402 is more than a payment protocol, it’s a new financial standard for the AI era.
It allows software agents to pay as they go, per API call, per data request, per inference, all without subscriptions, cards, or intermediaries.
That opens a new economy: one where AI models, tools, and bots transact directly, autonomously, and transparently.
By aligning payments with machine speed, x402 eliminates one of the biggest bottlenecks in AI deployment, billing.
BNB Chain at the Core
BNB Chain has quickly become the home for x402 integrations.
Its speed, low fees, and EVM compatibility make it an ideal ground for developers experimenting with autonomous payments.
According to BNB Chain’s official announcement, the protocol’s adoption rate has already begun to climb, with multiple agent-based dApps adopting the standard.
Traditional online payment systems today are slow, expensive and human-dependent.
x402 changes that, allowing developers and AI agents to pay for APIs, software and services directly with stablecoins over HTTP.
BNB Chain’s ecosystem has long supported innovation in DeFi, gaming, and payments, and now, it’s positioning itself as the AI payment layer of Web3.
The x402 Boom on Solana
Interestingly, x402 isn’t just a BNB Chain story.
On Solana, the trend has exploded, up over 4,000% in just seven days, according to data tracked across developer communities.
The $X402 token, which powers the Solana side of the movement, is gaining traction fast.
It enables ultra-fast, low-fee payments for AI agents, while attracting new developers through hackathons and open integrations.
The mission: to make Solana the “default payment layer” for the AI economy.
x402 is an internet-native payment standard for Agents: fast, cheap, and on-chain.
Agents can pay per API call in USDC with instant finality, no chargebacks, and full compliance. The entire process is achieved without the friction of managing API keys or subscriptions.… pic.twitter.com/NSGC6Y0Bf9
🚨 x402 trend is exploding on Solana – up over 4,000% in just 7 days 🚀 Powered by seamless HTTP 402 integration, $X402 enables ultra-fast, low-fee payments for #AIAgent. The $X402 token not only attracts developers through the upcoming hackathon but also promises to… https://t.co/KDSF0r4P81pic.twitter.com/sV3oBNeHZG
The rise of x402 marks a shift from human-driven payments to machine-native finance.
Just as DeFi decentralized trading and staking, x402 is decentralizing the act of paying itself, making transactions faster, smaller, and smarter.
It’s also setting the foundation for PayFi, a new movement that combines payment infrastructure with DeFi principles for AI and Web3.
As stablecoins continue to dominate settlement flows and agents become more autonomous, protocols like x402 will likely become the backbone of the next financial internet.
The internet of money is evolving again, this time, for machines.
x402 bridges the gap between AI agents and blockchain payments, offering speed, efficiency, and autonomy that traditional payment rails can’t match.
Whether on BNB Chain or Solana, the momentum is clear.
x402 is no longer just a protocol, it’s a standard in the making.
And as developers continue to build around it, one question lingers: Will the x402 trend take over Solana next?
Disclosure: This is not trading or investment advice. Always do your research before buying any cryptocurrency or investing in any services.
Follow us on Twitter @themerklehash to stay updated with the latest Crypto, NFT, AI, Cybersecurity, and Metaverse news!
Hyperliquid price rally appears to be cooling as a TD Sequential sell signal hints at short-term weakness despite strong on-chain catalysts. Hyperliquid was trading around $48.30 at press time, down 2.8% in the past 24 hours. Even with the daily…
Major cryptocurrencies slipped on Tuesday, Oct. 28 as investors turned cautious ahead of the Federal Reserve’s two-day policy meeting. Bitcoin fell 1.4% to $113,831, while Ethereum dropped 3.7% to $4,090. XRP declined 1% to $2.64, and BNB also fell 1.6%…
Kalshi has filed a lawsuit against New York regulators, as the state is looking to classify its sports event contracts as unlicensed gambling and enforce a cease-and-desist order threatening civil and criminal penalties. Kalshi filed the federal complaint on Oct.…
If you have been tracking the markets lately, you probably noticed that Hedera’s price just pulled off an impressive rally. HBAR price soared more than 10% in a single day and nearly 18.5% in a week. It has climbed above the important $0.20 level for the first time in months.
Why did this happen? The answer lies in the following 3 events. First, the much-anticipated launch of the Canary HBAR ETF (HBR) on Nasdaq opened the doors for institutional investors. Second, HBAR staged a breakout above major technical barriers, invalidating a long-standing bearish pattern. Finally, the broader altcoin rotation worked in HBAR’s favor.
HBAR Price Analysis
HBAR’s recent price action paints a striking picture of bullish revival. The current price sits at $0.2007, up over 10% in the last 24 hours and nearly 18.5% for the week. The surge comes with a robust 24-hour trading volume of $580.6 million and a market cap of $8.53 billion.
One of the most significant signals was the break above the 23.6% Fibonacci retracement level at $0.20116. This breakout also coincided with the price crossing above both its 30-day SMA at $0.19255 and the upper Bollinger Band, confirming that momentum shifted to the bulls. Additionally, the MACD histogram flipped positive (+0.0025).
On the sentiment side, HBAR’s surge invalidated a bearish descending channel. While the trend looks strong, the 14-day RSI sits at 48.45, which is considered neutral territory. This suggests there’s still room for upside before the token enters overbought conditions. The next test for the bulls is clear, immediate resistance looms at $0.233, the July swing high. If HBAR conquers this level, momentum could draw further inflows.
FAQs
What caused the recent HBAR price spike?
The HBAR rally is mainly driven by the new Canary HBAR ETF (HBR) launching on Nasdaq, a technical breakout above major resistance, and capital rotating from Bitcoin into altcoins.
Is HBAR’s current breakout sustainable?
HBAR’s breakout is supported by high trading volume, strong technical signals, and a neutral RSI. However, a retest of support levels may occur if bullish momentum fades.
What price levels should I watch next?
Traders should watch $0.233 as the next resistance. Support sits near $0.1925 (30-day SMA) and $0.1847, while holding above these keeps the bullish case intact.
Bitcoin’s recent rise has started a new debate among traders and analysts. Many are wondering if the bull run is coming to an end or if a new rally is just beginning. One of the most respected crypto chart analysts, Stockmoney Lizards, thinks this cycle is different from the past ones and says Bitcoin may still have more room to grow.
The 4-Year Cycle Debate
Traditionally, Bitcoin’s market follows a four-year cycle, roughly 1.5 years from halving to peak, and four years from one peak to the next. By that logic, the market should now be entering its bear phase.
But according to Stockmoney Lizards, this cycle is different. The total market cap has grown from $10 billion in 2016 to over $2 trillion in 2025, making simple historical comparisons less relevant.
Unlike previous cycles marked by dramatic parabolic rises, Bitcoin has been climbing in a steady channel. There hasn’t been a “blow-off top” or explosive hype phase yet, a sign that the cycle could still have room to grow.
Institutional Buying Changes the Game
One major difference this time is institutional involvement. Spot Bitcoin ETFs now hold roughly $150 billion worth of BTC, and inflows have remained strong throughout October.
Stockmoney Lizards points out that such large-scale investment reduces the chances of a -90% crash, which was common in previous cycles.
Apart from it, on-chain data like the Satoshimeter shows the market hasn’t reached its typical “hype zone.” Other technical patterns, like three rising valleys and Bollinger Band compression, also suggest a strong foundation for another leg up.
Bitcoin Nears Final Resistance Zone
Adding bullishness to the analysis, crypto analyst Castrades says Bitcoin is still moving in a large ABC correction pattern, which often appears after big rallies.
He points out a key resistance area between $117,000 and $119,500 — calling it the “final resistance zone.” If Bitcoin can’t break above this range, it might drop back toward $94,000–$97,000.
But if the price climbs above $123,500, Castrades believes it could start a new strong bullish phase instead.
Despite the volatility in crypto markets this quarter, traders remain interested in several household names. Cardano (ADA) has managed to shrug off the impending price volatility, while Ripple (XRP) appears to be completing a technical setup for another leg upward. Little Pepe (LILPEPE), on the other hand, is emerging as one of the fastest-growing new meme coins that actually has an underlying infrastructure.
Cardano (ADA): Steady Progress Amid Volatility
Cardano’s price action has been firm even in the face of broader market weakness. Trading between $0.64 and $0.67, ADA has managed to hold key levels that other assets have slipped from. The network’s steady pace of upgrades and vigorous developer activity is helping maintain long-term confidence among holders. Recent data also shows an uptick in whale accumulation and exchange outflows, both signals that large investors are taking positions for the next leg higher. Most analysts remain relatively optimistic, though they’re tempering their expectations. The more cautious believe ADA could reach $1 by early 2026, while the more bullish think it could easily climb to $2 or even $3 if network usage picks up.
Ripple (XRP): Technical Setup Points to a Final Push
Ripple’s native token has also been under close watch from technical analysts. Using Elliott Wave theory, a model that tracks investor behavior through recurring price patterns, several traders believe XRP is approaching the end of its fourth wave, the final consolidation before a breakout.
Analyst STEPH recently noted how XRP’s current chart mirrors its 2020 cycle almost perfectly. XRP has been moving sideways for a while, but the last time that happened, it suddenly broke out and surpassed its previous highs. If history repeats, XRP’s next rally could push it up to $4.50, maybe even $5.50.
Little Pepe (LILPEPE): Meme Energy Meets Real Infrastructure
Honestly, there’s a lot of excitement around Little Pepe (LILPEPE) right now. It’s not just another meme coin; it has a genuine community feel, is entertaining, and actually functions well. Since it operates on an Ethereum-compatible Layer 2, transactions are fast, and there’s no tax on trades. So, it has more substance than just hype. The project’s presale has already raised over $27.2 million, selling nearly 16.6 billion tokens and drawing interest from both retail and whale investors. LILPEPE’s growth story has been supported by transparency and engagement.
They also ran a $777,000 giveaway with tens of thousands of entries and have earned a reputation for being an inclusive and fair project. Market analysts believe that once listings on major exchanges go live, the token could see its first primary price discovery phase. Some forecasts place LILPEPE’s short-term targets near $0.10, while longer-term expectations stretch toward $1 by the next market top in 2026.
Why LILPEPE Outshines Ripple (XRP) and Solana (SOL)
When it comes to raw return potential, the gap between established cryptos and early-stage projects like Little Pepe is massive. Ripple (XRP) would rise 107%, solidly outperforming its large-cap peers, yet again falling short of the performance seen for newer projects. If Solana (SOL) revisits $250 once again during this cycle, that would represent about a 16% upside, with price action more characterized by consolidation rather than exponential growth. It remains the safest high-throughput blockchain. Finally, Little Pepe (LILPEPE) is another strong candidate for outsized returns.
Currently priced at $0.0022 in Stage 13 of the Presale, it is expected to reach $0.10-$0.20 in the medium term and potentially as high as $1 at the peak of the cycle. That would equal a rate of return anywhere between 4,000% and more than 45,000%, exceeding the projected returns of XRP and Solana combined.
Conclusion
Despite recent market pullbacks, optimism is returning as investors anticipate the next crypto cycle. Cardano’s measured progress, Ripple’s technical setup, and Little Pepe’s viral traction each represent different facets of this emerging confidence. However, Little Pepe has by far the most significant potential for return. While XRP and Solana offer more modest upside, Little Pepe is positioned as the high-risk, high-reward play with potential returns magnitudes higher.
For more information about Little Pepe (LILPEPE) visit the links below:
Bitcoin and Ethereum spot ETFs kept their upward momentum on October 27, drawing a combined $283 million in net inflows. Bitcoin ETFs led with $149 million, marking their third consecutive day of gains. Ethereum ETFs followed with $134 million in positive flows, with all nine funds recording no outflows. The steady inflows highlight growing market optimism and rising institutional confidence in the two largest cryptocurrencies.
Malgo DEX, a decentralized peer-to-peer (P2P) crypto exchange platform, has announced the rollout of a major feature upgrade aimed at empowering users with greater control, privacy, and real-time trading flexibility.
This latest update introduces several key features that align with Malgo’s mission to provide a fast, secure, and anonymous crypto trading experience, all without requiring KYC or AML procedures.
Key Features Now Live:
No-KYC P2P Trading:
Users can now trade directly with one another without providing personal identification. This opens the platform to privacy-conscious users who prefer decentralized, non-custodial crypto exchange options.
Expanded Trading Pairs:
Malgo DEX now supports a growing list of trading pairs including BTC, ETH, USDT, XMR, and more. This broadens accessibility and trading opportunities across popular and privacy-focused assets.
Slippage Settings:
Traders can set custom slippage tolerance to avoid unexpected price fluctuations. This feature is especially useful for large-volume swaps or volatile market conditions.
Built-in Escrow System:
All P2P trades are protected by a secure, automated escrow mechanism that ensures both parties uphold their side of the transaction before funds are released.
Telegram Bot Notifications:
Malgo users can now link their accounts to receive real-time trade alerts and updates via Telegram -streamlining trade management and improving user engagement.
“We designed this upgrade with privacy and usability in mind,” said a spokesperson for Malgo DEX. “Our users want fast and secure trades without sacrificing anonymity or control, and this release delivers on that promise.”
The new features are live and available to all users starting today. The platform is accessible via [https://malgoswap.io/p2p] and does not require any registration or personal data to begin trading.
About Malgo DEX
Malgo is a decentralized, privacy-respecting crypto exchange platform focused on peer-to-peer trading. It allows users to buy, sell, and swap crypto assets without intermediaries or invasive KYC requirements. Malgo prioritizes transparency, user autonomy, and cross-chain flexibility.
Trump-linked American Bitcoin Corp, co-founded by Eric and Donald Trump Jr., just acquired 1,414 Bitcoins valued at $163 million, boosting its total holdings to 3,865 BTC worth nearly $445 million. Formed in March after a merger with Hut 8’s mining assets, American Bitcoin listed on Nasdaq in September. The company combines mining with direct buys, and now ranks among the top 25 public Bitcoin holders globally.
Henrik Zeberg, the Head Macro Economist at Swissblock, known for connecting macroeconomic cycles with asset bubbles, says we are now living through what he calls “the biggest bubble in modern financial history.”
According to Zeberg, current global financial conditions are fueling a “blow-off top,” a phase characterized by extreme price euphoria before a market peak.
In a tweet post, he anticipates that Ethereum will not only join but may outperform Bitcoin in this sharp upward move, driven by rising institutional interest, Layer 2 adoption, and Ethereum’s essential role in the DeFi and Web3 ecosystems.
Data and analysis after the October market flash crash indicate that ETH saw a 52.9% surge in futures volume, highlighting enduring demand and market resilience even as volatility persists.
Meanwhile, institutional developments such as growing spot-ETH ETF interest and the expansion of tokenized assets expected to surpass $25 billion by early 2025, support Zeberg’s view of Ethereum’s strong near-term potential.
Zeberg warns that global markets are in the “biggest bubble ever,” fueled by years of easy money and investor greed. But with inflation returning, he says the era of “free liquidity” is over.
He predicts a final “blow-off top,” a sharp, emotional rally before a major crash. According to him, Ethereum could outperform Bitcoin in this last surge as altcoin excitement peaks, but both will likely face a deep correction afterward.
Drawing from history, Zeberg compares today’s euphoria to the 1840s railway boom and the 2000 dot-com bubble, both revolutionary, yet followed by painful collapses.
Ethereum Price Outlook
Ethereum’s recent bounce from $3,686 to $4,134 shows its volatility and potential for rapid gains.
As of now, Ethereum (ETH) is showing signs of a potential breakout as its price forms a symmetrical triangle, a pattern that often leads to strong moves once the price breaks out.
The Relative Strength Index (RSI) sits around 54, showing that buying pressure is building, but the asset isn’t overbought yet, suggesting there’s still room for further gains if momentum continues.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
How does Ethereum differ from Bitcoin?
While both are major cryptocurrencies, Ethereum’s value is also tied to its foundational role in powering decentralized finance (DeFi) and Web3 applications, not just as a digital asset.
How do macro trends and Fed policy link to Ethereum’s rally?
Lower rates boost market liquidity and investor optimism, often fueling crypto rallies—Ethereum could benefit the most.
What is the ETH price prediction for 2025?
As per our Ethereum price forecast 2025, the ETH price could reach a maximum of $9,428.11.
The Hedera (HBAR) community is celebrating a major milestone as the network’s first U.S. exchange-traded fund (ETF) is set to start trading on Nasdaq this Tuesday, October 28, 2025.
The Canary Capital HBAR ETF, trading under the ticker HBR, will give investors direct spot exposure to HBAR, making it easier for institutions and advisors to invest in the network without managing crypto wallets.
A Breakthrough for Institutional Investors
Crypto Analyst Mark Chadwickx confirmed the listing, calling it a major step for institutional access to HBAR through Nasdaq. Many saw this as a huge credibility boost for the network.
Canary Capital CEO Steven McClurg confirmed the ETF launch after the company completed all required filings, using the SEC’s shutdown playbook, which allows new ETFs to go live 20 days after filing, even when regulators are short-staffed.
The new HBAR ETF will hold actual HBAR tokens in custody with BitGo and Coinbase Custody, while CoinDesk Indices will provide official price tracking.
Alongside the HBAR product, Canary is also rolling out a Litecoin (LTC) ETF, both debuting in what’s turning out to be a busy week for new crypto fund listings in the U.S.
Crypto Community Reacts
The Hedera ETF launch stirred quite a buzz on social media. X users praised Hedera’s quiet strength, noting that while Bitcoin and Ethereum dominate headlines, Hedera has been steadily handling over 10,000 transactions per second for giants like IBM and Google. They described the ETF launch as “institutional stealth mode activated,” hinting at growing big-money interest behind the scenes.
However, not everyone was convinced. Another User, LuckyToken7777, cautioned that listing and full SEC approval are different matters, warning traders to be careful of potential hype-driven price moves.
Faster ETF Approvals Under New SEC Rules
However, the launch timing isn’t random. In mid-September, the SEC approved new listing standards that make it easier for exchanges to list spot commodity ETFs like HBAR, Solana, and Litecoin. These new standards cut down the long review times that previously delayed crypto ETF launches.
Despite the ongoing U.S. government shutdown, Elenor Terrett explained that these ETFs can still go live because the 8-A filings, which register ETF shares for trading, have been certified, and the S-1 filings include language allowing them to take effect automatically after 20 days without SEC intervention.
Having said that, this rule change has opened the door for multiple ETF debuts, including Bitwise’s Solana ETF on the NYSE and Canary’s listings on Nasdaq, all happening within days.
For Hedera, this marks a major turning point. The ETF not only increases market visibility but also gives traditional investors access to HBAR through regulated brokerage accounts, a big leap for a blockchain known for its enterprise and institutional partnerships with companies like IBM and Google.
Never Miss a Beat in the Crypto World!
Stay ahead with breaking news, expert analysis, and real-time updates on the latest trends in Bitcoin, altcoins, DeFi, NFTs, and more.
FAQs
What is the HBAR ETF?
The Canary Capital HBAR ETF (ticker: HBR) is a new investment fund on Nasdaq that holds actual Hedera tokens, giving investors direct spot exposure to HBAR without needing to manage a crypto wallet.
How can I invest in the Hedera ETF?
You can invest in the HBAR ETF (HBR) through any standard brokerage account that offers access to Nasdaq, just like you would trade any other stock or exchange-traded fund, starting October 28, 2025.
What is the ticker for the Hedera ETF?
The ticker symbol for the new spot Hedera ETF on the Nasdaq exchange is HBR. This is the symbol you will use to find and trade the fund in your brokerage account.
What do you get when you combine XRP and DeFi? Why, XRPfi of course. Welcome to decentralized finance powered by XRP, the native asset of the Ripple ledger (also known as XRP Ledger) that’s since found a new lease on life with Flare’s blockchain for data. XRPfi has taken off in a big way this year, with Flare’s TVL growing by the tens-of-millions, weekly, since its launch in late-September 2025, as its XRP-focused DeFi ecosystem gathers momentum. The market has indicated that there is much positive sentiment surrounding XRPfi, and for good reason – it’s been a long time in the making.
From XRP to XRPfi
DeFi as we know it really got going in 2020 on Ethereum before expanding to other networks. Today, virtually all public blockchains have some kind of DeFi sector, enabling users to borrow and lend; stake and trade; and participate in other on-chain money markets without needing to custody the owner’s assets – thanks to the magic of smart contracts.
In parallel to DeFi taking Ethereum by storm, another leading OG chain – Ripple – was had no choice but to be limited to watching from the sidelines. Like Bitcoin, Ripple doesn’t natively support Turing-complete smart contracts, making it very difficult to build the sort of dapps that can be assembled with Solidity.
Also around the same time as DeFi Summer, a new blockchain ecosystem emerged, by the name of Flare Network, with an ambitious goal of expanding XRP’s native functionality. The asset was already one of the most liquid and valuable cryptocurrencies by market cap after ETH and BTC, and the upside to making XRP smart-contract compatible offered plenty of financial incentive to many stakeholders. The technical challenges were indeed challenging, however, Flare’s core team persisted and has successfully built out its ecosystem, with XRP at its core.
In 2025, efforts began paying off. TVL on Flare has grown by almost 40% since the launch of FXRP (Flare-issued XRP), and is up five-fold YTD. What started out as a bold idea has turned into a working reality. Not only has the growth of XRPfi transformed Flare into a major DeFi hub, but there are signs that it’s stimulating demand for XRP, with its price predicted to move higher as users put the crypto asset to work in order to earn yield. Here’s how it works.
The DeFi Framework That XRP Deserves
As Flare explains in its introduction to XRPfi, “XRP holders should have access to a wider selection of DeFi-enabled financial tools. For instance, there’s only one AMM live on XRPL [the XRP Ledger], when a holder of XRP – the [fifth] biggest market cap cryptocurrency – should have a suite of options to choose from.”
Flare achieves this by enabling non-smart contract assets such as XRP, BTC, and DOGE to be bridged to its network, where they can be used in DeFi. The benefits of this recently unlocked capability are manifold. For one thing, it means that users can hold XRP – and capitalize on the upside to further growth – while also borrowing against it and earning yield across numerous protocols.
For another thing, with the Tether-developed USD₮0 stablecoin now available on Flare, there’s access to a native stable that doesn’t have to be wrapped or bridged. This provides another important DeFi primitive and has helped to further deepen TVL on Flare. With both XRP and USD₮0 readily available on the network, there are ample opportunities for supplying liquidity and trading spot and perps markets. Once a simple payments token favored by various fintechs and money transmitters, XRP is now a multi-purpose DeFi asset.
The way in which Flare has achieved this without increasing security risk is through FAssets, its protocol that enables tokenized representations of assets such as XRP to be issued. This allows “plain” cryptocurrencies to be transformed into EVM-compatible tokens that can be used in an array of creative ways.
Making Staking an XRP Staple
One of the use cases that’s formed a cornerstone of Flare’s thriving DeFi ecosystem is XRP staking. Revealed in May 2025 with the support of Firelight, this allows users to stake their FXRP, into protocols such as Sceptre. In return, staker receive a staking token – stXRP – that can be used to earn additional yield, in the same manner as stETH on Ethereum.
But this is by no means the only way in which XRP has found a new lease of life on Flare: it’s also being used in native protocols where leveraged perpetual futures can be traded fully on-chain, and is deeply embedded into decentralized exchanges such as SparkDEX, which has created its own fully-fledged DeFi ecosystem that includes yield farming, staking, and a token launchpad. In short, if you’re an XRP holder and are still keeping your assets in cold storage, you’re likely leaving considerable yield on the table.
Where Next for XRPfi?
While September saw large quantities of the asset being bridged to the network, one of the reasons behind this surge has been improved onramps that make it easier for users to move XRP over to Flare’s network. This includes recent integrations such as the rising Xaman wallet which now enables FXRP to be directly minted. As a result, XRP holders can begin putting their assets to work on Flare in a matter of minutes.
Other catalysts include a 2.2 billion FLR incentive program that offers additional rewards for liquidity providers, juicing the total APY that is attainable. Flare is now busy onboarding more partners that are looking to enhance access to its DeFi services including MoreMarkets, which has just launched its XRP Flare Account, further simplifying access to yield.
XRP may have started out as a simple cryptocurrency designed for payments and speculative trading, but it’s since evolved into much more and it’s thanks in no small part to Flare. Its DeFi network marks the most successful example to date of a non-native asset being revitalized on a secondary chain. Whereas other attempts at recreating DeFi for non-smart contact assets, such as BTC with “BTCfi,” have struggled to gain traction, XRPfi has found product-market fit. If Flare’s TVL can keep on rising, there’s every prospect of XRP following suit as users flock to acquire DeFi’s unlikely utility token.
Market analysts are urging calm among XRP holders amid rising confusion in the community. According to recent analysis, XRP’s current mid-base channel movement suggests accumulation following its initial rally, with even the latest liquidation wick closing within range a sign of continued buyer interest. However, experts caution that consecutive closes below this channel could signal trouble, as a critical resonance line from past pivots sits just beneath. While upside potential remains, projections of $9 XRP are seen as highly optimistic, representing a 4.236 Fibonacci extension. Analysts recommend a laddered exit between $5–$10, emphasizing the need for a clear trading plan over speculation.
October 28, 2025 06:51:25 UTC
Peter Schiff Questions Fed’s Logic on Rate Cuts Amid “Booming” U.S. Economy
Economist Peter Schiff has criticized the conflicting narratives around the U.S. economy and monetary policy. In a post on X, Schiff pointed out that those claiming the economy is “booming” are simultaneously calling for the Federal Reserve to slash interest rates. He questioned the rationale behind cutting rates when inflation remains at least 50% above the Fed’s 2% target and is still rising, arguing that such actions contradict claims of economic strength
October 28, 2025 06:47:53 UTC
India Verifies Over 34 Crore Government Documents on National Blockchain Platform
India has verified over 34 crore government documents on its National Blockchain Platform as of October 21, 2025 a major leap in digital governance. Launched under MeitY’s National Blockchain Framework (NBF) in 2024 with a ₹64.76 crore budget, it aims to enhance trust, transparency, and efficiency. Powered by the Vishvasya Blockchain Stack, the platform supports projects like Property Chain, Judiciary Chain, and Certificate Chain. Over 21,000 officials have been trained, with integrations across RBI, TRAI, and NSDL. India is embedding blockchain into governance, setting a global benchmark for digital trust and transparency.
October 28, 2025 06:47:53 UTC
Bitcoin and Ethereum ETFs See Strong Inflows Ahead of FOMC Meeting
Bitcoin spot ETFs recorded $149 million in net inflows on October 27 their third straight day of gains — signaling renewed investor confidence ahead of the Fed meeting. Ethereum spot ETFs also saw robust activity, attracting $134 million in net inflows with zero outflows across all nine funds. The consistent demand highlights growing institutional appetite for crypto exposure despite near-term market volatility.
October 28, 2025 06:47:53 UTC
Lighter Surpasses Aster and Hyperliquid in Daily Trading Volume
According to data from Artemis, on-chain perpetuals protocol Lighter has outpaced Aster and Hyperliquid in daily trading volume for three consecutive days. As of October 26, Lighter’s daily trading volume hit $8.6 billion, while its open interest stood at $1.7 billion — still lower than its competitors. The surge in volume highlights Lighter’s growing traction among on-chain traders despite its relatively smaller open interest base.
October 28, 2025 06:43:48 UTC
BlackRock Offloads $2B in Bitcoin Ahead of Fed Meeting
Ahead of today’s Federal Reserve meeting, BlackRock has reportedly sold 17,400 BTC valued at over $2 billion — and continues to reduce its holdings every few hours. The timing has stirred market speculation, with traders debating whether the world’s largest asset manager is anticipating short-term volatility or positioning for a post-FOMC rebound. The sell-off comes just as Bitcoin hovers near the $115,000 mark amid broader market uncertainty.
October 28, 2025 05:59:15 UTC
SEI Price To Surge 3-4x
Crypto analyst Michaël van de Poppe predicts a strong rebound for SEI as the altcoin retests a crucial support zone after its initial upward move. He notes that such retests are common in altcoin markets — where price builds strength before the next breakout. Van de Poppe expects SEI to consolidate before targeting around 500 sats, potentially delivering a 3–4x gain against Bitcoin over the next 2–4 months.
$SEI is at a strong support zone as it retests this level for support after its first run upwards.
Bitcoin is showing renewed market confidence as it exits the “fear” zone in investor sentiment. The Crypto Fear & Greed Index climbed to a neutral score of 51 on Sunday, up 11 points from Saturday and more than 20 points higher than last week. This shift follows Bitcoin’s rebound to around $115,000 after weeks of caution triggered by Trump’s China tariff announcement. The sentiment turnaround signals a potential return of bullish momentum in the broader crypto market.
October 28, 2025 05:32:30 UTC
Bitcoin Eyes $112K Retest Before Potential New ATH Ahead of FOMC
A strong start to the week has Bitcoin traders bracing for a possible short-term correction as the FOMC meeting approaches. Analysts suggest a retest of the $112,000 level could be healthy before the next leg up. With bullish momentum building, many expect Bitcoin to rebound quickly — potentially setting the stage for a new all-time high once the Fed’s rate decision is out.
October 28, 2025 05:19:59 UTC
Crypto Market Today
Crypto markets kicked off the week on a bullish note, with Bitcoin briefly surpassing $116,000 and Ethereum climbing above $4,240 their highest levels in two weeks. The surge comes ahead of the FOMC meetings starting tomorrow, fueling speculation around potential policy cues. Adding to the optimism, renewed enthusiasm surrounding Trump’s Crypto Advisory Board has further boosted trader sentiment across major digital assets.
US Representative Ro Khanna is looking to introduce a bill to restrict all elected officials from trading stocks and crypto, citing conflicts of interest.
The near-$100 spike on rival DEX Lighter wasn’t whale activity but an automated trading error that exposed the challenges of maintaining transparency and usability on decentralized exchanges.
Ethereum treasury company ETHZilla has sold roughly $40 million worth of ETH from its treasury to support a share buyback program as it looks to narrow the gap between its stock price and net asset value. The Nasdaq-listed company acquired…
ETH price is testing a crucial support level after carving out a bullish reversal pattern. Could a bounce from here put it back on track for a strong upward move? After rallying 10% to a weekly high of $4,232 on…
Chinese tech giants rushed to secure stablecoin licenses in Hong Kong after it adopted new laws, but Beijing has now stepped in, suspending these plans.
The Cardano weekly chart is still looking strongly bullish according to independent technician Charting Guy (@ChartingGuy on X) who resurfaced his long-running Fibonacci roadmap and channel study.
Can Cardano Top $6 This Cycle?
His latest post on X on October 26 noted that “ADA is fine as long as uptrend holds,” a view that is anchored in a multi-year rising channel that has contained price action since the 2018–2019 base. The channel features a lower rail now passing through roughly the $0.33–$0.35 area, a midline that has behaved as a recurring pivot since 2020, and overhead parallels that intersect with Fibonacci extension targets later in the cycle.
The chart history mapped on his visuals is orderly. The 2021–2022 bear trend, drawn as a steep descending line from the prior peak, ended into the channel’s lower support and resolved through a series of falling trendline breakouts during 2023 and early 2024. Since Q4 2023, the chart has shown a series of higher highs and higher lows. Currently, the ADA price is again guided by a falling trendline.
Everything in the layout revolves around the Fibonacci ladder. The retracement set on the right margin—derived from the 2021 peak to the cycle low—marks 0% at $0.23488, then $0.33360 (0.136), $0.43180 (0.236), $0.62932 (0.382), a mid-range 0.5 at $0.85, $1.15694 (0.618), $1.43911 (0.702), $1.78464 (0.786), $2.32189 (0.888), and $3.09981 (1.000). Above that stack, the cycle extensions are plotted at $6.25325 (1.272), $9.00941 (1.414) and $15.26831 (1.618).
Those numbers are consistent with how the analyst framed the market earlier in the year. On April 27 he wrote that “ADA fibs are very important here. The 0.618 is a STRONG resistance… the 0.382 MUST hold… neutral until one of these breaks on a weekly close.” That roadmap has aged intact.
Rallies through spring and summer repeatedly stalled in the 0.500–0.618 zone, with the 0.618 level at $1.15694 capping advances. Pullbacks, in turn, have found bids near the 0.382 pivot at $0.62932.
On September 18, after that rejection, he updated that “ADA higher low … higher high pending… still targeting 1.272 fib this cycle,” tying the price structure back to the extension grid. The implication is not casual moon-math; it is geometric. If ADA continues to defend the uptrend defined by the channel’s lower rail and, crucially, converts the 0.618 retracement at $1.15694 into support on weekly closes, the path reopens into the upper retracement shelf—$1.43911 at 0.702 and $1.78464 at 0.786—before confronting the 0.888 marker at $2.32189.
A yellow waypoint for a higher high (on the main chart) sits near ~$2.30, deliberately aligning with that 0.888 level to flag a logical checkpoint for the next impulsive leg beneath the full retrace at $3.09981.
Only beyond that zone does the headline question come into play. The analyst’s cycle objective is the 1.272 extension at $6.25325. On his canvas, that target is not an orphaned price label; it intersects with the upper parallels of the multi-year rising channel further out in time, which means the extension is technically consistent with the same structure that has governed ADA since the last cycle’s base.
The risk management side of the ledger remains equally explicit: lose the 0.382 at $0.62932 on a weekly closing basis and the neutral-to-constructive stance is impaired, pushing focus back to $0.43180 and $0.33360, with the 0% anchor at $0.23488 defining the absolute boundary of the cycle floor inside the channel’s lower third.
As the latest candles on the charts show, ADA sits mid-channel with the higher low confirmed and the range unresolved beneath descending trendline supply. The triggers are unchanged and numerically clear. A sustained weekly close above $1.15694 would validate an attempt toward $1.44, $1.78, and $2.32, with $3.10 the final retrace before extension math takes over.
A failure through $0.62932 would flatten the uptrend call. Between those guardrails, the analyst’s October 26 message reads less like bravado and more like a conditional statement embedded in the chart itself: Cardano can still reach $6.25 this cycle—but only if the uptrend continues to hold and the 0.618 ceiling finally gives way.
XRP price started a fresh increase above $2.50. The price is now showing positive signs and might rise further if it clears the $2.6880 resistance.
XRP price gained pace for a move above $2.50 and $2.550.
The price is now trading above $2.50 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average.
There is a bullish trend line forming with support at $2.60 on the hourly chart of the XRP/USD pair (data source from Kraken).
The pair could start a fresh increase if it clears the $2.6880 resistance.
XRP Price Holds Support
XRP price started a fresh increase after it settled above $2.40, like Bitcoin and Ethereum. The price surpassed the $2.420 and $2.50 resistance levels.
The bulls were able to push the price above $2.550 and $2.65. A high was formed at $2.6972 and the price is now consolidating gains above the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the recent move from the $2.327 swing low to the $2.6972 high.
The price is now trading below $2.60 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average. There is a bullish trend line forming with support at $2.60 on the hourly chart of the XRP/USD pair.
If there is a fresh upward move, the price might face resistance near the $2.650 level. The first major resistance is near the $2.6880 level, above which the price could rise and test $2.70. A clear move above the $2.70 resistance might send the price toward the $2.7650 resistance. Any more gains might send the price toward the $2.80 resistance. The next major hurdle for the bulls might be near $2.880.
Downside Correction?
If XRP fails to clear the $2.6880 resistance zone, it could start a fresh decline. Initial support on the downside is near the $2.60 level. The next major support is near the $2.5650 level.
If there is a downside break and a close below the $2.5650 level, the price might continue to decline toward $2.5120 or the 50% Fib retracement level of the recent move from the $2.327 swing low to the $2.6972 high. The next major support sits near the $2.4680 zone, below which the price could continue lower toward $2.420.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for XRP/USD is now losing pace in the bullish zone.
Hourly RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for XRP/USD is now above the 50 level.
The XRP market is bracing for a new phase of intense volatility, with anticipation growing around key legal, regulatory, and institutional developments. Ripple CEO Brad Garlinghouse has recently addressed the XRP community, offering guidance and setting expectations for what is to come.
XRP Unusual Stability May Be Setting Up A Major Move
The cryptocurrency world is buzzing with increased anticipation for XRP, following a series of strategic announcements from Ripple and compelling technical analysis. Popular crypto news source CryptosRus has highlighted on X that the altcoin is poised for a sharp move, as Ripple CEO Brad Garlinghouse has mentioned that investors should be prepared for a substantial shift.
At the core of this move, Ripple has just launched Ripple Prime, a new global prime brokerage service tailored for institutional clients. According to the company, Ripple Prime will be powered by Ripple’s foundational digital asset infrastructure, encompassing its robust solutions for payments, crypto custody, and stablecoin capabilities, alongside XRP.
However, CEO Brad Garlinghouse called this move another step toward building the internet of value, emphasizing that the XRP sits at the center of everything Ripple does. CryptosRus noted that the altcoin has recently bounced off a key support level at $2.33. This technical indicator is signaling a potential 30% rally, with an initial target of $3.45 or even higher, as market momentum continues to build.
An analyst known as TylerHillYT, who is also the president of FluenceGlobal and Co-Founder of the CSS, has also stated that the XRP price comeback is showing structural strength. In just a day, the token burn rate spiked 29%, mirroring its 29% price surge, signaling a synchronized increase in both on-chain demand and heightened investor activity.
This Ripple’s deeper expansion into traditional finance and the recent launch of Ripple Prime have caused the network usage to ramp up again. TylerHillYT emphasized that at the accelerated pace, XRP is not just riding a wave of market momentum, but it’s rebuilding its long-term narrative. However, the burn acceleration with renewed institutional traction could be the early signs of a sustained upward trajectory, pushing the token structurally toward the $3.00 mark.
Connecting Market Surge To Foundational Growth
While the digital asset market is vibrating with renewed excitement surrounding XRP, a prominent crypto influencer and creator on Binance and CMC, Jack, has revealed that the bulls have firmly smashed through the critical $2.55 resistance level with conviction. This decisive breakout has now set the immediate sights of traders on $2.80 and beyond.
Jack mentioned that whale activity is back, and the Open Interest (OI) is climbing steadily, while sentiment is flipping fast. If this powerful momentum holds, the next significant pit stop for XRP could be the $3.00 mark and beyond.
Ethereum price started a decent increase above $4,000. ETH is consolidating gains and could aim for more gains above the $4,220 resistance.
Ethereum started a fresh upward move above $4,000 and $4,120.
The price is trading above $4,080 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average.
There is a bullish trend line forming with support at $4,055 on the hourly chart of ETH/USD (data feed via Kraken).
The pair could continue to move up if it trades above $4,200.
Ethereum Price Holds Gains
Ethereum price started a steady upward move above the $3,880 zone, like Bitcoin. ETH price surpassed the $4,000 and $4,120 levels to enter a short-term positive zone.
The price even spiked above $4,200. A high was formed at $4,252 and the price is now consolidating gains. There was a minor decline below the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $3,708 swing low to the $4,252 high.
Ethereum price is now trading above $4,080 and the 100-hourly Simple Moving Average. Besides, there is a bullish trend line forming with support at $4,055 on the hourly chart of ETH/USD.
On the upside, the price could face resistance near the $4,180 level. The next key resistance is near the $4,200 level. The first major resistance is near the $4,250 level. A clear move above the $4,250 resistance might send the price toward the $4,320 resistance. An upside break above the $4,320 region might call for more gains in the coming sessions. In the stated case, Ether could rise toward the $4,480 resistance zone or even $4,500 in the near term.
Another Pullback In ETH?
If Ethereum fails to clear the $4,200 resistance, it could start a fresh decline. Initial support on the downside is near the $4,080 level. The first major support sits near the $4,050 zone and the trend line.
A clear move below the $4,050 support might push the price toward the $3,980 support or the 50% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $3,708 swing low to the $4,252 high. Any more losses might send the price toward the $3,840 region in the near term. The next key support sits at $3,780.
Technical Indicators
Hourly MACD – The MACD for ETH/USD is losing momentum in the bullish zone.
Hourly RSI – The RSI for ETH/USD is now below the 50 zone.
Bitcoin edged higher on Sunday as signs of easing US-China trade tensions lifted risk assets, while Strategy’s founder hinted the company kept adding to its Bitcoin holdings.
Strategy Keeps Buying
Michael Saylor posted a chart on October 26 that uses orange dots to mark recent purchases. The visual cue has become his shorthand for new buys.
Based on reports, Strategy added 387 BTC between October 13 and October 20, bringing its total to 640,418 BTC. That number is striking on its own. It shows a steady, deliberate approach to buying even when prices are volatile.
Strategy’s disclosed average cost for its Bitcoin stands at $74,010. The company’s moves lately have been small compared with September, when it took in more than 7,000 BTC across several large transactions. The size of any fresh purchases this week has not been publicly revealed.
At the same time, Bitcoin’s market moves were influenced by broader news. The price of Bitcoin rose about 1.6% on Sunday, while Ethereum gained roughly 2.8%. Short-term swings appear driven more by headlines than by a single company’s actions.
Based on reports, at prices a little over $115,000 per BTC, Strategy’s Bitcoin stash is valued at around $72 billion. That valuation implies a paper gain of more than $25 billion over a total cost basis of about $47.4 billion since the program began in 2020.
Reports have logged 83 separate purchase events in that time, a pattern that has left investors with a clear view of the firm’s playbook: buy repeatedly and report afterward.
Some of the buying was concentrated in September, when the firm added thousands of coins in a few large moves. Recently, however, allocations have looked smaller and more frequent. That shift suggests a preference for steady accumulation rather than single big bets.
Buying Behavior And Market Response
Strategy shares have been trading above the company’s net asset value. That fact suggests investors are comfortable owning MSTR as a way to gain Bitcoin exposure without buying the token directly. The company’s method — announce purchases after the fact and let the market reflect the holdings — has been consistent and predictable.
Geopolitical Headlines Drive Volatility
Meanwhile, officials from the US and China signaled progress in trade talks, and that helped calm some investors. According to reports, Scott Bessent told CBS News he expected the threat of 100% tariffs and an immediate export control regime to have receded.
Earlier in October, China announced tighter limits on rare earth exports used in chip manufacturing. On October 11, US President Donald Trump said he would impose an additional 100% tariff on Chinese goods and planned export controls on certain software to take effect on November 1.
Those days of sharp rhetoric caused heavy losses across markets and triggered one of the largest liquidation events in crypto this year.
Featured image from Gemini, chart from TradingView
Bitcoin price is consolidating gains above $113,500. BTC could rise further if there is a clear move above the $115,750 resistance.
Bitcoin started a fresh upward move above the $114,000 resistance level.
The price is trading above $114,200 and the 100 hourly Simple moving average.
There is a bullish trend line forming with support at $113,900 on the hourly chart of the BTC/USD pair (data feed from Kraken).
The pair might continue to move up if it trades above the $115,750 zone.
Bitcoin Price Starts Consolidation
Bitcoin price formed a base and started a fresh increase above the $112,500 zone. BTC gained pace for a move above the main hurdle at $113,500.
It opened the doors for a move above $115,000 and the 100 hourly Simple moving average. Finally, the price spiked above $116,000 and is currently consolidating gains above the 23.6% Fib retracement level of the recent wave from the $106,718 swing low to the $116,309 high.
Besides, there is a bullish trend line forming with support at $113,900 on the hourly chart of the BTC/USD pair. Bitcoin is now trading above $114,000 and the 100 hourly Simple moving average.
Immediate resistance on the upside is near the $115,000 level. The first key resistance is near the $115,500 level. The next resistance could be $115,750. A close above the $115,750 resistance might send the price further higher. In the stated case, the price could rise and test the $116,300 resistance. Any more gains might send the price toward the $117,500 level. The next barrier for the bulls could be $118,000.
Another Pullback In BTC?
If Bitcoin fails to rise above the $115,500 resistance zone, it could start a fresh decline. Immediate support is near the $114,000 level. The first major support is near the $113,500 level or the trend line.
The next support is now near the $111,000 zone. Any more losses might send the price toward the $110,500 support in the near term. The main support sits at $108,500, below which BTC might struggle to recover in the short term.
Technical indicators:
Hourly MACD – The MACD is now gaining pace in the bullish zone.
Hourly RSI (Relative Strength Index) – The RSI for BTC/USD is now above the 50 level.
Major Support Levels – $114,000, followed by $113,500.
Data shows cryptocurrency short investors have suffered large liquidations during the past day as Bitcoin and altcoins have made a recovery.
Bitcoin, Ethereum Have Surged In The Last 24 Hours
Bitcoin and other cryptocurrencies have witnessed a rally during the past day, breaking away from the slump the market had earlier fallen into. At the height of this surge, Bitcoin broke past $116,000, while Ethereum touched $4,250.
The assets have since seen a small retracement. The chart below shows how BTC’s latest trajectory has looked.
At its current price of $115,400, Bitcoin is up about 4% on the weekly timeframe. Similarly, Ethereum at $4,160 is in a profit of 3.4%. Most other digital assets have seen similarly positive returns, although there are some outliers like Tron, which is down more than 7%. The market-wide recovery during the past day has meant that a large amount of short liquidations have piled up on the derivatives exchanges.
Crypto Market Liquidations Have Totaled At $467 Million
According to data from CoinGlass, about $467 million in cryptocurrency-related derivatives contracts have been liquidated over the last 24 hours. A contract is said to be “liquidated” when its platform forcibly shuts it down after it accumulates losses of a certain degree (as defined by the exchange).
Given that coins across the board have rebounded, the contracts crossing this threshold would mostly be the short ones. And indeed, the data would confirm so.
As is visible above, liquidations related to bearish cryptocurrency bets have reached $358 million in this window, representing 76.6% of the total flush in the sector. Bitcoin led the liquidations with $177 million in contracts involved, while Ethereum contributed the second most with $130 million in contracts. Out of the rest, Solana witnessed the largest flush at $34 million.
In some other news, Bitcoin spot exchange-traded funds (ETFs) have observed a notable amount of inflows over the past month, as CryptoQuant community analyst Maartunn has pointed out in an X post.
Spot ETFs refer to investment vehicles that allow investors to gain exposure to an asset without having to directly own it. The US SEC approved BTC spot ETFs in January of 2024. Here is the chart shared by the analyst that shows how the 30-day netflow for these vehicles has fluctuated since:
As displayed in the above graph, Bitcoin spot ETFs have seen inflows of $4.7 billion during the past month. Ethereum spot ETFs, which gained approval in mid-2024, have also enjoyed inflows in this period, although their value of $983 million is significantly less than BTC’s.
Why did the crypto investor bring a ladder to the exchange? Because the next big meme coin was ready to “scale” new heights! Meme coins have transformed from internet jokes into serious investment opportunities. Recent market surges highlight BullZilla, SPX6900, and Shiba Inu, each establishing a unique position. Investors now focus on projects offering structured growth, strong community support, and real utility, combining excitement with tangible market potential. These top meme coins exemplify the dynamic opportunities in today’s evolving crypto World.
BullZilla ($BZIL) stands out as a promising meme coin. Its phased presale, scarcity-driven tokenomics, and staking incentives have drawn significant investor attention. Over 3,300 holders and 31 billion tokens sold reflect strong early engagement. With mechanisms fostering scarcity, community growth, and structured ROI, BullZilla merges hype with utility. Early participants can benefit from high returns while supporting a sustainable project. This combination positions BullZilla as a leading contender among the top 100x meme coin presales with potential in 2025.
Don’t wait! Join Stage 8B of BullZilla presale and maximize your $BZIL gains today
SPX6900 ($SPX): A Billion-Dollar Meme Coin Powerhouse
SPX6900 ($SPX) has firmly established itself as a key player in the meme coin market. Currently priced at $1.12, it boasts a market capitalization exceeding $1 billion and a 24-hour trading volume of about $47 million. With more than 215,000 holders, SPX6900 reflects increasing investor confidence and growing market interest. Its evolution from a niche token into a billion-dollar asset demonstrates how strong community engagement, strategic development, and consistent updates can enhance value and ensure long-term relevance.
Frequently Asked Questions About SPX6900
What factors contribute to SPX6900’s rapid growth?
SPX6900’s growth stems from active community engagement, strategic partnerships, and regular development updates. These factors foster investor trust, enhance market visibility, and create momentum, helping SPX6900 stand out in the increasingly competitive meme coin World.
How does SPX6900 compare to other meme coins?
Compared to many meme coins, SPX6900 emphasizes utility, structured development, and long-term growth strategies. This approach differentiates it from purely speculative tokens, attracting investors seeking credibility, sustained value, and potential for lasting market relevance.
BullZilla ($BZIL): Top 100x Meme Coin Presales in 2025 Primed for Explosive Growth
BullZilla ($BZIL) is rapidly emerging as a top 100x meme coin presale in 2025. Currently in Stage 8 of its presale, $BZIL trades at $0.00019906, with over $980k raised and 31 billion tokens sold. Its growing community of more than 3,300 holders reflects strong investor confidence. Early participants may achieve an ROI of 2,548.15% from Stage 8B to the listing price, highlighting BullZilla’s structured presale as a high-growth opportunity for investors seeking substantial returns in the competitive meme coin market.
Maximize Your Returns: BullZilla Dominates as the Top 100x Meme Coin Presale in 2025 While SPX6900 and Shiba Inu Gain Momentum 14
A $1,000 investment today secures approximately 5.023 million $BZIL tokens, with Stage 8C anticipating a price increase to $0.00020573. Strategic features, including staking, referral rewards, and token burns, reinforce scarcity and long-term growth. BullZilla’s strong presale performance, active community engagement, and innovative tokenomics combine to create one of the most promising top 100x meme coin presales. For investors seeking high-return opportunities in 2025, BullZilla offers a structured, high-growth project with significant potential in the competitive crypto World.
How to Join the BullZilla Presale
Joining the BullZilla presale is simple and secure. Investors can visit the official BullZilla website to access step-by-step instructions for purchasing $BZIL tokens. The platform is designed for both beginners and experienced crypto enthusiasts, ensuring smooth transactions. Participants can fund their wallets, select the desired token amount, and confirm their purchase quickly. This streamlined process reduces errors and increases confidence for first-time presale participants, creating a seamless investment experience while supporting the growing BullZilla community.
BullZilla’s HODL Furnace allows token holders to stake their $BZIL for rewards, enhancing long-term investment value. By locking tokens, participants contribute to market stability while earning additional tokens as incentives. Staking reduces circulating supply, which can positively influence token value. This mechanism combines financial benefit with community engagement, encouraging investors to remain committed. Full staking instructions and potential earnings are outlined, making it straightforward for holders to maximize their returns while supporting the project’s growth.
Frequently Asked Questions About BullZilla Presale
Why are presale tokens not showing in my wallet after purchase?
Presale tokens might not appear immediately due to network delays or wallet synchronization issues. It’s recommended to wait a few hours and, if necessary, contact the project’s official support channels for guidance and confirmation.
How can I identify fake Telegram channels about a presale project?
Official channels usually feature verified badges, consistent branding, and links from the project’s website. Avoid channels with minor name differences, unusual activity, or lack of verification, and always cross-check announcements with official sources before acting.
Why could presales be a life-changing instrument?
Presales allow early access to tokens at discounted rates, offering potential high returns if the project succeeds. While the upside can be significant, participants should understand risks, project credibility, and market volatility before investing.
Shiba Inu ($SHIB) Maintains Meme Coin Supremacy
Shiba Inu ($SHIB) continues to dominate the meme coin market. Currently priced at $0.00001050, it has a market capitalization of $6.18 billion and a 24-hour trading volume of $173.8 million. With over 2.87 million holders, SHIB maintains its leading position through strong community engagement and strategic ecosystem developments. Consistent updates, partnerships, and utility-focused projects help preserve investor confidence, ensuring liquidity and long-term relevance while balancing meme coin hype with tangible market growth and adoption.
Frequently Asked Questions About Shiba Inu
What factors contribute to Shiba Inu’s sustained popularity?
Shiba Inu’s lasting popularity is driven by its dedicated community, consistent ecosystem updates, and strategic partnerships. These efforts ensure ongoing engagement, media attention, and investor confidence, helping SHIB maintain relevance and a strong position within the competitive meme coin market.
How does Shiba Inu’s market performance compare to other meme coins?
Despite rising competition from new meme coins, Shiba Inu maintains a strong market presence. Its extensive holder base, active community, and continuous development initiatives help SHIB outperform many rivals in terms of liquidity, visibility, and overall adoption.
Maximize Your Returns: BullZilla Dominates as the Top 100x Meme Coin Presale in 2025 While SPX6900 and Shiba Inu Gain Momentum 15
Conclusion
Recent market activity highlights the continued relevance of meme coins. SPX6900 demonstrates steady growth with strong adoption, while Shiba Inu maintains its massive community and high market cap. Amid these developments, BullZilla’s presale performance, unique tokenomics, and community-driven incentives stand out. Investors participating in BullZilla now benefit from projected high ROI, scarcity mechanisms, and staking rewards. Its combination of hype, utility, and strategy positions it as a leading contender in the top 100x meme coin presales category, capturing both attention and investment potential.
BullZilla showcases how well-structured presales drive early participation and long-term engagement. Mechanisms like the HODL Furnace and Roarblood Vault incentivize investors to contribute actively while ensuring growth sustainability. With over 3,300 holders, $980k raised, and projections exceeding 2,500% ROI, BullZilla presents a tangible, exciting opportunity for investors seeking to maximize returns in the current market World. Strategic involvement now can create substantial rewards as the token launches and the community expands.
Maximize Your Returns: BullZilla Dominates as the Top 100x Meme Coin Presale in 2025 While SPX6900 and Shiba Inu Gain Momentum 16
Secure your stake now – join over 3,300 early investors and claim millions of $BZIL tokens before the next surge.
This article is for informational purposes only and does not constitute financial advice. Readers should conduct their own research before investing in any cryptocurrency or presale project.
Cybersecurity in 2025 is not just the ability to ensure that hackers stay away. It is about securing massive networks, confidential data and millions of online interactions daily that make businesses alive. The world has never been more connected through global enterprise systems and that translates to more entry points to intruders. The 2025 Cost of a Data Breach Report by IBM states that the average breach now costs an organization and its visitors an average of 5.6 million dollars or approximately 15 percent more than it was only two years ago in 2023. That is a definite sign of one thing, that is, traditional methodologies are no longer enough.
This is where the blockchain-based cybersecurity protocols are starting gaining attention. Originally serving as the basis of cryptocurrencies, blockchain is becoming one of the most powerful barriers to enterprise systems. Blockchain is equally powerful in the cybersecurity domain because of the same characteristics that render it the optimal choice in the digital currency industry, transparency, decentralization, and immutability of data.
In this article, we shall endeavor to articulate clearly how blockchain will play its role in security to the large organizations. We are going to cover some of the definitions in the field of cybersecurity that will relate to blockchain, why cybersecurity is becoming such a large portion of 2025, and how it will be used by organizations to mitigate cybersecurity threats.
What Is Blockchain-Based Cybersecurity for Enterprises?
Blockchain can sound like a complicated word. But in simple terms, it means a digital record book that no one can secretly change. All transactions or actions recorded are checked and stored by many different computers at the same time. Even though one computer may be compromised, the “truth” is still safe among the other stored copies.
This is great for organizations. Large organizations run massive IT systems that have thousands of users, partners, and vendors accessing data. They hold financial records, customer data, supply chain documents, etc. If a hacker gets access to a centralized database, they can change or steal the information very easily. But with a blockchain, the control is distributed across the network, making it much harder for a hacker, especially in large organizations.
In a blockchain cybersecurity model, data can be broken into blocks and shared across the network of nodes (virtual), where the nodes will verify the data before being added to the blockchain. Once added, it is not possible to delete or modify it in secret. This makes it perfect for applications that require audit trails, integrity and identity management.
While blockchain is not an alternative to firewalls or antivirus software, it offers additional security similar to the solid base of a trusted solution that assures the data cannot be modified in secret. For example, a company could use blockchain to record every employee login and file access. If a hacker tries to fake an entry, the other nodes will notice the mismatch immediately.
Why Enterprises Are Turning to Blockchain for Cybersecurity in 2025
In 2025, there have already been digital attacks that have never been witnessed. In another instance, Microsoft declared in April 2025 that over 160,000 ransomware assaults took place every day, a rise of 40 percent compared to 2024. In the meantime, Gartner predicts that almost 68 percent of large enterprises will include blockchain as part of its security architecture by 2026.
Businesses are seeking blockchain since it eliminates a significant amount of historic burdens of possessing a digital security feature. The conventional cybersecurity functionality is based on a central database and central administrator. This implies that; in case the central administrator is compromised, the whole system may be compromised. Blockchain is not operated in this manner. No single central administrator can change or manipulate records in secrecy.
Here is a simple comparison that shows why many enterprises are shifting to blockchain-based protocols:
Feature
Traditional Cybersecurity
Blockchain-Based Cybersecurity
Data integrity
Centralized logs that can be changed
Distributed ledger, tamper-proof
Single point of failure
High risk if central server is hacked
Very low, multiple verifying nodes
Audit trail
Often incomplete
Transparent, immutable record
Deployment complexity
Easier setup but limited trust
Needs expertise but stronger trust
Cost trend (2025)
Rising due to more threats
Falling with automation and shared ledgers
As global regulations get tighter, enterprises also need systems that can prove they followed rules correctly. For instance, the European Union’s Digital Resilience Act of 2025 now requires financial firms to keep verifiable digital audit trails. Blockchain helps meet such requirements automatically because every transaction is recorded forever.
Another major reason is insider threats. In a 2025 Verizon Data Breach Report, 27 percent of all corporate breaches came from inside the company. Blockchain helps fix this problem by giving everyone a transparent log of who did what and when.
Key Blockchain Protocols and Technologies Used in Enterprise Cybersecurity
There are two main types of blockchains – permissionless and permissioned. A permissionless blockchain provides access to anyone publicly, for example, Bitcoin or Ethereum. A permissioned blockchain is typically used internally to an organization that only provides access to users with permission. Many enterprises tend to favor permissioned chains because of the security, compliance, and data control.
Let’s take a look at some of the form classes of blockchain technologies that are being used in enterprise cybersecurity today.
Smart contracts are programs that automatically run on the blockchain. A smart contract can execute the rules that are coded in the contract without an administrator needing to take action. For example, the smart contract would not permit an unauthorized user to access the information until an authorized digital key is used. The benefit of smart contracts is that they remove the human from the access granting process as a result limiting human error.
Identity and Access Management (IAM) with Blockchain
Traditional identity systems use central databases, which can be hacked or misused. Blockchain makes identity management decentralized. Each employee or partner gets a cryptographic identity stored on the blockchain. Access permissions can be verified instantly without sending personal data across multiple systems.
Threat Intelligence Sharing on Distributed Ledgers
Many enterprises face the same types of threats, but they rarely share that information in real time. Blockchain allows companies to share verified threat data securely without exposing sensitive details. IBM’s 2025 Enterprise Security Survey found that blockchain-based information sharing cut response time to new cyber attacks by 32 percent across participating companies.
Protocol / Technology
Use Case in Enterprise Security
Main Benefit
Permissioned Blockchain
Secure internal records and data sharing
Controlled access with strong audit trail
Smart Contracts
Automated compliance and access control
No manual errors or delays
Blockchain-IoT Networks
Secure connected devices in factories
Device trust and tamper detection
Decentralized IAM Systems
Employee verification and login
Reduces credential theft
Threat Intelligence Ledger
Global cyber threat data sharing
Real-time awareness and faster defense
How to Design and Deploy Blockchain-Based Cybersecurity Protocols in an Enterprise
Designing a blockchain-based security system takes planning. Enterprises must figure out where blockchain fits best in their cybersecurity setup. It should not replace every system, but rather add strength to the areas that need higher trust, like logs, identity, and access.
A good plan usually moves in stages.
Assessing Cybersecurity Maturity and Blockchain Readiness
Enterprises first need to check their current cybersecurity setup. Some already have strong monitoring systems and access control, others still depend on older tools. Blockchain works best when the company already understands where its weak spots are.
Designing Governance and Access Control
Blockchain does not manage itself. There must be rules about who can join the chain, who can approve updates, and how audits are done. Governance is very important here. If governance is weak, even a strong blockchain system can become unreliable.
Integration with Existing Systems
Enterprises use many other systems like cloud services, databases, and IoT devices. The blockchain layer must work with all of them. This is where APIs and middleware tools come in. They connect the blockchain with normal IT tools.
Testing and Auditing
Once deployed, the new blockchain protocol should be tested under real conditions. Security teams need to simulate attacks and watch how the system reacts. Regular audits should be done to check smart contracts and node performance.
Here is a table that explains the general process:
Phase
Key Tasks
Important Considerations
Phase 1: Planning
Identify data and assets that need blockchain protection
Check data sensitivity and regulations
Phase 2: Design
Choose blockchain type and create smart contracts
Think about scalability and vendor risk
Phase 3: Deployment
Install nodes and connect to IT systems
Staff training and system testing
Phase 4: Monitoring
Watch logs and performance on the chain
Make sure data is synced and secure
The companies that succeed in deploying blockchain for cybersecurity often start small. They begin with one department, like finance or HR, and then expand after proving the results. This gradual rollout helps avoid big technical shocks.
Real-World Use Cases of Blockchain Cybersecurity for Enterprises
By 2025, many global companies already started to use blockchain to protect data. For example, Walmart uses blockchain to secure its supply chain data and verify product origins. Siemens Energy uses blockchain to protect industrial control systems and detect fake device signals. Mastercard has been developing a blockchain framework to manage digital identities and reduce fraud in payment systems.
These real-world examples show how blockchain protocols are not just theory anymore. They are working tools.
Use Case
Industry
Benefits of Blockchain Security
Digital Identity Verification
Finance / Insurance
Lower identity theft and fraud
Supply Chain Data Integrity
Retail / Manufacturing
Prevents tampered records and improves traceability
IIoT Device Authentication
Industrial / Utilities
Protects machine-to-machine communication
Secure Document Exchange
Legal / Healthcare
Reduces leaks of private data
Inter-Company Audits
Banking / IT
Enables transparent, shared audit logs
Each of these use cases solves a specific pain point that traditional security tools struggled with for years. For instance, in industrial IoT networks, devices often communicate without human supervision. Hackers can easily fake a signal and trick systems. Blockchain creates a shared log of all signals and commands. That means even if one device sends false data, others will immediately see the mismatch and stop it from spreading.
In the financial sector, blockchain-based identity systems are helping banks reduce fraudulent applications. A shared digital identity ledger means once a person’s ID is verified by one institution, others can trust it without redoing all checks. This saves both time and cost while improving customer security.
Challenges and Risks When Using Blockchain for Enterprise Cybersecurity
Even though blockchain adds strong layers of protection, it also comes with some new problems. Enterprises must be careful during deployment. Many companies in 2025 found that using blockchain for cybersecurity is not as simple as turning on a switch. It needs planning, training, and coordination.
One of the biggest challenges is integration with older systems. Many large organizations still run software from ten or even fifteen years ago. These systems were never built to connect with distributed ledgers. So when blockchain is added on top, it can create technical issues or data delays.
Another major issue is governance. A blockchain network has many participants. If there is no clear structure on who approves transactions or who maintains the nodes, it can quickly become messy. Without good governance, even the most secure network can fail.
Smart contracts also come with code vulnerabilities. In 2024, over $2.1 billion was lost globally due to faulty or hacked smart contracts (Chainalysis 2025 report). A single programming error can create an entry point for attackers.
Then there is regulation. Legislations regarding blockchain are in their infancy. To illustrate, the National Data Security Framework 2025, which was launched in the U.S., has new reporting requirements of decentralized systems. Now enterprises have to demonstrate the flow of data in their blockchain networks.
Lastly, another threat is quantum computing. The cryptographic systems in the present could soon be broken by quantum algorithms. Although big-scale quantum attack is not occurring as yet, cybersecurity professionals already advise the implementation of post-quantum cryptography within blockchain applications.
Conclusion
Blockchain-based cybersecurity will transform the process of enterprise defense in the digital environment. In a blockchain, trust is encouraged by all members in the network where an organization usually depends on one system or administrator (or both) to keep the trust intact. It might not be short-term and might not be cost effective but it will be long term. In 2025, blockchain will be an enterprise security bargain, providing audit trails that are immutable, decentralized control, secure identities and more rapid breach detection.
Forward-looking organizations will have carbon floor plans, but they will also balance blockchain with Ai and quantum-resistant encryption techniques with conventional security layers. Our focus is not on replacing cybersecurity systems, but on strengthening cybersecurity systems with trustless verification outside of striking distance. In 2025, that is essential as hackers will make attacks and espionage more complex than ever, while blockchain offers something reliable and powerful, transparency that cannot be faked.
Frequently Asked Questions About Blockchain-Based Cybersecurity Protocols
What does blockchain actually do for cybersecurity?
Blockchain keeps records in a shared digital ledger that no one can secretly change. It verifies every action through many computers, which makes data harder to tamper with.
Are blockchain cybersecurity systems expensive for enterprises?
At first, they can be costly because they require integration and new software. But over time, costs drop since there are fewer breaches and less manual auditing.
How does blockchain help in preventing ransomware?
Blockchain prevents tampering and records all activity. If an attacker tries to change a file, the blockchain record shows the exact time and user. It also helps restore clean versions faster.
Is blockchain useful for small companies too?
Yes, but large enterprises benefit the most because they manage complex supply chains and sensitive data. Smaller firms can use simpler blockchain tools for data logging or document verification.
What industries are leading in blockchain cybersecurity adoption?
Financial services, manufacturing, healthcare, and logistics are leading in 2025. These industries need strong auditability and traceable data protection.
Glossary
Blockchain: A decentralized record-keeping system that stores data in blocks linked chronologically.
Smart Contract: Code on a blockchain that runs automatically when certain rules are met.
Node: A computer that helps verify transactions in a blockchain network.
Permissioned Blockchain: A private blockchain where only approved members can join.
Decentralization: Distribution of control among many nodes instead of one central authority.
Immutable Ledger: A record that cannot be changed once added to the blockchain.
Quantum-Resistant Cryptography: Encryption designed to withstand attacks from quantum computers.
Threat Intelligence Ledger: A blockchain system for sharing verified cyber threat data across organizations.
Final Summary
By 2025, blockchain has become a serious tool for cybersecurity in enterprises. From supply chain tracking to digital identity management, it helps companies create trust that cannot be faked. It records every change in a transparent and permanent way, reducing insider risk and external manipulation.
However, blockchain should not replace existing cybersecurity layers. It should work alongside traditional systems, adding trust where it was missing before. As businesses prepare for more advanced digital threats, blockchain stands out as one of the best answers, a shared truth system that protects data even when everything else fails.
In a surprising turn of events, spot ETFs for Litecoin (LTC) and Hedera (HBAR) are now officially effective and will begin trading on NASDAQ tomorrow, according to Canary Funds CEO Steven McClurg. Litecoin and Hedera are the next two token ETFs to go effective after Ethereum, and Canary Funds has confirmed their launch tomorrow.
Additionally, Bloomberg’s Senior ETF Analyst Eric Balchunas confirmed that the NYSE has certified the 8-A filings for multiple crypto ETFs, including Bitwise’s spot Solana ETF (SOL) and Grayscale’s GSOL, which will convert on Wednesday.
He said that the Exchange has posted listing notices for Bitwise Solana, Canary Litecoin, and Canary HBAR to launch tomorrow, and Grayscale Solana to convert the day after. Unless there is last-minute SEC intervention, the launches are moving forward.
How Are ETFs Launching During a Government Shutdown?
This set of ETF approvals has raised questions about how such progress is possible during the ongoing U.S. government shutdown. Journalist Eleanor Terrett explained that certain legal provisions allow ETFs to move forward without active SEC oversight.
Under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Form 8-A filing formally registers ETF shares for exchange trading, while the S-1 filing registers them under the Securities Act of 1933.
The NYSE certified all relevant 8-A filings this morning, marking the final procedural step before trading begins. As for the S-1s, issuers included language allowing their registration statements to automatically go effective 20 days after filing, bypassing the need for manual SEC approval.
This mechanism means ETFs can legally go live even when the SEC staff is unavailable, allowing launches to continue uninterrupted despite the shutdown.
However, not every digital asset community is celebrating.
XRP Community Frustrated as Others Move Ahead
While the crypto market welcomes new ETF launches, XRP investors are once again left behind. Legal expert Bill Morgan noted that delays around XRP have become a recurring theme and that the asset continues to be excluded from major developments.
I had a strong feeling XRP Spot ETFs would not be next. There are always delays when it comes to XRP. Always held back. https://t.co/7Vhzi6Cesv
He also said that XRP’s price generally mirrors Bitcoin’s movements, explaining that even multiple ETF approvals would not necessarily drive the token higher if Bitcoin were to fall.
Traders are betting on a Trump–Xi breakthrough and a dovish Fed pivot to revive “Uptober,” though markets remain wary that rare-earth restrictions and the U.S. shutdown could spoil the rally.
Young Filipino innovators shine at Byte Forward Hackathon 2025, creating digital solutions and proving the nation's tech talent can shape a better future.
Bitcoin’s recent liquidity flush has stirred volatility across the market, leaving traders cautious as Ethereum shows signs of a potential recovery. While BTC struggles to stabilize after clearing key liquidity levels, ETH is attempting to reclaim crucial resistance, setting the stage for what could be the next major directional move in the crypto market.
Market Weakness Persists After $116,000 Liquidity Sweep
Can Özsüer, in his latest BTC 1H Current Chart update shared on X, highlighted that the hourly chart of Bitcoin shows little to no bullish reflection at the moment. He pointed out that market sentiment has weakened, particularly after the $116,000 liquidity zone was cleared, which further dampened the outlook across the broader crypto market.
According to Özsüer, the overall setup remains fragile, and taking scalp long positions in such conditions could be risky until a clearer reversal structure begins to form. Özsüer identified the $111,000 level as a potential zone for an initial reaction buy, suggesting that some short-term support could emerge around this point. However, he cautioned that if this level fails to hold, Bitcoin could experience a sharper decline toward the trendline support near $109,000.
He further advised that traders should construct their strategies carefully, focusing on the zones within what he referred to as “box number 1.” This area could provide a technical framework for identifying potential entry points and managing risk effectively.
To conclude, Özsüer noted that the cleanest and safest approach would be to align trading plans around optimal price levels while ensuring that positions remain protected above the defined support structure.
Bullish Momentum Builds If $4,200 Is Reclaimed
While Bitcoin faces a potential drawdown, crypto analyst Ted Pillows revealed that ETH is currently engaged in a critical fight to reclaim the $4,200 resistance zone. The success of this immediate technical battle is crucial, as it will determine the asset’s trajectory in the days to come.
Ted pillows outlined the condition for a continuation of the rally; if Ethereum is able to decisively reclaim and hold the $4,200 level, traders should “expect more bullish continuation.” Conquering this resistance would likely signal a clear path to the next higher price targets.
Conversely, should ETH fail to secure the $4,200 zone, the price will likely retreat. The analyst predicts that this failure would trigger a necessary retest of the $4,000 level before the market can attempt any further upward moves, indicating that $4,000 acts as the crucial defense line against a deeper correction.
Zcash (ZEC) has exploded in value past $350, clearing its 2021 high and igniting a wave of renewed optimism across the digital assets ecosystem. A surge in demand tied to privacy, cross-chain integration and bold market calls are pushing ZEC into the spotlight.
Rally Driven by Privacy Narrative and Major Price Call
Zcash’s recent rally is nothing short of dramatic. In the past month, ZEC’s price surged roughly 380 % and smashed through its May 2021 closing level of around US$319.
This breakout has drawn fresh attention to the coin’s core value proposition, transaction anonymity, at a time when regulatory scrutiny and surveillance concerns are rising globally.
Adding fuel to the fire, Arthur Hayes, co-founder and former CEO of BitMEX, publicly predicted that ZEC could ultimately reach US$10,000. Markets responded swiftly; within 24 hours of Hayes’s “vibe check” post on X, ZEC jumped over 30 %. The privacy-coin resurgence appears well underway.
Meanwhile, technical analysts argue the rise is more than hype. ZEC’s chart now showcases breakout patterns, rising volumes, and a shift in smart-money positioning. However, caution remains. Many analysts note that although the price is reflecting a strong narrative, actual usage of shielded transactions remains limited.
Zcash (ZEC) Ecosystem Integrations Add Strength
Behind the price action lies concrete ecosystem development. Zcash integration into other chains, such as its wrapped version on Solana, is reviving interest, while new solutions seek to restore ZEC’s full privacy features across cross-chain networks.
For example, the project Encifher is enabling encrypted versions of ZEC (eZEC) using fully homomorphic encryption on Solana so that users can transact privately while still engaging with DeFi.
Other catalysts include the anticipated halving event, which is due to cut miner rewards in mid-November, tightening supply. Added to that, institutional frameworks such as the debut of a trust vehicle for ZEC are reportedly expanding exposure. All told, these structural shifts support the narrative.
Nevertheless, even with infrastructure rising, the risk remains that price is racing ahead of real adoption. Analysts warn of a “sell the news” scenario if new integrations or usage metrics fail to materialize.
Cover image from ChatGPT, ZECUSD chart from Tradingview
Bitcoin (BTC) is showing renewed strength, reclaiming the $115,000 level after weeks of volatility and uncertainty. Bulls are attempting to build momentum for a potential impulse move higher, aiming to confirm a sustained bullish structure after the recent consolidation phase.
On-chain data continues to reveal a clear and repeating pattern tied to investor behavior and market cycles. Historically, when the percentage of Bitcoin supply in profit climbs above 95%, the market tends to enter an overheated phase, often leading to sharp corrections. These pullbacks serve as natural cooling periods, resetting sentiment and liquidity before the next major leg up.
Interestingly, each correction cycle has shown consistent bottoming zones around the 75% threshold, where long-term holders reaccumulate and market confidence begins to rebuild. More specifically, data highlights profit supply lows of 73% in September 2024, 76% in April 2024, and a recent rebound from 81%, signaling a potential mid-cycle recovery phase.
Bitcoin Supply in Profit Rises to 83.6% — Momentum Rebuilds Ahead of Key Threshold
According to top analyst Darkfost, the percentage of Bitcoin supply in profit has started to climb again, currently standing at 83.6%. This steady rise indicates that a growing share of Bitcoin holders are once again sitting on unrealized gains — a trend that often reflects improving sentiment and renewed market confidence.
Darkfost notes that this level can be interpreted as encouraging, suggesting that investors are willing to hold their BTC instead of realizing profits, anticipating further upside in the near term. Historically, such behavior has been characteristic of mid-cycle recovery phases, when fear starts to fade and accumulation resumes across both retail and institutional segments.
This stage of the cycle is considered healthy for rebuilding momentum, as it allows the market to stabilize after large corrections. Holders who previously capitulated often reenter at this stage, while long-term participants strengthen their positions, creating a more resilient market structure.
However, Darkfost cautions that once the supply in profit surpasses 95%, it typically signals overheated market conditions — a point where euphoria tends to replace rational conviction. In such phases, Bitcoin historically faces increased volatility and sharp corrections as overleveraged traders and short-term speculators take profits.
Bitcoin (BTC) is showing renewed bullish momentum, trading around $115,443 and successfully reclaiming key short-term support levels after weeks of consolidation. The daily chart highlights a strong recovery structure, with BTC breaking above both the 50-day and 100-day moving averages, signaling a shift in short-term market sentiment.
The next critical test lies at $117,500, a historical resistance zone that previously rejected multiple attempts in September and early October. A clear breakout and daily close above this level would likely confirm an impulse continuation toward $120K–$125K, opening the door for a more sustained uptrend.
Momentum indicators suggest strengthening buying pressure, while the recent bounce from the 200-day moving average near $107K underscores the market’s resilience. This level acted as a springboard for the current rally, aligning with the broader pattern of accumulation seen on-chain, where investor profitability is rising steadily.
However, BTC remains within a range-bound structure, and rejection at $117.5K could trigger short-term consolidation back toward $111K–$112K. Overall, Bitcoin’s technical outlook appears constructive — if the bulls can sustain above $115K and confirm strength above $117.5K, the market could transition into a new bullish leg, supported by improving investor sentiment and on-chain health.
Featured image from ChatGPT, chart from TradingView.com
Are cryptocurrencies still the ultimate game-changer in finance? Cardano (ADA) continues to spark curiosity among investors, developers, and crypto enthusiasts, as it hovers around $0.689, up 6.09% weekly. The burning question remains whether ADA will surge to new heights or slide into downside fears.
Interestingly, while Cardano draws attention with its blockchain innovations, MoonBull stands out as the best crypto presale, attracting early investors with massive ROI potential. Comparing both highlights the contrast between established tokens like ADA and emerging opportunities with explosive early gains. Market trends, whales, and community buzz are driving both ecosystems, fueling speculation.
MoonBull Dominates as the Best Crypto Presale: Launch, Security, and Massive Gains
MoonBull dominates as the best crypto presale with a launch designed to reward early investors and protect holders. After the final presale stage, liquidity will be supplied to decentralized exchanges, and all $MOBU tokens will be fully claimable immediately following a 48-hour lock, with no vesting delays.
Cardano Price Prediction: Could ADA Hit $2 While MoonBull Surges With 9,256% ROI as the Best Crypto Presale in Q4 2025? 21
To stabilize the launch, a 60-minute claim delay requires any sell to be matched with a buy, preventing price drops and immediate dump pressure. Built on Ethereum’s ERC-20 standard, $MOBU ensures deep liquidity, seamless wallet access, staking, reflections, burns, and sell taxes. Leveraging Ethereum’s validator network and audit infrastructure, MoonBull thrives with scalability, cross-chain tools, governance frameworks, and broad ecosystem interoperability.
MoonBull Stage 5: $500 Investment Could Yield $46,780 in $MOBU Presale
MoonBull’s $MOBU presale is heating up, currently in Stage 5 with a price of $0.00006584, over $500K raised, and 1,500+ token holders. Early buyers already enjoy 163.36% ROI, while Stage 5 to listing at $0.00616 projects a staggering 9,256% return. Investing $500 now secures 7,594,167.68 $MOBU tokens, potentially earning $46,780 at listing.
Each presale stage rises by 27.40% until Stage 22, with Stage 23 increasing 20.38%. The presale’s structured growth and limited supply create urgency and FOMO, making MoonBull a must-watch opportunity for crypto enthusiasts seeking high early-stage returns and maximum ROI potential.
Cardano (ADA) Current Price and Market Overview
Cardano (ADA) today’s price stands at $0.689766 with a 24-hour trading volume of $837 million, reflecting steady demand despite broader crypto market swings. The seven-day price movement shows a 6.09% increase, indicating short-term momentum in ADA trading. Analysts note that institutional participation and staking adoption are supporting the current price. Cardano (ADA) live price movements suggest that technical levels near $0.77 may serve as resistance, while $0.60 remains critical support.
Cardano Price Prediction: Could ADA Hit $2 While MoonBull Surges With 9,256% ROI as the Best Crypto Presale in Q4 2025? 22
Crypto developers and financial analysts monitor these metrics to anticipate potential breakouts or corrections. With the ecosystem maturing and DApps gaining traction, Cardano’s crypto price presents a blend of opportunity and caution, especially as new investors compare it with presales like MoonBull.
Cardano (ADA) Price Prediction for 2025
Cardano (ADA) price forecast for 2025 points to a potential trading range between $0.76 and $1.80, depending on adoption and market sentiment. Optimistic projections suggest ADA could reach $2 if blockchain developments such as scalability upgrades and interoperability features succeed. Analysts argue that if Cardano maintains support levels, institutional inflows may accelerate growth.
Conversely, risks include market volatility, regulatory changes, and short-term corrections. Social media chatter and retail sentiment indicate cautious optimism, with many investors eyeing ADA as a long-term hold. Compared to MoonBull, which has explosive presale stages and an early ROI of 9256%, ADA may seem slower, yet it offers stability and proven blockchain infrastructure, making it suitable for moderate risk investors.
Technical Analysis and Market Trends
Technical analysis of Cardano (ADA) highlights a symmetrical triangle pattern, with resistance near $0.77 and support at $0.60. Breaking above $0.77 could indicate bullish momentum, while falling below $0.60 may trigger short-term declines. Trading volumes have slightly declined, signaling the need for buyers to push momentum higher.
Price indicators such as the RSI suggest ADA is not overbought, leaving room for gradual appreciation. Historically, ADA has seen repeated cycles of growth and corrections, and investors are advised to monitor trendlines closely. Meanwhile, MoonBull dominates as the best crypto presale by offering structured stages, increasing prices by 27.40% per stage, making early entry a high-risk, high-reward contrast to ADA’s measured market moves.
Cardano Price Prediction: Could ADA Hit $2 While MoonBull Surges With 9,256% ROI as the Best Crypto Presale in Q4 2025? 23
Conclusion
In conclusion, Cardano (ADA) offers a solid, mature blockchain with potential upside, supported by institutional interest and upcoming network upgrades. Its price forecast for 2025 ranges from $0.76 to $1.80, appealing to long-term investors seeking stability. In contrast, MoonBull dominates as the best crypto presale, providing early participants with significant ROI and FOMO-driven urgency.
Both present valuable opportunities: ADA with measured growth and MoonBull with explosive potential. Investors must weigh risk tolerance, investment goals, and market timing. Whether focusing on Cardano’s blockchain fundamentals or MoonBull’s presale hype, informed research remains key to navigating the evolving crypto landscape successfully.
Cardano Price Prediction: Could ADA Hit $2 While MoonBull Surges With 9,256% ROI as the Best Crypto Presale in Q4 2025? 24
The best crypto to buy now depends on risk appetite and market conditions. Presales with structured stages like MoonBull offer high ROI potential, while established coins like Cardano provide more stability and long-term growth prospects.
How can investors identify the next breakout crypto?
Monitoring presale structures, social engagement, and blockchain fundamentals helps identify breakout crypto. MoonBull presale demonstrates early-stage growth, whereas established coins rely on adoption and institutional interest to drive price.
Which crypto presale offers maximum early-stage gains?
Presales with tiered pricing and strong community incentives deliver maximum early-stage gains. MoonBull presale stages, increasing 27.40% per stage, ensure early investors can achieve substantial ROI compared to other cryptos.
How does institutional interest affect crypto price?
Institutional participation improves liquidity, stability, and market confidence. Cardano benefits from ETF and large fund interest, whereas presales like MoonBull rely on retail investors and community hype to fuel momentum.
Is it safer to invest in established coins or new presales?
Established coins like ADA offer security, proven tech, and steady growth. New presales like MoonBull dominate the hype space, providing high ROI but with increased risk. Diversified strategies are often recommended.
Glossary of Key Terms
ADA: Native token of the Cardano blockchain. ERC-20: Ethereum standard for creating tokens. Liquidity Pool: Funds locked in smart contracts for decentralized trading. Staking: Locking tokens to support blockchain network operations. Presale: Early offering of a crypto token before public trading.
Article Summary
This article analyzed Cardano (ADA) price prediction for 2025, including market trends, technical analysis, institutional interest, and upcoming upgrades. MoonBull dominates as the best crypto presale, providing structured stages, massive ROI, and Ethereum security. While ADA offers stability, MoonBull brings explosive potential, allowing investors to balance risk and reward in the evolving crypto market.
Ever notice how crypto news now reads like a movie trailer? Bitcoin smashing $115K, Avalanche breaking $20, and a newcomer called BullZilla roaring through presale milestones, it’s a full-blown blockbuster. This November, the market’s rhythm feels electric, driven by ETF inflows, election speculation, and new-age presales redefining investing. Whether you’re holding Bitcoin or hunting the next big presale gem, the action is heating up. Amid this chaos, investors are asking: which project truly stands tall among the top crypto to buy for November?
Bitcoin’s steady climb has re-ignited faith in digital gold, Avalanche is fueling DeFi revival, and BullZilla is engineering the presale era’s most explosive ROI mechanism. From traders chasing stability to investors eyeing early-stage profits, these three projects dominate November’s spotlight. Bitcoin brings scale and certainty, Avalanche carries DeFi speed, and BullZilla delivers early-entry advantage. Together, they define the evolving balance between security and opportunity. But only one offers structured scarcity designed for exponential returns, and that’s where the BullZilla story begins.
Only BullZilla Projects 2,548% Roi, Join Stage 8 Before The Next 3.35% Surge!
Bitcoin Soars Above $115K as Institutional Demand Fuels Market Revival
Bitcoin (BTC) surged 2.89% over the past 24 hours to reach $115,015, accompanied by a remarkable 169% spike in daily trading volume to $59.58 billion. This sharp increase reflects renewed investor confidence driven by institutional inflows and strong ETF demand. Analysts attribute Bitcoin’s momentum to improving macroeconomic conditions, lower Treasury yields, and growing optimism surrounding broader crypto adoption. As the leading digital asset, Bitcoin remains the ultimate benchmark for market sentiment and liquidity. Its gradual climb toward the $126K peak demonstrates sustained strength amid global uncertainty. Despite smaller percentage moves than those of emerging altcoins, Bitcoin continues to serve as a stabilizing force for portfolios worldwide, offering long-term security, deep liquidity, and unmatched recognition as the cornerstone of the modern crypto economy.
Frequently Asked Questions about Bitcoin
What drives Bitcoin’s current surge?
Bitcoin’s surge is fueled by strong ETF inflows, rising institutional participation, and easing macroeconomic pressures. These factors have restored investor confidence, propelling BTC closer to its previous $126,000 all-time high.
Is Bitcoin still the safest crypto investment?
Yes. Bitcoin remains the most secure and recognized cryptocurrency, backed by deep liquidity, regulatory clarity, and institutional adoption, making it a stable long-term store of value compared to emerging altcoins.
BullZilla ($BZIL): The Presale Revolution and Top Crypto to Buy for November
BullZilla ($BZIL) isn’t just another presale; it’s redefining what the top crypto to buy for November truly means. Now in Stage 8 (Echoes of the Bull-A, Phase 2), each token trades at $0.00019906. The project has already raised over $980,000, sold 31 billion tokens, and attracted more than 3,300 holders globally. Analysts forecast a 2,548.15% ROI to its $0.00527 listing, while early entrants already enjoy 3,361.91% gains. A $1,000 investment secures 5.023 million tokens before the next 3.35% surge hits. Through The HODL Furnace, investors can stake tokens for flexible durations, earning compounding rewards while contributing to deflation. With over 32 billion tokens allocated for staking, holders generate passive income while strengthening liquidity and project resilience.
Crypto Price Today (27th Oct): BTC Nears $116K, AVAX Eyes $30, Yet All Eyes are On BullZilla, The Top Crypto to Buy for November 28
ROI Projection – $1,500 BullZilla Investment Could Soar to Nearly $40,000
A $1,500 investment at the current Stage 8 price nets around 7.53 million $BZIL tokens. If projections to the $0.00527 listing hold, this could translate to roughly $39,700 in value, a 2,548% increase. Such exponential potential stems from BullZilla’s Progressive Price Engine, which lifts value every 48 hours or when $100K is raised. Coupled with the Roar Burn mechanism and staking features, it builds mechanical scarcity into the ecosystem, driving both long-term token appreciation and short-term presale demand.
How to Join the BullZilla Presale
Start by setting up a Web3 wallet, such as MetaMask or Trust Wallet. Buy ETH on an exchange such as Binance or Coinbase, then transfer it to your wallet. Then visit BullZilla’s official presale site, connect your wallet, and swap ETH for $BZIL. Your tokens will be securely locked until the presale ends, then claimable. Vesting schedules are fully transparent on the platform. Joining early ensures the highest ROI potential and access to referral rewards through the exclusive Roarblood Vault program.
Frequently Asked Questions about BullZilla Presale
What makes BullZilla different from other presales?
BullZilla stands out with its 24-stage burn model, Roar Burn mechanism, and Progressive Price Engine, ensuring automatic scarcity, transparent growth, and consistent upward pricing rarely seen in conventional meme or presale tokens.
How secure is the BullZilla presale?
BullZilla’s smart contracts are fully audited and transparent. Investors maintain complete wallet control, while vesting mechanisms promote fairness and protect against early dumps or sudden market volatility.
Can I earn rewards by referring others?
Yes. Through the Roarblood Vault, investors can earn up to 12% referral bonuses for bringing in new buyers, strengthening community growth and increasing presale participation before the token listing.
Join 3,300+ Investors Before Stage 8 Ends, The Next 3.35% Surge Could Boost ROI Past 2,550%!
Crypto Price Today (27th Oct): BTC Nears $116K, AVAX Eyes $30, Yet All Eyes are On BullZilla, The Top Crypto to Buy for November 29
Avalanche Breaks $20 Barrier as Bulls Eye $30 Rally and $40M Short Squeeze
Avalanche (AVAX) recently broke through the critical $20 threshold after weeks of consolidation, confirming the start of a sustained bullish continuation. Currently trading at $19.71 and up 1.66% in the last 24 hours, AVAX appears poised for a potential rally toward the $30 zone. Analysts believe that once it clears the $22 resistance level, roughly $40 million in short positions could be liquidated, accelerating upward momentum. With a robust DeFi footprint and expanding subnet ecosystem, Avalanche continues to attract developers, institutional investors, and liquidity providers. Consistent higher lows since $18.50 reinforce its strong technical foundation, positioning it as one of the most resilient, innovative, and scalable blockchain networks in 2025, capable of driving long-term growth across decentralized applications and cross-chain integrations.
Frequently Asked Questions about Avalanche Coin
Why is Avalanche gaining traction again?
Avalanche’s move past $20 highlights renewed investor confidence driven by its scalable architecture, ultra-fast transactions, and expanding DeFi ecosystem, positioning AVAX as one of the most efficient and adopted Layer-1 networks.
What’s next for AVAX price targets?
If Avalanche sustains momentum above $22, analysts anticipate a breakout toward the $25–$30 range, supported by increasing institutional accumulation and strengthening on-chain activity across DeFi and enterprise integrations.
Conclusion
Bitcoin’s 2.89% jump reflects renewed macro optimism, Avalanche’s $20 breakout signals DeFi resurgence, and BullZilla’s Stage 8 success redefines what presale strength looks like. Together, these cryptos show a market evolving beyond volatility into structured opportunity. The November narrative highlights balance, stability from Bitcoin, scalability from Avalanche, and exponential growth from BullZilla. As the presale scene matures, projects offering real mechanics, transparency, and utility stand out as the actual top crypto to buy for November.
BullZilla’s engineered scarcity and price progression present a modern blueprint for long-term value creation. While Bitcoin and Avalanche attract traditional confidence, BullZilla captures the excitement of structured ROI. Its 24-stage burn mechanism, staking systems, and referral rewards create a balanced ecosystem of reward and scarcity. As the next 3.35% price rise nears, the presale’s explosive start underscores one message: opportunity favors the early. BullZilla might just be the beast leading the next bull wave.
Don’t Wait, BullZilla’s Stage 8 Presale Is Almost Full! Secure Tokens Now Before The Next 3.35% Surge Hits
Crypto Price Today (27th Oct): BTC Nears $116K, AVAX Eyes $30, Yet All Eyes are On BullZilla, The Top Crypto to Buy for November 30
The eight-hour outage occurred during the largest liquidation event in crypto history, prompting dYdX to propose community-governed reimbursements from its insurance fund.
Citi partnered with Coinbase to pilot stablecoin payments as the bank forecasts a $4 trillion market by 2030, signaling Wall Street’s growing crypto embrace.
Just a few weeks after a Singaporean court approved WazirX's parent company's restructuring plan, a decision out of one of India's courts may impact users.
The Bitcoin price is positioning for a potentially explosive move that could take it well beyond its previous all-time highs. Analysts are closely watching a critical resistance level near $116,000, which may serve as the final hurdle before BTC catapults into uncharted territory above $126,000.
Analyst Predicts New Bitcoin Price All-Time High
Crypto analyst Donny Dicey revealed in an X social media post this week that the $116,000 price level is the decisive zone Bitcoin must breach to confirm a breakout toward a new all-time high. His technical analysis suggests that once BTC achieves a clean break above this resistance area, momentum could swiftly carry it above $126,000.
Notably, Bitcoin set a new ATH on October 6, 2025, after breaking through its previous record above $124,000 and climbing past $126,000. Since achieving this level, the price of BTC has fallen dramatically to $115,000. Dicey’s accompanying chart shows the market steadily recovering after testing support near $108,000, marked as a “market structure break” region, with bullish price action consolidating above $109,000.
The analyst has emphasized that each day Bitcoin maintains a close above $109,000 strengthens the probability of a strong upward swing as the market heads into November. This period coincides with the Federal Open Market Committee’s (FOMC) next meeting, where investors are anticipating dovish signals such as rate cuts or the formal end of Quantitative Tightening (QT).
Dicey also notes that bullish S&P 500 earnings, easing global trade tensions from a potential agreement between US President Donald Trump and China’s President Xi Jinping, and improving ISM manufacturing data point to a macro environment supportive of risk assets. A community member commented that whales may have underestimated how much BTC’s demand tends to persist during these conditions. Dicey responded that the same whales might become “exit liquidity” as Bitcoin accelerates higher, possibly missing out on the strongest phase of this cycle.
Consolidation Above January Highs Signal Unbreakable Strength
In a follow-up analysis, Dicey highlighted Bitcoin’s remarkable stability above its January highs, describing its price structure as “unbreakable” amid global macroeconomic uncertainty. He pointed to several converging factors that reinforce BTC’s resilience, including ongoing fiscal and monetary expansion, a weakening US dollar, and renewed confidence in the global business cycle.
The analyst also emphasized that geopolitical tensions tied to US-China relations appear to be subsiding. At the same time, ETF inflows and exponential growth in the Artificial Intelligence (AI) sector contribute to acting as tailwinds for digital assets. He disclosed that despite strong underlying fundamentals, skepticism remains widespread in the market.
According to him, many still believe in the traditional four-year cycle narrative, while retail enthusiasm has not fully returned. Furthermore, the Russell 2000 index has yet to breakout, and rotation from traditional assets, such as the S&P 500 and gold, into Bitcoin remains limited. With these developments subduing broader market participation, Dicey suggests it creates the perfect setup for a powerful rally in BTC once sentiment shifts decisively.
After months of growing uncertainty and anticipation, the debut of exchange-traded funds (ETFs) for Hedera (HBAR) and Litecoin (LTC) is set to commence tomorrow, as confirmed by Canary Capital’s CEO Steven McClurg on Monday.
Hedera And Litecoin ETF Launches Imminent
Crypto reporter Eleanor Terret shared the news on X (formerly Twitter), revealing that the ETF launches for Litecoin and Hedera are imminent, with a statement from McClurg underscoring the excitement for the upcoming launch.
Notably, the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) has also made significant moves in the ETF sector by certifying 8-A filings and issuing listing notices for Bitwise Invest’s spot Solana (SOL) ETF launch tomorrow and Grayscale’s GSOL conversion slated for Wednesday.
Despite the ongoing government shutdown, these ETF debuts are proceeding smoothly, Terret confirmed. The legal processes behind ETF launches, including the crucial 8-A filings, have been completed successfully, paving the way for the launch of these investment vehicles.
ETF Listings Confirmed
Addressing concerns about Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) approval during the shutdown, a key detail emerged: the issuers strategically included provisions in their amended S-1 filings, enabling automatic effectiveness 20 days post-filing. This ensures a seamless transition to trading without manual SEC approval.
Bloomberg’s ETF expert, Eric Balchunas, further corroborated this development on social media, confirming the listing notices for Bitwise, Canary, to launch imminently, with grayscale Solana’s conversion scheduled shortly after. Balchunas stated, “Assuming there’s not some last min SEC intervention, looks like this is happening.”
The news has sparked a recovery in HBAR and LTC prices. Litecoin has regained the key $100 mark with a 2% surge in the 24-hour time frame, while Hedera has seen similar gains of 2.1% during the same period.
Featured image from DALL-E, chart from TradingView.com
XRP is staging a remarkable rebound, rising from early October lows of $1.77 to over $2.60, even as the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) prolongs its review of pending XRP ETF filings.
The delays have sparked mixed market sentiment, yet XRP’s trading volume and technical setup indicate growing bullish momentum. Over the weekend, XRP surged to $2.68, breaking critical resistance at $2.63 on a 147% volume spike, one of the largest in recent months.
This explosive move coincided with renewed optimism following Ripple’s strategic acquisitions, including the integration of Ripple Prime and GTreasury, which CEO Brad Garlinghouse said place XRP “at the center of everything Ripple does.”
Technical Indicators Strengthen the Bullish Outlook
From a technical perspective, XRP’s chart paints a clear bullish picture. The token has moved firmly above both its 50-day and 200-day exponential moving averages (EMAs), key indicators of trend continuation.
It has also formed an inverse head-and-shoulders pattern, historically signaling potential for higher highs. The Relative Strength Index (RSI) remains near 70, showing strong demand despite slightly overbought conditions.
Analysts expect a confirmed breakout above $2.70 to set the stage for XRP to reach the $2.90–$3.00 range in the near term. Momentum indicators such as the True Strength Index (TSI) and rising open interest in CME XRP futures, which recently crossed $27 billion in notional volume, reinforce this bullish outlook.
However, traders are watching the $2.54–$2.58 support zone closely. A drop below this range could weaken momentum and invite short-term corrections.
Institutional Flows Signal Confidence in XRP’s Future
While ETF delays have briefly dented sentiment, institutional accumulation around XRP remains strong. The token’s rapid integration into U.S.-listed ETFs, expanding derivatives markets, and corporate adoption, including Evernorth’s treasury allocation, underscore growing confidence in Ripple’s long-term fundamentals.
Institutional demand continues to accelerate through vehicles like the REX-Osprey XRP ETF, which recently surpassed $100 million in assets under management, placing XRP as a mainstream financial instrument rather than a speculative token.
With global crypto market capitalization hovering near $3.8 trillion and the Federal Reserve’s upcoming rate decision expected to ease liquidity constraints, analysts believe XRP could outperform peers in the next leg of the bull cycle.
If buying pressure holds above $2.70, the $2.90 breakout target may only mark the beginning of a broader rally, one that cements XRP’s role at the heart of institutional digital finance.
In August 2021 a huge event happened; Poly Network got hit. Over $600 million vanishes in one of crypto’s biggest heists. The vulnerability? Something proper testing would have caught easily. This wasn’t some sophisticated zero-day exploit requiring nation-state resources. It was a bug sitting there in plain sight, waiting for someone to notice.
Here’s what makes this worse: smart contract bugs are permanent. You can’t hotfix blockchain code like patching a web server. Once deployed, that’s it. The code lives forever in that exact form. And we’re not talking about broken images or 404 errors here. We’re talking about actual money disappearing, real financial damage that can’t be undone. Think about the Wormhole bridge losing $320 million, or Ronin Network’s $625 million disaster. Every single one could have been prevented with better testing.
Why We Test And Debug Smart Contracts
Blockchains don’t allow quiet hotfixes. Once a contract is out, it behaves as written, not as intended. Thorough testing cuts catastrophic risk, speeds reviews with executable documentation, and gives auditors a cleaner target. It also exposes design gaps while fixes are still cheap.
Attackers are motivated and methodical. Your suite should model adversaries, not polite users. Determinism is your ally: you can replay the same failing path, capture it as a regression, and never trip on it again. Over time, this turns panic into process and folklore into tests.
Why Testing Smart Contracts is Actually Different
Traditional software gives you room for mistakes. Your web app crashes? Push a fix in an hour. Database gets corrupted? Restore from backup. Smart contracts don’t work that way. Deploy buggy code and you’re stuck with it forever, watching helplessly as attackers drain funds while you frantically try implementing emergency measures.
The financial aspect changes everything about how we think about bugs. In normal software, a bug might annoy users or crash their session. Common smart contract bugs can empty wallets in seconds. And here’s the thing people don’t talk about enough: gas costs create this whole additional testing dimension. Inefficient code doesn’t just run slower, it literally costs your users money every single time they interact with your contract. Users will absolutely abandon your dApp if transactions cost $50 in gas, regardless of how brilliant your features are.
Testing requirements get more complex because everything happens in public. Your code sits there on the blockchain where anyone can read it, analyze it, and look for vulnerabilities. Attack vectors that would never occur to you become obvious when thousands of people with financial incentives start examining your contracts. This public scrutiny means your testing needs to be absolutely paranoid, assuming attackers will find any weakness you miss.
How Smart Contract Bugs Hurt Users — From Drained Funds to High Gas Costs
Setting Up Your Smart Contract Testing Environment
Hardhat: The Industry Standard
Hardhat testing has pretty much won the framework wars for Ethereum development. The JavaScript and TypeScript integration just works smoothly, and the testing suite includes everything you actually need. Assertions make sense, contract deployment is straightforward, and console.log actually functions in Solidity which still feels like magic. Most production teams use Hardhat because it’s reliable and doesn’t fight you.
Foundry: Speed and Solidity-Native Testing
Foundry offers something different. Tests run incredibly fast, like 10-100x faster than JavaScript frameworks. More interesting though: you write tests in Solidity itself. No more switching between JavaScript test syntax and Solidity contract logic. Your brain stays in one place. The ecosystem is younger, documentation can be sparse, but teams obsessed with speed swear by it.
Local Blockchain Simulators
Local blockchain simulators are non-negotiable. Hardhat Network comes bundled with Hardhat and simulates Ethereum accurately, including proper gas calculations and network conditions. Anvil does the same for Foundry users with even better performance. Ganache still has fans, especially for the GUI that visualizes what’s happening with blockchain state during tests. Each resets state between tests automatically, which saves you from debugging mysterious test failures caused by leftover state from previous runs.
Essential Supporting Tools
Beyond frameworks, you need supporting tools. Hardhat Gas Reporter shows exactly where gas gets consumed so you can optimize intelligently. Solidity-coverage identifies untested code paths. Static analysis tools like Slither should run from day one, catching obvious security problems before you even start writing tests. OpenZeppelin Test Helpers provide utilities for handling time-dependent functions, big number math, and event checking that would otherwise require writing tons of boilerplate.
Writing Unit Tests That Actually Matter
Solidity unit testing verifies individual functions work correctly in isolation. Each test sets up conditions, executes one function, and checks the results match expectations. The pattern is simple: Arrange your test data, Act by calling the function, Assert the results are correct. Keeping tests focused on one behavior makes debugging failures trivial because you know exactly what broke.
// Hardhat testing example
describe(“TokenContract”, function() {
it(“transfers tokens between accounts correctly”, async function() {
Testing happy paths where everything works is just the start. The real bugs hide in edge cases. What happens when transferring zero tokens? What about the maximum uint256 value? What if someone passes the zero address? Each edge case is a potential vulnerability waiting to be exploited. Boundary testing catches off-by-one errors and weird behavior at limits that normal usage never triggers.
Failure scenarios need as much attention as success cases. Verify functions revert with appropriate errors when given invalid inputs. Check that unauthorized users get rejected properly. Test what happens when funds are insufficient or contracts are paused. These negative tests often reveal the most critical security issues because they verify your defensive programming actually works.
Smart contracts have unique testing requirements beyond normal functions. Events communicate state changes and provide the primary interface for external monitoring. Test that events emit with correct parameters. State changes need thorough verification because blockchain state is permanent and expensive. Access control mechanisms demand exhaustive testing since they protect critical functions from unauthorized access. Modifiers should be tested independently to ensure they correctly validate conditions before allowing function execution.
// Foundry testing example
function testTransferRevertsWhenBalanceInsufficient() public {
vm.expectRevert(“Insufficient balance”);
token.transfer(address(1), 1000);
}
Integration Testing Complex Contract Systems
Integration testing verifies multiple contracts working together as a system. Real applications almost never consist of one contract. DeFi protocols combine tokens, lending pools, price oracles, governance, and more. Integration tests catch problems that unit tests miss entirely because they test actual system behavior rather than isolated components.
Setting up realistic test scenarios takes work. Deploy all contracts in proper order with correct initialization. Test complete user flows from beginning to end, like depositing collateral, borrowing against it, accruing interest, and repaying. Mock external dependencies when real ones are impractical. Testing with actual Chainlink oracles during development is expensive and slow; mock oracles give you control and speed.
Different contract patterns need specific testing approaches. Factory patterns that deploy contracts programmatically require verifying both factory logic and deployed contract functionality. Proxy patterns used for upgradeability need tests confirming proxies delegate correctly and upgrades preserve state without corruption. Multi-signature wallets demand testing all threshold scenarios and signature validation edge cases that could allow unauthorized access.
Fuzz Testing Discovers What You Miss
Fuzz testing automates finding edge cases you’d never think to write manually. Instead of specifying exact test inputs, you define properties that must always hold true. The fuzzer then generates thousands of random inputs trying to violate those properties. This discovers entire bug categories that traditional testing overlooks.
Foundry’s built-in fuzzing makes this accessible. Mark function parameters for fuzzing and Foundry generates test cases automatically. Write assertions about invariants that should hold regardless of inputs. The fuzzer hammers your contract with random values, looking for assertion failures.
// Foundry fuzz test example
function testTransferNeverChangesTotalSupply(address to, uint256 amount) public {
Echidna takes fuzzing further with longer execution sequences and more sophisticated invariant checking. Real vulnerabilities get caught this way. Fuzzing found integer overflow bugs before Solidity 0.8.0 added automatic protection. Reentrancy vulnerabilities emerge when fuzzers test malicious callback patterns. Access control flaws appear when fuzzers try calling restricted functions from random addresses with random parameters.
Debugging When Tests Fail or Transactions Revert
Smart contract debugging starts when something breaks. Transactions revert without clear reasons. Gas consumption explodes unexpectedly. State doesn’t update as planned. Events fail to emit. Each symptom points to different debugging approaches.
Hardhat’s console.log brings familiar debugging patterns to Solidity. Import the library and drop console.log statements directly into contract code during development. Watch variable values and execution flow in ways external tools can’t provide. Just remember to remove them before production since they add gas costs and clutter.
import “hardhat/console.sol”;
function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) public {
Tenderly’s transaction simulator becomes essential for complex debugging. Paste any transaction hash and see complete execution traces with every function call, state change, and gas cost. The visual debugger lets you step through execution line by line. You can simulate transactions before sending them, catching problems without spending gas or waiting for confirmations.
Block explorers provide transaction traces that often solve production mysteries. Etherscan shows input data, emitted events, internal transactions, and state changes for any transaction. Failed transactions display revert reasons if contracts include descriptive error messages. Learning to read these traces quickly separates developers who ship from developers who struggle.
Remix’s debugger excels for step-by-step analysis. Deploy contracts in Remix, execute transactions, open the debugger. Step through every operation while watching stack, memory, and storage evolve. The visual representation makes complex execution flows comprehensible in ways text debuggers can’t match.
Advanced techniques include time-travel debugging with snapshots. Hardhat and Foundry let you snapshot blockchain state, run experiments, then revert perfectly. Test time-dependent functions without waiting. Try destructive operations without permanent effects. For deployed contracts, fork mainnet locally to test against real contracts and actual state without any risk.
Security Testing Against Common Vulnerabilities
Security-focused testing targets specific attack patterns rather than just checking functionality. Reentrancy attacks exploit external calls that recursively callback before state updates complete. Test this explicitly by deploying malicious contracts that attempt reentrancy, verifying your guards actually prevent the attack.
// Testing reentrancy protection
contract MaliciousContract {
VulnerableContract target;
function attack() public {
target.withdraw();
}
receive() external payable {
if (address(target).balance > 0) {
target.withdraw(); // Attempting reentrancy
}
}
}
Static analysis tools like Slither automate vulnerability scanning. Slither examines code without executing it, spotting patterns indicating problems. Run it before every deployment to catch reentrancy risks, unchecked external calls, access control mistakes, and optimization opportunities. Integration into CI/CD pipelines means every pull request gets scanned automatically.
Integer issues still matter for older Solidity versions or unchecked blocks. Test arithmetic operations with maximum values ensuring proper overflow handling. Access control testing verifies restricted functions reject unauthorized callers. Front-running tests manipulate transaction ordering to verify contracts behave correctly regardless of sequence. Oracle manipulation testing uses extreme price values, confirming contracts handle volatility without catastrophic failures.
Mock oracles during testing give control over returned values, letting you test edge cases that rarely occur naturally but could be exploited. Test with price crashes, spikes, and stale data to verify your contract degrades gracefully rather than breaking catastrophically.
Gas Optimization and Performance Testing
Gas testing matters because inefficient contracts cost users money. People abandon dApps with ridiculous gas fees regardless of features. Testing identifies bottlenecks and verifies optimizations reduce costs without breaking functionality.
Hardhat Gas Reporter tracks consumption automatically during tests. Configure it, run tests, get detailed reports showing gas usage per function. Compare implementations choosing the most efficient. Foundry’s built-in profiling provides even more granular breakdowns of where gas gets consumed.
Storage operations cost dramatically more than memory or stack operations. Test that moving frequently accessed data to memory reduces costs without changing behavior. Loop optimizations multiply gas costs with iterations. Verify optimizations don’t introduce off-by-one errors or skip operations. Batch operations combining multiple actions into single transactions reduce overhead, but need testing to ensure atomic behavior remains correct.
Testing optimizations systematically prevents regressions. Write tests for original functionality, optimize code, verify tests still pass, check gas consumption decreased. This methodical approach catches optimizations that reduce gas while silently introducing bugs nobody notices until production.
Continuous Integration Automates Quality Control
Continuous Integration catches problems before production. GitHub Actions provides free CI/CD for public repositories and works excellently for smart contract testing. Configure workflows running on every commit and pull request, executing complete test suites automatically without human intervention.
# GitHub Actions workflow
name: Smart Contract Tests
on: [push, pull_request]
jobs:
test:
runs-on: ubuntu-latest
steps:
– uses: actions/checkout@v2
– uses: actions/setup-node@v2
– run: npm install
– run: npx hardhat test
– run: npx hardhat coverage
– run: npx slither .
Pre-deployment checks prevent disasters. Require passing tests before allowing merges to main branches. Run Slither on every pull request, failing builds if critical vulnerabilities appear. Check test coverage enforcing minimum thresholds, typically 90% on critical contracts and 80% overall. Verify gas consumption stays reasonable by failing builds if costs increase unexpectedly without justification.
Deployment testing validates contracts in production-like environments. Deploy to testnets automatically through CI/CD pipelines and run integration tests against deployed contracts. Mainnet forking tests against actual production state without risk or cost. Post-deployment monitoring watches for unexpected behavior, failed transactions, or suspicious activity patterns requiring investigation.
Best Practices That Prevent Problems
Test-Driven Development writes tests before implementing features. This ensures testable code design and comprehensive coverage from the start. Each test verifies one specific behavior, making failures immediately obvious and fixes straightforward. Use descriptive test names explaining what gets tested and expected behavior clearly.
Maintain test independence so tests run in any order without interference. Tests depending on previous test state create debugging nightmares with intermittent failures. Keep tests fast by avoiding unnecessary blockchain operations and using fixtures for common setup scenarios. Fast tests encourage running the suite frequently during development, catching regressions immediately.
Common Mistakes to Avoid
Insufficient coverage leaves vulnerabilities for production.
Only testing happy paths ignores errors, edge cases, and invalid inputs.
Unrealistic test data masks performance issues in real use.
Ignoring gas costs creates painful UX at launch.
Skipping boundary tests lets off-by-one and limit bugs slip through.
Code Review and Collaboration
Review tests alongside implementation to confirm they assert the right things.
Pair testing surfaces hidden assumptions and logic gaps. Security-focused reviews target access control, reentrancy, and known vuln patterns.
Common Testing Mistakes in Smart Contract Development You Should Avoid
Professional Testing Workflow From Dev to Deploy
Professional workflows follow systematic processes from development to deployment. Start with unit tests for new functionality before implementing features. This Test-Driven Development approach ensures testable design and comprehensive coverage naturally. Run unit tests frequently during development catching regressions immediately when they’re cheapest to fix.
After unit tests pass, run integration tests verifying contracts work together correctly. Integration tests catch interface mismatches and interaction bugs unit tests miss. Perform security analysis using automated tools like Slither and manual review for common vulnerability patterns. Run fuzz tests overnight catching edge cases manual testing overlooks completely.
Deploy to testnet verifying everything works in real blockchain environments rather than just simulators. Test all user flows end-to-end including wallet interactions and external dependencies. Monitor testnet contracts for days catching issues appearing only over time or with real usage patterns. Run final verification checks confirming coverage requirements, acceptable gas costs, and passing security scans.
Pre-deployment checklists ensure nothing gets forgotten. Verify all tests pass without skips or pending tests. Confirm coverage exceeds 90% on critical contracts and 80% overall. Run Slither fixing all high-severity findings. Check common operation gas costs remain reasonable. Verify upgradeability mechanisms work if implemented. Ensure access controls properly restrict sensitive functions. Get professional security audits for contracts managing significant value. Document known limitations and intended behavior clearly.
Conclusion
Effective testing and debugging is what separates professionals from folks paying tuition in production. Because blockchains are immutable, mistakes stick and can get expensive fast. Treat testing as risk management: write unit tests for each function, add integration tests to validate cross-contract flows, include fuzzing to flush out edge cases, and layer in security analysis for known attack patterns. Use the right tools for the job: Hardhat for a smooth developer experience, Foundry for speed and Solidity-native workflows, Slither for static analysis, and Tenderly plus block explorers for step-through debugging. Together, these keep bugs from graduating to mainnet.
Security should drive every decision. Write tests that try to break your own contracts, automate checks for reentrancy, access control slips, and arithmetic quirks, and bring in professional audits when real money will touch the code. Testing is never “done,” because new exploits and patterns keep showing up. Stay current with research, study public postmortems, refine your suite, and iterate. The ecosystem gets safer only when developers take testing seriously enough to ship contracts that are actually secure.
Summary
Effective testing and debugging requires understanding blockchain’s unique challenges: immutability, financial stakes, gas costs. Comprehensive approaches combine unit testing for individual functions, integration testing for system behavior, fuzz testing discovering edge cases, and security testing targeting vulnerabilities. Essential tools include Hardhat for JavaScript integration, Foundry for Solidity-native performance, and Slither for automated analysis. Debugging uses console.log during development, Tenderly for transaction simulation, block explorers for production issues. Best practices emphasize Test-Driven Development, test independence, high coverage, continuous integration. Security testing specifically targets reentrancy, access control flaws, integer issues, oracle manipulation. Professional workflows progress systematically from unit tests through security analysis and testnet deployment before mainnet. Success requires security-first mindset, proper tooling, continuous learning about emerging threats.
FAQs about Test and Debug Smart Contracts
How to test and debug smart contracts effectively?
Use a layered approach: unit tests for each function, integration tests for contract systems, fuzz tests for edge cases, and security tests for known attacks. Pair Hardhat or Foundry with Slither, coverage, gas reporters, Tenderly, and block explorers. Automate everything in CI and gate deployments on passing checks.
Hardhat vs Foundry for smart contract testing — which is better?
Hardhat shines for JS/TS teams, plugins, and DX; Foundry is blazing fast and Solidity-native with built-in fuzzing. Many teams use both: Hardhat for workflow and scripting, Foundry for speed, invariants, and fuzz. Pick the one your team can run daily without friction.
How do I fuzz test Solidity contracts (Foundry/Echidna quick start)?
Define invariants (what must always be true), mark parameters for fuzzing, and assert them under randomized inputs. In Foundry, write invariant and property tests; in Echidna, specify properties and let it generate sequences. Failures expose edge-case bugs you wouldn’t handwrite.
How do I debug a failed Ethereum transaction (revert) fast?
Grab the tx on a block explorer to read revert data and logs. Reproduce locally: fork mainnet, run the call with a debugger, and add console.log (Hardhat) for variables. Use Tenderly’s simulator for full traces and gas hotspots. Fix, re-run, then add a regression test.
What test coverage and CI pipeline do I need for Solidity?
Aim ~90% on funds-touching/core contracts and ~80% overall. CI should run unit, integration, fuzz/invariant tests, slither, coverage, and gas checks on every PR. Block merges if coverage drops or high-severity findings appear; auto-deploy to testnets and run end-to-end flows before mainnet.
Glossary
Test Coverage: Measurement of code executed during testing, expressed as percentage. High coverage doesn’t guarantee correctness but low coverage definitely indicates insufficient testing.
Fuzz Testing: Automated testing generating random inputs to find edge cases and vulnerabilities. Particularly effective for smart contracts where unexpected inputs cause security issues or crashes.
Mock Contract: Fake contract implementation used during testing to simulate external dependencies. Mocks provide controlled behavior and let you test in isolation without deploying actual dependencies.
Test Fixture: Reusable setup code establishing known state before tests run. Fixtures improve test efficiency avoiding redundant setup and ensure consistent starting conditions.
Assertion: Statement in tests verifying expected conditions are true. Failed assertions indicate code doesn’t behave as expected.
Invariant: Property or condition that must always remain true regardless of operations performed. Invariant testing verifies these properties hold under all circumstances, catching violations indicating bugs.
Symbolic Execution: Analysis technique executing programs with symbolic rather than concrete input values, exploring multiple execution paths simultaneously. Tools like Mythril use symbolic execution for vulnerability detection.
Static Analysis: Examining code without executing it, identifying potential issues through pattern matching and rule-based analysis. Static analysis tools like Slither catch common vulnerabilities quickly.
Reentrancy: Vulnerability where external contract calls recursively callback into original contract before state updates complete, potentially allowing unauthorized operations. One of the most dangerous smart contract vulnerabilities.
Stack Trace: Detailed report showing the sequence of function calls leading to errors. Smart contract stack traces help identify exactly where and why transactions failed.
Gas Profiling: Analyzing gas consumption during contract execution to identify inefficiencies and optimization opportunities. Essential for ensuring contracts remain economically viable for users.
Continuous Integration: Practice of automatically building and testing code on every change. CI catches integration problems early and ensures all tests pass before code reaches production.
Crypto market today: XRP price eyes $3 breakout; John Bollinger warns Bitcoin may not be bottoming; Shiba Inu team has penned a crucial message for the SHIB community.
Citigroup teams up with Coinbase to simplify crypto-to-fiat payments for corporate clients.
Citi plans to integrate stablecoin payments, boosting speed and 24/7 transaction access.
Coinbase expands institutional reach as Wall Street embraces blockchain innovation.
Citigroup Inc. and Coinbase Global Inc. are partnering to enhance digital-asset payment solutions for the bank’s corporate clients, marking another major step by a traditional financial institution toward embracing blockchain technology.
The collaboration reflects Wall Street’s growing interest in digital assets after years of regulatory caution and market volatility.
The initiative aims to make it easier for Citi’s institutional clients to move funds between cryptocurrencies and traditional fiat currencies — a long-standing challenge in the digital economy.
The move comes as banks and payment providers increasingly explore blockchain to enable faster, cheaper, and more efficient transactions across global financial networks.
Citi eyes faster, programmable payments
The initial phase of the Citi-Coinbase partnership will focus on simplifying the process of converting crypto to fiat and vice versa, particularly for cross-border transactions.
Debopama Sen, head of payments for Citi Services, said the bank’s clients are increasingly seeking innovations that go beyond traditional transaction models.
Citi’s clients want “programmability and conditional payments and other cost and speed and efficiency aspects,” Sen said, emphasizing the growing demand for payment systems that can operate continuously and offer greater flexibility than conventional financial rails.
Sen added that Citi is also “exploring solutions to really enable on-chain stablecoin payments for our clients” in the coming months, noting that stablecoins could play a key role in the evolution of corporate payment infrastructure.
“Stablecoins will be another enabler in the digital payment ecosystem,” she said.
“It’ll help grow the space, it’ll help grow functionality for our clients.”
Stablecoins — cryptocurrencies typically pegged to fiat currencies such as the US dollar — have become one of the most promising use cases for blockchain technology.
They combine the efficiency of digital payments with the relative stability of traditional money, making them increasingly attractive for corporate transactions and settlements.
Stablecoins seen as cornerstone of digital finance growth
Citi’s “Future of Finance” team, led by Ronit Ghose, has projected that the global stablecoin market could surpass $1 trillion within five years, up from about $300 billion today.
This growth outlook underscores how blockchain-based assets are rapidly evolving from speculative investments to tools for practical financial operations.
The collaboration with Coinbase follows Citi’s earlier introduction of a blockchain platform that enables institutional clients to move tokenized deposits around the clock within the bank’s internal network.
This system offers clients real-time settlement capabilities, reducing the delays and costs associated with traditional payment systems such as ACH and wire transfers.
Coinbase’s institutional infrastructure expands
Coinbase, one of the world’s leading digital-asset exchanges, brings extensive infrastructure and experience to the partnership.
The company works with more than 250 banks and financial institutions globally, according to Brian Foster, Coinbase’s global head of crypto-as-a-service.
“Coinbase has spent years developing very specialized infrastructure,” Foster told Bloomberg News, adding that traditional financial institutions are increasingly seeking partnerships across various crypto-related services — from spot and derivatives trading to custody, staking, and payments.
Foster said that growing interest in stablecoins, crypto exchange-traded funds (ETFs), and tokenized assets is prompting more financial institutions to engage with blockchain-based systems.
As Citigroup and Coinbase explore new ways to bridge traditional banking and digital assets, their collaboration signals how mainstream finance is steadily integrating blockchain into its infrastructure — moving beyond experimentation toward real-world adoption.
Reliance Global Group adds Solana to diversify its financial holdings.
The company’s crypto portfolio includes exposure to Bitcoin, Ethereum, XRP and Cardano.
Investing in Solana allows Reliance to proactively embrace blockchain innovation.
Reliance Global Group Inc. (NASDAQ: RELI) has expanded its cryptocurrency portfolio with the addition of Solana (SOL), marking another step in its ongoing digital asset treasury strategy.
The move positions the company among a growing list of publicly traded firms integrating blockchain-based assets into their corporate balance sheets.
The announcement, made on October 27, 2025, confirms that Reliance now holds five of the top ten cryptocurrencies by market capitalization — Bitcoin, Ethereum, Cardano, XRP, and Solana.
The addition underscores the company’s belief in the long-term potential of blockchain technology and its applications in both finance and enterprise innovation.
Reliance expands its Blockchain exposure
Reliance’s decision to purchase Solana represents a milestone in its broader digital asset diversification strategy.
The company described the acquisition as part of its disciplined approach to building exposure across major blockchain ecosystems.
“By adding Solana alongside Bitcoin, Ethereum, Cardano, and XRP, we continue to execute our disciplined strategy of diversifying across leading blockchain ecosystems,” said Moshe Fishman, a member of the Reliance Global Group Crypto Advisory Board and Director of Insurtech at Reliance. “Solana represents the next generation of blockchain performance — built for real-world adoption and institutional-scale applications.”
Solana, currently the sixth-largest cryptocurrency by market capitalization at over $110 billion, has become increasingly attractive to corporate treasuries and institutional investors.
Known for its hybrid Proof-of-Stake and Proof-of-History consensus mechanisms, Solana can process over 65,000 transactions per second, with blocks confirming in about 400 milliseconds.
The blockchain’s scalability and efficiency have made it a favored platform for decentralized finance (DeFi), non-fungible tokens (NFTs), and Web3 applications.
Fishman noted that expanding into Solana aligns with Reliance’s commitment to innovation while maintaining a balanced approach to governance, security, and compliance.
Institutional interest in Solana grows
Solana’s inclusion in Reliance’s treasury comes amid growing institutional and corporate interest in the blockchain.
Its expanding ecosystem — spanning DeFi protocols, tokenized real-world assets, and NFT platforms — continues to drive adoption.
Market analysts point to the increasing appeal of Solana as a potential treasury asset, bolstered by the anticipation of regulatory approval for spot Solana exchange-traded funds (ETFs).
The token traded near $200 on October 27, reflecting broader optimism surrounding blockchain utility and scalability.
Reliance’s move follows similar announcements by other public companies in recent months, as corporate treasuries diversify away from traditional assets to hedge against inflation and capture long-term value in digital markets.
Solana treasury companies
The addition of Solana to Reliance Global Group’s treasury is a strategic effort that many other public companies have tapped into across the market.
SOL’s price has largely benefited from the sentiment around these efforts.
While DeFi, NFTs and RWA traction stands out, Solana’s native token has received notable upside momentum from the growing treasury asset plays.
Forward Industries, Solana Company, Upexi, DeFi Development Corp, Sol Strategies and Sharps Technology are among the top SOL treasury companies.
Data from CoinGecko shows the 10 leading public companies cumulatively hold over 15.7 million SOL, currently worth over $3.18 billion.
The maneuver highlights the pressure digital asset treasury stocks face, with many once-high-flying names now trading below the value of the crypto on their books.
Coinbase Global Inc. (NASDAQ: COIN) has partnered with Citigroup Inc. (NYSE: C). The strategic partnership between Citigroup and Collaboration will help democratize stablecoin and crypto payments to both retail and institutional clients.
According to Brian Armstrong, CEO of Coinbase, the collaboration with Citi will work on improving stablecoin utility and digital assets adoption. Furthermore, Citi is a top-tier bank with more than 200 million customers from over 160 nations and jurisdictions.
What’s The Market Impact of Citi’s Collaboration with Coinbase
Bull Market Fuel: Mainstream Crypto Adoption Facilitated by Institutional
The direct impact of Citi’s collaboration with Coinbase is the enhancement of the mainstream adoption of digital assets, amid the ongoing macro bull market. With both entities serving millions of global users, their partnership will enhance crypto liquidity and demand in the short term.
“This collaboration will combine Coinbase’s years of experience building secure, streamlined, and scalable infrastructure for digital assets with Citi’s global payments network that spans 94 markets and over 300 payment clearing systems. Together we’re working to create innovative payment solutions for institutions operating at scale,” Coinbase noted.
Both entities will be building their collaboration on the notable crypto regulatory clarity, especially in the United States. For instance, Citi users will seamlessly access stablecoin payments via Coinbase in a regulated manner through the GENIUS Act.
Stock Market Rebound on Competitive Edge
Following the announcement, COIN shares edged 5% higher on Monday, October 27, to trade about $366 at press time. Investors have gained more confidence in the long-term growth of COIN, since the exchange has an edge over its competitors.
Notably, the COIN stock price in the weekly timeframe has signaled a potential bullish breakout towards market discovery. Meanwhile, Citi’s stock price gained 2% on Monday to trade at about $100.81 at press time.
White House crypto and AI czar David Sacks announced Selig as US President Donald Trump's pick after Brian Quintenz's nomination to lead the regulator was withdrawn.
The tokenized asset marketplace plans to go public next year, joining a wave of crypto companies moving into public markets amid clearer US regulations.
Bitcoin and several major altcoins have started a strong recovery, but the relief rally is expected to face significant headwinds near major overhead resistance levels.
Japan has officially stepped into the regulated stablecoin era with the launch of JPYC EX, the country’s first fully licensed digital yen under the revised Payment Services Act. This milestone marks a pivotal moment for Japan’s financial sector, bridging traditional banking infrastructure with the Web3 ecosystem.
Building on earlier versions of JPYC, the new JPYC EX is designed to serve as a compliant, yen-backed stablecoin connecting the nation’s banking system to blockchain-based commerce, DeFi applications, and cross-border payments. With full legal authorization and asset backing, it positions the yen as a future cornerstone in global digital finance.
According to CryptoQuant, the total stablecoin market capitalization has now surpassed $150 billion, forming the backbone of liquidity for crypto markets, DeFi protocols, and global payments. Analysts from Citi and Bloomberg project that this figure could expand to between $1.6 and $4 trillion by 2030. Within that rapid growth, JPYC is forecasted to capture roughly 2% of the market, reaching a valuation of around $70 billion.
A Fully Regulated Digital Yen Bridging Japan’s Finance and Web3
What distinguishes JPYC EX from other stablecoins is its combination of regulatory clarity, asset backing, and technical versatility. Domestic bank deposits and Japanese government bonds fully collateralize each token, ensuring complete transparency and stability. This structure makes JPYC EX one of the world’s most legally robust stablecoins. A benchmark for compliance-driven innovation in digital finance.
Built on Ethereum, Polygon, and Avalanche, JPYC EX provides instant yen transfers with near-zero fees. Making it a practical tool for businesses and individuals alike. It supports commerce, payroll, peer-to-peer payments, and DeFi applications, offering the efficiency of blockchain without sacrificing legal or operational safeguards.
JPYC EX also aligns closely with Japan’s digital transformation strategy, which aims to merge traditional finance with emerging Web3 systems. By serving as a settlement layer for e-commerce platforms, NFT marketplaces, and cross-border transactions, the stablecoin enables instant yen transfers across Asia, lowering costs and increasing accessibility for international trade.
Looking ahead, analysts forecast JPYC’s market capitalization could reach $70 billion by 2030. It represents roughly 2% of the global stablecoin market. This growth potential underscores Japan’s ambition to establish the digital yen as a key pillar of the decentralized global economy. With its blend of regulatory trust, technological precision, and global reach, JPYC EX may redefine how national currencies operate in the Web3 era.
Stablecoin Dominance Shows a Cooling Phase After Recent Surge
The chart shows that stablecoin market dominance currently sits around 8.31%, following a sharp rise earlier in October that pushed the ratio above 9%. This level often signals heightened demand for liquidity and safety, as traders move capital into stable assets amid market uncertainty.
Over the past few months, dominance has steadily climbed from the 7.3%–7.5% range, reflecting a cautious sentiment as Bitcoin and major altcoins face selling pressure. However, the recent pullback suggests that some funds are beginning to rotate back into risk assets, a potential early sign of market stabilization.
Technically, the dominance remains above both the 50-day and 200-day moving averages, indicating a broader uptrend in liquidity positioning. If this level holds, it may serve as a buffer during continued volatility. Conversely, a sustained drop below 8% could signal that traders are redeploying capital into crypto assets, possibly fueling short-term rallies.
Stablecoin dominance remains elevated — a sign that market participants still prefer holding dry powder. Until dominance begins a more decisive decline, this cautious stance will likely persist, underscoring the market’s fragile balance between risk-off sentiment and the readiness for re-entry into volatile assets.
Featured image from ChatGPT, chart from TradingView.com
Investor sentiment, as shown by trading volume and flows on exchanges, has turned optimistic amidst the recovery. Now that Ethereum’s price action is starting to turn bullish again, a new technical analysis shared by crypto analyst Freedomby40 on the social media platform X suggests that the current rally could be far from over, projecting a possible long-term climb to $16,000.
Wave Count Structure Points To A Continuation Phase
Freedomby40’s analysis, which is based on the Elliott Wave structure, presents Ethereum as currently positioned in an extended bullish sequence that began forming in late 2022. Posting the technical analysis on X, the analyst noted that Ethereum’s price action looks great for a continuation.
His chart shows that the asset has just completed a corrective phase and is entering a renewed impulse wave, with support established between $3,225 and $3,563 at the 0.5 and 0.382 Fibonacci retracement zones, respectively. The analyst labels this zone as the ideal accumulation area for the next leg up, consistent with previous cycle structures seen in 2017 and 2021.
The Elliott Wave projection in his analysis presents a multi-layered confluence of impulse waves extending to the third degree. It illustrates that Ethereum is currently unfolding its fifth major impulse wave in a structure that traces back to mid-2022.
The internal structure of this wave sequence also reveals a C wave in motion, which itself contains smaller sub-impulse waves. Within that C wave, Ethereum appears to be entering its own fifth sub-wave, which is known to be a decisively bullish wave.
Based on this setup, the analyst outlined two potential target zones on the chart: a green box representing the realistic price range for this wave cycle and a red box depicting the higher, more extended scenario that could push Ethereum’s market cap into the trillion-dollar level.
Fibonacci Extensions Predict Targets Of $9,000, $11,000, And $16,000
Freedomby40’s analysis identifies multiple price levels based on Fibonacci extensions from the current price action. The first price target is at $6,303, which is based on the 1.0 Fibonacci extension. This initial price target will see the Ethereum price break above its current all-time high, but this is the first of many.
The next target, the 1.236 extension, is positioned around $9,013. These two price targets ($6,303 and $9,013) were described by the analyst as very realistic. Possible extensions are at the 1.382 and 1.618 Fibonacci extension levels, corresponding to $11,210 and $16,077, respectively.
At the time of writing, Ethereum is trading at $4,160, up by 5.2% in the past 24 hours. Freedomby40’s outlook joins a growing list of ultra-bullish Ethereum price forecasts from institutional research desks and top analysts. Standard Chartered Bank recently raised its 2025 price target for Ethereum to $7,500, while projecting a potential long-term path to $25,000 by 2028.
Crypto analyst Bobby A is warning that the XRP price may face trouble soon. He says the large monthly chart is showing weak signs, and this could mean the market is turning bearish again. The analyst thinks the price might need to drop further before it can move higher.
Bearish Signals Showing On The XRP Price Monthly Chart
Bobby A says the big XRP chart does not look healthy right now. He explains that many important monthly indicators are crossing bearishly. He says XRP is trading below the 1.618 level, and the price action there looks like a rejection rather than a breakout. He thinks this rejection is happening at a terrible time for XRP, noting that the monthly candle is closing near the BMSB line, another dangerous sign for the price.
Bobby A reminds traders that when the Bressert indicator crosses bearish on the monthly chart, history shows it has never been good for XRP. He believes that history could repeat itself, and these bearish signals are evident on the chart right now, suggesting the mid-term trend may not be strong. His analysis says that in six days, XRP will be facing the monthly candle close again, and facing it while price action is weak is usually not a good sign. He is worried because the chart’s overall structure shows more weakness than strength at this time.
He explains that when a chart shows this kind of technical damage, the smart move is to stay alert. He says traders must focus on risk control during times when the big charts start to flash warning signs. He shares this because he has trusted his chart study before when XRP was under $0.30, and now he needs to trust what he sees again with XRP above $2. He says the market can change very fast, and traders must be ready for those changes.
XRP May Drop To Lower Support Before Moving Up Again
Right now, XRP is already making a small move downward. Bobby A says this retracement is happening in real time. He warns that XRP could roll over again and retest lower price support levels. If this happens, the token price could fall under $1 to find more substantial support before it tries to recover. He believes there is a real and present risk that the price will crash below $1 if sellers keep pushing it down.
He advises traders to protect their money and manage their trades carefully. He says capital safety must come first in times like these. Even though he still believes in XRP’s long-term future and remains a strong supporter of the project, he feels the odds right now point to lower prices in the mid-term. He says this is because the latest market signs are not strong enough to support a big bullish move yet.
This article was first published on The Bit Journal: Why is Ripple CEO emphasizing the role of XRP in Ripple’s future strategy despite the growing influence of stablecoin RLUSD? Read on to discover.
Ripple CEO Brad Garlinghouse has reaffirmed XRP’s role in Ripple’s future strategy. Saying that XRP wasn’t simply a token, the CEO stated that it was central to Ripple’s entire ecosystem and daily operations.
The Center of Everything Ripple Does
According to a statement by the chief executive on the social media platform X, Garlinghouse said that even as the company continued building other solutions to enable the Internet of Value, the role of XRP remained at the center of everything. He made the statement after completing a $1.25 billion acquisition of the prime brokerage platform Hidden Road, which has since been renamed Ripple Prime. Commenting on Ripple’s future strategy, Garlinghouse stated:
“With today’s close of Hidden Road (now Ripple Prime), Ripple has announced 5 major acquisitions in ~2 years (GTreasury last week, Rail in August, Standard Custody in 2024, Metaco in 2023) […] As we continue to build solutions to enable an Internet of Value, I’m reminding you all that XRP sits at the center of everything Ripple does. Lock in.”
Grant Greater Access to Traders
Ripple’s future strategy has involved several acquisitions, such as Hidden Road, aimed at strengthening XRP’s role and improving its liquidity. As a result, it will now be easier for users to buy, sell, and use XRP, enabling more individual traders and institutions to access the token.
According to Ripple President Monica Long, “the future ahead is mighty bright,” since the firm intended to use the deal to unlock utility for both XRP and new stablecoin RLUSD. Long noted that RLUSD was already being used as collateral in prime brokerage products and that Ripple Prime was exploring additional ways to use XRP.
The Center of Ripple’s Future Strategy
While stablecoin RLUSD was already receiving increased market focus, Garlinghouse stated that XRP would continue to serve as a bridge asset within its On-Demand Liquidity (ODL) solution, which has now been rebranded as Ripple Payments. Addressing concerns that an emphasis on stablecoin RLUSD would diminish XRP’s role, Garlinghouse reassured the XRP community that XRP would remain at the center of Ripple’s future strategy. He further stated:
“XRP is the heart of Ripple’s strategy. We are committed to ensuring its continued role in our ecosystem.”
Conclusion
Even amid ongoing global expansion and strategic acquisitions, the company’s entire leadership has reassured users that XRP’s role within the Ripple ecosystem remains intact. Garlinghouse states that the token was not simply a cryptocurrency, as Ripple’s future strategy was founded on.
Ripple’s infrastructure has been designed to complement XRP’s utility and ensure that it remains the central cog of the firm’s growing portfolio.
As Ripple’s influence expands globally, it will be interesting to see how the company places the token as central to its success in the digital asset market.
Glossary to Key Terms
Ripple: A blockchain-based digital payment company that has created a network and protocol that uses the cryptocurrency XRP and the XRP Ledger.
XRP: A digital asset that serves as the native cryptocurrency for the XRP Ledger (XRPL), an open-source, decentralized blockchain built for fast and low-cost global payments.
RLUSD: Also known as Ripple USD, it’s the official Ripple stablecoin, pegged 1:1 to the U.S. Dollar and built on the XRP Ledger. Designed for instant payments and institutional use, RLUSD brings together stability, compliance, and speed, connecting the traditional financial world with on-chain liquidity.
Frequently Asked Questions about XRP
What are the interesting facts about XRP?
XRP is sometimes referred to as “the banker’s coin,” and for that reason, XRP was originally used for sending cross-border remittances. Today, the primary use case for XRP is making high-value cross-border payments.
What Can I Buy or Pay for With XRP?
Online stores, gift card sites, and some businesses accept XRP for goods and services. Many payment gateways (like Bitpay) integrate XRP as a payment method.
Is XRP Used Outside of Crypto Trading?
Yes. Ripple Labs partners with major banks and payment providers to enable XRP for real-world cross-border payments (e.g., remittances and B2B payment services).
Can I use XRP to transfer money overseas?
Yes. XRP is designed for fast, low-cost international transfers. Many remittance services integrate XRP into their workflows.
Mike Selig has just been nominated by President Donald Trump to lead the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC).
According to multiple reports, crypto regulator Mike Selig is currently the chief counsel for the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) Crypto Task Force and has experience at the CFTC under former chair Chris Giancarlo.
The nomination comes as the Trump administration is trying to refine the regulation, oversight, and institutional framework of the digital assets space.
Who is Crypto Regulator Mike Selig?
Mike Selig’s background is a mix of traditional financial regulation and crypto-policy experience. He’s currently Chief Counsel for the SEC’s Crypto Task Force and has advised SEC Chair Jay Clayton.
Before that, he worked at the CFTC as a law clerk or counsel and was a partner at the law firm Willkie Farr & Gallagher, specializing in asset-management and digital-asset regulation.
He’s publicly commented on the classification of digital assets, including saying in 2023 that “XRP itself is simply computer code. A fungible commodity, like gold or whiskey.”
Hence, experts say he would bring regulatory gravitas and crypto awareness to the role.
The Timing and Strategy Behind the Nomination
Selig’s nomination comes at a time when the U.S. regulatory framework for crypto is in flux. Legislation like the CLARITY Act and the GENIUS Act are being set to clarify which agency oversees which types of digital assets.
Reports share that the CFTC and SEC just had joint discussions to eliminate fragmentation in crypto oversight. Crypto regulator Mike Selig is to replaces a previously stalled candidate, Brian Quintenz, whose appointment was met with industry push-back.
White House crypto adviser David Sacks described Selig as “deeply knowledgeable about financial markets and passionate about modernizing our regulatory approach” in his announcement.
What Selig’s Nomination Means for Crypto Markets
With Selig in charge, the CFTC may get more responsibility in the digital-asset space. The nomination is about the agency’s role in overseeing commodities and derivatives, including digital asset-related products.
Sources reported that Selig is charged with just as the CFTC is expected to take on new authority over the nearly $4 trillion crypto market.
Moreover, Selig’s comments and analysis of the Ripple Labs litigation show he’s comfortable classifying digital assets as commodities rather than securities, a big holding block in regulatory terms.
His appointment may make market participants open up more access to regulated platforms and vehicles.
Agency Boundaries and Oversight
The big question in crypto regulation has been jurisdiction: which agency regulates what? The SEC has always focused on securities, while the CFTC handles commodities and derivatives.
Crypto regulator Mike Selig’s nomination aligns with recent signals of cooperation between the two agencies. A joint roundtable held in September featured SEC Chairman Atkins and acting CFTC Chair Caroline Pham saying they would end decades of regulatory fragmentation.
Selig’s nomination reinforces that. According to expert analysis, his dual agency background means he can streamline overlapping regulatory mandates. That could mean clearer paths for token classification, custody frameworks, and digital-asset exchanges, fewer grey areas for issuers and investors.
Industry Reaction and Outlook
Industry has welcomed the nomination. The crypto community noted his previous comments and legal positions align with the adoption of digital assets. Charles Hoskinson, founder of Cardano, wrote on X:
“Chairman Selig is going to do a great job at the CFTC. I have full confidence in his ability and leadership.”
The media also said crypto regulator Mike Selig is seen as a market-friendly regulator compared to previous enforcement-heavy regimes. While confirmation by the Senate is still needed, the nomination itself is a signal that the regulatory environment may favor of more structured crypto oversight.
Conclusion
Crypto regulator Mike Selig’s nomination as CFTC chair means a big change for digital-asset oversight in the US. With experience at both the SEC and CFTC, Selig is put uo to lead at a moment of regulatory convergence, institutional engagement and legislative momentum.
His nomination means the US is doubling down on its goal to be a global hub for crypto innovation, with clearer rules and coordinated oversight.
The impact is expected to be far-reaching, from institutional access to token classification, custody services, and trading venues.
Glossary
CFTC: US regulatory agency that oversees commodity futures, options, and derivatives.
SEC: US federal agency; that enforces securities laws and regulates securities markets.
Crypto-Task Force: A unit within the SEC, focused on crypto-asset regulation, compliance, and enforcement.
Token classification: The legal determination of whether a digital asset is a security, commodity, or other asset class with regulatory implications.
Confirmation (Senate): The process by which the US Senate approves presidential nominees for agency leadership.
Regulatory convergence: The alignment of rules, mandates, and enforcement approaches across multiple agencies, to reduce conflict and overlap.
Frequently Asked Questions About Crypto Regulator Mike Selig
Who is Mike Selig and why is his background important?
Mike Selig is the current chief counsel for the SEC’s Crypto Task Force, previously worked at the CFTC and in private practice focused on asset-management and digital-asset regulation.
Why is this big for crypto?
He’s being nominated at a time of regulatory flux and legislative movement so clarity on oversight, token classification and institutional access might be seen.
What will the CFTC do under his leadership?
He may expand CFTC oversight of digital assets treated as commodities or derivatives and coordinate more with the SEC on securities-type tokens.
Is the nomination confirmed?
As of the latest report; he’s been nominated but still needs Senate confirmation before he can take the chair.
How is the crypto community reacting?
Many are positive; citing his prior legal commentary and regulatory experience. For example; Cardano’s founder is fully confident in his ability to lead the CFTC.
When market experts, watchers and enthusiasts speak of bull market in crypto, wild rallies, retail joy and altcoins mooning, are easily brought to mind . However, this cycle seems different. For many, the term crypto bull market no longer means euphoric highs, it feels like a grind.
The blockchains are active, big-name institutions are all in and the charts are up. But the energy and optimism of past cycles is missing. This is the backdrop that is making experts question why this crypto bull market grind has emerged, what’s shaping it and how it’s different from 2017 and 2021.
Institutions Took Over the Room
The tale around this cycle starts with institutions. Certain market reports call 2025 the year the “world went on-chain”, highlighting institutional adoption and stablecoins as the main themes. Traditional banking, asset management, and fintech firms have dabbled and built infrastructure, custody networks, and tokenization platforms.
As a recent sources put it, they say financial institutions have embraced crypto after years of watching from the sidelines.
This has changed the market. Instead of chasing altcoin hype, many big players are focused on regulated corridors, institutional custody and real-world asset tokenization.
In effect; they own the pipes through which retail traders must flow. The result therefore is that the cycle looks more like the maturation of crypto’s financial plumbing and less like the wild west of earlier years.
Memecoins Became the Culture Engine and the Drain
While institutions professionalized the space, the opposite force roared from the grassroots which are meme coins. Humor, irony and community tokens exploded across chains, changing the tone of the cycle. According to sources, what began as satire became the dominant narrative of 2024 and 2025.
Data shows meme coin market is still growing but in a weird way. In 2025, it is estimated to be 5-7% of global crypto market-cap, or $80-90 billion.
Platforms like Pump.fun on Solana enabled millions of tokens to launch, but most traders lost money while infrastructure owners made the money.
That changed the psychology of the cycle. Retail that once chased broad altcoin seasons found themselves playing mini-token launches and the odds were stacked against the individual.
The meme coin culture thrived but the era of alt-season joy became harder to sustain.
Macro Pressures Squeezed Risk Appetite
Beyond institutions and meme culture, the macro environment has had a big impact on this crypto bull market grind. High interest rates, risk-off sentiment and liquidity constraints reportedly killed speculative flows. And indeed in 2025, capital seems more expensive and speculative asset classes (many altcoins included) have fewer positive developments.
As a result, even though Bitcoin is at new highs, the rest of the market feels flat, lethargic or brutally repressed.
The interplay of institutional adoption which favors big, regulated assets, and macro caution which limits speculative leverage has created a cycle where growth exists but feels thin, incremental and far less exciting than previous bull runs.
Bitcoin’s Role in a Changing Narrative
Bitcoin on its own stays as the anchor. According to multiple market sources, Bitcoin price appreciation and growing legitimacy are backed by macro- and regulatory-driven forces not just hype. Reports say Bitcoin is core to crypto’s maturation.
This means the crypto bull market grind is less about risk-on altcoin explosions and more about consolidation, institutional ingress and standards of infrastructure.
For many in crypto, that is less exciting, but arguably more sustainable. The sentiment has shifted as this cycle is reinforcing the system rather than igniting wild outsized alts.
Conclusion
Combining these threads, a clearer picture of why the crypto bull market grind feels so different is obtained.
Institutional adoption has increased legitimacy but also anchored expectations around regulated assets rather than speculative up-swings.
Meme coins dominate cultural narratives but the upside is skewed and the environment is highly competitive and treacherous.
Macro conditions has restrained speculative flows and forced the market into a slower growth mode.
Bitcoin’s dominance means the broader market is less about wild rallies and more about incremental infrastructure growth and asset re-classification.
In short, this bull cycle is about transition from frontier experimentation to a more integrated, regulated, infrastructure-led phase of crypto.
This removes some of the fireworks but replaces them with the architecture of a financial system. For many who came for the “number goes up” style ride, the word “grind” feels apt.
Glossary
Altcoin: Any cryptocurrency other than Bitcoin.
Institutional adoption: The participation of big financial firms (banks; asset managers); in crypto assets and infrastructure.
Meme coin: A cryptocurrency built around internet memes; jokes or viral culture, with little underlying use.
Macro: Broad economic factors like interest rates, liquidity; inflation and risk appetite that affect asset markets.
Tokenization: Creating digital tokens to represent ownership of real-world assets; on a blockchain.
Bull: A market where prices are up everyone is positive and more people are buying.
Frequently Asked Questions About Crypto Bull Market Grind
Why does the 2025 crypto bull market feel different from past cycles?
Because the market is being shaped by institutional infrastructure; meme coin culture and macro constraints rather than widespread retail frenzy and broad alt-season surges.
Are meme coins still important in this cycle?
Yes, they are still culturally prominent and active, but their value dynamics are different. The infrastructure around them captures most of the returns and the environment is more competitive and less favorable for the average retail trader.
Is Bitcoin dominating because of maturity rather than hype?
Exactly. Bitcoin’s increasing institutional support; regulatory clarity and role as a foundational asset means it’s less subject to wild swings and more aligned with long-term finance systems.
Does this mean altcoins are dead?
Not dead, but altcoins face a tougher environment. With less speculative capital, more scrutiny and higher expectations for utility, only those with strong fundamentals and product-market fit are likely to perform.
As Cardano struggles to recover from the recent downturn, enthusiasts are debating the potential impact burns could have on ADA’s price. Cardano is gradually recovering from the recent downturn that pushed its price below the $0.35 mark on October 10.